org-mode/doc/org-manual.org

21511 lines
764 KiB
Org Mode
Raw Normal View History

2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+title: The Org Manual
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @insertcopying
* Introduction
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Getting started.
:END:
#+cindex: introduction
** Summary
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Brief summary of what Org does.
:END:
#+cindex: summary
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and project
planning with a fast and effective plain-text markup language. It
also is an authoring system with unique support for literate
programming and reproducible research.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org is implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to
keep the content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling
and structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily
created with a built-in table editor. Plain text URL-like links
connect to websites, emails, Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any
files related to the projects.
Org develops organizational tasks around notes files that contain
lists or information about projects as plain text. Project planning
and task management make use of metadata which is part of an outline
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
node. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in
queries and create dynamic /agenda views/ that also integrate the
Emacs calendar and diary. Org can be used to implement many different
project planning schemes, such as David Allen's GTD system.
Org files can serve as a single source authoring system with export to
many different formats such as HTML, LaTeX, Open Document, and
Markdown. New export backends can be derived from existing ones, or
defined from scratch.
Org files can include source code blocks, which makes Org uniquely
suited for authoring technical documents with code examples. Org
source code blocks are fully functional; they can be evaluated in
place and their results can be captured in the file. This makes it
possible to create a single file reproducible research compendium.
Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should feel
like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when needed.
Org is a toolbox. Many users actually run only a---very
personal---fraction of Org's capabilities, and know that there is more
whenever they need it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
All of this is achieved with strictly plain text files, the most
portable and future-proof file format. Org runs in Emacs. Emacs is
one of the most widely ported programs, so that Org mode is available
on every major platform.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: FAQ
There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest version
of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked questions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
(FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
[[https://orgmode.org]].
#+cindex: print edition
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
An earlier version (7.3) of this manual is available as a [[http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/][paperback
book from Network Theory Ltd.]].
** Installation
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Installing Org.
:END:
#+cindex: installation
Org is included in all recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you
probably do not need to install it. Most users will simply activate
Org and begin exploring its many features.
If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top of this
pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it:
- by using the Emacs package system;
- by downloading Org as an archive; or
- by using Org's git repository.
We *strongly recommend* sticking to a single installation method.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Using Emacs packaging system
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you
install Elisp libraries. You can install Org with {{{kbd(M-x
package-install RET org)}}}.
#+attr_texinfo: :tag Important
#+begin_quote
You need to do this in a session where no =.org= file has been
visited, i.e., where no Org built-in function have been loaded.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Otherwise autoload Org functions will mess up the installation.
#+end_quote
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Then, to make sure your Org configuration is taken into account,
initialize the package system with =(package-initialize)= in your
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Emacs init file before setting any Org option. If you want to use
Org's package repository, check out the [[https://orgmode.org/elpa.html][Org ELPA page]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Downloading Org as an archive
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
You can download Org latest release from [[https://orgmode.org/][Org's website]]. In this case,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
make sure you set the load-path correctly in your Emacs init file:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not
included in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the =contrib/=
directory to your load-path:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your
system. Run =make help= to list compilation and installation options.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Using Org's git repository
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this:
#+begin_example
$ cd ~/src/
$ git clone git@code.orgmode.org:bzg/org-mode.git
$ cd org-mode/
$ make autoloads
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that in this case, ~make autoloads~ is mandatory: it defines
Org's version in =org-version.el= and Org's autoloads in
=org-loaddefs.el=.
Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method
above.
You can also compile with =make=, generate the documentation with
=make doc=, create a local configuration with =make config= and
install Org with =make install=. Please run =make help= to get the
list of compilation/installation options.
For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the
Org Build System page on [[https://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html][Worg]].
** Activation
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to activate Org for certain buffers.
:END:
#+cindex: activation
#+cindex: autoload
#+cindex: ELPA
#+cindex: global key bindings
#+cindex: key bindings, global
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode buffers need Font Lock to be turned on: this is the default
in Emacs[fn:1].
There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
packages (see [[*Packages that conflict with Org mode]]). Please take the
time to check the list.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda
#+findex: org-capture
#+findex: org-store-link
For a better experience, the three Org commands ~org-store-link~,
~org-capture~ and ~org-agenda~ ought to be accessible anywhere in
Emacs, not just in Org buffers. To that effect, you need to bind them
to globally available keys, like the ones reserved for users (see
[[info:elisp::Key%20Binding%20Conventions]]). Here are suggested
bindings, please modify the keys to your own liking.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(global-set-key (kbd "C-c l") 'org-store-link)
(global-set-key (kbd "C-c a") 'org-agenda)
(global-set-key (kbd "C-c c") 'org-capture)
#+end_src
#+cindex: Org mode, turning on
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Files with the =.org= extension use Org mode by default. To turn on
Org mode in a file that does not have the extension =.org=, make the
first line of a file look like this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
#+vindex: org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
which selects Org mode for this buffer no matter what the file's name
is. See also the variable ~org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file~.
Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is /active/. To
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
make use of this, you need to have ~transient-mark-mode~ turned on,
which is the default. If you do not like ~transient-mark-mode~, you
can create an active region by using the mouse to select a region, or
pressing {{{kbd(C-SPC)}}} twice before moving point.
** Feedback
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Bug reports, ideas, patches, etc.
:END:
#+cindex: feedback
#+cindex: bug reports
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: reporting a bug
#+cindex: maintainer
#+cindex: author
If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or
2018-04-26 07:37:58 -04:00
ideas about it, please send an email to the Org mailing list
[[mailto:emacs-orgmode@gnu.org]]. You can subscribe to the list [[https://lists.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/emacs-orgmode][from this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
web page]]. If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will
be passed to the list after a moderator has approved it[fn:2].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-version
#+findex: org-submit-bug-report
For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it
is quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug
persists, prepare a report and provide as much information as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
possible, including the version information of Emacs ({{{kbd(M-x
emacs-version)}}}) and Org ({{{kbd(M-x org-version)}}}), as well as
the Org related setup in the Emacs init file. The easiest way to do
this is to use the command
: M-x org-submit-bug-report <RET>
#+texinfo: @noindent
which puts all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so that you
only need to add your description. If you are not sending the Email
from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email
program.
Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or
Org mode setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start
Emacs with minimal customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so
often helps you determine if the problem is with your customization or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
with Org mode itself. You can start a typical minimal session with
a command like the example below.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal
setup is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as =emacs -Q=. The =minimal-org.el= setup file can have contents as
shown below.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'.
;; Activate debugging.
(setq debug-on-error t
debug-on-signal nil
debug-on-quit nil)
;; Add latest Org mode to load path.
(add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
(add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
#+end_src
If an error occurs, a "backtrace" can be very useful---see below on
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
how to create one. Often a small example file helps, along with clear
information about:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
1. What exactly did you do?
2. What did you expect to happen?
3. What happened instead?
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Thank you for helping to improve this program.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** How to create a useful backtrace
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: backtrace of an error
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If working with Org produces an error with a message you do not
understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a backtrace. This
is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
1. Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The
backtrace contains much more information if it is produced with
uncompiled code. To do this, use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: C-u M-x org-reload <RET>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or, from the menu: Org \rarr Refresh/Reload \rarr Reload Org uncompiled.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2. Then, activate the debugger:
2018-03-05 11:34:40 -05:00
: M-x toggle-debug-or-error <RET>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or, from the menu: Options \rarr Enter Debugger on Error.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
3. Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Do not forget to
document the steps you take.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
4. When you hit the error, a =*Backtrace*= buffer appears on the
screen. Save this buffer to a file---for example using {{{kbd(C-x
C-w)}}}---and attach it to your bug report.
** Typesetting Conventions Used in this Manual
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Typesetting conventions used in this manual.
:ALT_TITLE: Conventions
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org uses various syntactical elements: TODO keywords, tags, property
names, keywords, blocks, etc. In this manual we use the following
conventions:
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- =TODO=, =WAITING= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
user-defined.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =boss=, =ARCHIVE= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Tags are case-sensitive. User-defined tags are written in
lowercase; built-in tags with special meaning are written as they
should appear in the document, usually with all capitals.
- =Release=, =PRIORITY= ::
User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
special meaning are written with all capitals.
- =TITLE=, =BEGIN= ... =END= ::
Keywords and blocks are written in uppercase to enhance their
readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Key bindings and commands
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for
different functions, depending on context. The command that is bound
to such keys has a generic name, like ~org-metaright~. In the manual
we will, wherever possible, give the function that is internally
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
called by the generic command. For example, in the chapter on
document structure, {{{kbd(M-RIGHT)}}} will be listed to call
~org-do-demote~, while in the chapter on tables, it will be listed to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
call ~org-table-move-column-right~.
* Document Structure
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: A tree works like your brain.
:END:
#+cindex: document structure
#+cindex: structure of document
Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
edit the structure of the document.
** Outlines
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Org is based on Outline mode.
:END:
#+cindex: outlines
#+cindex: Outline mode
Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a document
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which, least for me, is
the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview of this
structure is achieved by folding, i.e., hiding large parts of the
document to show only the general document structure and the parts
currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of outlines
by compressing the entire show and hide functionalities into a single
command, ~org-cycle~, which is bound to the {{{kbd(TAB)}}} key.
** Headlines
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to typeset Org tree headlines.
:END:
#+cindex: headlines
#+cindex: outline tree
#+vindex: org-special-ctrl-a/e
#+vindex: org-special-ctrl-k
#+vindex: org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in
Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin[fn:3]. For
example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Top level headline
,** Second level
,*** Third level
some text
,*** Third level
more text
,* Another top level headline
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-footnote-section
The name defined in ~org-footnote-section~ is reserved. Do not use it
as a title for your own headings.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an outline
that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline starters.
See [[*A Cleaner Outline View]].
#+vindex: org-cycle-separator-lines
An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
is hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at least
two empty lines, one empty line remains visible after folding the
subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the variable
~org-cycle-separator-lines~ to modify this behavior.
** Visibility Cycling
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Show and hide, much simplified.
:END:
#+cindex: cycling, visibility
#+cindex: visibility cycling
#+cindex: trees, visibility
#+cindex: show hidden text
#+cindex: hide text
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Global and local cycling
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Cycling through various visibility states.
:END:
#+cindex: subtree visibility states
#+cindex: subtree cycling
#+cindex: folded, subtree visibility state
#+cindex: children, subtree visibility state
#+cindex: subtree, subtree visibility state
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
Org uses just two commands, bound to {{{kbd(TAB)}}} and
{{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} (~org-cycle~) ::
#+kindex: TAB
#+findex: org-cycle
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
/Subtree cycling/: Rotate current subtree among the states
#+begin_example
,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
'-----------------------------------'
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+vindex: org-cycle-emulate-tab
Point must be on a headline for this to work[fn:4].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} (~org-global-cycle~), {{{kbd(C-u TAB)}}} ::
#+cindex: global visibility states
#+cindex: global cycling
#+cindex: overview, global visibility state
#+cindex: contents, global visibility state
#+cindex: show all, global visibility state
#+kindex: C-u TAB
#+kindex: S-TAB
#+findex: org-global-cycle
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
/Global cycling/: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
#+begin_example
,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
'--------------------------------------'
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N,
the CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N are shown. Note
that inside tables (see [[*Tables]]), {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} jumps to the
previous field instead.
#+vindex: org-cycle-global-at-bob
You can run global cycling using {{{kbd(TAB)}}} only if point is
at the very beginning of the buffer, but not on a headline, and
~org-cycle-global-at-bob~ is set to a non-~nil~ value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u TAB)}}} (~org-set-startup-visibility~) ::
#+cindex: startup visibility
#+kindex: C-u C-u TAB
#+findex: org-set-startup-visibility
Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer (see [[*Initial
visibility]]).
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-u TAB)}}} (~outline-show-all~) ::
#+cindex: show all, command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-u TAB
#+findex: outline-show-all
Show all, including drawers.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-r)}}} (~org-reveal~) ::
#+cindex: revealing context
#+kindex: C-c C-r
#+findex: org-reveal
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the
following heading and the hierarchy above. Useful for working
near a location that has been exposed by a sparse tree command
(see [[*Sparse Trees]]) or an agenda command (see [[*Commands in the
Agenda Buffer]]). With a prefix argument show, on each level, all
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
entire subtree of the parent.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-k)}}} (~outline-show-branches~) ::
#+cindex: show branches, command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-k
#+findex: outline-show-branches
Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENTS view for just
one subtree.
- {{{kbd(C-c TAB)}}} (~outline-show-children~) ::
#+cindex: show children, command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c TAB
#+findex: outline-show-children
Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix
argument N, expose all children down to level N.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x b)}}} (~org-tree-to-indirect-buffer~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x b
#+findex: org-tree-to-indirect-buffer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer[fn:5]. With
a numeric prefix argument, N, go up to level N and then take that
tree. If N is negative then go up that many levels. With
a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, do not remove the previously used
indirect buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x v)}}} (~org-copy-visible~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x v
#+findex: org-copy-visible
Copy the /visible/ text in the region into the kill ring.
*** Initial visibility
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Setting the initial visibility state.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-folded
When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible[fn:6]. This
can be configured through the variable ~org-startup-folded~, or on
a per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
buffer:
#+cindex: @samp{STARTUP}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+STARTUP: overview
,#+STARTUP: content
,#+STARTUP: showall
,#+STARTUP: showeverything
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+cindex: @samp{VISIBILITY}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Furthermore, any entries with a =VISIBILITY= property (see [[*Properties
and Columns]]) get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
for this property are =folded=, =children=, =content=, and =all=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u TAB)}}} (~org-set-startup-visibility~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-u TAB
#+findex: org-set-startup-visibility
Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.,
whatever is requested by startup options and =VISIBILITY=
properties in individual entries.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Catching invisible edits
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts.
:END:
#+cindex: edits, catching invisible
#+vindex: org-catch-invisible-edits
Sometimes you may inadvertently edit an invisible part of the buffer
and be confused on what has been edited and how to undo the mistake.
Setting ~org-catch-invisible-edits~ to non-~nil~ helps preventing
this. See the docstring of this option on how Org should catch
invisible edits and process them.
** Motion
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Jumping to other headlines.
:END:
#+cindex: motion, between headlines
#+cindex: jumping, to headlines
#+cindex: headline navigation
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-n)}}} (~outline-next-visible-heading~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-n
#+findex: outline-next-visible-heading
Next heading.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-p)}}} (~outline-previous-visible-heading~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-p
#+findex: outline-previous-visible-heading
Previous heading.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-f)}}} (~org-forward-same-level~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-f
#+findex: org-forward-same-level
Next heading same level.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-b)}}} (~org-backward-same-level~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-b
#+findex: org-backward-same-level
Previous heading same level.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-u)}}} (~outline-up-heading~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-u
#+findex: outline-up-heading
Backward to higher level heading.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-j)}}} (~org-goto~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-j
#+findex: org-goto
#+vindex: org-goto-auto-isearch
Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer,
where you can use the following keys to find your destination:
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.3 0.7
| {{{kbd(TAB)}}} | Cycle visibility. |
| {{{kbd(DOWN)}}} / {{{kbd(UP)}}} | Next/previous visible headline. |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| {{{kbd(RET)}}} | Select this location. |
| {{{kbd(/)}}} | Do a Sparse-tree search |
#+texinfo: @noindent
The following keys work if you turn off ~org-goto-auto-isearch~
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.3 0.7
| {{{kbd(n)}}} / {{{kbd(p)}}} | Next/previous visible headline. |
| {{{kbd(f)}}} / {{{kbd(b)}}} | Next/previous headline same level. |
| {{{kbd(u)}}} | One level up. |
| {{{kbd(0)}}} ... {{{kbd(9)}}} | Digit argument. |
| {{{kbd(q)}}} | Quit. |
#+vindex: org-goto-interface
#+texinfo: @noindent
See also the variable ~org-goto-interface~.
** Structure Editing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Changing sequence and level of headlines.
:END:
#+cindex: structure editing
#+cindex: headline, promotion and demotion
#+cindex: promotion, of subtrees
#+cindex: demotion, of subtrees
#+cindex: subtree, cut and paste
#+cindex: pasting, of subtrees
#+cindex: cutting, of subtrees
#+cindex: copying, of subtrees
#+cindex: sorting, of subtrees
#+cindex: subtrees, cut and paste
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-RET)}}} (~org-meta-return~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-RET
#+findex: org-meta-return
#+vindex: org-M-RET-may-split-line
Insert a new heading, item or row.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If the command is used at the /beginning/ of a line, and if there
is a heading or a plain list item (see [[*Plain Lists]]) at point,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the new heading/item is created /before/ the current line. When
used at the beginning of a regular line of text, turn that line
into a heading.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When this command is used in the middle of a line, the line is
split and the rest of the line becomes the new item or headline.
If you do not want the line to be split, customize
~org-M-RET-may-split-line~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Calling the command with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix unconditionally
inserts a new heading at the end of the current subtree, thus
preserving its contents. With a double {{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}}
prefix, the new heading is created at the end of the parent
subtree instead.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-RET)}}} (~org-insert-heading-respect-content~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-RET
#+findex: org-insert-heading-respect-content
Insert a new heading at the end of the current subtree.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-S-RET)}}} (~org-insert-todo-heading~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-S-RET
#+findex: org-insert-todo-heading
#+vindex: org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See
also the variable
~org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change~.
- {{{kbd(C-S-RET)}}} (~org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content~) ::
#+kindex: C-S-RET
#+findex: org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content
Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
{{{kbd(C-RET)}}}, the new headline is inserted after the current
subtree.
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} (~org-cycle~) ::
#+kindex: TAB
#+findex: org-cycle
In a new entry with no text yet, the first {{{kbd(TAB)}}} demotes
the entry to become a child of the previous one. The next
{{{kbd(TAB)}}} makes it a parent, and so on, all the way to top
level. Yet another {{{kbd(TAB)}}}, and you are back to the
initial level.
- {{{kbd(M-LEFT)}}} (~org-do-promote~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-do-promote
Promote current heading by one level.
- {{{kbd(M-RIGHT)}}} (~org-do-demote~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-do-demote
Demote current heading by one level.
- {{{kbd(M-S-LEFT)}}} (~org-promote-subtree~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-promote-subtree
Promote the current subtree by one level.
- {{{kbd(M-S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-demote-subtree~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-demote-subtree
Demote the current subtree by one level.
- {{{kbd(M-UP)}}} (~org-move-subtree-up~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-move-subtree-up
Move subtree up, i.e., swap with previous subtree of same level.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} (~org-move-subtree-down~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-move-subtree-down
Move subtree down, i.e., swap with next subtree of same level.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c @)}}} (~org-mark-subtree~) ::
#+kindex: C-c @@
#+findex: org-mark-subtree
Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly marks subsequent
subtrees of the same level as the marked subtree.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-w)}}} (~org-cut-subtree~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-w
#+findex: org-cut-subtree
Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x M-w)}}} (~org-copy-subtree~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x M-w
#+findex: org-copy-subtree
Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N,
copy the N sequential subtrees.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-y)}}} (~org-paste-subtree~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-y
#+findex: org-paste-subtree
Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the
subtree to make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank
position. The yank level can also be specified with a numeric
prefix argument, or by yanking after a headline marker like
=****=.
- {{{kbd(C-y)}}} (~org-yank~) ::
#+kindex: C-y
#+findex: org-yank
#+vindex: org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
#+vindex: org-yank-folded-subtrees
Depending on the variables ~org-yank-adjusted-subtrees~ and
~org-yank-folded-subtrees~, Org's internal ~yank~ command pastes
subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as
{{{kbd(C-c C-x C-y)}}}. With the default settings, no level
adjustment takes place, but the yanked tree is folded unless
doing so would swallow text previously visible. Any prefix
argument to this command forces a normal ~yank~ to be executed,
with the prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal yank
is {{{kbd(C-u C-y)}}}. If you use ~yank-pop~ after a yank, it
yanks previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
folding.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x c)}}} (~org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x c
#+findex: org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift
Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You
are prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also
specify if any timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This
can be useful, for example, to create a number of tasks related
to a series of lectures to prepare. For more details, see the
docstring of the command ~org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift~.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-w)}}} (~org-refile~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-w
#+findex: org-refile
Refile entry or region to a different location. See [[*Refile and
Copy]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ^)}}} (~org-sort~) ::
#+kindex: C-c ^
#+findex: org-sort
Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all
entries in the region are sorted. Otherwise the children of the
current headline are sorted. The command prompts for the sorting
method, which can be alphabetically, numerically, by time---first
timestamp with active preferred, creation time, scheduled time,
deadline time---by priority, by TODO keyword---in the sequence
the keywords have been defined in the setup---or by the value of
a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also
supply your own function to extract the sorting key. With
a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, sorting is case-sensitive.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-x n s)}}} (~org-narrow-to-subtree~) ::
#+kindex: C-x n s
#+findex: org-narrow-to-subtree
Narrow buffer to current subtree.
- {{{kbd(C-x n b)}}} (~org-narrow-to-block~) ::
#+kindex: C-x n b
#+findex: org-narrow-to-block
Narrow buffer to current block.
- {{{kbd(C-x n w)}}} (~widen~) ::
#+kindex: C-x n w
#+findex: widen
Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
- {{{kbd(C-c *)}}} (~org-toggle-heading~) ::
#+kindex: C-c *
#+findex: org-toggle-heading
Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline---so that
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
it becomes a subheading at its location. Also turn a headline
into a normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active
region, turn all lines in the region into headlines. If the
first line in the region was an item, turn only the item lines
into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a headline, remove
the stars from all headlines in the region.
#+cindex: region, active
#+cindex: active region
#+cindex: transient mark mode
When there is an active region---i.e., when Transient Mark mode is
active---promotion and demotion work on all headlines in the region.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To select a region of headlines, it is best to place both point and
mark at the beginning of a line, mark at the beginning of the first
headline, and point at the line just after the last headline to
change. Note that when point is inside a table (see [[*Tables]]), the
Meta-Cursor keys have different functionality.
** Sparse Trees
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Matches embedded in context.
:END:
#+cindex: sparse trees
#+cindex: trees, sparse
#+cindex: folding, sparse trees
#+cindex: occur, command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-show-context-detail
An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct /sparse
trees/ for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
is made visible along with the headline structure above it[fn:7].
Just try it out and you will see immediately how it works.
Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c /)}}} (~org-sparse-tree~) ::
#+kindex: C-c /
#+findex: org-sparse-tree
This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating
command.
- {{{kbd(C-c / r)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c / /)}}} (~org-occur~) ::
#+kindex: C-c / r
#+kindex: C-c / /
#+findex: org-occur
#+vindex: org-remove-highlights-with-change
Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches.
If the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If
the match is in the body of an entry, headline and body are made
visible. In order to provide minimal context, also the full
hierarchy of headlines above the match is shown, as well as the
headline following the match. Each match is also highlighted;
the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an editing
command, or by pressing {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}}[fn:8]. When called
with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument, previous highlights are
kept, so several calls to this command can be stacked.
- {{{kbd(M-g n)}}} or {{{kbd(M-g M-n)}}} (~next-error~) ::
#+kindex: M-g n
#+kindex: M-g M-n
#+findex: next-error
Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-g p)}}} or {{{kbd(M-g M-p)}}} (~previous-error~) ::
#+kindex: M-g p
#+kindex: M-g M-p
#+findex: previous-error
Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
#+vindex: org-agenda-custom-commands
For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
use the variable ~org-agenda-custom-commands~ to define fast keyboard
access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
accessible through the agenda dispatcher (see [[*The Agenda Dispatcher]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For example:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
defines the key {{{kbd(f)}}} as a shortcut for creating a sparse tree
matching the string =FIXME=.
The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
tags, or properties and are discussed later in this manual.
#+kindex: C-c C-e v
#+cindex: printing sparse trees
#+cindex: visible text, printing
To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~ps-print-buffer-with-faces~ which does not print invisible parts of
the document. Or you can use the command {{{kbd(C-c C-e v)}}} to
export only the visible part of the document and print the resulting
file.
** Plain Lists
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Additional structure within an entry.
:END:
#+cindex: plain lists
#+cindex: lists, plain
#+cindex: lists, ordered
#+cindex: ordered lists
Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
checkboxes (see [[*Checkboxes]]). Org supports editing such lists, and
every exporter (see [[*Exporting]]) can parse and format them.
Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :indic @bullet
- /Unordered/ list items start with =-=, =+=, or =*=[fn:9] as bullets.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
#+vindex: org-alphabetical-lists
/Ordered/ list items start with a numeral followed by either
a period or a right parenthesis[fn:10], such as =1.= or =1)=[fn:11]
If you want a list to start with a different value---e.g.,
20---start the text of the item with =[@20]=[fn:12]. Those
constructs can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce
a particular numbering.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Description/ list items are unordered list items, and contain the
separator =::= to distinguish the description /term/ from the
description.
Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
first line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number =10.=,
then the 2-digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other
numbers in the list. An item ends before the next line that is less
or equally indented than its bullet/number.
A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line
less or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before
two blank lines. In that case, all items are closed. Here is an
example:
#+begin_example
,* Lord of the Rings
My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1. The attack of the Rohirrim
2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
+ this was already my favorite scene in the book
+ I really like Miranda Otto.
3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
- on DVD only
He makes a really funny face when it happens.
But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
Important actors in this film are:
- Elijah Wood :: He plays Frodo
- Sean Astin :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember him
very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in /The Goonies/.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
deal with them correctly, and by exporting them properly (see
[[*Exporting]]). Since indentation is what governs the structure of these
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
lists, many structural constructs like =#+BEGIN_= blocks can be
indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
#+vindex: org-list-demote-modify-bullet
#+vindex: org-list-indent-offset
If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list---than that
used for the current list-level---improves readability, customize the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
variable ~org-list-demote-modify-bullet~. To get a greater difference
of indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
~org-list-indent-offset~.
#+vindex: org-list-automatic-rules
The following commands act on items when point is in the first line of
an item---the line with the bullet or number. Some of them imply the
application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some
of these actions get in your way, configure ~org-list-automatic-rules~
to disable them individually.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} (~org-cycle~) ::
#+cindex: cycling, in plain lists
#+kindex: TAB
#+findex: org-cycle
#+vindex: org-cycle-include-plain-lists
Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this
works only if point is on a plain list item. For more details,
see the variable ~org-cycle-include-plain-lists~. If this
variable is set to ~integrate~, plain list items are treated like
low-level headlines. The level of an item is then given by the
indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate
to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely
separated. In a new item with no text yet, the first
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
{{{kbd(TAB)}}} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
one. Subsequent {{{kbd(TAB)}}}s move the item to meaningful
levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
position.
- {{{kbd(M-RET)}}} (~org-insert-heading~) ::
#+kindex: M-RET
#+findex: org-insert-heading
#+vindex: org-M-RET-may-split-line
Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force
a new heading (see [[*Structure Editing]]). If this command is used
in the middle of an item, that item is /split/ in two, and the
second part becomes the new item[fn:13]. If this command is
executed /before item's body/, the new item is created /before/
the current one.
- {{{kbd(M-S-RET)}}} ::
#+kindex: M-S-RET
Insert a new item with a checkbox (see [[*Checkboxes]]).
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
- {{{kbd(S-UP)}}}, {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} ::
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
#+kindex: S-UP
#+kindex: S-DOWN
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
#+cindex: shift-selection-mode
#+vindex: org-support-shift-select
#+vindex: org-list-use-circular-motion
Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
~org-support-shift-select~ is off[fn:14]. If not, you can
still use paragraph jumping commands like {{{kbd(C-UP)}}}
and {{{kbd(C-DOWN)}}} to quite similar effect.
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
- {{{kbd(M-UP)}}}, {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} ::
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
#+kindex: M-UP
#+kindex: M-DOWN
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
Move the item including subitems up/down[fn:15], i.e., swap with
previous/next item of same indentation. If the list is ordered,
renumbering is automatic.
- {{{kbd(M-LEFT)}}}, {{{kbd(M-RIGHT)}}} ::
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
#+kindex: M-LEFT
#+kindex: M-RIGHT
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children
alone.
- {{{kbd(M-S-LEFT)}}}, {{{kbd(M-S-RIGHT)}}} ::
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
#+kindex: M-S-LEFT
#+kindex: M-S-RIGHT
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including
subitems. Initially, the item tree is selected based on current
indentation. When these commands are executed several times in
direct succession, the initially selected region is used, even if
the new indentation would imply a different hierarchy. To use
the new hierarchy, break the command chain by moving point.
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
As a special case, using this command on the very first item of
a list moves the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by
configuring ~org-list-automatic-rules~. The global indentation
of a list has no influence on the text /after/ the list.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-c
If there is a checkbox (see [[*Checkboxes]]) in the item line, toggle
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
the state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and
indentation consistency in the whole list.
- {{{kbd(C-c -)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c -
#+vindex: org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
Cycle the entire list level through the different
itemize/enumerate bullets (=-=, =+=, =*=, =1.=, =1)=) or a subset
of them, depending on ~org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator~,
the type of list, and its indentation. With a numeric prefix
argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
active region when calling this, selected text is changed into an
item. With a prefix argument, all lines are converted to list
items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
marker is removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
region, a normal line is converted into a list item.
- {{{kbd(C-c *)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c *
Turn a plain list item into a headline---so that it becomes
a subheading at its location. See [[*Structure Editing]], for
a detailed explanation.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-*)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-*
Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading.
Checkboxes (see [[*Checkboxes]]) become TODO, respectively DONE,
keywords when unchecked, respectively checked.
- {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}}, {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} ::
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
#+vindex: org-support-shift-select
#+kindex: S-LEFT
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
This command also cycles bullet styles when point is in on the
2018-01-22 08:23:41 -05:00
bullet or anywhere in an item line, details depending on
~org-support-shift-select~.
- {{{kbd(C-c ^)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c ^
#+cindex: sorting, of plain list
Sort the plain list. Prompt for the sorting method: numerically,
alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
** Drawers
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tucking stuff away.
:END:
#+cindex: drawers
#+cindex: visibility cycling, drawers
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but
you normally do not want to see it. For this, Org mode has /drawers/.
They can contain anything but a headline and another drawer. Drawers
look like this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,** This is a headline
Still outside the drawer
:DRAWERNAME:
This is inside the drawer.
:END:
After the drawer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+kindex: C-c C-x d
#+findex: org-insert-drawer
You can interactively insert a drawer at point by calling
~org-insert-drawer~, which is bound to {{{kbd(C-c C-x d)}}}. With an
active region, this command puts the region inside the drawer. With
a prefix argument, this command calls ~org-insert-property-drawer~,
which creates a =PROPERTIES= drawer right below the current headline.
Org mode uses this special drawer for storing properties (see
[[*Properties and Columns]]). You cannot use it for anything else.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Completion over drawer keywords is also possible using
{{{kbd(M-TAB)}}}[fn:16].
Visibility cycling (see [[*Visibility Cycling]]) on the headline hides and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
shows the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In
order to look inside the drawer, you need to move point to the drawer
line and press {{{kbd(TAB)}}} there.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can also arrange for state change notes (see [[Tracking TODO state
changes]]) and clock times (see [[*Clocking Work Time]]) to be stored in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a =LOGBOOK= drawer. If you want to store a quick note there, in
a similar way to state changes, use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-z)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-z
Add a time-stamped note to the =LOGBOOK= drawer.
** Blocks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Folding blocks.
:END:
#+vindex: org-hide-block-startup
#+cindex: blocks, folding
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode uses =#+BEGIN= ... =#+END= blocks for various purposes from
including source code examples (see [[*Literal Examples]]) to capturing
time logging information (see [[*Clocking Work Time]]). These blocks can
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
be folded and unfolded by pressing {{{kbd(TAB)}}} in the =#+BEGIN=
line. You can also get all blocks folded at startup by configuring
the variable ~org-hide-block-startup~ or on a per-file basis by using
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: STARTUP, keyword
#+begin_example
,#+STARTUP: hideblocks
,#+STARTUP: nohideblocks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** Creating Footnotes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax.
:END:
#+cindex: footnotes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode supports the creation of footnotes.
A footnote is started by a footnote marker in square brackets in
column 0, no indentation allowed. It ends at the next footnote
definition, headline, or after two consecutive empty lines. The
footnote reference is simply the marker in square brackets, inside
text. Markers always start with =fn:=. For example:
#+begin_example
The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
...
[fn:1] The link is: https://orgmode.org
#+end_example
Org mode extends the number-based syntax to /named/ footnotes and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
optional inline definition. Here are the valid references:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =[fn:NAME]= ::
A named footnote reference, where {{{var(NAME)}}} is a unique
label word, or, for simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
- =[fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A LaTeX-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given
directly at the reference point.
- =[fn:NAME: a definition]= ::
An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name
for the note. Since Org allows multiple references to the same
note, you can then use =[fn:NAME]= to create additional
references.
#+vindex: org-footnote-auto-label
Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
yourself. This is handled by the variable ~org-footnote-auto-label~
and its corresponding =STARTUP= keywords. See the docstring of that
variable for details.
The following command handles footnotes:
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x f)}}} ::
The footnote action command.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x f
When point is on a footnote reference, jump to the
definition. When it is at a definition, jump to
the---first---reference.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-footnote-define-inline
#+vindex: org-footnote-section
Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
~org-footnote-define-inline~[fn:17], the definition is placed
right into the text as part of the reference, or separately into
the location determined by the variable ~org-footnote-section~.
When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of
additional options is offered:
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.1 0.9
| {{{kbd(s)}}} | Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. |
| {{{kbd(r)}}} | Renumber the simple =fn:N= footnotes. |
| {{{kbd(S)}}} | Short for first {{{kbd(r)}}}, then {{{kbd(s)}}} action. |
| {{{kbd(n)}}} | Rename all footnotes into a =fn:1= ... =fn:n= sequence. |
| {{{kbd(d)}}} | Delete the footnote at point, including definition and references. |
#+vindex: org-footnote-auto-adjust
Depending on the variable ~org-footnote-auto-adjust~[fn:18],
renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each
insertion or deletion.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
If point is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If it is at the definition, jump back to the reference. When
called at a footnote location with a prefix argument, offer the
same menu as {{{kbd(C-c C-x f)}}}.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} or {{{kbd(mouse-1/2)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-o
#+kindex: mouse-1
#+kindex: mouse-2
Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition or
reference, and you can use the usual commands to follow these
links.
* Tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Pure magic for quick formatting.
:END:
#+cindex: tables
#+cindex: editing tables
Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2018-03-28 10:24:27 -04:00
calculations are supported using the Emacs Calc package (see [[info:calc][GNU Emacs
Calculator Manual]]).
** Built-in Table Editor
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Simple tables.
:END:
#+cindex: table editor, built-in
#+cindex: header lines, in tables
#+cindex: horizontal rule, in tables
#+cindex: row separator, in tables
#+cindex: table syntax
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with =|=
as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table.
=|= is also the column separator[fn:19]. Moreover, a line starting
with =|-= is a horizontal rule. It separates rows explicitely. Rows
before the first horizontal rule are header lines. A table might look
like this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
| Name | Phone | Age |
|-------+-------+-----|
| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press
{{{kbd(TAB)}}}, {{{kbd(RET)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} inside the table.
{{{kbd(TAB)}}} also moves to the next field---{{{kbd(RET)}}} to the
next row---and creates new table rows at the end of the table or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
before horizontal lines. The indentation of the table is set by the
first line. Horizontal rules are automatically expanded on every
re-align to span the whole table width. So, to create the above
table, you would only type
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
|Name|Phone|Age|
|-
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
and then press {{{kbd(TAB)}}} to align the table and start filling in
fields. Even faster would be to type =|Name|Phone|Age= followed by
{{{kbd(C-c RET)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When typing text into a field, Org treats {{{kbd(DEL)}}},
{{{kbd(Backspace)}}}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
typing /immediately/ after point was moved into a new field with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{kbd(TAB)}}}, {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} or {{{kbd(RET)}}}, the field is
automatically made blank. If this behavior is too unpredictable for
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you, configure the option ~org-table-auto-blank-field~.
*** Creation and conversion
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- {{{kbd(C-c |)}}} (~org-table-create-or-convert-from-region~) ::
#+kindex: C-c |
#+findex: org-table-create-or-convert-from-region
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at
least one {{{kbd(TAB)}}} character, the function assumes that the
material is tab separated. If every line contains a comma,
comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed. If not, lines are
split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix argument
to force a specific separator: {{{kbd(C-u)}}} forces CSV,
{{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}} forces {{{kbd(TAB)}}}, {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-u)}}}
prompts for a regular expression to match the separator, and
a numeric argument N indicates that at least N consecutive
spaces, or alternatively a {{{kbd(TAB)}}} will be the separator.
If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
table. But it is easier just to start typing, like {{{kbd(|
N a m e | P h o n e | A g e RET | - TAB)}}}.
*** Re-aligning and field motion
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-table-align~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+findex: org-table-align
Re-align the table without moving point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} (~org-table-next-field~) ::
#+kindex: TAB
#+findex: org-table-next-field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
necessary.
- {{{kbd(C-c SPC)}}} (~org-table-blank-field~) ::
#+kindex: C-c SPC
#+findex: org-table-blank-field
Blank the field at point.
- {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} (~org-table-previous-field~) ::
#+kindex: S-TAB
#+findex: org-table-previous-field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Re-align, move to previous field.
- {{{kbd(RET)}}} (~org-table-next-row~) ::
#+kindex: RET
#+findex: org-table-next-row
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row
if necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, {{{kbd(RET)}}}
still inserts a new line, so it can be used to split a table.
- {{{kbd(M-a)}}} (~org-table-beginning-of-field~) ::
#+kindex: M-a
#+findex: org-table-beginning-of-field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the
previous field.
- {{{kbd(M-e)}}} (~org-table-end-of-field~) ::
#+kindex: M-e
#+findex: org-table-end-of-field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
*** Column and row editing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- {{{kbd(M-LEFT)}}} (~org-table-move-column-left~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-move-column-left
Move the current column left.
- {{{kbd(M-RIGHT)}}} (~org-table-move-column-right~) ::
#+kindex: M-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-move-column-right
Move the current column right.
- {{{kbd(M-S-LEFT)}}} (~org-table-delete-column~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-delete-column
Kill the current column.
- {{{kbd(M-S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-table-insert-column~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-insert-column
Insert a new column to the left of point position.
- {{{kbd(M-UP)}}} (~org-table-move-row-up~) ::
#+kindex: M-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-move-row-up
Move the current row up.
- {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} (~org-table-move-row-down~) ::
#+kindex: M-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-move-row-down
Move the current row down.
- {{{kbd(M-S-UP)}}} (~org-table-kill-row~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-UP
#+findex: org-table-kill-row
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Kill the current row or horizontal line.
- {{{kbd(M-S-DOWN)}}} (~org-table-insert-row~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-DOWN
#+findex: org-table-insert-row
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument,
the line is created below the current one.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c -)}}} (~org-table-insert-hline~) ::
#+kindex: C-c -
#+findex: org-table-insert-hline
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix
argument, the line is created above the current line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c RET)}}} (~org-table-hline-and-move~) ::
#+kindex: C-c RET
#+findex: org-table-hline-and-move
Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move point
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
into the row below that line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ^)}}} (~org-table-sort-lines~) ::
#+kindex: C-c ^
#+findex: org-table-sort-lines
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point
indicates the column to be used for sorting, and the range of
lines is the range between the nearest horizontal separator
lines, or the entire table. If point is before the first column,
you are prompted for the sorting column. If there is an active
region, the mark specifies the first line and the sorting column,
while point should be in the last line to be included into the
sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type,
alphabetically, numerically, or by time. You can sort in normal
or reverse order. You can also supply your own key extraction
and comparison functions. When called with a prefix argument,
alphabetic sorting is case-sensitive.
*** Regions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x M-w)}}} (~org-table-copy-region~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x M-w
#+findex: org-table-copy-region
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard.
Point and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there
is no active region, copy just the current field. The process
ignores horizontal separator lines.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-w)}}} (~org-table-cut-region~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-w
#+findex: org-table-cut-region
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard,
and blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the "cut"
operation.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-y)}}} (~org-table-paste-rectangle~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-y
#+findex: org-table-paste-rectangle
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Paste a rectangular region into a table. The upper left corner
ends up in the current field. All involved fields are
overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present
table, the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores
horizontal separator lines.
- {{{kbd(M-RET)}}} (~org-table-wrap-region~) ::
#+kindex: M-RET
#+findex: org-table-wrap-region
Split the current field at point position and move the rest
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to the line below. If there is an active region, and both point
and mark are in the same column, the text in the column is
wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines.
A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number of
desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix
argument, the current field is made blank, and the content is
appended to the field above.
*** Calculations
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: formula, in tables
#+cindex: calculations, in tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c +)}}} (~org-table-sum~) ::
#+kindex: C-c +
#+findex: org-table-sum
Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle
defined by the active region. The result is shown in the echo
area and can be inserted with {{{kbd(C-y)}}}.
- {{{kbd(S-RET)}}} (~org-table-copy-down~) ::
#+kindex: S-RET
#+findex: org-table-copy-down
#+vindex: org-table-copy-increment
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field
above. When not empty, copy current field down to next row and
move point along with it. Depending on the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-table-copy-increment~, integer field values can be
incremented during copy. Integers that are too large are not
incremented, however. Also, a ~0~ prefix argument temporarily
disables the increment. This key is also used by shift-selection
and related modes (see [[*Packages that conflict with Org mode]]).
*** Miscellaneous
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c `)}}} (~org-table-edit-field~) ::
#+kindex: C-c `
#+findex: org-table-edit-field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for
fields that are not fully visible (see [[*Column Width and
Alignment]]). When called with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, just make
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the full field visible, so that it can be edited in place. When
called with two {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefixes, make the editor window
follow point through the table and always show the current field.
The follow mode exits automatically when point leaves the table,
or when you repeat this command with {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c `)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-x org-table-import)}}} ::
#+findex: org-table-import
Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or
data from a database, because these programs generally can write
TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the
file into the buffer and then converting the region to a table.
Any prefix argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it
to determine the separator.
- {{{kbd(C-c |)}}} (~org-table-create-or-convert-from-region~) ::
#+kindex: C-c |
#+findex: org-table-create-or-convert-from-region
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
buffer, selecting the pasted text with {{{kbd(C-x C-x)}}} and
then using the {{{kbd(C-c |)}}} command (see [[*Creation and
conversion]]).
- {{{kbd(M-x org-table-export)}}} ::
#+findex: org-table-export
#+vindex: org-table-export-default-format
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for
data exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database
programs. The format used to export the file can be configured
in the variable ~org-table-export-default-format~. You may also
use properties =TABLE_EXPORT_FILE= and =TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT= to
specify the file name and the format for table export in
a subtree. Org supports quite general formats for exported
tables. The exporter format is the same as the format used by
Orgtbl radio tables, see [[*Translator functions]], for a detailed
description.
** Column Width and Alignment
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Overrule the automatic settings.
:END:
#+cindex: narrow columns in tables
#+cindex: alignment in tables
The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The alignment of a column is determined automatically from the
fraction of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-table-automatic-realign
Editing a field may modify alignment of the table. Moving
a contiguous row or column---i.e., using {{{kbd(TAB)}}} or
{{{kbd(RET)}}}---automatically re-aligns it. If you want to disable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
this behavior, set ~org-table-automatic-realign~ to ~nil~. In any
case, you can always align manually a table:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-table-align~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+findex: org-table-align
Align the current table.
#+vindex: org-startup-align-all-tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Setting the option ~org-startup-align-all-tables~ re-aligns all tables
in a file upon visiting it. You can also set this option on
a per-file basis with:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+STARTUP: align
,#+STARTUP: noalign
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
leading to inconveniently wide columns. Maybe you want to hide away
several columns or display them with a fixed width, regardless of
content, as shown in the following example.
#+begin_example
|---+---------------------+--------| |---+-------…|…|
| | <6> | | | | <6> …|…|
| 1 | one | some | ----\ | 1 | one …|…|
| 2 | two | boring | ----/ | 2 | two …|…|
| 3 | This is a long text | column | | 3 | This i…|…|
|---+---------------------+--------| |---+-------…|…|
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
To set the width of a column, one field anywhere in the column may
contain just the string =<N>= where {{{var(N)}}} specifies the width
as a number of characters. You control displayed width of columns
with the following tools:
- {{{kbd(C-c TAB)}}} (~org-table-toggle-column-width~) ::
#+kindex: C-c TAB
#+findex: org-table-toggle-column-width
Shrink or expand current column.
If a width cookie specifies a width W for the column, shrinking
it displays the first W visible characters only. Otherwise, the
column is shrunk to a single character.
When called before the first column or after the last one, ask
for a list of column ranges to operate on.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c TAB)}}} (~org-table-shrink~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-c TAB
#+findex: org-table-shrink
Shrink all columns with a column width. Expand the others.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c TAB)}}} (~org-table-expand~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c TAB
#+findex: org-table-expand
Expand all columns.
To see the full text of a shrunk field, hold the mouse over it:
a tool-tip window then shows the full contents of the field.
Alternatively, {{{kbd(C-h .)}}} (~display-local-help~) reveals them,
too. For convenience, any change near the shrunk part of a column
expands it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-shrink-all-tables
Setting the option ~org-startup-shrink-all-tables~ shrinks all columns
containing a width cookie in a file the moment it is visited. You can
also set this option on a per-file basis with:
: #+STARTUP: shrink
If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich
columns to the right and of string-rich columns to the left, you can
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
use =<r>=, =<c>= or =<l>= in a similar fashion. You may also combine
alignment and field width like this: =<r10>=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Lines which only contain these formatting cookies are removed
automatically upon exporting the document.
** Column Groups
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Grouping to trigger vertical lines.
:END:
#+cindex: grouping columns in tables
When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical lines
because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
first field contains only =/=. The further fields can either contain
=<= to indicate that this column should start a group, =>= to indicate
the end of a column, or =<>= (no space between =<= and =>=) to make
a column a group of its own. Upon export, boundaries between column
groups are marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
#+begin_example
| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
| / | < | | > | < | > |
| 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
| 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
| 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
every vertical line you would like to have:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
| / | < | | | < | |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** The Orgtbl Minor Mode
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The table editor as minor mode.
:ALT_TITLE: Orgtbl Mode
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: Orgtbl mode
#+cindex: minor mode for tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: orgtbl-mode
If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you might
also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode. The
minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle the
mode with {{{kbd(M-x orgtbl-mode)}}}. To turn it on by default, for
example in Message mode, use
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
#+end_src
Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain
tables in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
possible to construct LaTeX tables with the underlying ease and power
of Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
[[*Tables in Arbitrary Syntax]].
** The Spreadsheet
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities.
:END:
#+cindex: calculations, in tables
#+cindex: spreadsheet capabilities
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: Calc package
The table editor makes use of the Emacs Calc package to implement
spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms
to derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
Org knows the concept of a /column formula/ that will be applied to
all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the formula
to each relevant field. There is also a formula debugger, and a
formula editor with features for highlighting fields in the table
corresponding to the references at point in the formula, moving these
references by arrow keys.
*** References
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to refer to another field or range.
:END:
#+cindex: references
To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced by
name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
out what the coordinates of a field are, press {{{kbd(C-c ?)}}} in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
that field, or press {{{kbd(C-c })}}} to toggle the display of a grid.
**** Field references
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: field references
#+cindex: references, to fields
Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
in any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with
a letter/number combination like =B3=, meaning the second field in the
third row. However, Org prefers to use another, more general
representation that looks like this:[fn:20]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: @ROW$COLUMN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Column specifications can be absolute like =$1=, =$2=, ..., =$N=, or
relative to the current column, i.e., the column of the field which is
being computed, like =$+1= or =$-2=. =$<= and =$>= are immutable
references to the first and last column, respectively, and you can use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=$>>>= to indicate the third column from the right.
The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
separator lines, or "hlines". Like with columns, you can use absolute
row numbers =@1=, =@2=, ..., =@N=, and row numbers relative to the
current row like =@+3= or =@-1=. =@<= and =@>= are immutable
references the first and last row in the table, respectively. You may
also specify the row relative to one of the hlines: =@I= refers to the
first hline, =@II= to the second, etc. =@-I= refers to the first such
line above the current line, =@+I= to the first such line below the
current line. You can also write =@III+2= which is the second data
line after the third hline in the table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=@0= and =$0= refer to the current row and column, respectively, i.e.,
to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
row/column is implied.
Org's references with /unsigned/ numbers are fixed references in the
sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
different fields, the same field is referenced each time. Org's
references with /signed/ numbers are floating references because the
same reference operator can reference different fields depending on
the field being calculated by the formula.
Here are a few examples:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.2 0.8
| =@2$3= | 2nd row, 3rd column (same as =C2=) |
| =$5= | column 5 in the current row (same as =E&=) |
| =@2= | current column, row 2 |
| =@-1$-3= | field one row up, three columns to the left |
| =@-I$2= | field just under hline above current row, column 2 |
| =@>$5= | field in the last row, in column 5 |
**** Range references
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: range references
#+cindex: references, to ranges
You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
field references connected by two dots =..=. If both fields are in
the current row, you may simply use =$2..$7=, but if at least one
field is in a different row, you need to use the general =@ROW$COLUMN=
format at least for the first field, i.e., the reference must start
with =@= in order to be interpreted correctly. Examples:
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.2 0.8
| =$1..$3= | first three fields in the current row |
| =$P..$Q= | range, using column names (see [[*Advanced features]]) |
| =$<<<..$>>= | start in third column, continue to the last but one |
| =@2$1..@4$3= | six fields between these two fields (same as =A2..C4=) |
| =@-1$-2..@-1= | 3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left |
| =@I..II= | between first and second hline, short for =@I..@II= |
#+texinfo: @noindent
Range references return a vector of values that can be fed into Calc
vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed, so
that the vector contains only the non-empty fields. For other options
with the mode switches =E=, =N= and examples, see [[*Formula syntax for
Calc]].
**** Field coordinates in formulas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: field coordinates
#+cindex: coordinates, of field
#+cindex: row, of field coordinates
#+cindex: column, of field coordinates
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-table-current-column
#+vindex: org-table-current-dline
One of the very first actions during evaluation of Calc formulas and
Lisp formulas is to substitute =@#= and =$#= in the formula with the
row or column number of the field where the current result will go to.
The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are ~org-table-current-dline~
and ~org-table-current-column~. Examples:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =if(@# % 2, $#, string(""))= ::
Insert column number on odd rows, set field to empty on even
rows.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =$2 = '(identity remote(FOO, @@#$1))= ::
Copy text or values of each row of column 1 of the table named
{{{var(FOO)}}} into column 2 of the current table.
- =@3 = 2 * remote(FOO, @@1$$#)= ::
Insert the doubled value of each column of row 1 of the table
named {{{var(FOO)}}} into row 3 of the current table.
#+texinfo: @noindent
For the second and third examples, table {{{var(FOO)}}} must have at
least as many rows or columns as the current table. Note that this is
inefficient[fn:21] for large number of rows.
**** Named references
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: named references
#+cindex: references, named
#+cindex: name, of column or field
#+cindex: constants, in calculations
#+cindex: @samp{CONSTANTS}, keyword
#+vindex: org-table-formula-constants
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=$name= is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or constant.
Constants are defined globally through the variable
~org-table-formula-constants~, and locally---for the file---through
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a line like this example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
#+vindex: constants-unit-system
#+pindex: constants.el
Also, properties (see [[*Properties and Columns]]) can be used as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
constants in table formulas: for a property =Xyz= use the name
=$PROP_Xyz=, and the property will be searched in the current outline
entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the =constants.el=
package, it will also be used to resolve constants, including natural
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
constants like =$h= for Planck's constant, and units like =$km= for
kilometers[fn:22]. Column names and parameters can be specified in
special table lines. These are described below, see [[*Advanced
features]]. All names must start with a letter, and further consist
of letters and numbers.
**** Remote references
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: remote references
#+cindex: references, remote
#+cindex: references, to a different table
#+cindex: name, of column or field
#+cindex: @samp{NAME}, keyword
You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different
table, either in the current file or even in a different file. The
syntax is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: remote(NAME,REF)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
where {{{var(NAME)}}} can be the name of a table in the current file
as set by a =#+NAME:= line before the table. It can also be the ID of
an entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to
the first table in that entry. {{{var(REF)}}} is an absolute field or
range reference as described above for example =@3$3= or =$somename=,
valid in the referenced table.
#+cindex: table indirection
When {{{var(NAME)}}} has the format =@ROW$COLUMN=, it is substituted
with the name or ID found in this field of the current table. For
example =remote($1, @@>$2)= \Rightarrow =remote(year_2013, @@>$1)=. The format
=B3= is not supported because it can not be distinguished from a plain
table name or ID.
*** Formula syntax for Calc
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Using Calc to compute stuff.
:END:
#+cindex: formula syntax, Calc
#+cindex: syntax, of formulas
A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs Calc
package. Note that Calc has the non-standard convention that =/= has
lower precedence than =*=, so that =a/b*c= is interpreted as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=(a/(b*c))=. Before evaluation by ~calc-eval~ (see [[info:calc#Calling Calc from Your Programs][Calling Calc from
Your Lisp Programs]]), variable substitution takes place according to
the rules described above.
#+cindex: vectors, in table calculations
The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
like ~vmean~ and ~vsum~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: format specifier, in spreadsheet
#+cindex: mode, for Calc
#+vindex: org-calc-default-modes
A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The
display format, however, has been changed to =(float 8)= to keep
tables compact. The default settings can be configured using the
variable ~org-calc-default-modes~.
- =p20= ::
Set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits.
- =n3=, =s3=, =e2=, =f4= ::
Normal, scientific, engineering or fixed format of the result of
Calc passed back to Org. Calc formatting is unlimited in
precision as long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.
- =D=, =R= ::
Degree and radian angle modes of Calc.
- =F=, =S= ::
Fraction and symbolic modes of Calc.
- =T=, =t=, =U= ::
Duration computations in Calc or Lisp, [[*Durations and time
values]].
- =E= ::
If and how to consider empty fields. Without =E= empty fields in
range references are suppressed so that the Calc vector or Lisp
list contains only the non-empty fields. With =E= the empty
fields are kept. For empty fields in ranges or empty field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
references the value =nan= (not a number) is used in Calc
formulas and the empty string is used for Lisp formulas. Add =N=
to use 0 instead for both formula types. For the value of
a field the mode =N= has higher precedence than =E=.
- =N= ::
Interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers. See the
next section to see how this is essential for computations with
Lisp formulas. In Calc formulas it is used only occasionally
because there number strings are already interpreted as numbers
without =N=.
- =L= ::
Literal, for Lisp formulas only. See the next section.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision calculation and
display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide
a ~printf~ format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has
been passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
formatting[fn:23]. A few examples:
| =$1+$2= | Sum of first and second field |
| =$1+$2;%.2f= | Same, format result to two decimals |
| =exp($2)+exp($1)= | Math functions can be used |
| =$0;%.1f= | Reformat current cell to 1 decimal |
| =($3-32)*5/9= | Degrees F \to C conversion |
| =$c/$1/$cm= | Hz \to cm conversion, using =constants.el= |
| =tan($1);Dp3s1= | Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1 |
| =sin($1);Dp3%.1e= | Same, but use ~printf~ specifier for display |
| =vmean($2..$7)= | Compute column range mean, using vector function |
| =vmean($2..$7);EN= | Same, but treat empty fields as 0 |
| =taylor($3,x=7,2)= | Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree |
Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations (see [[info:calc#Logical%20Operations][Logical
Operations]]). For example
- =if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))= ::
="teen"= if age =$1= is less than 20, else the Org table result
field is set to empty with the empty string.
- =if("$1" == "nan" || "$2" == "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E f-1= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Sum of the first two columns. When at least one of the input
fields is empty the Org table result field is set to empty. =E=
is required to not convert empty fields to 0. =f-1= is an
optional Calc format string similar to =%.1f= but leaves empty
results empty.
- =if(typeof(vmean($1..$7)) == 12, string(""), vmean($1..$7); E= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mean value of a range unless there is any empty field. Every
field in the range that is empty is replaced by =nan= which lets
=vmean= result in =nan=. Then =typeof == 12= detects the =nan=
from ~vmean~ and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use
this when the sample set is expected to never have missing
values.
- =if("$1..$7" == "[]", string(""), vmean($1..$7))= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mean value of a range with empty fields skipped. Every field in
the range that is empty is skipped. When all fields in the range
are empty the mean value is not defined and the Org table result
field is set to empty. Use this when the sample set can have
a variable size.
- =vmean($1..$7); EN= ::
To complete the example before: Mean value of a range with empty
fields counting as samples with value 0. Use this only when
incomplete sample sets should be padded with 0 to the full size.
You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with
~defmath~ and use them in formula syntax for Calc.
*** Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp.
:ALT_TITLE: Formula syntax for Lisp
:END:
#+cindex: Lisp forms, as table formulas
It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be
useful for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
functionality is not enough.
If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
should return either a string or a number. Just as with Calc
formulas, you can specify modes and a ~printf~ format after
a semicolon.
With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference is
interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field.
If you provide the =N= mode switch, all referenced elements are
numbers---non-number fields will be zero---and interpolated as Lisp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
numbers, without quotes. If you provide the =L= flag, all fields are
interpolated literally, without quotes. For example, if you want a
reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the
reference operator itself in double-quotes, like ="$3"=. Ranges are
inserted as space-separated fields, so you can embed them in list or
vector syntax.
Here are a few examples---note how the =N= mode is used when we do
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
computations in Lisp:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ='(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1.
- ='(+ $1 $2);N= ::
Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's =$1+$2=.
- ='(apply '+ '($1..$4));N= ::
Compute the sum of columns 1 to 4, like Calc's =vsum($1..$4)=.
*** Durations and time values
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to compute durations and time values.
:END:
#+cindex: duration, computing
#+cindex: time, computing
#+vindex: org-table-duration-custom-format
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you want to compute time values use the =T=, =t=, or =U= flag,
either in Calc formulas or Elisp formulas:
#+begin_example
| Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
|---------+----------+----------|
| 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
| 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59 |
| 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
,#+TBLFM: @2$3=$1+$2;T::@3$3=$1+$2;U::@4$3=$1+$2;t
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Input duration values must be of the form =HH:MM[:SS]=, where seconds
are optional. With the =T= flag, computed durations are displayed as
=HH:MM:SS= (see the first formula above). With the =U= flag, seconds
are omitted so that the result is only =HH:MM= (see second formula
above). Zero-padding of the hours field depends upon the value of the
variable ~org-table-duration-hour-zero-padding~.
With the =t= flag, computed durations are displayed according to the
value of the option ~org-table-duration-custom-format~, which defaults
to ~hours~ and displays the result as a fraction of hours (see the
third formula in the example above).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers are
considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
*** Field and range formulas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields.
:END:
#+cindex: field formula
#+cindex: range formula
#+cindex: formula, for individual table field
#+cindex: formula, for range of fields
To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
field, preceded by =:==, for example =vsum(@II..III)=. When you press
{{{kbd(TAB)}}} or {{{kbd(RET)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} with point
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
still in the field, the formula is stored as the formula for this
field, evaluated, and the current field is replaced with the result.
#+cindex: @samp{TBLFM}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Formulas are stored in a special =TBLFM= keyword located directly
below the table. If you type the equation in the fourth field of the
third data line in the table, the formula looks like =@3$4=$1+$2=.
When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate
commands, /absolute references/ (but not relative ones) in stored
formulas are modified in order to still reference the same field. To
avoid this from happening, in particular in range references, anchor
ranges at the table borders (using =@<=, =@>=, =$<=, =$>=), or at
hlines using the =@I= notation. Automatic adaptation of field
references does not happen if you edit the table structure with normal
editing commands---you must fix the formulas yourself.
Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
following command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c =)}}} (~org-table-eval-formula~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-c =
#+findex: org-table-eval-formula
Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts
for a formula with default taken from the =TBLFM= keyword,
applies it to the current field, and stores it.
The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in
order to assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is
no keyboard shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the formula editor (see [[*Editing and debugging formulas]]) or edit the
=TBLFM= keyword directly.
- =$2== ::
Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common
that Org treats these formulas in a special way, see [[*Column
formulas]].
- ~@3=~ ::
Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. =@>==
means the last row.
- =@1$2..@4$3== ::
Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular
range. This can also be used to assign a formula to some but not
all fields in a row.
- =$NAME== ::
Named field, see [[*Advanced features]].
*** Column formulas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Formulas valid for an entire column.
:END:
#+cindex: column formula
#+cindex: formula, for table column
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like =$3==, the
same formula is used in all fields of that column, with the following
very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal
separator hlines with rows above and below, everything before the
first such hline is considered part of the table /header/ and is not
modified by column formulas. Therefore a header is mandatory when you
use column formulas and want to add hlines to group rows, like for
example to separate a total row at the bottom from the summand rows
above. (ii) Fields that already get a value from a field/range
formula are left alone by column formulas. These conditions make
column formulas very easy to use.
To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the column, preceded by an equal sign, like ==$1+$2=. When you press
{{{kbd(TAB)}}} or {{{kbd(RET)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} with point
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
still in the field, the formula is stored as the formula for the
current column, evaluated and the current field replaced with the
result. If the field contains only ===, the previously stored formula
for this column is used. For each column, Org only remembers the most
recently used formula. In the =TBLFM= keyword, column formulas look
like =$4=$1+$2=. The left-hand side of a column formula can not be
the name of column, it must be the numeric column reference or =$>=.
Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
following command:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c =)}}} (~org-table-eval-formula~) ::
#+kindex: C-c =
#+findex: org-table-eval-formula
Install a new formula for the current column and replace current
field with the result of the formula. The command prompts for
a formula, with default taken from the =TBLFM= keyword, applies
it to the current field and stores it. With a numeric prefix
argument, e.g., {{{kbd(C-5 C-c =)}}}, the command applies it to
that many consecutive fields in the current column.
*** Lookup functions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Lookup functions for searching tables.
:END:
#+cindex: lookup functions in tables
#+cindex: table lookup functions
Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables.
- =(org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-lookup-first
Searches for the first element {{{var(S)}}} in list
{{{var(S-LIST)}}} for which
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(PREDICATE VAL S)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
is non-~nil~; returns the value from the corresponding position
in list {{{var(R-LIST)}}}. The default {{{var(PREDICATE)}}} is
~equal~. Note that the parameters {{{var(VAL)}}} and
{{{var(S)}}} are passed to {{{var(PREDICATE)}}} in the same order
as the corresponding parameters are in the call to
~org-lookup-first~, where {{{var(VAL)}}} precedes
{{{var(S-LIST)}}}. If {{{var(R-LIST)}}} is ~nil~, the matching
element {{{var(S)}}} of {{{var(S-LIST)}}} is returned.
- =(org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-lookup-last
Similar to ~org-lookup-first~ above, but searches for the /last/
element for which {{{var(PREDICATE)}}} is non-~nil~.
- =(org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-lookup-all
Similar to ~org-lookup-first~, but searches for /all/ elements
for which {{{var(PREDICATE)}}} is non-~nil~, and returns /all/
corresponding values. This function can not be used by itself in
a formula, because it returns a list of values. However,
powerful lookups can be built when this function is combined with
other Emacs Lisp functions.
If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the =E=
mode for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
fields are not included in {{{var(S-LIST)}}} and/or {{{var(R-LIST)}}}
which can, for example, result in an incorrect mapping from an element
of {{{var(S-LIST)}}} to the corresponding element of
{{{var(R-LIST)}}}.
These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays,
count matching cells, rank results, group data, etc. For practical
examples see [[https://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html][this tutorial on Worg]].
*** Editing and debugging formulas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Fixing formulas.
:END:
#+cindex: formula editing
#+cindex: editing, of table formulas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-table-use-standard-references
You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas
of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org converts
references to the standard format (like =B3= or =D&=) if possible. If
you prefer to only work with the internal format (like =@3$2= or
=$4=), configure the variable ~org-table-use-standard-references~.
- {{{kbd(C-c =)}}} or {{{kbd(C-u C-c =)}}} (~org-table-eval-formula~) ::
#+kindex: C-c =
#+kindex: C-u C-c =
#+findex: org-table-eval-formula
Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
minibuffer. See [[*Column formulas]], and [[*Field and range formulas]].
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c =)}}} (~org-table-eval-formula~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c =
#+findex: org-table-eval-formula
Re-insert the active formula (either a field formula, or a column
formula) into the current field, so that you can edit it directly
in the field. The advantage over editing in the minibuffer is
that you can use the command {{{kbd(C-c ?)}}}.
- {{{kbd(C-c ?)}}} (~org-table-field-info~) ::
#+kindex: C-c ?
#+findex: org-table-field-info
While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
referenced by the reference at point position in the formula.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c })}}} (~org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays~) ::
#+kindex: C-c @}
#+findex: org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you
can force it with {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}}.
- {{{kbd(C-c {)}}} (~org-table-toggle-formula-debugger~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c @{
#+findex: org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} (~org-table-edit-formulas~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c '
#+findex: org-table-edit-formulas
Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer,
where the formulas are displayed one per line. If the current
field has an active formula, point in the formula editor marks
it. While inside the special buffer, Org automatically
highlights any field or range reference at point position. You
may edit, remove and add formulas, and use the following
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} or {{{kbd(C-x C-s)}}} (~org-table-fedit-finish~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-x C-s
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+findex: org-table-fedit-finish
Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With
{{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, also apply the new formulas to the
entire table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-q)}}} (~org-table-fedit-abort~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-q
#+findex: org-table-fedit-abort
Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-r)}}} (~org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-r
#+findex: org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type
Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard
(like =B3=) and internal (like =@3$2=).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} (~org-table-fedit-lisp-indent~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: TAB
#+findex: org-table-fedit-lisp-indent
Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line
containing a Lisp formula, format the formula according to
Emacs Lisp rules. Another {{{kbd(TAB)}}} collapses the formula
back again. In the open formula, {{{kbd(TAB)}}} re-indents
just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} (~lisp-complete-symbol~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-TAB
#+findex: lisp-complete-symbol
Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
- {{{kbd(S-UP)}}}, {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}}, {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}}, {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} ::
#+kindex: S-UP
#+kindex: S-DOWN
#+kindex: S-LEFT
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-fedit-ref-up
#+findex: org-table-fedit-ref-down
#+findex: org-table-fedit-ref-left
#+findex: org-table-fedit-ref-right
Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference
is =B3= and you press {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}}, it becomes =C3=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This also works for relative references and for hline
references.
- {{{kbd(M-S-UP)}}} (~org-table-fedit-line-up~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-fedit-line-up
Move the test line for column formulas up in the Org buffer.
- {{{kbd(M-S-DOWN)}}} (~org-table-fedit-line-down~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-fedit-line-down
Move the test line for column formulas down in the Org buffer.
- {{{kbd(M-UP)}}} (~org-table-fedit-scroll-up~) ::
#+kindex: M-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-fedit-scroll-up
Scroll up the window displaying the table.
- {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} (~org-table-fedit-scroll-down~) ::
#+kindex: M-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-table-fedit-scroll-down
Scroll down the window displaying the table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c })}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c @}
#+findex: org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
the field, because that is stored in a different line---the =TBLFM=
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
keyword line. During the next recalculation, the field will be filled
again. To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty
reply when prompted for the formula, or to edit the =TBLFM= keyword.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
You may edit the =TBLFM= keyword directly and re-apply the changed
equations with {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} in that line or with the normal
recalculation commands in the table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Using multiple =TBLFM= lines
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: multiple formula lines
#+cindex: @samp{TBLFM} keywords, multiple
#+cindex: @samp{TBLFM}, switching
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
You may apply the formula temporarily. This is useful when you want
to switch the formula applied to the table. Place multiple =TBLFM=
keywords right after the table, and then press {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} on
the formula to apply. Here is an example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
| x | y |
|---+---|
| 1 | |
| 2 | |
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1*1
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
Pressing {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} in the line of =#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2= yields:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
| x | y |
|---+---|
| 1 | 2 |
| 2 | 4 |
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1*1
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
If you recalculate this table, with {{{kbd(C-u C-c *)}}}, for example,
you get the following result from applying only the first =TBLFM=
keyword.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
| x | y |
|---+---|
| 1 | 1 |
| 2 | 2 |
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1*1
,#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Debugging formulas
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: formula debugging
#+cindex: debugging, of table formulas
When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
becomes the string =#ERROR=. If you would like to see what is going
on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find
a bug, turn on formula debugging in the Tbl menu and repeat the
calculation, for example by pressing {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c = RET)}}} in
a field. Detailed information are displayed.
*** Updating the table
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Recomputing all dependent fields.
:END:
#+cindex: recomputing table fields
#+cindex: updating, table
Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
triggered by a command. To make recalculation at least
semi-automatic, see [[*Advanced features]].
In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
following commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c *)}}} (~org-table-recalculate~) ::
#+kindex: C-c *
#+findex: org-table-recalculate
Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column
formulas from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the
current row.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c *)}}} or {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-c)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-u C-c *
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-c
Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the
first hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the
table header.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c *)}}} or {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c C-c)}}} (~org-table-iterate~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c *
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c C-c
#+findex: org-table-iterate
Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes
occur. This may be necessary if some computed fields use the
value of other fields that are computed /later/ in the
calculation sequence.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables)}}} ::
#+findex: org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables)}}} ::
#+findex: org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge
table-to-table dependencies.
*** Advanced features
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Field and column names, automatic recalculation...
:END:
If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you want to be able to assign /names/[fn:24] to fields and columns,
you need to reserve the first column of the table for special marking
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
characters.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-#)}}} (~org-table-rotate-recalc-marks~) ::
#+kindex: C-#
#+findex: org-table-rotate-recalc-marks
Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states
=#=, =*=, =!=, =$=. When there is an active region, change all
marks in the region.
Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students
and makes use of these features:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
| # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
| ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
| # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
| ^ | | | | | at | |
| $ | max=50 | | | | | |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
,#+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@-II..@-I);%.1f
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+attr_texinfo: :tag Important
#+begin_quote
Please note that for these special tables, recalculating the table
with {{{kbd(C-u C-c *)}}} only affects rows that are marked =#= or
=*=, and fields that have a formula assigned to the field itself. The
column formulas are not applied in rows with empty first field.
#+end_quote
#+cindex: marking characters, tables
The marking characters have the following meaning:
- =!= ::
The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you
may refer to a column as =$Tot= instead of =$6=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =^= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This row defines names for the fields /above/ the row. With such
a definition, any formula in the table may use =$m1= to refer to
the value =10=. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field,
it is stored as =$name = ...=.
- =_= ::
Similar to =^=, but defines names for the fields in the row
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
/below/.
- =$= ::
Fields in this row can define /parameters/ for formulas. For
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
example, if a field in a =$= row contains =max=50=, then formulas
in this table can refer to the value 50 using =$max=. Parameters
work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
a per-table basis.
- =#= ::
Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
{{{kbd(TAB)}}} or {{{kbd(RET)}}} or {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} in this row.
Also, this row is selected for a global recalculation with
{{{kbd(C-u C-c *)}}}. Unmarked lines are left alone by this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
command.
- =*= ::
Selects this line for global recalculation with {{{kbd(C-u C-c
*)}}}, but not for automatic recalculation. Use this when
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
automatic recalculation slows down editing too much.
- =/= ::
Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
narrowing =<N>= markers or column group markers.
Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
fantastic Calc package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
series of degree n at location x for a couple of functions.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
| | Func | n | x | Result |
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
| # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
| # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
| # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
| * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
,#+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Org Plot
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Plotting from Org tables.
:END:
#+cindex: graph, in tables
#+cindex: plot tables using Gnuplot
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org Plot can produce graphs of information stored in Org tables,
either graphically or in ASCII art.
*** Graphical plots using Gnuplot
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{PLOT}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in Org
tables using [[http://www.gnuplot.info/][Gnuplot]] and [[http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html][Gnuplot mode]]. To see this in action, ensure
that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system,
then call {{{kbd(C-c \quot g)}}} or {{{kbd(M-x org-plot/gnuplot)}}} on the
following table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
| Sede | Max cites | H-index |
|-----------+-----------+---------|
| Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
| Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
| Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
| Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2018-03-28 08:36:13 -04:00
| Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
labels. Further control over the labels, type, content, and
appearance of plots can be exercised through the =PLOT= keyword
preceding a table. See below for a complete list of Org Plot options.
For more information and examples see the [[https://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html][Org Plot tutorial]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Plot options
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- =set= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specify any Gnuplot option to be set when graphing.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =title= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specify the title of the plot.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =ind= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specify which column of the table to use as the =x= axis.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =deps= ::
Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by
parentheses and separated by spaces for example =dep:(3 4)= to
graph the third and fourth columns. Defaults to graphing all
other columns aside from the =ind= column.
- =type= ::
Specify whether the plot is =2d=, =3d=, or =grid=.
- =with= ::
Specify a =with= option to be inserted for every column being
plotted, e.g., =lines=, =points=, =boxes=, =impulses=. Defaults
to =lines=.
- =file= ::
If you want to plot to a file, specify
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
="path/to/desired/output-file"=.
- =labels= ::
List of labels to be used for the =deps=. Defaults to the column
headers if they exist.
- =line= ::
Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
- =map= ::
When plotting =3d= or =grid= types, set this to =t= to graph
a flat mapping rather than a =3d= slope.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =timefmt= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by
Gnuplot. Defaults to =%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =script= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you want total control, you can specify a script file---place
the file name between double-quotes---which will be used to plot.
Before plotting, every instance of =$datafile= in the specified
script will be replaced with the path to the generated data file.
Note: even if you set this option, you may still want to specify
the plot type, as that can impact the content of the data file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ASCII bar plots
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
While point is on a column, typing {{{kbd(C-c " a)}}} or {{{kbd(M-x
orgtbl-ascii-plot)}}} create a new column containing an ASCII-art bars
plot. The plot is implemented through a regular column formula. When
the source column changes, the bar plot may be updated by refreshing
the table, for example typing {{{kbd(C-u C-c *)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
| Sede | Max cites | |
|---------------+-----------+--------------|
| Chile | 257.72 | WWWWWWWWWWWW |
| Leeds | 165.77 | WWWWWWWh |
| Sao Paolo | 71.00 | WWW; |
| Stockholm | 134.19 | WWWWWW: |
| Morelia | 257.56 | WWWWWWWWWWWH |
| Rochefourchat | 0.00 | |
,#+TBLFM: $3='(orgtbl-ascii-draw $2 0.0 257.72 12)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
The formula is an Elisp call.
#+attr_texinfo: :options orgtbl-ascii-draw value min max &optional width
#+begin_defun
Draw an ASCII bar in a table.
{{{var(VALUE)}}} is the value to plot.
{{{var(MIN)}}} is the value displayed as an empty bar. {{{var(MAX)}}}
is the value filling all the {{{var(WIDTH)}}}. Sources values outside
this range are displayed as =too small= or =too large=.
{{{var(WIDTH)}}} is the number of characters of the bar plot. It
defaults to =12=.
#+end_defun
* Hyperlinks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Notes in context.
:END:
#+cindex: hyperlinks
Like HTML, Org provides support for links inside a file, external
links to other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
** Link Format
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How links in Org are formatted.
:END:
#+cindex: link format
#+cindex: format, of links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org recognizes plain URL-like links and activate them as clickable
links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[LINK][DESCRIPTION]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or alternatively
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[LINK]]
Once a link in the buffer is complete---all brackets present---, Org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
changes the display so that =DESCRIPTION= is displayed instead of
=[[LINK][DESCRIPTION]]= and =LINK= is displayed instead of =[[LINK]]=.
Links are highlighted in the ~org-link~ face, which, by default, is an
underlined face.
You can directly edit the visible part of a link. This can be either
the {{{var(LINK)}}} part, if there is no description, or the
{{{var(DESCRIPTION)}}} part otherwise. To also edit the invisible
{{{var(LINK)}}} part, use {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}} with point on the link
(see [[*Handling Links]]).
If you place point at the beginning or just behind the end of the
displayed text and press {{{kbd(BS)}}}, you remove
the---invisible---bracket at that location[fn:25]. This makes the link
incomplete and the internals are again displayed as plain text.
Inserting the missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show
the internal structure of all links, use the menu: Org \rarr Hyperlinks \rarr
Literal links.
** Internal Links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Links to other places in the current file.
:END:
#+cindex: internal links
#+cindex: links, internal
#+cindex: targets, for links
#+cindex: @samp{CUSTOM_ID}, property
If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal
in the current file. The most important case is a link like
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=[[#my-custom-id]]= which links to the entry with the =CUSTOM_ID= property
=my-custom-id=. You are responsible yourself to make sure these
custom IDs are unique in a file.
Links such as =[[My Target]]= or =[[My Target][Find my target]]= lead to a text search in
the current file.
The link can be followed with {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} when point is on
the link, or with a mouse click (see [[*Handling Links]]). Links to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
custom IDs point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match
for a text link is a /dedicated target/: the same string in double
angular brackets, like =<<My Target>>=.
#+cindex: @samp{NAME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If no dedicated target exists, the link tries to match the exact name
of an element within the buffer. Naming is done with the =NAME=
keyword, which has to be put in the line before the element it refers
to, as in the following example
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: My Target
| a | table |
|----+------------|
| of | four cells |
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If none of the above succeeds, Org searches for a headline that is
exactly the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and
tags[fn:26].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
During export, internal links are used to mark objects and assign them
a number. Marked objects are then referenced by links pointing to
them. In particular, links without a description appear as the number
assigned to the marked object[fn:27]. In the following excerpt from
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
an Org buffer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
1. one item
2. <<target>>another item
Here we refer to item [[target]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The last sentence will appear as =Here we refer to item 2= when
exported.
In non-Org files, the search looks for the words in the link text. In
the above example the search would be for =target=.
Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
return to the previous position with {{{kbd(C-c &)}}}. Using this
command several times in direct succession goes back to positions
recorded earlier.
** Radio Targets
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Make targets trigger links in plain text.
:END:
#+cindex: radio targets
#+cindex: targets, radio
#+cindex: links, radio targets
Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names in
normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target =<<<My
Target>>>= causes each occurrence of =my target= in normal text to
become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically for
radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
update the target list during editing, press {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} with
point on or at a target.
** External Links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: URL-like links to the world.
:END:
#+cindex: links, external
#+cindex: external links
#+cindex: Gnus links
#+cindex: BBDB links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: irc links
#+cindex: URL links
#+cindex: file links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: Rmail links
#+cindex: MH-E links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: Usenet links
#+cindex: shell links
#+cindex: Info links
#+cindex: Elisp links
Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB
database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs.
External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
| =http://www.astro.uva.nl/=dominik= | on the web |
| =doi:10.1000/182= | DOI for an electronic resource |
| =file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg= | file, absolute path |
| =/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg= | same as above |
| =file:papers/last.pdf= | file, relative path |
| =./papers/last.pdf= | same as above |
| =file:/ssh:me@some.where:papers/last.pdf= | file, path on remote machine |
| =/ssh:me@some.where:papers/last.pdf= | same as above |
| =file:sometextfile::NNN= | file, jump to line number |
| =file:projects.org= | another Org file |
| =file:projects.org::some words= | text search in Org file[fn:28] |
| =file:projects.org::*task title= | heading search in Org file |
| =file+sys:/path/to/file= | open via OS, like double-click |
| =file+emacs:/path/to/file= | force opening by Emacs |
| =docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN= | open in doc-view mode at page |
| =id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9= | link to heading by ID |
| =news:comp.emacs= | Usenet link |
| =mailto:adent@galaxy.net= | mail link |
| =mhe:folder= | MH-E folder link |
| =mhe:folder#id= | MH-E message link |
| =rmail:folder= | Rmail folder link |
| =rmail:folder#id= | Rmail message link |
| =gnus:group= | Gnus group link |
| =gnus:group#id= | Gnus article link |
| =bbdb:R.*Stallman= | BBDB link (with regexp) |
| =irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob= | IRC link |
| =info:org#External links= | Info node link |
| =shell:ls *.org= | shell command |
| =elisp:org-agenda= | interactive Elisp command |
| =elisp:(find-file "Elisp.org")= | Elisp form to evaluate |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: VM links
#+cindex: Wanderlust links
On top of these built-in link types, additional ones are available
through the =contrib/= directory (see [[*Installation]]). For example,
these links to VM or Wanderlust messages are available when you load
the corresponding libraries from the =contrib/= directory:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| =vm:folder= | VM folder link |
| =vm:folder#id= | VM message link |
| =vm://myself@some.where.org/folder#id= | VM on remote machine |
| =vm-imap:account:folder= | VM IMAP folder link |
| =vm-imap:account:folder#id= | VM IMAP message link |
| =wl:folder= | Wanderlust folder link |
| =wl:folder#id= | Wanderlust message link |
For information on customizing Org to add new link types, see [[*Adding
Hyperlink Types]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain
descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (see [[*Link
Format]]), for example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
export (see [[*HTML Export]]) inlines the image as a clickable button. If
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
there is no description at all and the link points to an image, that
image is inlined into the exported HTML file.
#+cindex: square brackets, around links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: angular brackets, around links
#+cindex: plain text external links
Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them as
links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=bbdb:Richard Stallman=), or if you need to remove ambiguities about
the end of the link, enclose the link in square or angular brackets.
** Handling Links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
2017-12-17 07:37:29 -05:00
:DESCRIPTION: Creating, inserting and following.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: links, handling
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to insert
it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
#+findex: org-store-link
#+cindex: storing links
The main function is ~org-store-link~, called with {{{kbd(M-x
org-store-link)}}}. Because of its importance, we suggest to bind it
to a widely available key (see [[*Activation]]). It stores a link to the
current location. The link is stored for later insertion into an Org
buffer---see below. The kind of link that is created depends on the
current buffer:
- /Org mode buffers/ ::
For Org files, if there is a =<<target>>= at point, the link
points to the target. Otherwise it points to the current
headline, which is also the description[fn:29].
#+vindex: org-link-to-org-use-id
#+cindex: @samp{CUSTOM_ID}, property
#+cindex: @samp{ID}, property
If the headline has a =CUSTOM_ID= property, store a link to this
custom ID. In addition or alternatively, depending on the value
of ~org-link-to-org-use-id~, create and/or use a globally unique
=ID= property for the link[fn:30]. So using this command in Org
buffers potentially creates two links: a human-readable link from
the custom ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if
the entry is moved from file to file. Later, when inserting the
link, you need to decide which one to use.
- /Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus/ ::
#+vindex: org-email-link-description-format
Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link
points to the current article, or, in some Gnus buffers, to the
group. The description is constructed according to the variable
~org-email-link-description-format~. By default, it refers to
the addressee and the subject, possibly truncated.
- /Web browsers: W3, W3M and EWW/ ::
Here the link is the current URL, with the page title as the
description.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Contacts: BBDB/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Links created in a BBDB buffer point to the current entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Chat: IRC/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-irc-links-to-logs
For IRC links, if the variable ~org-irc-link-to-logs~ is
non-~nil~, create a =file= style link to the relevant point in
the logs for the current conversation. Otherwise store an =irc=
style link to the user/channel/server under the point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Other files/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For any other file, the link points to the file, with a search
string (see [[*Search Options in File Links]]) pointing to the
contents of the current line. If there is an active region, the
selected words form the basis of the search string. You can write
custom Lisp functions to select the search string and perform the
search for particular file types (see [[*Custom Searches]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can also define dedicated links to other files. See [[*Adding
Hyperlink Types]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Agenda view/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When point is in an agenda view, the created link points to
the entry referenced by the current line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
From an Org buffer, the following commands create, navigate or, more
generally, act on links.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}} (~org-insert-link~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-l
#+findex: org-insert-link
#+cindex: link completion
#+cindex: completion, of links
#+cindex: inserting links
#+vindex: org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
Insert a link[fn:31]. This prompts for a link to be inserted
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
into the buffer. You can just type a link, using text for an
internal link, or one of the link type prefixes mentioned in the
examples above. The link is inserted into the buffer, along with
a descriptive text[fn:32]. If some text was selected at this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
time, it becomes the default description.
- /Inserting stored links/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
All links stored during the current session are part of the
history for this prompt, so you can access them with
{{{kbd(UP)}}} and {{{kbd(DOWN)}}} (or {{{kbd(M-p)}}},
{{{kbd(M-n)}}}).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Completion support/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Completion with {{{kbd(TAB)}}} helps you to insert valid link
prefixes like =http= or =ftp=, including the prefixes defined
through link abbreviations (see [[*Link Abbreviations]]). If you
press {{{kbd(RET)}}} after inserting only the prefix, Org
offers specific completion support for some link types[fn:33].
For example, if you type {{{kbd(f i l e RET)}}}---alternative
access: {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-l)}}}, see below---Org offers file
name completion, and after {{{kbd(b b d b RET)}}} you can
complete contact names.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-l)}}} ::
#+cindex: file name completion
#+cindex: completion, of file names
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-l
When {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}} is called with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix
argument, insert a link to a file. You may use file name
completion to select the name of the file. The path to the file
is inserted relative to the directory of the current Org file, if
the linked file is in the current directory or in a sub-directory
of it, or if the path is written relative to the current
directory using =../=. Otherwise an absolute path is used, if
possible with =~/= for your home directory. You can force an
absolute path with two {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefixes.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}} (with point on existing link) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: following links
When point is on an existing link, {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}} allows
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you to edit the link and description parts of the link.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} (~org-open-at-point~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-o
#+findex: org-open-at-point
#+vindex: org-file-apps
Open link at point. This launches a web browser for URL (using
~browse-url-at-point~), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB
for the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell
link. When point is on an internal link, this command runs the
corresponding search. When point is on the tags part of a
headline, it creates the corresponding tags view (see [[*Matching
tags and properties]]). If point is on a timestamp, it compiles
the agenda for that date. Furthermore, it visits text and remote
files in =file= links with Emacs and select a suitable
application for local non-text files. Classification of files is
based on file extension only. See option ~org-file-apps~. If
you want to override the default application and visit the file
with Emacs, use a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix. If you want to avoid
opening in Emacs, use a {{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}} prefix.
#+vindex: org-link-frame-setup
If point is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in
the headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame
configuration for following links, customize
~org-link-frame-setup~.
- {{{kbd(RET)}}} ::
#+vindex: org-return-follows-link
#+kindex: RET
When ~org-return-follows-link~ is set, {{{kbd(RET)}}} also
follows the link at point.
- {{{kbd(mouse-2)}}} or {{{kbd(mouse-1)}}} ::
#+kindex: mouse-2
#+kindex: mouse-1
On links, {{{kbd(mouse-1)}}} and {{{kbd(mouse-2)}}} opens the
link just as {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} does.
- {{{kbd(mouse-3)}}} ::
#+vindex: org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
#+kindex: mouse-3
Like {{{kbd(mouse-2)}}}, but force file links to be opened with
Emacs, and internal links to be displayed in another
window[fn:34].
- {{{kbd(C-c %)}}} (~org-mark-ring-push~) ::
#+kindex: C-c %
#+findex: org-mark-ring-push
#+cindex: mark ring
Push the current position onto the Org mark ring, to be able to
return easily. Commands following an internal link do this
automatically.
- {{{kbd(C-c &)}}} (~org-mark-ring-goto~) ::
#+kindex: C-c &
#+findex: org-mark-ring-goto
#+cindex: links, returning to
Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
commands following internal links, and by {{{kbd(C-c %)}}}.
Using this command several times in direct succession moves
through a ring of previously recorded positions.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-n)}}} (~org-next-link~), {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-p)}}} (~org-previous-link~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-p
#+findex: org-previous-link
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-n
#+findex: org-next-link
#+cindex: links, finding next/previous
Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the
limit of the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps
around. The key bindings for this are really too long; you might
want to bind this also to {{{kbd(M-n)}}} and {{{kbd(M-p)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'org-load-hook
(lambda ()
(define-key org-mode-map "\M-n" 'org-next-link)
(define-key org-mode-map "\M-p" 'org-previous-link)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
** Using Links Outside Org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Linking from my C source code?
:END:
2018-02-18 05:25:53 -05:00
#+findex: org-insert-link-global
#+findex: org-open-at-point-global
You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in Org,
2018-02-18 05:25:53 -05:00
but in any Emacs buffer. For this, Org provides two functions:
~org-insert-link-global~ and ~org-open-at-point-global~.
2018-02-18 05:25:53 -05:00
You might want to bind them to globally available keys. See
2018-02-18 16:48:32 -05:00
[[*Activation]] for some advice.
** Link Abbreviations
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Shortcuts for writing complex links.
:END:
#+cindex: link abbreviations
#+cindex: abbreviation, links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Long URL can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
abbreviated link looks like this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[linkword:tag][description]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
#+vindex: org-link-abbrev-alist
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
where the tag is optional. The /linkword/ must be a word, starting
with a letter, followed by letters, numbers, =-=, and =_=.
Abbreviations are resolved according to the information in the
variable ~org-link-abbrev-alist~ that relates the linkwords to
replacement text. Here is an example:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-link-abbrev-alist
'(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If the replacement text contains the string =%s=, it is replaced with
the tag. Using =%h= instead of =%s= percent-encodes the tag (see the
example above, where we need to encode the URL parameter). Using
=%(my-function)= passes the tag to a custom Lisp function, and replace
it by the resulting string.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If the replacement text do not contain any specifier, it is simply
appended to the string in order to create the link.
Instead of a string, you may also specify a Lisp function to create
the link. Such a function will be called with the tag as the only
argument.
With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=[[bugzilla:129]]=, search the web for =OrgMode= with =[[google:OrgMode]]=,
show the map location of the Free Software Foundation =[[gmap:51
Franklin Street, Boston]]= or of Carsten office =[[omap:Science Park 904,
Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]= and find out what the Org author is doing
besides Emacs hacking with =[[ads:Dominik,C]]=.
If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
can define them in the file with
#+cindex: @samp{LINK}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
,#+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In-buffer completion (see [[*Completion]]) can be used after =[= to
complete link abbreviations. You may also define a Lisp function that
implements special (e.g., completion) support for inserting such a
link with {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}}. Such a function should not accept any
arguments, and should return the full link with a prefix. You can set
the link completion function like this:
2016-07-05 10:38:42 -04:00
2018-01-28 08:13:39 -05:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(org-link-set-parameter "type" :complete #'some-completion-function)
2018-01-28 08:13:39 -05:00
#+end_src
** Search Options in File Links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Linking to a specific location.
:ALT_TITLE: Search Options
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: search option in file links
#+cindex: file links, searching
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to
a particular location in the file when following a link. This can be
a line number or a search option after a double colon[fn:35]. For
example, when the command ~org-store-link~ creates a link (see
[[*Handling Links]]) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as a search string that can be used to find this line back later when
following the link with {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}}.
Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
link, together with explanations for each:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
[[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
[[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
[[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
[[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
[[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- =255= ::
Jump to line 255.
- =My Target= ::
Search for a link target =<<My Target>>=, or do a text search for
=my target=, similar to the search in internal links, see
[[*Internal Links]]. In HTML export (see [[*HTML Export]]), such a file
link becomes a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor
in the linked file.
- =*My Target= ::
In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
- =#my-custom-id= ::
Link to a heading with a =CUSTOM_ID= property
- =/REGEXP/= ::
Do a regular expression search for {{{var(REGEXP)}}}. This uses
the Emacs command ~occur~ to list all matches in a separate
window. If the target file is in Org mode, ~org-occur~ is used
to create a sparse tree with the matches.
As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to search the current file. For example, =[[file:::find me]]= does
a search for =find me= in the current file, just as =[[find me]]= would.
** Custom Searches
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: When the default search is not enough.
:END:
#+cindex: custom search strings
#+cindex: search strings, custom
The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
2016-05-16 19:04:15 -04:00
cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~year="1993"~ which would not result in good search strings, because
the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the citation key.
#+vindex: org-create-file-search-functions
#+vindex: org-execute-file-search-functions
If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to
set the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the
search for the string in the file. Using ~add-hook~, these functions
need to be added to the hook variables
~org-create-file-search-functions~ and
~org-execute-file-search-functions~. See the docstring for these
variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism for
2016-05-16 19:04:15 -04:00
BibTeX database files, and you can use the corresponding code as an
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
implementation example. See the file =org-bibtex.el=.
* TODO Items
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Every tree branch can be a TODO item.
:END:
#+cindex: TODO items
Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents[fn:36].
Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the notes file, because
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org mode, simply
mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the
TODO item emerged is always present.
Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by
providing methods to give you an overview of all the things that you
have to do.
** Basic TODO Functionality
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Marking and displaying TODO entries.
:ALT_TITLE: TODO Basics
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word =TODO=,
for example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}} (~org-todo~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-t
#+cindex: cycling, of TODO states
Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
'--------------------------------'
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see [[*Fast access to
TODO states]]), prompt for a TODO keyword through the fast
selection interface; this is the default behavior when
~org-use-fast-todo-selection~ is non-~nil~.
The same rotation can also be done "remotely" from the agenda
buffer with the {{{kbd(t)}}} command key (see [[*Commands in the
Agenda Buffer]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-t)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-t
When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific
keyword using completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO
states with no prompt. When ~org-use-fast-todo-selection~ is set
to ~prefix~, use the fast selection interface.
- {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} ::
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
#+kindex: S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Useful mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (see
[[*Extended Use of TODO Keywords]]). See also [[*Packages that
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
conflict with Org mode]], for a discussion of the interaction with
~shift-selection-mode~. See also the variable
~org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c / t)}}} (~org-show-todo-tree~) ::
#+kindex: C-c / t
#+cindex: sparse tree, for TODO
#+vindex: org-todo-keywords
#+findex: org-show-todo-tree
View TODO items in a /sparse tree/ (see [[*Sparse Trees]]). Folds
the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items---with not-DONE
state---and the headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
argument, or by using {{{kbd(C-c / T)}}}, search for a specific
TODO. You are prompted for the keyword, and you can also give
a list of keywords like =KWD1|KWD2|...= to list entries that
match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
~org-todo-keywords~. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO
states, both un-done and done.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda t)}}} (~org-todo-list~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: t @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with
not-DONE states) from all agenda files (see [[*Agenda Views]]) into
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a single buffer. The new buffer is in Org Agenda mode, which
provides commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries from
the new buffer (see [[*Commands in the Agenda Buffer]]). See [[*The
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
global TODO list]], for more information.
- {{{kbd(S-M-RET)}}} (~org-insert-todo-heading~) ::
#+kindex: S-M-RET
#+findex: org-insert-todo-heading
Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
#+vindex: org-todo-state-tags-triggers
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring
of the option ~org-todo-state-tags-triggers~ for details.
** Extended Use of TODO Keywords
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Workflow and assignments.
:ALT_TITLE: TODO Extensions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: extended TODO keywords
#+vindex: org-todo-keywords
By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
with /TODO keywords/ (stored in ~org-todo-keywords~). With special
setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
files.
Note that /tags/ are another way to classify headlines in general and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
TODO items in particular (see [[*Tags]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** TODO keywords as workflow states
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: From TODO to DONE in steps.
:ALT_TITLE: Workflow states
:END:
#+cindex: TODO workflow
#+cindex: workflow states as TODO keywords
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can use TODO keywords to indicate different /sequential/ states in
the process of working on an item, for example[fn:37]:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
#+end_src
The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that /need
action/) from the DONE states (which need /no further action/). If
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you do not provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the
DONE state.
#+cindex: completion, of TODO keywords
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
With this setup, the command {{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}} cycles an entry from
=TODO= to =FEEDBACK=, then to =VERIFY=, and finally to =DONE= and
=DELEGATED=. You may also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly
select a specific state. For example {{{kbd(C-3 C-c C-t)}}} changes
the state immediately to =VERIFY=. Or you can use {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to go backward through the sequence. If you define many keywords, you
can use in-buffer completion (see [[*Completion]]) or even a special
one-key selection scheme (see [[*Fast access to TODO states]]) to insert
these words into the buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with
a timestamp, see [[*Tracking TODO state changes]], for more information.
*** TODO keywords as types
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: I do this, Fred does the rest.
:ALT_TITLE: TODO types
:END:
#+cindex: TODO types
#+cindex: names as TODO keywords
#+cindex: types as TODO keywords
The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
/types/ of action items. For example, you might want to indicate that
items are for "work" or "home". Or, when you work with several people
on a single project, you might want to assign action items directly to
persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would be set up
like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but
rather different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign
a task to a person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this
style by adapting the workings of the command {{{kbd(C-c
C-t)}}}[fn:38]. When used several times in succession, it still
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
cycles through all names, in order to first select the right type for
a task. But when you return to the item after some time and execute
{{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}} again, it will switch from any name directly to
=DONE=. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select
a specific name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO
type in a sparse tree by using a numeric prefix to {{{kbd(C-c / t)}}}.
For example, to see all things Lucy has to do, you would use
{{{kbd(C-3 C-c / t)}}}. To collect Lucy's items from all agenda files
into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix argument as
well when creating the global TODO list: {{{kbd(C-3 M-x org-agenda
t)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Multiple keyword sets in one file
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Mixing it all, still finding your way.
:ALT_TITLE: Multiple sets in one file
:END:
#+cindex: TODO keyword sets
Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic TODO/DONE, but
also a workflow for bug fixing, and a separate state indicating that
an item has been canceled---so it is not DONE, but also does not
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
require action. Your setup would then look like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
(sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
(sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
#+end_src
The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode keep track
of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
{{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}} only operates within a sub-sequence, so it switches
from =DONE= to (nothing) to =TODO=, and from =FIXED= to (nothing) to
=REPORT=. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially select the
correct sequence. In addition to typing a keyword or using completion
(see [[*Completion]]), you may also apply the following commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c C-t)}}}, {{{kbd(C-S-RIGHT)}}}, {{{kbd(C-S-LEFT)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-S-RIGHT
#+kindex: C-S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c C-t
These keys jump from one TODO sub-sequence to the next. In the
above example, {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c C-t)}}} or {{{kbd(C-S-RIGHT)}}}
would jump from =TODO= or =DONE= to =REPORT=, and any of the
words in the second row to =CANCELED=. Note that the
{{{kbd(C-S-)}}} key binding conflict with ~shift-selection-mode~
(see [[*Packages that conflict with Org mode]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}}, {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
#+kindex: S-LEFT
{{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} and {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} walk through /all/
keywords from all sub-sequences, so for example
{{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} would switch from =DONE= to =REPORT= in the
example above. For a discussion of the interaction with
~shift-selection-mode~, see [[*Packages that conflict with Org
mode]].
*** Fast access to TODO states
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Single letter selection of state.
:END:
If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO
state instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the
selection character after each keyword, in parentheses[fn:39]. For
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
example:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
(sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
(sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
#+end_src
#+vindex: org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
If you then press {{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}} followed by the selection key,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the entry is switched to this state. {{{kbd(SPC)}}} can be used to
remove any TODO keyword from an entry[fn:40].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Setting up keywords for individual files
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Different files, different requirements.
:ALT_TITLE: Per-file keywords
:END:
#+cindex: keyword options
#+cindex: per-file keywords
#+cindex: @samp{TODO}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{TYP_TODO}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{SEQ_TODO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism
in different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special
lines to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that
file only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed
above, you need one of the following lines, starting in column zero
anywhere in the file:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
You may also write =#+SEQ_TODO= to be explicit about the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
interpretation, but it means the same as =#+TODO=, or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
#+begin_example
,#+TODO: TODO | DONE
,#+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
,#+TODO: | CANCELED
#+end_example
#+cindex: completion, of option keywords
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-TAB
To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type =#+= into the
buffer and then use {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} to complete it (see [[*Completion]]).
#+cindex: DONE, final TODO keyword
Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar---or the last
keyword if no bar is there---must always mean that the item is DONE,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
although you may use a different word. After changing one of these
lines, use {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} with point still in the line to make the
changes known to Org mode[fn:41].
*** Faces for TODO keywords
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Highlighting states.
:END:
#+cindex: faces, for TODO keywords
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-todo, face
#+vindex: org-done, face
#+vindex: org-todo-keyword-faces
Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: ~org-todo~ for
keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
~org-done~ for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If you
are using more than two different states, you might want to use
special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
~org-todo-keyword-faces~. For example:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-todo-keyword-faces
'(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-faces-easy-properties
While using a list with face properties as shown for =CANCELED=
/should/ work, this does not always seem to be the case. If
necessary, define a special face and use that. A string is
interpreted as a color. The variable ~org-faces-easy-properties~
determines if that color is interpreted as a foreground or
a background color.
*** TODO dependencies
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: When one task needs to wait for others.
:END:
#+cindex: TODO dependencies
#+cindex: dependencies, of TODO states
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-enforce-todo-dependencies
#+cindex: @samp{ORDERED}, property
The structure of Org files---hierarchy and lists---makes it easy to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
define TODO dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be
marked DONE until all TODO subtasks, or children tasks, are marked as
DONE. Sometimes there is a logical sequence to (sub)tasks, so that
one subtask cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it have
been marked DONE. If you customize the variable
~org-enforce-todo-dependencies~, Org blocks entries from changing
state to DONE while they have TODO children that are not DONE.
Furthermore, if an entry has a property =ORDERED=, each of its TODO
children is blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here
is an example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* TODO Blocked until (two) is done
,** DONE one
,** TODO two
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,* Parent
:PROPERTIES:
:ORDERED: t
:END:
,** TODO a
,** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
,** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+cindex: TODO dependencies, @samp{NOBLOCKING}
#+cindex: @samp{NOBLOCKING}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can ensure an entry is never blocked by using the =NOBLOCKING=
property (see [[*Properties and Columns]]):
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* This entry is never blocked
:PROPERTIES:
:NOBLOCKING: t
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x o)}}} (~org-toggle-ordered-property~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x o
#+findex: org-toggle-ordered-property
#+vindex: org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
Toggle the =ORDERED= property of the current entry. A property
is used for this behavior because this should be local to the
current entry, not inherited from entries above like a tag (see
[[*Tags]]). However, if you would like to /track/ the value of this
property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-track-ordered-property-with-tag~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
Change TODO state, regardless of any state blocking.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
If you set the variable ~org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks~, TODO entries
that cannot be marked DONE because of unmarked children are shown in a
dimmed font or even made invisible in agenda views (see [[*Agenda
Views]]).
#+cindex: checkboxes and TODO dependencies
#+vindex: org-enforce-todo-dependencies
You can also block changes of TODO states by using checkboxes (see
[[*Checkboxes]]). If you set the variable
~org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies~, an entry that has unchecked
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
checkboxes is blocked from switching to DONE.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you need more complex dependency structures, for example
dependencies between entries in different trees or files, check out
the contributed module =org-depend.el=.
** Progress Logging
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Dates and notes for progress.
:END:
#+cindex: progress logging
#+cindex: logging, of progress
Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and optionally a note
when you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the
state of a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings
can be on a per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a
subtree. For information on how to clock working time for a task, see
[[*Clocking Work Time]].
*** Closing items
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: When was this entry marked DONE?
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The most basic logging is to keep track of /when/ a certain TODO item
was marked DONE. This can be achieved with[fn:42]
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-log-done 'time)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-closed-keep-when-no-todo
#+texinfo: @noindent
Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
of the DONE states, a line =CLOSED: [timestamp]= is inserted just
after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
through further state cycling, that line is removed again. If you
turn the entry back to a non-TODO state (by pressing {{{kbd(C-c C-t
SPC)}}} for example), that line is also removed, unless you set
~org-closed-keep-when-no-todo~ to non-~nil~. If you want to record
a note along with the timestamp, use[fn:43]
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-log-done 'note)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
You are then be prompted for a note, and that note is stored below the
entry with a =Closing Note= heading.
*** Tracking TODO state changes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: When did the status change?
:END:
#+cindex: drawer, for state change recording
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-log-states-order-reversed
#+vindex: org-log-into-drawer
#+cindex: @samp{LOG_INTO_DRAWER}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (see [[*TODO keywords as workflow states][*Workflow states]]),
you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe
take a note about this change. You can either record just a
timestamp, or a time-stamped note. These records are inserted after
the headline as an itemized list, newest first[fn:44]. When taking a
lot of notes, you might want to get the notes out of the way into a
drawer (see [[*Drawers]]). Customize the variable ~org-log-into-drawer~
to get this behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called
=LOGBOOK=[fn:45]. You can also overrule the setting of this variable
for a subtree by setting a =LOG_INTO_DRAWER= property.
Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org
mode expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
achieved by adding special markers =!= (for a timestamp) or =@= (for
a note with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For
example, with the setting
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@)")))
#+end_src
#+texinfo: @noindent
to record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=@=, just type {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} to enter a blank note when prompted.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-log-done
You not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
also request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to =DONE=,
and that a note is recorded when switching to =WAIT= or
=CANCELED=[fn:46]. The setting for =WAIT= is even more special: the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=!= after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when /leaving/ the
=WAIT= state, if and only if the /target/ state does not configure
logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from
=WAIT= to =DONE=, because =DONE= is configured to record a timestamp
only. But when switching from =WAIT= back to =TODO=, the =/!= in the
=WAIT= setting now triggers a timestamp even though =TODO= has no
logging configured.
You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
to a buffer:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@)
#+cindex: @samp{LOGGING}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or
a single item, define a =LOGGING= property in this entry. Any
non-empty =LOGGING= property resets all logging settings to ~nil~.
You may then turn on logging for this specific tree using =STARTUP=
keywords like =lognotedone= or =logrepeat=, as well as adding state
specific settings like =TODO(!)=. For example:
#+begin_example
,* TODO Log each state with only a time
:PROPERTIES:
:LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
:END:
,* TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
:PROPERTIES:
:LOGGING: WAIT(@) logrepeat
:END:
,* TODO No logging at all
:PROPERTIES:
:LOGGING: nil
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Tracking your habits
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How consistent have you been?
:END:
#+cindex: habits
#+cindex: @samp{STYLE}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of
TODO, called "habits." To use habits, you have to enable the ~habits~
module by customizing the variable ~org-modules~.
A habit has the following properties:
1. The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
state.
2. The property =STYLE= is set to the value =habit= (see [[*Properties
and Columns]]).
3. The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a =.+= style repeat
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
interval. A =++= style may be appropriate for habits with time
constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a =+= style for an
unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4. The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
using the syntax =.+2d/3d=, which says that you want to do the task
at least every three days, but at most every two days.
5. State logging for the DONE state is enabled (see [[*Tracking TODO
state changes]]), in order for historical data to be represented in
the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an error,
but the consistency graphs are largely meaningless.
To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
actual habit with some history:
#+begin_example
,** TODO Shave
SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
:PROPERTIES:
:STYLE: habit
:LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
:END:
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
#+end_example
What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days---given
by the =SCHEDULED= date and repeat interval---and at least every
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
4 days. If today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the
agenda (see [[*Agenda Views]]) on Oct 17, after the minimum of 2 days has
elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19, after four days have
elapsed.
What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along
with a consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at
getting that task done in the past. This graph shows every day that
the task was done over the past three weeks, with colors for each day.
The colors used are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Blue :: If the task was not to be done yet on that day.
- Green :: If the task could have been done on that day.
- Yellow :: If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
- Red :: If the task was overdue on that day.
In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an
asterisk if the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation
mark to show where the current day falls in the graph.
There are several configuration variables that can be used to change
the way habits are displayed in the agenda.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-habit-graph-column~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-habit-graph-column
The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn.
This overwrites any text in that column, so it is a good idea to
keep your habits' titles brief and to the point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-habit-preceding-days~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-habit-preceding-days
The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in
consistency graphs.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-habit-following-days~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-habit-following-days
The number of days after today that appear in consistency graphs.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
If non-~nil~, only show habits in today's agenda view. The
default value is ~t~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Lastly, pressing {{{kbd(K)}}} in the agenda buffer causes habits to
temporarily be disabled and do not appear at all. Press {{{kbd(K)}}}
again to bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if
you have habits which should only be done in certain contexts, for
example.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Priorities
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Some things are more important than others.
:END:
#+cindex: priorities
#+cindex: priority cookie
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items
that it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be
done by placing a /priority cookie/ into the headline of a TODO item,
like this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-priority-faces
By default, Org mode supports three priorities: =A=, =B=, and =C=.
=A= is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is treated as
equivalent if it had priority =B=. Priorities make a difference only
for sorting in the agenda (see [[*Weekly/daily agenda]]); outside the
agenda, they have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies are
displayed with the face defined by the variable ~org-priority-faces~,
which can be customized.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be
TODO items.
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ;
- {{{kbd(C-c \,)}}} (~org-priority~) ::
#+kindex: C-c ,
#+findex: org-priority
Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts
for a priority character =A=, =B= or =C=. When you press
{{{kbd(SPC)}}} instead, the priority cookie, if one is set, is
removed from the headline. The priorities can also be changed
"remotely" from the agenda buffer with the {{{kbd(\,)}}} command
(see [[*Commands in the Agenda Buffer]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} (~org-priority-up~); {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} (~org-priority-down~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: S-UP
#+kindex: S-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-priority-up
#+findex: org-priority-down
#+vindex: org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
Increase/decrease the priority of the current headline[fn:47].
Note that these keys are also used to modify timestamps (see
[[*Creating Timestamps]]). See also [[*Packages that conflict with Org
mode]], for a discussion of the interaction with
~shift-selection-mode~.
#+vindex: org-highest-priority
#+vindex: org-lowest-priority
#+vindex: org-default-priority
You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the
variables ~org-highest-priority~, ~org-lowest-priority~, and
~org-default-priority~. For an individual buffer, you may set these
values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that the
highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest priority):
#+cindex: @samp{PRIORITIES}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+PRIORITIES: A C B
** Breaking Down Tasks into Subtasks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Splitting a task into manageable pieces.
:ALT_TITLE: Breaking Down Tasks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: tasks, breaking down
#+cindex: statistics, for TODO items
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
manageable subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree
below a TODO item, with detailed subtasks on the tree[fn:48]. To keep
an overview of the fraction of subtasks that have already been marked
DONE, insert either =[/]= or =[%]= anywhere in the headline. These
cookies are updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or
when pressing {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} on the cookie. For example:
#+begin_example
,* Organize Party [33%]
,** TODO Call people [1/2]
,*** TODO Peter
,*** DONE Sarah
,** TODO Buy food
,** DONE Talk to neighbor
#+end_example
#+cindex: @samp{COOKIE_DATA}, property
If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the
meaning of the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=COOKIE_DATA= to either =checkbox= or =todo= to resolve this issue.
#+vindex: org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries
in the subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
~org-hierarchical-todo-statistics~. To do this for a single subtree,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
include the word =recursive= into the value of the =COOKIE_DATA=
property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example org
,* Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
:PROPERTIES:
:COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when
all children are done, you can use the following setup:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
"Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
(let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
(org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
(add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
#+end_src
Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
of) a large number of subtasks (see [[*Checkboxes]]).
** Checkboxes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tick-off lists.
:END:
#+cindex: checkboxes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-list-automatic-rules
Every item in a plain list[fn:49] (see [[*Plain Lists]]) can be made into
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a checkbox by starting it with the string =[ ]=. This feature is
similar to TODO items (see [[*TODO Items]]), but is more lightweight.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are
often great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can
use them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use {{{kbd(C-c
C-c)}}}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
=org-mouse.el=).
Here is an example of a checkbox list.
#+begin_example
,* TODO Organize party [2/4]
- [-] call people [1/3]
- [ ] Peter
- [X] Sarah
- [ ] Sam
- [X] order food
- [ ] think about what music to play
- [X] talk to the neighbors
#+end_example
Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
that are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes makes the
parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
checked.
#+cindex: statistics, for checkboxes
#+cindex: checkbox statistics
#+cindex: @samp{COOKIE_DATA}, property
#+vindex: org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =[2/4]= and =[1/3]= in the first and second line are cookies
indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked
off, and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an
idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded
entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the first
line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct
children structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie
appears[fn:50]. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
either =[/]= or =[%]=. With =[/]= you get an =n out of m= result, as
in the examples above. With =[%]= you get information about the
percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=[50%]= and =[33%]=, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can count
either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
displays whatever was changed last. Set the property =COOKIE_DATA= to
either =checkbox= or =todo= to resolve this issue.
#+cindex: blocking, of checkboxes
#+cindex: checkbox blocking
#+cindex: @samp{ORDERED}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If the current outline node has an =ORDERED= property, checkboxes must
be checked off in sequence, and an error is thrown if you try to check
off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following commands work with checkboxes:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-toggle-checkbox~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+findex: org-toggle-checkbox
Toggle checkbox status or---with prefix argument---checkbox
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
presence at point. With a single prefix argument, add an empty
checkbox or remove the current one[fn:51]. With a double prefix
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
argument, set it to =[-]=, which is considered to be an
intermediate state.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-b)}}} (~org-toggle-checkbox~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-b
Toggle checkbox status or---with prefix argument---checkbox
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
presence at point. With double prefix argument, set it to =[-]=,
which is considered to be an intermediate state.
- If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the
region and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the
first. With a prefix argument, add or remove the checkbox for
all items in the region.
- If point is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region
between this headline and the next---so /not/ the entire
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
subtree.
- If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at
point.
- {{{kbd(M-S-RET)}}} (~org-insert-todo-heading~) ::
#+kindex: M-S-RET
#+findex: org-insert-todo-heading
Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if point
is already in a plain list item (see [[*Plain Lists]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x o)}}} (~org-toggle-ordered-property~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x o
#+findex: org-toggle-ordered-property
#+vindex: org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
Toggle the =ORDERED= property of the entry, to toggle if
checkboxes must be checked off in sequence. A property is used
for this behavior because this should be local to the current
entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to
/track/ the value of this property with a tag for better
visibility, customize ~org-track-ordered-property-with-tag~.
- {{{kbd(C-c #)}}} (~org-update-statistics-cookies~) ::
#+kindex: C-c #
#+findex: org-update-statistics-cookies
Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When
called with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, update the entire file.
Checkbox statistic cookies are updated automatically if you
toggle checkboxes with {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} and make new ones with
{{{kbd(M-S-RET)}}}. TODO statistics cookies update when changing
TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
* Tags
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags.
:END:
#+cindex: tags
#+cindex: headline tagging
#+cindex: matching, tags
#+cindex: sparse tree, tag based
An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for
cross-correlating information is to assign /tags/ to headlines. Org
mode has extensive support for tags.
#+vindex: org-tag-faces
Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, =_=,
and =@=. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
=:work:=. Several tags can be specified, as in =:work:urgent:=. Tags
by default are in bold face with the same color as the headline. You
may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
~org-tag-faces~, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
(see [[*Faces for TODO keywords]]).
** Tag Inheritance
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tags use the tree structure of an outline.
:END:
#+cindex: tag inheritance
#+cindex: inheritance, of tags
#+cindex: sublevels, inclusion into tags match
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
/Tags/ make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If
a heading has a certain tag, all subheadings inherit the tag as well.
For example, in the list
#+begin_example
,* Meeting with the French group :work:
,** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
,*** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
the final heading has the tags =work=, =boss=, =notes=, and =action=
even though the final heading is not explicitly marked with those
tags. You can also set tags that all entries in a file should inherit
just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical level zero that
surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this[fn:52]
#+cindex: @samp{FILETAGS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
#+vindex: org-use-tag-inheritance
#+vindex: org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely,
use the variables ~org-use-tag-inheritance~ and
~org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance~.
#+vindex: org-tags-match-list-sublevels
When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is
turned on, all the sublevels in the same tree---for a simple match
form---match as well[fn:53]. The list of matches may then become
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
very long. If you only want to see the first tags match in a subtree,
configure the variable ~org-tags-match-list-sublevels~ (not
recommended).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match
a tag, either in the ~tags~ or ~tags-todo~ agenda types. In other
agenda types, ~org-use-tag-inheritance~ has no effect. Still, you may
want to have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag
filtering works fine, with inherited tags. Set
~org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance~ to control this: the default value
includes all agenda types, but setting this to ~nil~ can really speed
up agenda generation.
** Setting Tags
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to assign tags to a headline.
:END:
#+cindex: setting tags
#+cindex: tags, setting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-TAB
Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
After a colon, {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} offers completion on tags. There is
also a special command for inserting tags:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-q)}}} (~org-set-tags-command~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-q
#+findex: org-set-tags-command
#+cindex: completion, of tags
#+vindex: org-tags-column
Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode either offers
completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags,
see below. After pressing {{{kbd(RET)}}}, the tags are inserted
and aligned to ~org-tags-column~. When called with
a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, all tags in the current buffer are
aligned to that column, just to make things look nice. Tags are
automatically realigned after promotion, demotion, and TODO state
changes (see [[*Basic TODO Functionality]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-set-tags-command~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
When point is in a headline, this does the same as {{{kbd(C-c
C-q)}}}.
#+vindex: org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags
#+vindex: org-tag-alist
#+cindex: @samp{TAGS}, keyword
Org supports tag insertion based on a /list of tags/. By default this
list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags currently used in
the buffer[fn:54]. You may also globally specify a hard list of tags
with the variable ~org-tag-alist~. Finally you can set the default
tags for a given file using the =TAGS= keyword, like
#+begin_example
,#+TAGS: @work @home @tennisclub
,#+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
#+end_example
If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
variable ~org-tag-alist~, but would like to use a dynamic tag list in
a specific file, add an empty =TAGS= keyword to that file:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TAGS:
#+vindex: org-tag-persistent-alist
If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
every file, in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by =TAGS=
keyword, then you may specify a list of tags with the variable
~org-tag-persistent-alist~. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
by adding a =STARTUP= keyword to that file:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+STARTUP: noptag
By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities
for entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag
selection method called /fast tag selection/. This allows you to
select and deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to
work well you should assign unique letters to most of your commonly
used tags. You can do this globally by configuring the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-tag-alist~ in your Emacs init file. For example, you may find
the need to tag many items in different files with =@home=. In this
case you can set something like:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-tag-alist '(("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
can instead set the =TAGS= keyword as:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The tags interface shows the available tags in a splash window. If
you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert =\n= into
the tag list
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or write them in two lines:
#+begin_example
,#+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t)
,#+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
#+end_example
You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
braces, as in:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TAGS: { @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) } laptop(l) pc(p)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
you indicate that at most one of =@work=, =@home=, and =@tennisclub=
should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
Do not forget to press {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} with point in one of these
lines to activate any changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable
~org-tags-alist~, you must use the dummy tags ~:startgroup~ and
~:endgroup~ instead of the braces. Similarly, you can use ~:newline~
to indicate a line break. The previous example would be set globally
by the following configuration:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h)
("@tennisclub" . ?t)
(:endgroup . nil)
("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing {{{kbd(C-c
C-c)}}} automatically presents you with a special interface, listing
inherited tags, the tags of the current headline, and a list of all
valid tags with corresponding keys[fn:55].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Pressing keys assigned to tags adds or removes them from the list of
tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
exclusive tags turns off any other tag from that group.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In this interface, you can also use the following special keys:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: TAB
Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the
predefined list. You can complete on all tags present in the
buffer. You can also add several tags: just separate them with
a comma.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(SPC)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: SPC
Clear all tags for this line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(RET)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: RET
Accept the modified set.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-g)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-g
Abort without installing changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(q)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: q
If {{{kbd(q)}}} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like
{{{kbd(C-g)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(!)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: !
Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
exception) assign several tags from such a group.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below). If you are
using expert mode, the first {{{kbd(C-c)}}} displays the
selection window.
This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys.
With the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set
=@home=, =laptop= and =pc= tags with just the following keys:
{{{kbd(C-c C-c SPC h l p RET)}}}. Switching from =@home= to =@work=
would be done with {{{kbd(C-c C-c w RET)}}} or alternatively with
{{{kbd(C-c C-c C-c w)}}}. Adding the non-predefined tag =sarah= could
be done with {{{kbd(C-c C-c TAB s a r a h RET)}}}.
#+vindex: org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
modify your list of tags, set the variable
~org-fast-tag-selection-single-key~. Then you no longer have to press
{{{kbd(RET)}}} to exit fast tag selection---it exits after the first
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press {{{kbd(C-c)}}}
to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process (in
effect: start selection with {{{kbd(C-c C-c C-c)}}} instead of
{{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}}). If you set the variable to the value ~expert~,
the special window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it
comes up only when you press an extra {{{kbd(C-c)}}}.
** Tag Hierarchy
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Create a hierarchy of tags.
:END:
#+cindex: group tags
#+cindex: tags, groups
#+cindex: tags hierarchy
Tags can be defined in hierarchies. A tag can be defined as a /group
tag/ for a set of other tags. The group tag can be seen as the
"broader term" for its set of tags. Defining multiple group tags and
nesting them creates a tag hierarchy.
One use-case is to create a taxonomy of terms (tags) that can be used
to classify nodes in a document or set of documents.
When you search for a group tag, it return matches for all members in
the group and its subgroups. In an agenda view, filtering by a group
tag displays or hide headlines tagged with at least one of the members
of the group or any of its subgroups. This makes tag searches and
filters even more flexible.
You can set group tags by using brackets and inserting a colon between
the group tag and its related tags---beware that all whitespaces are
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
mandatory so that Org can parse this line correctly:
: #+TAGS: [ GTD : Control Persp ]
In this example, =GTD= is the group tag and it is related to two other
tags: =Control=, =Persp=. Defining =Control= and =Persp= as group
tags creates a hierarchy of tags:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+TAGS: [ Control : Context Task ]
,#+TAGS: [ Persp : Vision Goal AOF Project ]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
That can conceptually be seen as a hierarchy of tags:
- =GTD=
- =Persp=
- =Vision=
- =Goal=
- =AOF=
- =Project=
- =Control=
- =Context=
- =Task=
You can use the ~:startgrouptag~, ~:grouptags~ and ~:endgrouptag~
keyword directly when setting ~org-tag-alist~ directly:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-tag-alist '((:startgrouptag)
("GTD")
(:grouptags)
("Control")
("Persp")
(:endgrouptag)
(:startgrouptag)
("Control")
(:grouptags)
("Context")
("Task")
(:endgrouptag)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
The tags in a group can be mutually exclusive if using the same group
syntax as is used for grouping mutually exclusive tags together; using
curly brackets.
: #+TAGS: { Context : @Home @Work @Call }
When setting ~org-tag-alist~ you can use ~:startgroup~ and ~:endgroup~
instead of ~:startgrouptag~ and ~:endgrouptag~ to make the tags
mutually exclusive.
Furthermore, the members of a group tag can also be regular
expressions, creating the possibility of a more dynamic and rule-based
tag structure. The regular expressions in the group must be specified
within curly brackets. Here is an expanded example:
#+begin_example
,#+TAGS: [ Vision : {V@.+} ]
,#+TAGS: [ Goal : {G@.+} ]
,#+TAGS: [ AOF : {AOF@.+} ]
,#+TAGS: [ Project : {P@.+} ]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
Searching for the tag =Project= now lists all tags also including
regular expression matches for =P@.+=, and similarly for tag searches
on =Vision=, =Goal= and =AOF=. For example, this would work well for
a project tagged with a common project-identifier, e.g.,
=P@2014_OrgTags=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x q
#+findex: org-toggle-tags-groups
#+vindex: org-group-tags
If you want to ignore group tags temporarily, toggle group tags
support with ~org-toggle-tags-groups~, bound to {{{kbd(C-c C-x q)}}}.
If you want to disable tag groups completely, set ~org-group-tags~ to
~nil~.
** Tag Searches
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Searching for combinations of tags.
:END:
#+cindex: tag searches
#+cindex: searching for tags
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect
related information into special lists.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c / m)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c \)}}} (~org-match-sparse-tree~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c / m
#+kindex: C-c \
#+findex: org-match-sparse-tree
Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search.
With a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are
not a TODO line.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda m)}}} (~org-tags-view~) ::
#+kindex: m @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-tags-view
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. See
[[*Matching tags and properties]].
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda M)}}} (~org-tags-view~) ::
#+kindex: M @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-tags-match-list-sublevels
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but
check only TODO items and force checking subitems (see the option
~org-tags-match-list-sublevels~).
These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Boolean logic like =+boss+urgent-project1=, to find entries with tags
=boss= and =urgent=, but not =project1=, or =Kathy|Sally= to find
entries which are tagged, like =Kathy= or =Sally=. The full syntax of
the search string is rich and allows also matching against TODO
keywords, entry levels and properties. For a complete description
with many examples, see [[*Matching tags and properties]].
* Properties and Columns
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Storing information about an entry.
:END:
#+cindex: properties
A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties
can be set so they are associated with a single entry, with every
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
entry in a tree, or with every entry in an Org file.
There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining
a file where you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of
software. Instead of using tags like =release_1=, =release_2=, you
can use a property, say =Release=, that in different subtrees has
different values, such as =1.0= or =2.0=. Second, you can use
properties to implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org
buffer. Imagine keeping track of your music CDs, where properties
could be things such as the album, artist, date of release, number of
tracks, and so on.
Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view (see
[[*Column View]]).
** Property Syntax
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How properties are spelled out.
:END:
#+cindex: property syntax
#+cindex: drawer, for properties
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Properties are key--value pairs. When they are associated with
a single entry or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
drawer (see [[*Drawers]]) with the name =PROPERTIES=, which has to be
located right below a headline, and its planning line (see [[*Deadlines
and Scheduling]]) when applicable. Each property is specified on
a single line, with the key---surrounded by colons---first, and the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
value after it. Keys are case-insensitive. Here is an example:
#+begin_example
,* CD collection
,** Classic
,*** Goldberg Variations
:PROPERTIES:
:Title: Goldberg Variations
:Composer: J.S. Bach
:Artist: Glenn Gould
:Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
:NDisks: 1
:END:
#+end_example
Depending on the value of ~org-use-property-inheritance~, a property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
set this way is associated either with a single entry, or with the
sub-tree defined by the entry, see [[*Property Inheritance]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You may define the allowed values for a particular property =Xyz= by
setting a property =Xyz_ALL=. This special property is /inherited/,
so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it applies to the entire tree.
When allowed values are defined, setting the corresponding property
becomes easier and is less prone to typing errors. For the example
with the CD collection, we can pre-define publishers and the number of
disks in a box like this:
#+begin_example
,* CD collection
:PROPERTIES:
:NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
:Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in
a file, use a line like:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{_ALL} suffix, in properties
#+cindex: @samp{PROPERTY}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{+} suffix, in properties
If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a =+=
to the property name. The following results in the property =var=
having the value =foo=1 bar=2=.
#+begin_example
,#+PROPERTY: var foo=1
,#+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
#+end_example
It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
following results in the =Genres= property having the value =Classic
Baroque= under the =Goldberg Variations= subtree.
#+begin_example
,* CD collection
,** Classic
:PROPERTIES:
:Genres: Classic
:END:
,*** Goldberg Variations
:PROPERTIES:
:Title: Goldberg Variations
:Composer: J.S. Bach
:Artist: Glenn Gould
:Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
:NDisks: 1
:Genres+: Baroque
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that a property can only have one entry per drawer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-global-properties
Property values set with the global variable ~org-global-properties~
can be inherited by all entries in all Org files.
The following commands help to work with properties:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} (~pcomplete~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-TAB
#+findex: pcomplete
After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All
keys used in the current file are offered as possible
completions.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x p)}}} (~org-set-property~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x p
#+findex: org-set-property
Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value.
If necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u M-x org-insert-drawer)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-insert-drawer
Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer is
inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
information like deadlines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-property-action~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+findex: org-property-action
With point in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c s)}}} (~org-set-property~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c s
#+findex: org-set-property
Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
can be inserted using completion.
- {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-property-next-allowed-values~), {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} (~org-property-previous-allowed-value~) ::
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
#+kindex: S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c d)}}} (~org-delete-property~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c d
#+findex: org-delete-property
Remove a property from the current entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c D)}}} (~org-delete-property-globally~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c D
#+findex: org-delete-property-globally
Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c c)}}} (~org-compute-property-at-point~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c c
#+findex: org-compute-property-at-point
Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from
the nearest column format definition.
** Special Properties
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Access to other Org mode features.
:END:
#+cindex: properties, special
Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode
features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed
in the previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can
include these states in a column view (see [[*Column View]]), or to use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
them in queries. The following property names are special and should
not be used as keys in the properties drawer:
#+cindex: @samp{ALLTAGS}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{BLOCKED}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{CLOCKSUM}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{CLOCKSUM_T}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{CLOSED}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{DEADLINE}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{FILE}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{ITEM}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{PRIORITY}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{SCHEDULED}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{TAGS}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{TIMESTAMP}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{TIMESTAMP_IA}, special property
#+cindex: @samp{TODO}, special property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| =ALLTAGS= | All tags, including inherited ones. |
| =BLOCKED= | ~t~ if task is currently blocked by children or siblings. |
| =CATEGORY= | The category of an entry. |
| =CLOCKSUM= | The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. ~org-clock-sum~ |
| | must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer. |
| =CLOCKSUM_T= | The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today. |
| | ~org-clock-sum-today~ must be run first to compute the |
| | values in the current buffer. |
| =CLOSED= | When was this entry closed? |
| =DEADLINE= | The deadline time string, without the angular brackets. |
| =FILE= | The filename the entry is located in. |
| =ITEM= | The headline of the entry. |
| =PRIORITY= | The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter. |
| =SCHEDULED= | The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets. |
| =TAGS= | The tags defined directly in the headline. |
| =TIMESTAMP= | The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry. |
| =TIMESTAMP_IA= | The first inactive timestamp in the entry. |
| =TODO= | The TODO keyword of the entry. |
** Property Searches
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Matching property values.
:END:
#+cindex: properties, searching
#+cindex: searching, of properties
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on
properties, the same commands are used as for tag searches (see [[*Tag
Searches]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c / m)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c \)}}} (~org-match-sparse-tree~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c / m
#+kindex: C-c \
#+findex: org-match-sparse-tree
Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With
a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not
a TODO line.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda m)}}}, ~org-tags-view~ ::
#+kindex: m @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
#+findex: org-tags-view
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda
files.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda M)}}} (~org-tags-view~) ::
#+kindex: M @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-tags-match-list-sublevels
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but
check only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see the
option ~org-tags-match-list-sublevels~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The syntax for the search string is described in [[*Matching tags and
properties]].
There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
single property:
- {{{kbd(C-c / p)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c / p
Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This
first prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value.
A sparse tree is created with all entries that define this
property with the given value. If you enclose the value in curly
braces, it is interpreted as a regular expression and matched
against the property values.
** Property Inheritance
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Passing values down a tree.
:END:
#+cindex: properties, inheritance
#+cindex: inheritance, of properties
#+vindex: org-use-property-inheritance
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The outline structure of Org documents lends itself to an inheritance
model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain property,
the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not turn this
on by default, because it can slow down property searches
significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find
inheritance useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
~org-use-property-inheritance~. It may be set to ~t~ to make all
properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties that
should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches inherited
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
properties. If a property has the value ~nil~, this is interpreted as
an explicit un-define of the property, so that inheritance search
stops at this value and returns ~nil~.
Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
least for the special applications for which they are used:
- ~COLUMNS~ ::
#+cindex: @samp{COLUMNS}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =COLUMNS= property defines the format of column view (see
[[*Column View]]). It is inherited in the sense that the level where
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a =COLUMNS= property is defined is used as the starting point for
a column view table, independently of the location in the subtree
from where columns view is turned on.
- ~CATEGORY~ ::
#+cindex: @samp{CATEGORY}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For agenda view, a category set through a =CATEGORY= property
applies to the entire subtree.
- ~ARCHIVE~ ::
#+cindex: @samp{ARCHIVE}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For archiving, the =ARCHIVE= property may define the archive
location for the entire subtree (see [[*Moving a tree to an archive
file]]).
- ~LOGGING~ ::
#+cindex: @samp{LOGGING}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =LOGGING= property may define logging settings for an entry
or a subtree (see [[*Tracking TODO state changes]]).
** Column View
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tabular viewing and editing.
:END:
A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is /column
view/. In column view, each outline node is turned into a table row.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Columns in this table provide access to properties of the entries.
Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure over the
headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned into
a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline tree.
For example, you get a compact table by switching to "contents"
view---{{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}}, or simply {{{kbd(c)}}}
while column view is active---but you can still open, read, and edit
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the entry below each headline. Or, you can switch to column view
after executing a sparse tree command and in this way get a table only
for the selected items. Column view also works in agenda buffers (see
[[*Agenda Views]]) where queries have collected selected items, possibly
from a number of files.
*** Defining columns
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The COLUMNS format property.
:END:
#+cindex: column view, for properties
#+cindex: properties, column view
Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
done by defining a column format line.
**** Scope of column definitions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Where defined, where valid?
:END:
To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like:
#+cindex: @samp{COLUMNS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add
a =COLUMNS= property to the top node of that tree, for example:
#+begin_example
,** Top node for columns view
:PROPERTIES:
:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If a =COLUMNS= property is present in an entry, it defines columns for
the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the
document, you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough
for all sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you
edit a deeper part of the tree.
**** Column attributes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Appearance and content of a column.
:END:
A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
definition looks like this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: %[WIDTH]PROPERTY[(TITLE)][{SUMMARY-TYPE}]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{var(WIDTH)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
An integer specifying the width of the column in characters. If
omitted, the width is determined automatically.
- {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} ::
The property that should be edited in this column. Special
properties representing meta data are allowed here as well (see
[[*Special Properties]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{var(TITLE)}}} ::
The header text for the column. If omitted, the property name is
used.
- {{{var(SUMMARY-TYPE)}}} ::
The summary type. If specified, the column values for parent
nodes are computed from the children[fn:56].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Supported summary types are:
| =+= | Sum numbers in this column. |
| =+;%.1f= | Like =+=, but format result with =%.1f=. |
| =$= | Currency, short for =+;%.2f=. |
| =min= | Smallest number in column. |
| =max= | Largest number. |
| =mean= | Arithmetic mean of numbers. |
| =X= | Checkbox status, =[X]= if all children are =[X]=. |
| =X/= | Checkbox status, =[n/m]=. |
| =X%= | Checkbox status, =[n%]=. |
| =:= | Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours. |
| =:min= | Smallest time value in column. |
| =:max= | Largest time value. |
| =:mean= | Arithmetic mean of time values. |
| =@min= | Minimum age[fn:57] (in days/hours/mins/seconds). |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| =@max= | Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds). |
| =@mean= | Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds). |
| =est+= | Add low-high estimates. |
#+vindex: org-columns-summary-types
You can also define custom summary types by setting
~org-columns-summary-types~.
The =est+= summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example,
instead of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might
2018-03-02 19:41:44 -05:00
estimate it as 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much
work is required, or 1--10 days if you do not really know what needs
to be done. Both ranges average at 5.5 days, but the first represents
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a more predictable delivery.
When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
highs produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, =est+= adds
the statistical mean and variance of the subtasks, generating a final
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
estimate from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each
of which was estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition
produces an estimate of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if
everything goes either extremely well or extremely poorly. In
2018-03-02 19:41:44 -05:00
contrast, =est+= estimates the full job more realistically, at 10--15
days.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with
allowed values[fn:58].
#+begin_example
:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?){X} %Owner %11Status \
%10Time_Estimate{:} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
:Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
:Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
:Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The first column, =%25ITEM=, means the first 25 characters of the item
itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
column definition with the =ITEM= specifier. The other specifiers
create columns =Owner= with a list of names as allowed values, for
=Status= with four different possible values, and for a checkbox field
=Approved=. When no width is given after the =%= character, the
column is exactly as wide as it needs to be in order to fully display
all values. The =Approved= column does have a modified title
(=Approved?=, with a question mark). Summaries are created for the
=Time_Estimate= column by adding time duration expressions like HH:MM,
and for the =Approved= column, by providing an =[X]= status if all
children have been checked. The =CLOCKSUM= and =CLOCKSUM_T= columns
are special, they lists the sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree,
either for all clocks or just for today.
*** Using column view
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to create and use column view.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Turning column view on or off
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-c)}}} (~org-columns~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-c
#+vindex: org-columns
#+vindex: org-columns-default-format
Turn on column view. If point is before the first headline in
the file, column view is turned on for the entire file, using the
=#+COLUMNS= definition. If point is somewhere inside the
outline, this command searches the hierarchy, up from point, for
a =COLUMNS= property that defines a format. When one is found,
the column view table is established for the tree starting at the
entry that contains the =COLUMNS= property. If no such property
is found, the format is taken from the =#+COLUMNS= line or from
the variable ~org-columns-default-format~, and column view is
established for the current entry and its subtree.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(r)}}} or {{{kbd(g)}}} (~org-columns-redo~) ::
#+kindex: r
#+kindex: g
#+findex: org-columns-redo
Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the
buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(q)}}} (~org-columns-quit~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: q
#+findex: org-columns-quit
Exit column view.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Editing values
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep and
- {{{kbd(LEFT)}}}, {{{kbd(RIGHT)}}}, {{{kbd(UP)}}}, {{{kbd(DOWN)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Move through the column view from field to field.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(1..9\,0)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: 1..9,0
Directly select the Nth allowed value, {{{kbd(0)}}} selects the
10th value.
- {{{kbd(n)}}} or {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-columns-next-allowed-value~) and {{{kbd(p)}}} or {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} (~org-columns-previous-allowed-value~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: n
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: p
#+kindex: S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-columns-next-allowed-value
#+findex: org-columns-previous-allowed-value
Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For
this, you have to have specified allowed values for a property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(e)}}} (~org-columns-edit-value~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: e
#+findex: org-columns-edit-value
Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this
invokes the same interface that you normally use to change that
property. For example, the tag completion or fast selection
interface pops up when editing a =TAGS= property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+findex: org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle
When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(v)}}} (~org-columns-show-value~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: v
#+findex: org-columns-show-value
View the full value of this property. This is useful if the
width of the column is smaller than that of the value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(a)}}} (~org-columns-edit-allowed~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: a
#+findex: org-columns-edit-allowed
Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list
is found in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there.
If no list is found, the new value is stored in the first entry
that is part of the current column view.
**** Modifying column view on-the-fly
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep and
- {{{kbd(<)}}} (~org-columns-narrow~) and {{{kbd(>)}}} (~org-columns-widen~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: <
#+kindex: >
#+findex: org-columns-narrow
#+findex: org-columns-widen
Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
- {{{kbd(S-M-RIGHT)}}} (~org-columns-new~) ::
#+kindex: S-M-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-columns-new
Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
- {{{kbd(S-M-LEFT)}}} (~org-columns-delete~) ::
#+kindex: S-M-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-columns-delete
Delete the current column.
*** Capturing column view
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: A dynamic block for column view.
:END:
Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view,
use a =columnview= dynamic block (see [[*Dynamic Blocks]]). The frame of
this block looks like this:
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN columnview}
#+begin_example
,* The column view
,#+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
,#+END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This dynamic block has the following parameters:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:id= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature
that is often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture
block might be at a different location in the file. To identify
the tree whose view to capture, you can use four values:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =local= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Use the tree in which the capture block is located.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =global= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Make a global view, including all headings in the file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =file:FILENAME= ::
Run column view at the top of the {{{var(FILENAME)}}} file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =LABEL= ::
#+cindex: @samp{ID}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Call column view in the tree that has an =ID= property with
the value {{{var(LABEL)}}}. You can use {{{kbd(M-x
org-id-copy)}}} to create a globally unique ID for the
current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:hlines= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When ~t~, insert an hline after every line. When a number N,
insert an hline before each headline with level ~<= N~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:vlines= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When non-~nil~, force column groups to get vertical lines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:maxlevel= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When set to a number, do not capture entries below this level.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:skip-empty-rows= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When non-~nil~, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of
the column view is =ITEM=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:indent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When non-~nil~, indent each =ITEM= field according to its level.
- =:format= ::
Specify a column attribute (see [[*Column attributes]]) for the
dynamic block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x i)}}} (~org-insert-columns-dblock~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x i
#+findex: org-insert-columns-dblock
Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. Prompt for the
scope or ID of the view.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-u)}}} (~org-dblock-update~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-u
#+findex: org-dblock-update
Update dynamic block at point. point needs to be in the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=#+BEGIN= line of the dynamic block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-x C-u)}}} (~org-update-all-dblocks~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-x C-u
Update all dynamic blocks (see [[*Dynamic Blocks]]). This is useful
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
if you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks
or other dynamic blocks in a buffer.
You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
instructions in front of the table---these survive an update of the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
block. If there is a =TBLFM= keyword after the table, the table is
recalculated automatically after an update.
An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table
is provided by Eric Schulte's =org-collector.el=, which is
a contributed package[fn:59]. It provides a general API to collect
properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp
expressions to process these values before inserting them into a table
or a dynamic block.
* Dates and Times
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Making items useful for planning.
:END:
#+cindex: dates
#+cindex: times
#+cindex: timestamp
#+cindex: date stamp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date
and/or a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and
time information is called a /timestamp/ in Org mode. This may be
a little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
is used in a much wider sense.
** Timestamps, Deadlines and Scheduling
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Assigning a time to a tree entry.
:ALT_TITLE: Timestamps
:END:
#+cindex: timestamps
#+cindex: ranges, time
#+cindex: date stamps
#+cindex: deadlines
#+cindex: scheduling
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or
a range of times) in a special format, either =<2003-09-16 Tue>= or
=<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>= or =<2003-09-16 Tue 12:00-12:30>=[fn:60].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree
entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the agenda (see [[*Weekly/daily agenda]]). We distinguish:
- Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: timestamp
#+cindex: appointment
A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is
just like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda.
In the agenda display, the headline of an entry associated with
a plain timestamp is shown exactly on that date.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Meet Peter at the movies
<2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
,* Discussion on climate change
<2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Timestamp with repeater interval ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: timestamp, with repeater interval
A timestamp may contain a /repeater interval/, indicating that it
applies not only on the given date, but again and again after
a certain interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years
(y). The following shows up in the agenda every Wednesday:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Pick up Sam at school
<2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Diary-style sexp entries ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: diary style timestamps
#+cindex: sexp timestamps
For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the
special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs
calendar/diary package[fn:61]. For example, with optional time:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
<%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Time/Date range ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: timerange
#+cindex: date range
Two timestamps connected by =--= denote a range. The headline is
shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,** Meeting in Amsterdam
<2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Inactive timestamp ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: timestamp, inactive
#+cindex: inactive timestamp
Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that
they do /not/ trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Gillian comes late for the fifth time
[2006-11-01 Wed]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** Creating Timestamps
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Commands to insert timestamps.
:END:
For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
format.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-c .)}}} (~org-time-stamp~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c .
#+findex: org-time-stamp
Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When
point is at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
used to modify this timestamp instead of inserting a new one.
When this command is used twice in succession, a time range is
inserted.
#+kindex: C-u C-c .
#+vindex: org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
When called with a prefix argument, use the alternative format
which contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to
multiples of 5 minutes. See the option
~org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes~.
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c .
With two prefix arguments, insert an active timestamp with the
current time without prompting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c !)}}} (~org-time-stamp-inactive~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c !
#+kindex: C-u C-c !
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c !
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-time-stamp-inactive
Like {{{kbd(C-c .)}}}, but insert an inactive timestamp that does
not cause an agenda entry.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
Normalize timestamp, insert or fix day name if missing or wrong.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c <)}}} (~org-date-from-calendar~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c <
#+findex: org-date-from-calendar
Insert a timestamp corresponding to point date in the calendar.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c >)}}} (~org-goto-calendar~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c >
#+findex: org-goto-calendar
Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is
a timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
instead.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} (~org-open-at-point~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-o
#+findex: org-open-at-point
Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range
at point (see [[*Weekly/daily agenda]]).
- {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} (~org-timestamp-down-day~), {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-timestamp-up-day~) ::
#+kindex: S-LEFT
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-timestamp-down-day
#+findex: org-timestamp-up-day
Change date at point by one day. These key bindings conflict
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
with shift-selection and related modes (see [[*Packages that
conflict with Org mode]]).
- {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} (~org-timestamp-up~), {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} (~org-timestamp-down~) ::
#+kindex: S-UP
#+kindex: S-DOWN
On the beginning or enclosing bracket of a timestamp, change its
type. Within a timestamp, change the item under point. Point
can be on a year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp
contains a time range like =15:30-16:30=, modifying the first
time also shifts the second, shifting the time block with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
constant length. To change the length, modify the second time.
Note that if point is in a headline and not at a timestamp, these
same keys modify the priority of an item (see [[*Priorities]]). The
key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and related modes
(see [[*Packages that conflict with Org mode]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-y)}}} (~org-evaluate-time-range~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-y
#+findex: org-evaluate-time-range
#+cindex: evaluate time range
Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start
and end. With a prefix argument, insert result after the time
range (in a table: into the following column).
*** The date/time prompt
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How Org mode helps you enter dates and times.
:END:
#+cindex: date, reading in minibuffer
#+cindex: time, reading in minibuffer
#+vindex: org-read-date-prefer-future
When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
format. But it in fact accepts date/time information in a variety of
formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning of
the string. Org mode finds whatever information is in there and
derives anything you have not specified from the /default date and
time/. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of
a range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you want to enter
a date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given
day/month is /before/ today, it assumes that you mean a future
date[fn:62]. If the date has been automatically shifted into the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
future, the time prompt shows this with =(=>F)=.
For example, let's assume that today is *June 13, 2006*. Here is how
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
various inputs are interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are in
*bold*.
| =3-2-5= | \rArr{} 2003-02-05 |
| =2/5/3= | \rArr{} 2003-02-05 |
| =14= | \rArr{} *2006*-*06*-14 |
| =12= | \rArr{} *2006*-*07*-12 |
| =2/5= | \rArr{} *2007*-02-05 |
| =Fri= | \rArr{} nearest Friday (default date or later) |
| =sep 15= | \rArr{} *2006*-09-15 |
| =feb 15= | \rArr{} *2007*-02-15 |
| =sep 12 9= | \rArr{} 2009-09-12 |
| =12:45= | \rArr{} *2006*-*06*-*13* 12:45 |
| =22 sept 0:34= | \rArr{} *2006*-09-22 0:34 |
| =w4= | \rArr{} ISO week for of the current year *2006* |
| =2012 w4 fri= | \rArr{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012 |
| =2012-w04-5= | \rArr{} Same as above |
Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the /first/
thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter---=d=,
=w=, =m= or =y=---to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
years. With a single plus or minus, the date is always relative to
today. With a double plus or minus, it is relative to the default
date. If instead of a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day
name, the date is the Nth such day, e.g.:
| =+0= | \rArr{} today |
| =.= | \rArr{} today |
| =+4d= | \rArr{} four days from today |
| =+4= | \rArr{} same as +4d |
| =+2w= | \rArr{} two weeks from today |
| =++5= | \rArr{} five days from default date |
| =+2tue= | \rArr{} second Tuesday from now |
#+vindex: parse-time-months
#+vindex: parse-time-weekdays
The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you want to use un-abbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
the variables ~parse-time-months~ and ~parse-time-weekdays~.
#+vindex: org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By
default Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037
which works on all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates
outside of this range, read the docstring of the variable
~org-read-date-force-compatible-dates~.
You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by
giving a start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
dash(es) as the separator in the former case and use =+= as the
separator in the latter case, e.g.:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| =11am-1:15pm= | \rArr{} 11:00-13:15 |
| =11am--1:15pm= | \rArr{} same as above |
| =11am+2:15= | \rArr{} same as above |
#+cindex: calendar, for selecting date
#+vindex: org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up[fn:63].
When you exit the date prompt, either by clicking on a date in the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
calendar, or by pressing {{{kbd(RET)}}}, the date selected in the
calendar is combined with the information entered at the prompt. You
can control the calendar fully from the minibuffer:
#+kindex: <
#+kindex: >
#+kindex: M-v
#+kindex: C-v
#+kindex: mouse-1
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
#+kindex: S-LEFT
#+kindex: S-DOWN
#+kindex: S-UP
#+kindex: M-S-RIGHT
#+kindex: M-S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: RET
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.25 0.55
| {{{kbd(RET)}}} | Choose date at point in calendar. |
| {{{kbd(mouse-1)}}} | Select date by clicking on it. |
| {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} | One day forward. |
| {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} | One day backward. |
| {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} | One week forward. |
| {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} | One week backward. |
| {{{kbd(M-S-RIGHT)}}} | One month forward. |
| {{{kbd(M-S-LEFT)}}} | One month backward. |
| {{{kbd(>)}}} | Scroll calendar forward by one month. |
| {{{kbd(<)}}} | Scroll calendar backward by one month. |
| {{{kbd(M-v)}}} | Scroll calendar forward by 3 months. |
| {{{kbd(C-v)}}} | Scroll calendar backward by 3 months. |
#+vindex: org-read-date-display-live
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you
they will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty
much any other way of entering a date/time out there. To help you
understand what is going on, the current interpretation of your input
is displayed live in the minibuffer[fn:64].
*** Custom time format
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Making dates look different.
:END:
#+cindex: custom date/time format
#+cindex: time format, custom
#+cindex: date format, custom
#+vindex: org-display-custom-times
#+vindex: org-time-stamp-custom-formats
Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require
another representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get
it by customizing the variables ~org-display-custom-times~ and
~org-time-stamp-custom-formats~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-t)}}} (~org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-t
#+findex: org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays
Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom
date/time format does not /replace/ the default format. Instead, it
is put /over/ the default format using text properties. This has the
following consequences:
- You cannot place point onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
after.
- The {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} and {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} keys can no longer be used
to adjust each component of a timestamp. If point is at the
beginning of the stamp, {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} and {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} change
the stamp by one day, just like {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}}
{{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}}. At the end of the stamp, change the time by one
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
minute.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater,
these are not overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it only
disappears from the buffer after /all/ (invisible) characters
belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
- If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you
are using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If
the custom format is shorter, things do work as expected.
** Deadlines and Scheduling
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Planning your work.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate
planning. Both the timestamp and the keyword have to be positioned
immediately after the task they refer to.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =DEADLINE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{DEADLINE} marker
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not
necessarily) is supposed to be finished on that date.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-deadline-warning-days
On the deadline date, the task is listed in the agenda. In
addition, the agenda for /today/ carries a warning about the
approaching or missed deadline, starting
~org-deadline-warning-days~ before the due date, and continuing
until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,*** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled
You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with
a warning period of 5 days =DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>=.
This warning is deactivated if the task gets scheduled and you
set ~org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled~ to ~t~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SCHEDULED= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SCHEDULED} marker
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the
given date.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
The headline is listed under the given date[fn:65]. In addition,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a reminder that the scheduled date has passed is present in the
compilation for /today/, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
the task is automatically forwarded until completed.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,*** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-scheduled-delay-days
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline
If you want to /delay/ the display of this task in the agenda,
use =SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>=: the task is still
scheduled on the 25th but will appear two days later. In case
the task contains a repeater, the delay is considered to affect
all occurrences; if you want the delay to only affect the first
scheduled occurrence of the task, use =--2d= instead. See
~org-scheduled-delay-days~ and
~org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline~ for details on how
to control this globally or per agenda.
#+attr_texinfo: :tag Important
#+begin_quote
Scheduling an item in Org mode should /not/ be understood in the
same way that we understand /scheduling a meeting/. Setting
a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item
shown on the date where it applies. This is a frequent
misunderstanding by Org users. In Org mode, /scheduling/ means
setting a date when you want to start working on an action item.
#+end_quote
You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
entries. Org mode issues early and late warnings based on the
assumption that the timestamp represents the /nearest instance/ of the
repeater. However, the use of diary S-exp entries like
: <%%(diary-float t 42)>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
know enough about the internals of each S-exp function to issue early
and late warnings. However, it shows the item on each day where the
S-exp entry matches.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Inserting deadlines or schedules
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Planning items.
:ALT_TITLE: Inserting deadline/schedule
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to
schedule an item:[fn:66]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-d)}}} (~org-deadline~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-d
#+findex: org-deadline
#+vindex: org-log-redeadline
Insert =DEADLINE= keyword along with a stamp. The insertion
happens in the line directly following the headline. Remove any
=CLOSED= timestamp . When called with a prefix argument, also
remove any existing deadline from the entry. Depending on the
variable ~org-log-redeadline~, take a note when changing an
existing deadline[fn:67].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-s)}}} (~org-schedule~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-s
#+findex: org-schedule
#+vindex: org-log-reschedule
Insert =SCHEDULED= keyword along with a stamp. The insertion
happens in the line directly following the headline. Remove any
=CLOSED= timestamp. When called with a prefix argument, also
remove the scheduling date from the entry. Depending on the
variable ~org-log-reschedule~, take a note when changing an
existing scheduling time[fn:68].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-k)}}} (~org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-k
#+kindex: k a
#+kindex: k s
#+findex: org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action
Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked
the entry like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to
find an appropriate date. With point on the selected date, press
{{{kbd(k s)}}} or {{{kbd(k d)}}} to schedule the marked item.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c / d)}}} (~org-check-deadlines~) ::
#+kindex: C-c / d
#+findex: org-check-deadlines
#+cindex: sparse tree, for deadlines
#+vindex: org-deadline-warning-days
Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due,
or which will become due within ~org-deadline-warning-days~.
With {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With
a numeric prefix, check that many days. For example, {{{kbd(C-1
C-c / d)}}} shows all deadlines due tomorrow.
- {{{kbd(C-c / b)}}} (~org-check-before-date~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c / b
#+findex: org-check-before-date
Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given
date.
- {{{kbd(C-c / a)}}} (~org-check-after-date~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c / a
#+findex: org-check-after-date
Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
Note that ~org-schedule~ and ~org-deadline~ supports setting the date
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
by indicating a relative time e.g., =+1d= sets the date to the next
day after today, and =--1w= sets the date to the previous week before
any current timestamp.
*** Repeated tasks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Items that show up again and again.
:END:
#+cindex: tasks, repeated
#+cindex: repeated tasks
Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a =DEADLINE=,
=SCHEDULED=, or plain timestamp. In the following example:
#+begin_example
,** TODO Pay the rent
DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the =+1m= is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
has a deadline on =<2005-10-01>= and repeats itself every (one) month
starting from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily
and hourly repeat cookies by using the ~y/w/m/d/h~ letters. If you
need both a repeater and a special warning period in a deadline entry,
the repeater should come first and the warning period last: =DEADLINE:
<2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>=.
#+vindex: org-todo-repeat-to-state
Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they
are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as
DONE once you have done so. When you mark a =DEADLINE= or a
=SCHEDULED= with the TODO keyword =DONE=, it no longer produces
2017-12-29 14:37:14 -05:00
entries in the agenda. The problem with this is, however, is that
then also the /next/ instance of the repeated entry will not be
active. Org mode deals with this in the following way: when you try
to mark such an entry DONE, using {{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}}, it shifts the
base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
immediately sets the entry state back to TODO[fn:69]. In the example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
above, setting the state to DONE would actually switch the date like
this:
#+begin_example
,** TODO Pay the rent
DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To mark a task with a repeater as DONE, use {{{kbd(C-- 1 C-c C-t)}}},
i.e., ~org-todo~ with a numeric prefix argument of =-1=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-log-repeat
A timestamp[fn:70] is added under the deadline, to keep a record that
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry is no longer
visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future
instances will be visible.
With the =+1m= cookie, the date shift is always exactly one month. So
if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this entry
DONE still keeps it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the task,
this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you forgot
to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call him
3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
/after/ the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
special repeaters =++= and =.+=. For example:
#+begin_example
,** TODO Call Father
DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
Marking this DONE shifts the date by at least one week, but also
by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into the future.
However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called and marked it
done on Saturday.
,** TODO Empty kitchen trash
DEADLINE: <2008-02-08 Fri 20:00 ++1d>
Marking this DONE shifts the date by at least one day, and also
by as many days as it takes to get the timestamp into the future.
Since there is a time in the timestamp, the next deadline in the
future will be on today's date if you complete the task before
20:00.
,** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after today.
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown
You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
task. If the repeater is set for the scheduling information only, you
probably want the repeater to be ignored after the deadline. If so,
set the variable ~org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown~ to
~repeated-after-deadline~. However, any scheduling information
without a repeater is no longer relevant once the task is done, and
thus, removed upon repeating the task. If you want both scheduling
and deadline information to repeat after the same interval, set the
same repeater for both timestamps.
An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of
a task subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{kbd(C-c C-x c)}}} was created for this purpose; it is described in
[[*Structure Editing]].
** Clocking Work Time
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tracking how long you spend on a task.
:END:
#+cindex: clocking time
#+cindex: time clocking
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in
a project. When you start working on an item, you can start the
clock. When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task
done, the clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is
recorded. It also computes the total time spent on each
subtree[fn:71] of a project. And it remembers a history or tasks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a number of
tasks absorbing your time.
To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-clock-persist 'history)
(org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-clock-persist
When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
clock[fn:72] is retrieved (see [[*Resolving idle time]]) and you are
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
prompted about what to do with it.
*** Clocking commands
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Starting and stopping a clock.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-i)}}} (~org-clock-in~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-i
#+findex: org-clock-in
#+vindex: org-clock-into-drawer
#+vindex: org-clock-continuously
#+cindex: @samp{LOG_INTO_DRAWER}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the
CLOCK keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the
first clocking of this item, the multiple CLOCK lines are wrapped
into a =LOGBOOK= drawer (see also the variable
~org-clock-into-drawer~). You can also overrule the setting of
this variable for a subtree by setting a =CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER= or
=LOG_INTO_DRAWER= property. When called with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}}
prefix argument, select the task from a list of recently clocked
tasks. With two {{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}} prefixes, clock into the task
at point and mark it as the default task; the default task is
always be available with letter {{{kbd(d)}}} when selecting
a clocking task. With three {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-u)}}} prefixes,
force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last
clock stopped.
#+cindex: @samp{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL}, property
#+cindex: @samp{LAST_REPEAT}, property
2018-03-29 02:29:55 -04:00
#+vindex: org-clock-mode-line-total
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-clock-in-prepare-hook
While the clock is running, Org shows the current clocking time
in the mode line, along with the title of the task. The clock
time shown is all time ever clocked for this task and its
children. If the task has an effort estimate (see [[*Effort
Estimates]]), the mode line displays the current clocking time
against it[fn:73]. If the task is a repeating one (see [[*Repeated
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
tasks]]), show only the time since the last reset of the
task[fn:74]. You can exercise more control over show time with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the =CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL= property. It may have the values
=current= to show only the current clocking instance, =today= to
show all time clocked on this tasks today---see also the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
variable ~org-extend-today-until~, ~all~ to include all time, or
~auto~ which is the default[fn:75]. Clicking with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{kbd(mouse-1)}}} onto the mode line entry pops up a menu with
clocking options.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-o)}}} (~org-clock-out~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-o
#+findex: org-clock-out
#+vindex: org-log-note-clock-out
Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at
the same location where the clock was last started. It also
directly computes the resulting time in inserts it after the time
range as ==>HH:MM=. See the variable ~org-log-note-clock-out~
for the possibility to record an additional note together with
the clock-out timestamp[fn:76].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-x)}}} (~org-clock-in-last~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-x
#+findex: org-clock-in-last
#+vindex: org-clock-continuously
Re-clock the last clocked task. With one {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix
argument, select the task from the clock history. With two
{{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefixes, force continuous clocking by starting
the clock when the last clock stopped.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-e)}}} (~org-clock-modify-effort-estimate~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-e
#+findex: org-clock-modify-effort-estimate
Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-y)}}} (~org-evaluate-time-range~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+kindex: C-c C-y
#+findex: org-evaluate-time-range
Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps.
This is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If
you change them with {{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}} keys, the update is
automatic.
- {{{kbd(C-S-UP)}}} (~org-clock-timestamps-up~), {{{kbd(C-S-DOWN)}}} (~org-clock-timestamps-down~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-S-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-clock-timestamps-up
#+kindex: C-S-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-clock-timestamps-down
On CLOCK log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
clock duration keeps the same value.
- {{{kbd(S-M-UP)}}} (~org-timestamp-up~), {{{kbd(S-M-DOWN)}}} (~org-timestamp-down~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: S-M-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-clock-timestamp-up
#+kindex: S-M-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-clock-timestamp-down
On =CLOCK= log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point
and the one of the previous, or the next, clock timestamp by the
same duration. For example, if you hit {{{kbd(S-M-UP)}}} to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
increase a clocked-out timestamp by five minutes, then the
clocked-in timestamp of the next clock is increased by five
minutes.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-t)}}} (~org-todo~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-t
#+findex: org-todo
Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops
the clock if it is running in this same item.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-q)}}} (~org-clock-cancel~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-q
#+findex: org-clock-cancel
Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started
by mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-j)}}} (~org-clock-goto~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-j
#+findex: or-clock-goto
Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With
a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument, select the target task from
a list of recently clocked tasks.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-d)}}} (~org-clock-display~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-d
#+findex: org-clock-display
#+vindex: org-remove-highlights-with-change
Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer.
This puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total
time recorded under that heading, including the time of any
subheadings. You can use visibility cycling to study the tree,
but the overlays disappear when you change the buffer (see
variable ~org-remove-highlights-with-change~) or press {{{kbd(C-c
C-c)}}}.
The {{{kbd(l)}}} key may be used in the agenda (see [[*Weekly/daily
agenda]]) to show which tasks have been worked on or closed during
a day.
*Important:* note that both ~org-clock-out~ and ~org-clock-in-last~
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
can have a global keybinding and do not modify the window disposition.
*** The clock table
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Detailed reports.
:END:
#+cindex: clocktable, dynamic block
#+cindex: report, of clocked time
Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
information. Such a report is called a /clock table/, because it is
formatted as one or several Org tables.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-r)}}} (~org-clock-report~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-r
#+findex: org-clock-report
Insert a dynamic block (see [[*Dynamic Blocks]]) containing a clock
report as an Org mode table into the current file. When point is
at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a
prefix argument, jump to the first clock report in the current
document and update it. The clock table includes archived trees.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-u)}}} (~org-dblock-update~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-u
#+findex: org-dblock-update
Update dynamic block at point. Point needs to be in the =BEGIN=
line of the dynamic block.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-x C-u)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-x C-u
Update all dynamic blocks (see [[*Dynamic Blocks]]). This is useful
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
if you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
- {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}}, {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-clocktable-try-shift~) ::
#+kindex: S-LEFT
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-clocktable-try-shift
Shift the current =:block= interval and update the table. Point
needs to be in the =#+BEGIN: clocktable= line for this command.
If =:block= is =today=, it is shifted to =today-1=, etc.
Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted
into the buffer with the {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-r)}}} command:
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN clocktable}
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
,#+END: clocktable
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-clocktable-defaults
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =#+BEGIN= line and specify a number of options to define the
scope, structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all
these options can be configured in the variable
~org-clocktable-defaults~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
be selected:
- =:maxlevel= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.
Clocks at deeper levels are summed into the upper level.
- =:scope= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:
| =nil= | the current buffer or narrowed region |
| =file= | the full current buffer |
| =subtree= | the subtree where the clocktable is located |
| =treeN= | the surrounding level N tree, for example =tree3= |
| =tree= | the surrounding level 1 tree |
| =agenda= | all agenda files |
| =("file" ...)= | scan these files |
| =FUNCTION= | scan files returned by calling {{{var(FUNCTION)}}} with no argument |
| =file-with-archives= | current file and its archives |
| =agenda-with-archives= | all agenda files, including archives |
- =:block= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The time block to consider. This block is specified either
absolutely, or relative to the current time and may be any of
these formats:
| =2007-12-31= | New year eve 2007 |
| =2007-12= | December 2007 |
| =2007-W50= | ISO-week 50 in 2007 |
| =2007-Q2= | 2nd quarter in 2007 |
| =2007= | the year 2007 |
| =today=, =yesterday=, =today-N= | a relative day |
| =thisweek=, =lastweek=, =thisweek-N= | a relative week |
| =thismonth=, =lastmonth=, =thismonth-N= | a relative month |
| =thisyear=, =lastyear=, =thisyear-N= | a relative year |
| =untilnow= | all clocked time ever |
#+vindex: org-clock-display-default-range
When this option is not set, Org falls back to the value in
~org-clock-display-default-range~, which defaults to the current
year.
Use {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} or {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} to shift the time
interval.
- =:tstart= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A time string specifying when to start considering times.
Relative times like ="<-2w>"= can also be used. See [[*Matching
tags and properties]] for relative time syntax.
- =:tend= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A time string specifying when to stop considering times.
Relative times like ="<now>"= can also be used. See [[*Matching
tags and properties]] for relative time syntax.
- =:wstart= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for Monday.
- =:mstart= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The starting day of the month. The default is 1 for the first.
- =:step= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set to ~week~ or ~day~ to split the table into chunks. To use
this, ~:block~ or ~:tstart~, ~:tend~ are needed.
- =:stepskip0= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not show steps that have zero time.
- =:fileskip0= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.
- =:match= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See
[[*Matching tags and properties]] for the match syntax.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-clocktable-write-default
Then there are options that determine the formatting of the table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
There options are interpreted by the function
~org-clocktable-write-default~, but you can specify your own function
using the =:formatter= parameter.
- =:emphasize= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When ~t~, emphasize level one and level two items.
- =:lang= ::
Language[fn:77] to use for descriptive cells like "Task".
- =:link= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.
- =:narrow= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
An integer to limit the width of the headline column in the Org
table. If you write it like =50!=, then the headline is also
shortened in export.
- =:indent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Indent each headline field according to its level.
- =:tcolumns= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller than
=:maxlevel=, lower levels are lumped into one column.
- =:level= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Should a level number column be included?
- =:sort= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A cons cell containing the column to sort and a sorting type.
E.g., =:sort (1 . ?a)= sorts the first column alphabetically.
- =:compact= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Abbreviation for =:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1=.
All are overwritten except if there is an explicit =:narrow=.
- =:timestamp= ::
A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for =SCHEDULED=,
=DEADLINE=, =TIMESTAMP= and =TIMESTAMP_IA= special properties
(see [[*Special Properties]]), in this order.
- =:tags= ::
When this flag is non-~nil~, show the headline's tags.
- =:properties= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
List of properties shown in the table. Each property gets its
own column.
- =:inherit-props= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When this flag is non-~nil~, the values for =:properties= are
inherited.
- =:formula= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Content of a =TBLFM= keyword to be added and evaluated. As
a special case, =:formula %= adds a column with % time. If you
do not specify a formula here, any existing formula below the
clock table survives updates and is evaluated.
- =:formatter= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.
To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
day, you could write:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
,#+END: clocktable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
To use a specific time range you could write[fn:78]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
:tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
,#+END: clocktable
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "<now>"
,#+END: clocktable
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
,#+END: clocktable
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during
last week would be
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
,#+END: clocktable
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Resolving time when you've been idle.
:ALT_TITLE: Resolving idle time
:END:
**** Resolving idle time
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: resolve idle time
#+cindex: idle, resolve, dangling
If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
"resolve" the time you were away by either subtracting it from the
current clock, or applying it to another one.
#+vindex: org-clock-idle-time
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-clock-x11idle-program-name
By customizing the variable ~org-clock-idle-time~ to some integer,
such as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your
computer after being idle for that many minutes[fn:79], and ask what
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you want to do with the idle time. There will be a question waiting
for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has passed
constantly updated with the current amount, as well as a set of
choices to correct the discrepancy:
- {{{kbd(k)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: k
To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press
{{{kbd(k)}}}. Org asks how many of the minutes to keep. Press
{{{kbd(RET)}}} to keep them all, effectively changing nothing, or
enter a number to keep that many minutes.
- {{{kbd(K)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: K
If you use the shift key and press {{{kbd(K)}}}, it keeps however
many minutes you request and then immediately clock out of that
task. If you keep all of the minutes, this is the same as just
clocking out of the current task.
- {{{kbd(s)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: s
To keep none of the minutes, use {{{kbd(s)}}} to subtract all the
away time from the clock, and then check back in from the moment
you returned.
- {{{kbd(S)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: S
To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of
the away time, use the shift key and press {{{kbd(S)}}}.
Remember that using shift always leave you clocked out, no matter
which option you choose.
- {{{kbd(C)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C
To cancel the clock altogether, use {{{kbd(C)}}}. Note that if
instead of canceling you subtract the away time, and the
resulting clock amount is less than a minute, the clock is still
canceled rather than cluttering up the log with an empty entry.
What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
now want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task
immediately after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
subtracted time "on the books", so to speak, and will ask if you want
to apply those minutes to the next task you clock in on.
There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs.
Say you were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased
a mouse who scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
button! You suddenly lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save
you still have your recent Org mode changes, including your last clock
in.
If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you
have a dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last
session. Using that clock's starting time as the beginning of the
unaccounted-for period, Org will ask how you want to resolve that
time. The logic and behavior is identical to dealing with away time
due to idleness; it is just happening due to a recovery event rather
than a set amount of idle time.
You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
dangling clocks at any time using {{{kbd(M-x org-resolve-clocks
RET)}}} (or {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-z)}}}).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Continuous clocking
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: continuous clocking
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-clock-continuously
You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
previous task. To enable this systematically, set
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-clock-continuously~ to non-~nil~. Each time you clock in, Org
retrieves the clock-out time of the last clocked entry for this
session, and start the new clock from there.
If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix
arguments with ~org-clock-in~ and two {{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}} with
~org-clock-in-last~.
** Effort Estimates
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Planning work effort in advance.
:END:
#+cindex: effort estimates
#+cindex: @samp{EFFORT}, property
#+vindex: org-effort-property
If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need
to produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you
may want to assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also
clocking your work, you may later want to compare the planned effort
with the actual working time, a great way to improve planning
estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a special property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=EFFORT=. You can set the effort for an entry with the following
commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x e)}}} (~org-set-effort~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x e
#+findex: org-set-effort
Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a prefix
argument, set it to the next allowed value---see below. This
command is also accessible from the agenda with the {{{kbd(e)}}}
key.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-e)}}} (~org-clock-modify-effort-estimate~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-e
#+findex: org-clock-modify-effort-estimate
Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column
view (see [[*Column View]]). You should start by setting up discrete
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
values for effort estimates, and a =COLUMNS= format that displays
these values together with clock sums---if you want to clock your
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
time. For a specific buffer you can use:
#+begin_example
,#+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
,#+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort){:} %CLOCKSUM
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
#+vindex: org-global-properties
#+vindex: org-columns-default-format
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing
the variables ~org-global-properties~ and
~org-columns-default-format~. In particular if you want to use this
setup also in the agenda, a global setup may be advised.
The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to
column mode, and to use {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} and {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
change the value. The values you enter are immediately summed up in
the hierarchy. In the column next to it, any clocked time is
displayed.
#+vindex: org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort
column summarizes the estimated work effort for each day[fn:80], and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get an overview
of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
option ~org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum~. The
appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval
are then also added to the load estimate of the day.
Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
triggered with the {{{kbd(/)}}} key in the agenda (see [[*Commands in
the Agenda Buffer]]). If you have these estimates defined consistently,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
two or three key presses narrow down the list to stuff that fits into
an available time slot.
** Taking Notes with a Relative Timer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Notes with a running timer.
:ALT_TITLE: Timers
:END:
#+cindex: relative timer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: countdown timer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org provides two types of timers. There is a relative timer that
counts up, which can be useful when taking notes during, for example,
a meeting or a video viewing. There is also a countdown timer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The relative and countdown are started with separate commands.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x 0)}}} (~org-timer-start~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x 0
#+findex: org-timer-start
Start or reset the relative timer. By default, the timer is set
to 0. When called with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, prompt the user
for a starting offset. If there is a timer string at point, this
is taken as the default, providing a convenient way to restart
taking notes after a break in the process. When called with
a double prefix argument {{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}}, change all timer
strings in the active region by a certain amount. This can be
used to fix timer strings if the timer was not started at exactly
the right moment.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x ;)}}} (~org-timer-set-timer~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x ;
#+findex: org-timer-set-timer
#+vindex: org-timer-default-timer
Start a countdown timer. The user is prompted for a duration.
~org-timer-default-timer~ sets the default countdown value.
Giving a numeric prefix argument overrides this default value.
This command is available as {{{kbd(;)}}} in agenda buffers.
Once started, relative and countdown timers are controlled with the
same commands.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x .)}}} (~org-timer~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x .
#+findex: org-timer
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use
this, the timer starts. Using a prefix argument restarts it.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x -)}}} (~org-timer-item~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x -
#+findex: org-timer-item
Insert a description list item with the current relative time.
With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- {{{kbd(M-RET)}}} (~org-insert-heading~) ::
#+kindex: M-RET
#+findex: org-insert-heading
Once the timer list is started, you can also use
{{{kbd(M-RET)}}} to insert new timer items.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x \,)}}} (~org-timer-pause-or-continue~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x ,
#+findex: org-timer-pause-or-continue
Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x _)}}} (~org-timer-stop~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x _
#+findex: org-timer-stop
Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not
continue the old one. This command also removes the timer from
the mode line.
* Capture, Refile, Archive
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The ins and outs for projects.
:END:
#+cindex: capture
An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with
them. Org does this using a process called /capture/. It also can
store files related to a task (/attachments/) in a special directory.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Once in the system, tasks and projects need to be moved around.
Moving completed project trees to an archive file keeps the system
compact and fast.
** Capture
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Capturing new stuff.
:END:
#+cindex: capture
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your
work flow. Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired
by John Wiegley's excellent Remember package.
*** Setting up capture
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Where notes will be stored.
:END:
The following customization sets a default target file for notes.
#+vindex: org-default-notes-file
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
#+end_src
You may also define a global key for capturing new material (see
[[*Activation]]).
*** Using capture
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Commands to invoke and terminate capture.
:END:
- {{{kbd(M-x org-capture)}}} (~org-capture~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-capture
#+cindex: date tree
Display the capture templates menu. If you have templates
defined (see [[*Capture templates]]), it offers these templates for
selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template.
It inserts the template into the target file and switch to an
indirect buffer narrowed to this new node. You may then insert
the information you want.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} (~org-capture-finalize~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-c @r{(Capture buffer)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-capture-finalize
Once you have finished entering information into the capture
buffer, {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} returns you to the window
configuration before the capture process, so that you can resume
your work without further distraction. When called with a prefix
argument, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-w)}}} (~org-capture-refile~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-w @r{(Capture buffer)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-capture-refile
Finalize the capture process by refiling the note to a different
place (see [[*Refile and Copy]]). Please realize that this is a
normal refiling command that will be executed---so point position
at the moment you run this command is important. If you have
inserted a tree with a parent and children, first move point back
to the parent. Any prefix argument given to this command is
passed on to the ~org-refile~ command.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-k)}}} (~org-capture-kill~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-k @r{(Capture buffer)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-capture-kill
Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
#+kindex: k c @r{(Agenda)}
You can also call ~org-capture~ in a special way from the agenda,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
using the {{{kbd(k c)}}} key combination. With this access, any
timestamps inserted by the selected capture template defaults to the
date at point in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To find the locations of the last stored capture, use ~org-capture~
with prefix commands:
- {{{kbd(C-u M-x org-capture)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to
select the template in the usual way.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u M-x org-capture)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
#+vindex: org-capture-bookmark
#+vindex: org-capture-last-stored
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can also jump to the bookmark ~org-capture-last-stored~, which is
automatically created unless you set ~org-capture-bookmark~ to ~nil~.
To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call ~org-capture~
with a {{{kbd(C-0)}}} prefix argument.
*** Capture templates
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Define the outline of different note types.
:END:
#+cindex: templates, for Capture
You can use templates for different types of capture items, and for
different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates
is through the customize interface.
- {{{kbd(C)}}} ::
#+kindex: C @r{(Capture menu}
#+vindex: org-capture-templates
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Customize the variable ~org-capture-templates~.
Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's
look at an example. Say you would like to use one template to create
general TODO entries, and you want to put these entries under the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
heading =Tasks= in your file =~/org/gtd.org=. Also, a date tree in
the file =journal.org= should capture journal entries. A possible
configuration would look like:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-capture-templates
'(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
"* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
"* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
If you then press {{{kbd(t)}}} from the capture menu, Org will prepare
the template for you like this:
#+begin_example
,* TODO
[[file:LINK TO WHERE YOU INITIATED CAPTURE]]
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
During expansion of the template, =%a= has been replaced by a link to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You
fill in the task definition, press {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} and Org returns
you to the same place where you started the capture process.
To define special keys to capture to a particular template without
going through the interactive template selection, you can create your
key binding like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(define-key global-map "\C-cx"
(lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
#+end_src
**** Template elements
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: What is needed for a complete template entry.
:END:
Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
~org-capture-templates~ is a list with the following items:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- keys ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The keys that selects the template, as a string, characters only,
for example ="a"=, for a template to be selected with a single
key, or ="bt"= for selection with two keys. When using several
keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential in the
list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the prefix key,
for example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you do not define a template for the {{{kbd(C)}}} key, this
key opens the Customize buffer for this complex variable.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- description ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A short string describing the template, shown during selection.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- type ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~entry~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child
of the target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file
should be an Org file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~item~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the
target location. Again the target file should be an Org
file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~checkitem~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item
by the default template.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~table-line~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A new line in the first table at the target location. Where
exactly the line will be inserted depends on the properties
~:prepend~ and ~:table-line-pos~ (see below).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~plain~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Text to be inserted as it is.
- target ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-default-notes-file
#+vindex: org-directory
Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In
Org files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become
children of this node. Other types will be added to the table or
list in the body of this node. Most target specifications
contain a file name. If that file name is the empty string, it
defaults to ~org-default-notes-file~. A file can also be given
as a variable or as a function called with no argument. When an
absolute path is not specified for a target, it is taken as
relative to ~org-directory~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Valid values are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =(file "path/to/file")= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =(id "id of existing org entry")= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =(file+headline "filename" "node headline")= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =(file+olp "filename" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =(file+regexp "filename" "regexp to find location")= ::
Use a regular expression to position point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =(file+olp+datetree "filename" [ "Level 1 heading" ...])= ::
This target[fn:81] creates a heading in a date tree[fn:82] for
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
today's date. If the optional outline path is given, the tree
will be built under the node it is pointing to, instead of at
top level. Check out the ~:time-prompt~ and ~:tree-type~
properties below for additional options.
- =(file+function "filename" function-finding-location)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A function to find the right location in the file.
- =(clock)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
- =(function function-finding-location)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Most general way: write your own function which both visits the
file and moves point to the right location.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- template ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this
empty, an appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise
this is a string with escape codes, which will be replaced
depending on time and context of the capture call. The string
with escapes may be loaded from a template file, using the
special syntax =(file "template filename")=. See below for more
details.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- properties ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
Recognized properties are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:prepend~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Normally new captured information will be appended at the
target location (last child, last table line, last list item,
...). Setting this property changes that.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:immediate-finish~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When set, do not offer to edit the information, just file it
away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
information that can be added automatically.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:empty-lines~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set this to the number of lines to insert before and after the
new item. Default 0, and the only other common value is 1.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:clock-in~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Start the clock in this item.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:clock-keep~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:clock-resume~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock
when finished with the capture. Note that ~:clock-keep~ has
precedence over ~:clock-resume~. When setting both to
non-~nil~, the current clock will run and the previous one will
not be resumed.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:time-prompt~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prompt for a date/time to be used for date/week trees and when
filling the template. Without this property, capture uses the
current date and time. Even if this property has not been set,
you can force the same behavior by calling ~org-capture~ with
a {{{kbd(C-1)}}} prefix argument.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:tree-type~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When ~week~, make a week tree instead of the month tree, i.e.,
place the headings for each day under a heading with the
current ISO week.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:unnarrowed~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default
is to narrow it so that you only see the new material.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:table-line-pos~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specification of the location in the table where the new line
should be inserted. It should be a string like =II-3= meaning
that the new line should become the third line before the
second horizontal separator line.
- ~:kill-buffer~ ::
If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill
the buffer again after capture is completed.
- ~:no-save~ ::
Do not save the target file after finishing the capture.
**** Template expansion
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Filling in information about time and context.
:END:
In the template itself, special "%-escapes"[fn:83] allow dynamic
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given
here:
- =%[FILE]= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Insert the contents of the file given by {{{var(FILE)}}}.
- =%(EXP)= ::
Evaluate Elisp expression {{{var(EXP)}}} and replace it with the
result. The {{{var(EXP)}}} form must return a string. Only
placeholders pre-existing within the template, or introduced with
=%[file]=, are expanded this way. Since this happens after
expanding non-interactive "%-escapes", those can be used to fill
the expression.
- =%<FORMAT>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The result of format-time-string on the {{{var(FORMAT)}}}
specification.
- =%t= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Timestamp, date only.
- =%T= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Timestamp, with date and time.
- =%u=, =%U= ::
Like =%t=, =%T= above, but inactive timestamps.
- =%i= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Initial content, the region when capture is called while the
region is active. If there is text before =%i= on the same line,
such as indentation, and =%i= is not inside a =%(exp)= form, that
prefix is added before every line in the inserted text.
- =%a= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Annotation, normally the link created with ~org-store-link~.
- =%A= ::
Like =%a=, but prompt for the description part.
- =%l= ::
Like =%a=, but only insert the literal link.
- =%c= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Current kill ring head.
- =%x= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Content of the X clipboard.
- =%k= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Title of the currently clocked task.
- =%K= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Link to the currently clocked task.
- =%n= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
User name (taken from ~user-full-name~).
- =%f= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.
- =%F= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.
- =%:keyword= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specific information for certain link types, see below.
- =%^g= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.
- =%^G= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.
- =%^t= ::
Like =%t=, but prompt for date. Similarly =%^T=, =%^u=, =%^U=. You may
define a prompt like =%^{Birthday}t=.
- =%^C= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.
- =%^L= ::
Like =%^C=, but insert as link.
- =%^{PROP}p= ::
Prompt the user for a value for property {{{var(PROP)}}}.
- =%^{PROMPT}= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.
You may specify a default value and a completion table with
=%^{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...}=. The arrow keys
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
access a prompt-specific history.
- =%\N= ::
Insert the text entered at the {{{var(N)}}}th =%^{PROMPT}=, where
{{{var(N)}}} is a number, starting from 1.
- =%?= ::
After completing the template, position point here.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-store-link-props
For specific link types, the following keywords are defined[fn:84]:
#+vindex: org-from-is-user-regexp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| Link type | Available keywords |
|--------------+----------------------------------------------------------|
| bbdb | =%:name=, =%:company= |
| irc | =%:server=, =%:port=, =%:nick= |
| mh, rmail | =%:type=, =%:subject=, =%:message-id= |
| | =%:from=, =%:fromname=, =%:fromaddress= |
| | =%:to=, =%:toname=, =%:toaddress= |
| | =%:date= (message date header field) |
| | =%:date-timestamp= (date as active timestamp) |
| | =%:date-timestamp-inactive= (date as inactive timestamp) |
| | =%:fromto= (either "to NAME" or "from NAME")[fn:85] |
| gnus | =%:group=, for messages also all email fields |
| w3, w3m | =%:url= |
| info | =%:file=, =%:node= |
| calendar | =%:date= |
| org-protocol | =%:link=, =%:description=, =%:annotation= |
**** Templates in contexts
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Only show a template in a specific context.
:END:
#+vindex: org-capture-templates-contexts
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To control whether a capture template should be accessible from
a specific context, you can customize
~org-capture-templates-contexts~. Let's say, for example, that you
have a capture template "p" for storing Gnus emails containing
patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-capture-templates-contexts
'(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can also tell that the command key {{{kbd(p)}}} should refer to
another template. In that case, add this command key like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-capture-templates-contexts
'(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
See the docstring of the variable for more information.
** Attachments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Add files to tasks.
:END:
#+cindex: attachments
#+vindex: org-attach-directory
It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline
node/task. Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
subtree of a project. Hyperlinks (see [[*Hyperlinks]]) can establish
associations with files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the
cloud, like emails or source code files belonging to a project.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Another method is /attachments/, which are files located in
a directory belonging to an outline node. Org uses directories named
by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are located in the
=data/= directory which lives in the same directory where your Org
file lives[fn:86]. If you initialize this directory with =git init=,
Org automatically commits changes when it sees them. The attachment
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In cases where it seems better to do so, you can attach a directory of
your choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the
attachment directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the
same attached directory.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following commands deal with attachments:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-a)}}} (~org-attach~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-a
#+findex: org-attach
The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system.
After these keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must
press an additional key to select a command:
- {{{kbd(a)}}} (~org-attach-attach~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-a a
#+findex: org-attach-attach
#+vindex: org-attach-method
Select a file and move it into the task's attachment
directory. The file is copied, moved, or linked, depending
on ~org-attach-method~. Note that hard links are not
supported on all systems.
- {{{kbd(c)}}}/{{{kbd(m)}}}/{{{kbd(l)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a c
#+kindex: C-c C-a m
#+kindex: C-c C-a l
Attach a file using the copy/move/link method. Note that
hard links are not supported on all systems.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(n)}}} (~org-attach-new~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a n
#+findex: org-attach-new
Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(z)}}} (~org-attach-sync~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a z
#+findex: org-attach-sync
Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case
you added attachments yourself.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(o)}}} (~org-attach-open~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a o
#+findex: org-attach-open
#+vindex: org-file-apps
Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one,
prompt for a file name first. Opening follows the rules set
by ~org-file-apps~. For more details, see the information
on following hyperlinks (see [[*Handling Links]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(O)}}} (~org-attach-open-in-emacs~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a O
#+findex: org-attach-open-in-emacs
Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in
Emacs.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(f)}}} (~org-attach-reveal~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a f
#+findex: org-attach-reveal
Open the current task's attachment directory.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(F)}}} (~org-attach-reveal-in-emacs~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a F
#+findex: org-attach-reveal-in-emacs
Also open the directory, but force using Dired in Emacs.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(d)}}} (~org-attach-delete-one~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a d
Select and delete a single attachment.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(D)}}} (~org-attach-delete-all~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a D
Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open
the directory in Dired and delete from there.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(s)}}} (~org-attach-set-directory~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a s
#+cindex: @samp{ATTACH_DIR}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment
directory. This works by putting the directory path into
the =ATTACH_DIR= property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(i)}}} (~org-attach-set-inherit~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a i
#+cindex: @samp{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set the =ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT= property, so that children use
the same directory for attachments as the parent does.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: attach from Dired
#+findex: org-attach-dired-to-subtree
It is possible to attach files to a subtree from a Dired buffer. To
use this feature, have one window in Dired mode containing the file(s)
to be attached and another window with point in the subtree that shall
get the attachments. In the Dired window, with point on a file,
{{{kbd(M-x org-attach-dired-to-subtree)}}} attaches the file to the
subtree using the attachment method set by variable
~org-attach-method~. When files are marked in the Dired window then
all marked files get attached.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Add the following lines to the Emacs init file to have {{{kbd(C-c C-x
a)}}} attach files in Dired buffers.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'dired-mode-hook
(lambda ()
(define-key dired-mode-map
(kbd "C-c C-x a")
#'org-attach-dired-to-subtree))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
The following code shows how to bind the previous command with
a specific attachment method.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'dired-mode-hook
(lambda ()
(define-key dired-mode-map (kbd "C-c C-x c")
(lambda ()
(interactive)
(let ((org-attach-method 'cp))
(call-interactively #'org-attach-dired-to-subtree))))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
** RSS Feeds
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Getting input from RSS feeds.
:END:
#+cindex: RSS feeds
#+cindex: Atom feeds
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds
and Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new
podcast in a podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based
note-creating service on the web to import tasks into Org. To access
feeds, configure the variable ~org-feed-alist~. The docstring of this
variable has detailed information. With the following
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-feed-alist
'(("Slashdot"
"http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
"~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
new items from the feed provided by =rss.slashdot.org= result in new
entries in the file =~/org/feeds.org= under the heading =Slashdot
Entries=, whenever the following command is used:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x g)}}} (~org-feed-update-all~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x g
Collect items from the feeds configured in ~org-feed-alist~ and
act upon them.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x G)}}} (~org-feed-goto-inbox~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x G
Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Under the same headline, Org creates a drawer =FEEDSTATUS= in which it
stores information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
adding the same item several times.
For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=org-feed.el= and the docstring of ~org-feed-alist~.
** Protocols for External Access
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: External access to Emacs and Org.
:ALT_TITLE: Protocols
:END:
#+cindex: protocols, for external access
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org protocol is a means to trigger custom actions in Emacs from
external applications. Any application that supports calling external
programs with an URL as argument may be used with this functionality.
For example, you can configure bookmarks in your web browser to send
a link to the current page to Org and create a note from it using
capture (see [[*Capture]]). You can also create a bookmark that tells
Emacs to open the local source file of a remote website you are
browsing.
#+cindex: Org protocol, set-up
#+cindex: Installing Org protocol
In order to use Org protocol from an application, you need to register
=org-protocol://= as a valid scheme-handler. External calls are
passed to Emacs through the =emacsclient= command, so you also need to
ensure an Emacs server is running. More precisely, when the
application calls
: emacsclient org-protocol://PROTOCOL?key1=val1&key2=val2
#+texinfo: @noindent
Emacs calls the handler associated to {{{var(PROTOCOL)}}} with
argument =(:key1 val1 :key2 val2)=.
#+cindex: protocol, new protocol
#+cindex: defining new protocols
Org protocol comes with three predefined protocols, detailed in the
following sections. Configure ~org-protocol-protocol-alist~ to define
your own.
*** ~store-link~ protocol
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring.
:END:
#+cindex: store-link protocol
#+cindex: protocol, store-link
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Using ~store-link~ handler, you can copy links, insertable through
{{{kbd(M-x org-insert-link)}}} or yanking thereafter. More precisely,
the command
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: emacsclient org-protocol://store-link?url=URL&title=TITLE
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
stores the following link:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[URL][TITLE]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In addition, {{{var(URL)}}} is pushed on the kill-ring for yanking.
You need to encode {{{var(URL)}}} and {{{var(TITLE)}}} if they contain
slashes, and probably quote those for the shell.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To use this feature from a browser, add a bookmark with an arbitrary
name, e.g., =Org: store-link= and enter this as /Location/:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
javascript:location.href='org-protocol://store-link?url='+
encodeURIComponent(location.href);
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ~capture~ protocol
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Fill a buffer with external information.
:END:
#+cindex: capture protocol
#+cindex: protocol, capture
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Activating "capture" handler pops up a =Capture= buffer and fills the
capture template associated to the =X= key with them.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: emacsclient org-protocol://capture?template=X?url=URL?title=TITLE?body=BODY
To use this feature, add a bookmark with an arbitrary name, e.g.,
=Org: capture=, and enter this as =Location=:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
javascript:location.href='org-protocol://capture?template=x'+
'&url='+encodeURIComponent(window.location.href)+
'&title='+encodeURIComponent(document.title)+
'&body='+encodeURIComponent(window.getSelection());
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+vindex: org-protocol-default-template-key
The result depends on the capture template used, which is set in the
bookmark itself, as in the example above, or in
~org-protocol-default-template-key~.
The following template placeholders are available:
#+begin_example
%:link The URL
%:description The webpage title
%:annotation Equivalent to [[%:link][%:description]]
%i The selected text
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** ~open-source~ protocol
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Edit published contents.
:END:
#+cindex: open-source protocol
#+cindex: protocol, open-source
The ~open-source~ handler is designed to help with editing local
sources when reading a document. To that effect, you can use
a bookmark with the following location:
#+begin_example
javascript:location.href='org-protocol://open-source?&url='+
encodeURIComponent(location.href)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+vindex: org-protocol-project-alist
The variable ~org-protocol-project-alist~ maps URLs to local file
names, by stripping URL parameters from the end and replacing the
~:base-url~ with ~:working-directory~ and ~:online-suffix~ with
~:working-suffix~. For example, assuming you own a local copy of
=https://orgmode.org/worg/= contents at =/home/user/worg=, you can set
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-protocol-project-alist~ to the following
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-protocol-project-alist
'(("Worg"
:base-url "https://orgmode.org/worg/"
:working-directory "/home/user/worg/"
:online-suffix ".html"
:working-suffix ".org")))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
#+texinfo: @noindent
If you are now browsing
=https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.html= and find
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a typo or have an idea about how to enhance the documentation, simply
click the bookmark and start editing.
#+cindex: rewritten URL in open-source protocol
#+cindex: protocol, open-source rewritten URL
However, such mapping may not yield the desired results. Suppose you
maintain an online store located at =http://example.com/=. The local
sources reside in =/home/user/example/=. It is common practice to
serve all products in such a store through one file and rewrite URLs
that do not match an existing file on the server. That way, a request
to =http://example.com/print/posters.html= might be rewritten on the
server to something like
=http://example.com/shop/products.php/posters.html.php=. The
~open-source~ handler probably cannot find a file named
=/home/user/example/print/posters.html.php= and fails.
Such an entry in ~org-protocol-project-alist~ may hold an additional
property ~:rewrites~. This property is a list of cons cells, each of
which maps a regular expression to a path relative to the
~:working-directory~.
Now map the URL to the path =/home/user/example/products.php= by
adding ~:rewrites~ rules like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-protocol-project-alist
'(("example.com"
:base-url "http://example.com/"
:working-directory "/home/user/example/"
:online-suffix ".php"
:working-suffix ".php"
:rewrites (("example.com/print/" . "products.php")
("example.com/$" . "index.php")))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
#+texinfo: @noindent
Since =example.com/$= is used as a regular expression, it maps
=http://example.com/=, =https://example.com=,
=http://www.example.com/= and similar to
=/home/user/example/index.php=.
The ~:rewrites~ rules are searched as a last resort if and only if no
existing file name is matched.
#+cindex: protocol, open-source, set-up mapping
#+cindex: mappings in open-source protocol
#+findex: org-protocol-create
#+findex: org-protocol-create-for-org
Two functions can help you filling ~org-protocol-project-alist~ with
valid contents: ~org-protocol-create~ and
~org-protocol-create-for-org~. The latter is of use if you're editing
an Org file that is part of a publishing project.
** Refile and Copy
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another.
:END:
#+cindex: refiling notes
#+cindex: copying notes
When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy
some of the entries into a different list, for example into a project.
Cutting, finding the right location, and then pasting the note is
cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following
special command:
- {{{kbd(C-c M-w)}}} (~org-copy~) ::
#+kindex: C-c M-w
#+findex: org-copy
Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not
deleted.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-w)}}} (~org-refile~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-w
#+findex: org-refile
#+vindex: org-reverse-note-order
#+vindex: org-refile-targets
#+vindex: org-refile-use-outline-path
#+vindex: org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
#+vindex: org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
#+vindex: org-log-refile
Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers
possible locations for refiling the entry and lets you select one
with completion. The item (or all items in the region) is filed
below the target heading as a subitem. Depending on
~org-reverse-note-order~, it is either the first or last subitem.
By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are
considered to be targets, but you can have more complex
definitions across a number of files. See the variable
~org-refile-targets~ for details. If you would like to select
a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline
path, see the variables ~org-refile-use-outline-path~ and
~org-outline-path-complete-in-steps~. If you would like to be
able to create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly,
check the variable ~org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes~.
When the variable ~org-log-refile~[fn:87] is set, a timestamp or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a note is recorded whenever an entry is refiled.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-w)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-w
Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c C-w)}}} (~org-refile-goto-last-stored~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c C-w
#+findex: org-refile-goto-last-stored
Jump to the location where ~org-refile~ last moved a tree to.
- {{{kbd(C-2 C-c C-w)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-2 C-c C-w
Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
- {{{kbd(C-3 C-c C-w)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-3 C-c C-w
#+vindex: org-refile-keep
Refile and keep the entry in place. Also see ~org-refile-keep~
to make this the default behavior, and beware that this may
result in duplicated =ID= properties.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-0 C-c C-w)}}} or {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w)}}} (~org-refile-cache-clear~) ::
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
#+kindex: C-0 C-c C-w
#+findex: org-refile-cache-clear
#+vindex: org-refile-use-cache
Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned
on by setting ~org-refile-use-cache~. To make the command see
new possible targets, you have to clear the cache with this
command.
** Archiving
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: What to do with finished products.
:END:
#+cindex: archiving
When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want to
move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and
global searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-a)}}} (~org-archive-subtree-default~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-a
#+findex: org-archive-subtree-default
#+vindex: org-archive-default-command
Archive the current entry using the command specified in the
variable ~org-archive-default-command~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Moving a tree to an archive file
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Moving a tree to an archive file.
:ALT_TITLE: Moving subtrees
:END:
#+cindex: external archiving
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another
file, the archive file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-s)}}} or short {{{kbd(C-c $)}}} (~org-archive-subtree~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-s
#+kindex: C-c $
#+findex: org-archive-subtree
#+vindex: org-archive-location
Archive the subtree starting at point position to the location
given by ~org-archive-location~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-x C-s)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-x C-s
Check if any direct children of the current headline could be
moved to the archive. To do this, check each subtree for open
TODO entries. If none is found, the command offers to move it to
the archive location. If point is /not/ on a headline when this
command is invoked, check level 1 trees.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s
As above, but check subtree for timestamps instead of TODO
entries. The command offers to archive the subtree if it /does/
contain a timestamp, and that timestamp is in the past.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: archive locations
The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
current file, with the name derived by appending =_archive= to the
current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
For information and examples on how to specify the file and the
heading, see the documentation string of the variable
~org-archive-location~.
There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
example:
#+cindex: @samp{ARCHIVE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: ARCHIVE, property
If you would like to have a special archive location for a single
entry or a (sub)tree, give the entry an =ARCHIVE= property with the
location as the value (see [[*Properties and Columns]]).
#+vindex: org-archive-save-context-info
When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties
that record context information like the file from where the entry
came, its outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
~org-archive-save-context-info~ to adjust the amount of information
added.
*** Internal archiving
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ARCHIVE}, tag
If you want to just switch off---for agenda views---certain subtrees
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
without moving them to a different file, you can use the =ARCHIVE=
tag.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A headline that is marked with the =ARCHIVE= tag (see [[*Tags]]) stays at
its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-cycle-open-archived-trees
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
command (see [[*Visibility Cycling]]). You can force cycling archived
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
subtrees with {{{kbd(C-TAB)}}}, or by setting the option
~org-cycle-open-archived-trees~. Also normal outline commands, like
~outline-show-all~, open archived subtrees.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
During sparse tree construction (see [[*Sparse Trees]]), matches in
archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
~org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
During agenda view construction (see [[*Agenda Views]]), the content of
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
~org-agenda-skip-archived-trees~, in which case these trees are
always included. In the agenda you can press {{{kbd(v a)}}} to get
archives temporarily included.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-export-with-archived-trees
Archived trees are not exported (see [[*Exporting]]), only the headline
is. Configure the details using the variable
~org-export-with-archived-trees~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-columns-skip-archived-trees
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
~org-columns-skip-archived-trees~ is configured to ~nil~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following commands help manage the =ARCHIVE= tag:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x a)}}} (~org-toggle-archive-tag~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x a
#+findex: org-toggle-archive-tag
Toggle the archive tag for the current headline. When the tag is
set, the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree
below it is hidden.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-x a)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-x a
Check if any direct children of the current headline should be
archived. To do this, check each subtree for open TODO entries.
If none is found, the command offers to set the =ARCHIVE= tag for
the child. If point is /not/ on a headline when this command is
invoked, check the level 1 trees.
- {{{kbd(C-TAB)}}} (~org-force-cycle-archived~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-TAB
Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with =ARCHIVE=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x A)}}} (~org-archive-to-archive-sibling~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x A
#+findex: org-archive-to-archive-sibling
Move the current entry to the /Archive Sibling/. This is
a sibling of the entry with the heading =Archive= and the archive
tag. The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way
retains a lot of its original context, including inherited tags
and approximate position in the outline.
* Agenda Views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Collecting information into views.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda views
Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and tagged
headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
sorted and displayed in an organized way.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org can select items based on various criteria and display them in
a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
- an /agenda/ that is like a calendar and shows information for
specific dates,
- a /TODO list/ that covers all unfinished action items,
- a /match view/, showings headlines based on the tags, properties,
and TODO state associated with them,
- a /text search view/ that shows all entries from multiple files that
contain specified keywords,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- a /stuck projects view/ showing projects that currently do not move
along, and
- /custom views/ that are special searches and combinations of
different views.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The extracted information is displayed in a special /agenda buffer/.
This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to edit
these files remotely.
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-comment-trees
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
#+cindex: commented entries, in agenda views
#+cindex: archived entries, in agenda views
By default, the report ignores commented (see [[*Comment Lines]]) and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
archived (see [[*Internal archiving]]) entries. You can override this by
setting ~org-agenda-skip-comment-trees~ and
~org-agenda-skip-archived-trees~ to ~nil~.
#+vindex: org-agenda-window-setup
#+vindex: org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether
the window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
~org-agenda-window-setup~ and ~org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit~.
** Agenda Files
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Files being searched for agenda information.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda files
#+cindex: files for agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-files
The information to be shown is normally collected from all /agenda
files/, the files listed in the variable ~org-agenda-files~[fn:88].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If a directory is part of this list, all files with the extension
=.org= in this directory are part of the list.
Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
be put into the list[fn:89]. You can customize ~org-agenda-files~,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
but the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep and
- {{{kbd(C-c [)}}} (~org-agenda-file-to-front~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c [
#+findex: org-agenda-file-to-front
#+cindex: files, adding to agenda list
Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added
to the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is
moved to the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved
to the end.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ])}}} (~org-remove-file~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c ]
#+findex: org-remove-file
Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-')}}} and {{{kbd(C-\,)}}} (~org-cycle-agenda-files~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-'
#+kindex: C-,
#+findex: org-cycle-agenda-files
#+cindex: cycling, of agenda files
Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
2018-03-05 13:26:43 -05:00
- {{{kbd(M-x org-switchb)}}} ::
2018-03-05 13:26:43 -05:00
#+findex: org-switchb
Command to use an iswitchb-like interface to switch to and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
between Org buffers.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used to
visit any of them.
If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree
in a file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single
agenda command, you may press {{{kbd(<)}}} once or several times in
the dispatcher (see [[*The Agenda Dispatcher]]). To restrict the agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
scope for an extended period, use the following commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x <)}}} (~org-agenda-set-restriction-lock~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x <
#+findex: org-agenda-set-restriction-lock
Restrict the agenda to the current subtree. If there already is
a restriction at point, remove it. When called with a universal
prefix argument or with point before the first headline in
a file, set the agenda scope to the entire file. This
restriction remains in effect until removed with {{{kbd(C-c C-x
>)}}}, or by typing either {{{kbd(<)}}} or {{{kbd(>)}}} in the
agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an agenda
view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x >)}}} (~org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x >
#+findex: org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock
Remove the restriction created by {{{kbd(C-c C-x <)}}}.
When working with Speedbar, you can use the following commands in the
Speedbar frame:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(<)}}} (~org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction
Restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
in such a file---at point in the Speedbar frame. If agenda is
already restricted there, remove the restriction. If there is
a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
effect immediately.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(>)}}} (~org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock
Remove the restriction.
** The Agenda Dispatcher
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Keyboard access to agenda views.
:ALT_TITLE: Agenda Dispatcher
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: agenda dispatcher
#+cindex: dispatching agenda commands
The views are created through a dispatcher, accessible with {{{kbd(M-x
org-agenda)}}}, or, better, bound to a global key (see [[*Activation]]).
It displays a menu from which an additional letter is required to
execute a command. The dispatcher offers the following default
commands:
- {{{kbd(a)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Create the calendar-like agenda (see [[*Weekly/daily agenda]]).
- {{{kbd(t)}}} or {{{kbd(T)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Create a list of all TODO items (see [[*The global TODO list]]).
- {{{kbd(m)}}} or {{{kbd(M)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Create a list of headlines matching a given expression (see
[[*Matching tags and properties]]).
- {{{kbd(s)}}} ::
#+kindex: s @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of
keywords and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur
in the entry.
- {{{kbd(/)}}} ::
#+kindex: / @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and
additionally in the files listed in
~org-agenda-text-search-extra-files~. This uses the Emacs
command ~multi-occur~. A prefix argument can be used to specify
the number of context lines for each match, default is
1.
- {{{kbd(#)}}} or {{{kbd(!)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Create a list of stuck projects (see [[*Stuck projects]]).
- {{{kbd(<)}}} ::
#+kindex: < @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer[fn:90]. After
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
pressing {{{kbd(<)}}}, you still need to press the character
selecting the command.
- {{{kbd(< <)}}} ::
#+kindex: < < @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda
command to the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current
subtree[fn:91]. After pressing {{{kbd(< <)}}}, you still need to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
press the character selecting the command.
- {{{kbd(*)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: * @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-sticky
#+findex: org-toggle-sticky-agenda
Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only
a single agenda buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the
view, to make sure everything is always up to date. If you
switch between views often and the build time bothers you, you
can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
customizing the variable ~org-agenda-sticky~). With sticky
agendas, the dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you
need to update it by hand with {{{kbd(r)}}} or {{{kbd(g)}}}. You
can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
~org-toggle-sticky-agenda~.
You can also define custom commands that are accessible through the
dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list
and a number of special tags matches. See [[*Custom Agenda Views]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** The Built-in Agenda Views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: What is available out of the box?
:ALT_TITLE: Built-in Agenda Views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
In this section we describe the built-in views.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Weekly/daily agenda
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The calendar page with current tasks.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda
#+cindex: weekly agenda
#+cindex: daily agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The purpose of the weekly/daily /agenda/ is to act like a page of
a paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda a)}}} (~org-agenda-list~) ::
#+kindex: a @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-list
#+cindex: org-agenda, command
Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files.
The agenda shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix
argument[fn:92]---like {{{kbd(C-u 2 1 M-x org-agenda a)}}}---you
may set the number of days to be displayed.
#+vindex: org-agenda-span
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-start-day
#+vindex: org-agenda-start-on-weekday
The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the
variable ~org-agenda-span~. This variable can be set to any number of
days you want to see by default in the agenda, or to a span name, such
a ~day~, ~week~, ~month~ or ~year~. For weekly agendas, the default
is to start on the previous Monday (see
~org-agenda-start-on-weekday~). You can also set the start date using
a date shift: =(setq org-agenda-start-day "+10d")= starts the agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
ten days from today in the future.
Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in [[*Commands in
the Agenda Buffer]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Calendar/Diary integration
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: calendar integration
#+cindex: diary integration
Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward\nbsp{}M.\nbsp{}Reingold. The
calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with the diary.
In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
agenda, you only need to customize the variable
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
After that, everything happens automatically. All diary entries
including holidays, anniversaries, etc., are included in the agenda
buffer created by Org mode. {{{kbd(SPC)}}}, {{{kbd(TAB)}}}, and
{{{kbd(RET)}}} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
file in order to edit existing diary entries. The {{{kbd(i)}}}
command to insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda
buffer, as well as the commands {{{kbd(S)}}}, {{{kbd(M)}}}, and
{{{kbd(C)}}} to display Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to
convert to other calendars, respectively. {{{kbd(c)}}} can be used to
switch back and forth between calendar and agenda.
If you are using the diary only for S-exp entries and holidays, it is
faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them, as seen in the
following segment of an Org file:[fn:93]
#+begin_example
,* Holidays
:PROPERTIES:
:CATEGORY: Holiday
:END:
%%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
,* Birthdays
:PROPERTIES:
:CATEGORY: Ann
:END:
%%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14) Arthur Dent is %d years old
%%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Anniversaries from BBDB
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: BBDB, anniversaries
#+cindex: anniversaries, from BBDB
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-bbdb-anniversaries
If you are using the Insidious Big Brother Database to store your
contacts, you very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather
than in a separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and can show
BBDB anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to
add the following to one of your agenda files:
#+begin_example
,* Anniversaries
:PROPERTIES:
:CATEGORY: Anniv
:END:
%%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
#+end_example
You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record.
Basically, you need a field named =anniversary= for the BBDB record
which contains the date in the format =YYYY-MM-DD= or =MM-DD=,
followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (=birthday=,
=wedding=, or a format string). If you omit the class, it defaults to
=birthday=. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
=org-bbdb.el= contains more detailed information.
#+begin_example
1973-06-22
06-22
1955-08-02 wedding
2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of Org mode, %d years ago
#+end_example
After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Emacs session, the agenda display suffers a short delay as Org updates
its hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be
very fast, much faster in fact than a long list of
=%%(diary-anniversary)= entries in an Org or Diary file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-bbdb-anniversaries-future
If you would like to see upcoming anniversaries with a bit of
forewarning, you can use the following instead:
#+begin_example
,* Anniversaries
:PROPERTIES:
:CATEGORY: Anniv
:END:
%%(org-bbdb-anniversaries-future 3)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
That will give you three days' warning: on the anniversary date itself
and the two days prior. The argument is optional: if omitted, it
defaults to 7.
**** Appointment reminders
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: @file{appt.el}
#+cindex: appointment reminders
#+cindex: appointment
#+cindex: reminders
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: APPT_WARNTIME, keyword
Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To
add the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
~org-agenda-to-appt~. This command lets you filter through the list
of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific
category or matching a regular expression. It also reads
a =APPT_WARNTIME= property which overrides the value of
~appt-message-warning-time~ for this appointment. See the docstring
for details.
*** The global TODO list
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: All unfinished action items.
:ALT_TITLE: Global TODO list
:END:
#+cindex: global TODO list
#+cindex: TODO list, global
The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
collected into a single place.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda t)}}} (~org-todo-list~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: t @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-todo-list
Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
agenda files (see [[*Agenda Views]]) into a single buffer. By
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
default, this lists items with a state the is not a DONE state.
The buffer is in ~agenda-mode~, so there are commands to examine
and manipulate the TODO entries directly from that buffer (see
[[*Commands in the Agenda Buffer]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda T)}}} (~org-todo-list~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: T @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-todo-list
#+cindex: TODO keyword matching
#+vindex: org-todo-keywords
Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword.
You can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to
{{{kbd(t)}}}. You are prompted for a keyword, and you may also
specify several keywords by separating them with =|= as the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
boolean OR operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in
~org-todo-keywords~ is selected.
#+kindex: r
The {{{kbd(r)}}} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you
can give a prefix argument to this command to change the selected
TODO keyword, for example {{{kbd(3 r)}}}. If you often need
a search for a specific keyword, define a custom command for it
(see [[*The Agenda Dispatcher]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of
a tags search (see [[*Tag Searches]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of
a TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
TODO list are described in [[*Commands in the Agenda Buffer]].
#+cindex: sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
it more compact:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
#+vindex: org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
#+vindex: org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
#+vindex: org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Some people view a TODO item that has been /scheduled/ for execution
or have a /deadline/ (see [[*Timestamps, Deadlines and Scheduling]]) as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
no longer /open/. Configure the variables
~org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled~,
~org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines~,
~org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp~ and/or
~org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date~ to exclude such items from the
global TODO list.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks.
In such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO
headline and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the
variable ~org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels~ to get this behavior.
*** Matching tags and properties
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Structured information with fine-tuned search.
:END:
#+cindex: matching, of tags
#+cindex: matching, of properties
#+cindex: tags view
#+cindex: match view
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If headlines in the agenda files are marked with /tags/ (see [[*Tags]]),
or have properties (see [[*Properties and Columns]]), you can select
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
headlines based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda
buffer. The match syntax described here also applies when creating
sparse trees with {{{kbd(C-c / m)}}}.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda m)}}} (~org-tags-view~) ::
#+kindex: m @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-tags-view
Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags.
The command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean
logic expression with tags, like =+work+urgent-withboss= or
=work|home= (see [[*Tags]]). If you often need a specific search,
define a custom command for it (see [[*The Agenda Dispatcher]]).
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda M)}}} (~org-tags-view~) ::
#+kindex: M @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-tags-view
#+vindex: org-tags-match-list-sublevels
#+vindex: org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
Like {{{kbd(m)}}}, but only select headlines that are also TODO
items and force checking subitems (see the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-tags-match-list-sublevels~). To exclude scheduled/deadline
items, see the variable
~org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options~. Matching specific
TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
[[*Tag Searches]].
The commands available in the tags list are described in [[*Commands in
the Agenda Buffer]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: boolean logic, for agenda searches
A search string can use Boolean operators =&= for AND and =|= for OR.
=&= binds more strongly than =|=. Parentheses are currently not
implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
expression matching tags, or an expression like =PROPERTY OPERATOR
VALUE= with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each
element may be preceded by =-= to select against it, and =+= is
syntactic sugar for positive selection. The AND operator =&= is
optional when =+= or =-= is present. Here are some examples, using
only tags.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~+work-boss~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Select headlines tagged =work=, but discard those also tagged
=boss=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~work|laptop~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Selects lines tagged =work= or =laptop=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~work|laptop+night~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Like before, but require the =laptop= lines to be tagged
also =night=.
#+cindex: regular expressions, with tags search
Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
in curly braces. For example, =work+{^boss.*}= matches headlines that
contain the tag =:work:= and any tag /starting/ with =boss=.
#+cindex: group tags, as regular expressions
Group tags (see [[*Tag Hierarchy]]) are expanded as regular expressions.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
E.g., if =work= is a group tag for the group =:work:lab:conf:=, then
searching for =work= also searches for ={\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)}= and
searching for =-work= searches for all headlines but those with one of
the tags in the group (i.e., =-{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)}=).
#+cindex: TODO keyword matching, with tags search
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: level, for tags/property match
#+cindex: category, for tags/property match
#+vindex: org-odd-levels-only
You may also test for properties (see [[*Properties and Columns]]) at the
same time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
special properties that represent other metadata (see [[*Special
Properties]]). For example, the property =TODO= represents the TODO
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
keyword of the entry. Or, the property =LEVEL= represents the level
of an entry. So searching =+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"= lists all level
three headlines that have the tag =boss= and are /not/ marked with the
TODO keyword =DONE=. In buffers with ~org-odd-levels-only~ set,
=LEVEL= does not count the number of stars, but =LEVEL=2= corresponds
to 3 stars etc.
Here are more examples:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =work+TODO="WAITING"= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Select =work=-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO keyword
=WAITING=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used
to test the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
#+begin_example
+work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2
+With={Sarah|Denny}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The type of comparison depends on how the comparison value is written:
- If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
done, and the allowed operators are =<=, ===, =>=, =<==, =>==, and
=<>=.
- If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes, a string
comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
- If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes /and/ angular
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
brackets (like =DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"=), both values are
assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and
the comparison is done accordingly. Valid values also include
="<now>"= for now (including time), ="<today>"=, and ="<tomorrow>"=
for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time specification.
You can also use strings like ="<+5d>"= or ="<-2m>"= with units =d=,
=w=, =m=, and =y= for day, week, month, and year, respectively.
- If the comparison value is enclosed in curly braces, a regexp match
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
is performed, with === meaning that the regexp matches the property
value, and =<>= meaning that it does not match.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
So the search string in the example finds entries tagged =work= but
not =boss=, which also have a priority value =A=, a =Coffee= property
with the value =unlimited=, an =EFFORT= property that is numerically
smaller than 2, a =With= property that is matched by the regular
expression =Sarah|Denny=, and that are scheduled on or after October
11, 2008.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during
a search, but beware that this can slow down searches considerably.
See [[*Property Inheritance]], for details.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also
a different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate
the tags/property part of the search string (which may include several
terms connected with =|=) with a =/= and then specify a Boolean
expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that
for tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive
selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined
with boolean AND. However, /negative selection/ combined with AND can
be meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually
have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use {{{kbd(M-x
org-agenda M)}}}, or equivalently start the TODO part after the slash
with =!=. Using {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda M)}}} or =/!= does not match
TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =work/WAITING= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Same as =work+TODO="WAITING"=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =work/!-WAITING-NEXT= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Select =work=-tagged TODO lines that are neither =WAITING= nor
=NEXT=.
- =work/!+WAITING|+NEXT= ::
Select =work=-tagged TODO lines that are either =WAITING= or
=NEXT=.
*** Search view
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Find entries by searching for text.
:END:
#+cindex: search view
#+cindex: text search
#+cindex: searching, for text
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode
entries. It is particularly useful to find notes.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda s)}}} (~org-search-view~) ::
#+kindex: s @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-search-view
This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching
a substring or specific words using a boolean logic.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For example, the search string =computer equipment= matches entries
that contain =computer equipment= as a substring, even if the two
words are separated by more space or a line break.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using
Boolean logic. The search string =+computer
+wifi -ethernet -{8\.11[bg]}= matches note entries that contain the
keywords =computer= and =wifi=, but not the keyword =ethernet=, and
which are also not matched by the regular expression =8\.11[bg]=,
meaning to exclude both =8.11b= and =8.11g=. The first =+= is
necessary to turn on boolean search, other =+= characters are
optional. For more details, see the docstring of the command
~org-search-view~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can incrementally adjust a boolean search with the following keys
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.1 0.6
| {{{kbd([)}}} | Add a positive search word |
| {{{kbd(])}}} | Add a negative search word |
| {{{kbd({)}}} | Add a positive regular expression |
| {{{kbd(})}}} | Add a negative regular expression |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command also searches
the files listed in ~org-agenda-text-search-extra-files~.
*** Stuck projects
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Find projects you need to review.
:END:
#+pindex: GTD, Getting Things Done
If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
work, one of the "duties" you have is a regular review to make sure
that all projects move along. A /stuck/ project is a project that has
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
no defined next actions, so it never shows up in the TODO lists Org
mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such projects
and define next actions for them.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda #)}}} (~org-agenda-list-stuck-projects~) ::
#+kindex: # @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-list-stuck-projects
List projects that are stuck.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-agenda !)}}} ::
#+kindex: ! @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-stuck-projects
Customize the variable ~org-stuck-projects~ to define what
a stuck project is and how to find it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You almost certainly need to configure this view before it works for
you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are level-2
headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least one
entry marked with a TODO keyword =TODO= or =NEXT= or =NEXTACTION=.
Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
projects with a tag =:PROJECT:=, and that you use a TODO keyword
=MAYBE= to indicate a project that should not be considered yet.
Let's further assume that the TODO keyword =DONE= marks finished
projects, and that =NEXT= and =TODO= indicate next actions. The tag
=:@shop:= indicates shopping and is a next action even without the
NEXT tag. Finally, if the project contains the special word =IGNORE=
anywhere, it should not be listed either. In this case you would
start by identifying eligible projects with a tags/TODO match (see
[[*Tag Searches]]) =+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE=, and then check for =TODO=,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=NEXT=, =@shop=, and =IGNORE= in the subtree to identify projects that
are not stuck. The correct customization for this is:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-stuck-projects
'("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@shop")
"\\<IGNORE\\>"))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this
entry is searched for stuck projects.
** Presentation and Sorting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How agenda items are prepared for display.
:END:
#+cindex: presentation, of agenda items
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-prefix-format
#+vindex: org-agenda-tags-column
Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares
the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
starts with a /prefix/ that contains the /category/ (see [[*Categories]])
of the item and other important information. You can customize in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
which column tags are displayed through ~org-agenda-tags-column~. You
can also customize the prefix using the option
~org-agenda-prefix-format~. This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up
version of the outline headline associated with the item.
*** Categories
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Not all tasks are equal.
:END:
#+cindex: category
#+cindex: @samp{CATEGORY}, keyword
The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By
default, the category is simply derived from the file name, but you
can also specify it with a special line in the buffer, like
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+CATEGORY: Thesis
#+cindex: @samp{CATEGORY}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you would like to have a special category for a single entry or
a (sub)tree, give the entry a =CATEGORY= property with the special
category you want to apply as the value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
longer than 10 characters.
#+vindex: org-agenda-category-icon-alist
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can set up icons for category by customizing the
~org-agenda-category-icon-alist~ variable.
*** Time-of-day specifications
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How the agenda knows the time.
:END:
#+cindex: time-of-day specification
Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
agenda, for example
: <2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
Time ranges can be specified with two timestamps:
: <2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>
2018-04-24 17:26:27 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-search-headline-for-time
In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range)---like =12:45= or
a =8:30-1pm=---may also appear as plain text[fn:94].
2018-04-24 17:26:27 -04:00
If the agenda integrates the Emacs diary (see [[*Weekly/daily agenda]]),
time specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in
a standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
#+begin_example
8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
#+end_example
#+cindex: time grid
If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
#+begin_example
8:00...... ------------------
8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
10:00...... ------------------
12:00...... ------------------
12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
14:00...... ------------------
16:00...... ------------------
18:00...... ------------------
19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
20:00...... ------------------
20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
#+end_example
#+vindex: org-agenda-use-time-grid
#+vindex: org-agenda-time-grid
The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
~org-agenda-use-time-grid~, and can be configured with
~org-agenda-time-grid~.
*** Sorting of agenda items
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The order of things.
:END:
#+cindex: sorting, of agenda items
#+cindex: priorities, of agenda items
Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
done depends on the type of view.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
-
#+vindex: org-agenda-files
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
time-of-day specification. These entries are shown at the beginning
of the list, as a /schedule/ for the day. After that, items remain
grouped in categories, in the sequence given by ~org-agenda-files~.
Within each category, items are sorted by priority (see
[[*Priorities]]), which is composed of the base priority (2000 for
priority =A=, 1000 for =B=, and 0 for =C=), plus additional
increments for overdue scheduled or deadline items.
- For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but
within each category, sorting takes place according to priority (see
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[[*Priorities]]). The priority used for sorting derives from the
priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to
its due or scheduled date.
- For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in
the sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
#+vindex: org-agenda-sorting-strategy
Sorting can be customized using the variable
~org-agenda-sorting-strategy~, and may also include criteria based on
the estimated effort of an entry (see [[*Effort Estimates]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Filtering/limiting agenda times
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Dynamically narrow the agenda.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Agenda built-in or customized commands are statically defined. Agenda
filters and limits provide two ways of dynamically narrowing down the
list of agenda entries: /filters/ and /limits/. Filters only act on
the display of the items, while limits take effect before the list of
agenda entries is built. Filters are more often used interactively,
while limits are mostly useful when defined as local variables within
custom agenda commands.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Filtering in the agenda
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: agenda filtering
#+cindex: filtering entries, in agenda
#+cindex: tag filtering, in agenda
#+cindex: category filtering, in agenda
#+cindex: top headline filtering, in agenda
#+cindex: effort filtering, in agenda
#+cindex: query editing, in agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(/)}}} (~org-agenda-filter-by-tag~) ::
#+findex: org-agenda-filter-by-tag
#+vindex: org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort
estimates. The difference between this and a custom agenda
command is that filtering is very fast, so that you can switch
quickly between different filters without having to recreate the
agenda.[fn:95]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You are prompted for a tag selection letter; {{{kbd(SPC)}}} means
any tag at all. Pressing {{{kbd(TAB)}}} at that prompt offers
completion to select a tag, including any tags that do not have
a selection character. The command then hides all entries that
do not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix
argument, remove the entries that /do/ have the tag. A second
{{{kbd(/)}}} at the prompt turns off the filter and shows any
hidden entries. Pressing {{{kbd(+)}}} or {{{kbd(-)}}} switches
between filtering and excluding the next tag.
#+vindex: org-agenda-auto-exclude-function
Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the
variable ~org-agenda-auto-exclude-function~ is set to
a user-defined function, that function can decide which tags
should be excluded from the agenda automatically. Once this is
set, the {{{kbd(/)}}} command then accepts {{{kbd(RET)}}} as
a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example,
let's say you use a =Net= tag to identify tasks which need
network access, an =Errand= tag for errands in town, and a =Call=
tag for making phone calls. You could auto-exclude these tags
based on the availability of the Internet, and outside of
business hours, with something like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
(and (cond
((string= tag "Net")
(/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
"-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
(let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
(or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
(concat "-" tag)))
(setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(<)}}} (~org-agenda-filter-by-category~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-filter-by-category
Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of
the item at point. Pressing {{{kbd(<)}}} another time removes
this filter. When called with a prefix argument exclude the
category of the item at point from the agenda.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-category-filter-preset
You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the
option ~org-agenda-category-filter-preset~. See [[*Setting options
for custom commands]].
- {{{kbd(^)}}} (~org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline~) ::
#+findex: org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline
Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and
the parent headline of the one at point.
- {{{kbd(=)}}} (~org-agenda-filter-by-regexp~) ::
#+findex: org-agenda-filter-by-regexp
Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda
entries matching the regular expression the user entered. When
called with a prefix argument, it filters /out/ entries matching
the regexp. Called in a regexp-filtered agenda view, remove the
filter, unless there are two universal prefix arguments, in which
case filters are cumulated.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset
You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the
option ~org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset~. See [[*Setting options
for custom commands]].
- {{{kbd(_)}}} (~org-agenda-filter-by-effort~) ::
#+findex: org-agenda-filter-by-effort
Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates. You
first need to set up allowed efforts globally, for example
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-global-properties
'(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
#+vindex: org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator,
one of {{{kbd(<)}}}, {{{kbd(>)}}} and {{{kbd(=)}}}, and then the
one-digit index of an effort estimate in your array of allowed
values, where {{{kbd(0)}}} means the 10th value. The filter then
restricts to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal, or
larger-or-equal than the selected value. For application of the
operator, entries without a defined effort are treated according
to the value of ~org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high~.
When called with a prefix argument, it removes entries matching
the condition. With two universal prefix arguments, it clears
effort filters, which can be accumulated.
#+vindex: org-agenda-effort-filter-preset
You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the
option ~org-agenda-effort-filter-preset~. See [[*Setting options
for custom commands]].
- {{{kbd(|)}}} (~org-agenda-filter-remove-all~) ::
Remove all filters in the current agenda view.
**** Setting limits for the agenda
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: limits, in agenda
Here is a list of options that you can set, either globally, or
locally in your custom agenda views (see [[*Custom Agenda Views]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-agenda-max-entries~ ::
#+vindex: org-agenda-max-entries
Limit the number of entries.
- ~org-agenda-max-effort~ ::
#+vindex: org-agenda-max-effort
Limit the duration of accumulated efforts (as minutes).
- ~org-agenda-max-todos~ ::
#+vindex: org-agenda-max-todos
Limit the number of entries with TODO keywords.
- ~org-agenda-max-tags~ ::
#+vindex: org-agenda-max-tags
Limit the number of tagged entries.
When set to a positive integer, each option excludes entries from
other categories: for example, =(setq org-agenda-max-effort 100)=
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
limits the agenda to 100 minutes of effort and exclude any entry that
has no effort property. If you want to include entries with no effort
property, use a negative value for ~org-agenda-max-effort~. One
useful setup is to use ~org-agenda-max-entries~ locally in a custom
command. For example, this custom command displays the next five
entries with a =NEXT= TODO keyword.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("n" todo "NEXT"
((org-agenda-max-entries 5)))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
Once you mark one of these five entry as DONE, rebuilding the agenda
will again the next five entries again, including the first entry that
was excluded so far.
You can also dynamically set temporary limits, which are lost when
rebuilding the agenda:
- {{{kbd(~ )}}} (~org-agenda-limit-interactively~) ::
#+findex: org-agenda-limit-interactively
This prompts for the type of limit to apply and its value.
** Commands in the Agenda Buffer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Remote editing of Org trees.
:ALT_TITLE: Agenda Commands
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: commands, in agenda buffer
Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
original entry location, and to edit the Org files "remotely" from the
agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
the other commands, point needs to be in the desired line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Motion
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: motion commands in agenda
- {{{kbd(n)}}} (~org-agenda-next-line~) ::
#+kindex: n
#+findex: org-agenda-next-line
Next line (same as {{{kbd(DOWN)}}} and {{{kbd(C-n)}}}).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(p)}}} (~org-agenda-previous-line~) ::
#+kindex: p
#+findex: org-agenda-previous-line
Previous line (same as {{{kbd(UP)}}} and {{{kbd(C-p)}}}).
*** View/Go to Org file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: view file commands in agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(SPC)}}} or {{{kbd(mouse-3)}}} (~org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: SPC
#+kindex: mouse-3
#+findex: org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up
Display the original location of the item in another window.
With a prefix argument, make sure that drawers stay folded.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(L)}}} (~org-agenda-recenter~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-recenter
Display original location and recenter that window.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} or {{{kbd(mouse-2)}}} (~org-agenda-goto~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: TAB
#+kindex: mouse-2
#+findex: org-agenda-goto
Go to the original location of the item in another window.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(RET)}}} (~org-agenda-switch-to~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: RET
#+findex: org-agenda-switch-to
Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(F)}}} (~org-agenda-follow-mode~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: F
#+findex: org-agenda-follow-mode
#+vindex: org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move point through
the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
corresponding location in the Org file. The initial setting for
this mode in new agenda buffers can be set with the variable
~org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x b)}}} (~org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x b
#+findex: org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer
Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect
buffer. With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and
then take that tree. If N is negative, go up that many levels.
With a {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix, do not remove the previously used
indirect buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} (~org-agenda-open-link~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-o
#+findex: org-agenda-open-link
Follow a link in the entry. This offers a selection of any links
in the text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is
only one link, follow it without a selection prompt.
*** Change display
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: change agenda display
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: display changing, in agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(A)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: A
Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the
current view.
- {{{kbd(o)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: o
Delete other windows.
- {{{kbd(v d)}}} or short {{{kbd(d)}}} (~org-agenda-day-view~) ::
#+kindex: v d
#+kindex: d
#+findex: org-agenda-day-view
Switch to day view. When switching to day view, this setting
becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. A numeric
prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of
the year. For example, {{{kbd(32 d)}}} jumps to February 1st.
When setting day view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
argument as well. For example, {{{kbd(200712 d)}}} jumps to
January 12, 2007. If such a year specification has only one or
two digits, it is expanded into one of the 30 next years or the
last 69 years.
- {{{kbd(v w)}}} or short {{{kbd(w)}}} (~org-agenda-week-view~) ::
#+kindex: v w
#+kindex: w
#+findex: org-agenda-week-view
Switch to week view. When switching week view, this setting
becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. A numeric
prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of
the ISO week. For example {{{kbd(9 w)}}} to ISO week number 9.
When setting week view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
argument as well. For example, {{{kbd(200712 w)}}} jumps to week
12 in 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two
digits, it is expanded into one of the 30 next years or the last
69 years.
- {{{kbd(v m)}}} (~org-agenda-month-view~) ::
#+kindex: v m
#+findex: org-agenda-month-view
Switch to month view. Because month views are slow to create,
they do not become the default for subsequent agenda refreshes.
A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to
a specific day of the month. When setting month view, a year may
be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example,
{{{kbd(200712 m)}}} jumps to December, 2007. If such a year
specification has only one or two digits, it is expanded into one
of the 30 next years or the last 69 years.
- {{{kbd(v y)}}} (~org-agenda-year-view~) ::
#+kindex: v y
#+findex: org-agenda-year-view
Switch to year view. Because year views are slow to create, they
do not become the default for subsequent agenda refreshes.
A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to
a specific day of the year.
- {{{kbd(v SPC)}}} (~org-agenda-reset-view~) ::
#+kindex: v SPC
#+findex: org-agenda-reset-view
#+vindex: org-agenda-span
Reset the current view to ~org-agenda-span~.
- {{{kbd(f)}}} (~org-agenda-later~) ::
#+kindex: f
#+findex: org-agenda-later
Go forward in time to display the span following the current one.
For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the
following week. With a prefix argument, repeat that many times.
- {{{kbd(b)}}} (~org-agenda-earlier~) ::
#+kindex: b
#+findex: org-agenda-earlier
Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
- {{{kbd(.)}}} (~org-agenda-goto-today~) ::
#+kindex: .
#+findex: org-agenda-goto-today
Go to today.
- {{{kbd(j)}}} (~org-agenda-goto-date~) ::
#+kindex: j
#+findex: org-agenda-goto-date
Prompt for a date and go there.
- {{{kbd(J)}}} (~org-agenda-clock-goto~) ::
#+kindex: J
#+findex: org-agenda-clock-goto
Go to the currently clocked-in task /in the agenda buffer/.
- {{{kbd(D)}}} (~org-agenda-toggle-diary~) ::
#+kindex: D
#+findex: org-agenda-toggle-diary
Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See [[*Weekly/daily agenda]].
- {{{kbd(v l)}}} or {{{kbd(v L)}}} or short {{{kbd(l)}}} (~org-agenda-log-mode~) ::
#+kindex: v l
#+kindex: l
#+kindex: v L
#+findex: org-agenda-log-mode
#+vindex: org-log-done
#+vindex: org-agenda-log-mode-items
Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked
DONE while logging was on (see the variable ~org-log-done~) are
shown in the agenda, as are entries that have been clocked on
that day. You can configure the entry types that should be
included in log mode using the variable
~org-agenda-log-mode-items~. When called with a {{{kbd(C-u)}}}
prefix, show all possible logbook entries, including state
changes. When called with two prefix arguments {{{kbd(C-u
C-u)}}}, show only logging information, nothing else. {{{kbd(v
L)}}} is equivalent to {{{kbd(C-u v l)}}}.
- {{{kbd(v [)}}} or short {{{kbd([)}}} (~org-agenda-manipulate-query-add~) ::
#+kindex: v [
#+kindex: [
#+findex: org-agenda-manipulate-query-add
Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for
weekly/daily agenda.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(v a)}}} (~org-agenda-archives-mode~) ::
#+kindex: v a
#+findex: org-agenda-archives-mode
Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are archived
(see [[*Internal archiving]]) are also scanned when producing the
agenda. To exit archives mode, press {{{kbd(v a)}}} again.
- {{{kbd(v A)}}} ::
#+kindex: v A
Toggle Archives mode. Include all archive files as well.
- {{{kbd(v R)}}} or short {{{kbd(R)}}} (~org-agenda-clockreport-mode~) ::
#+kindex: v R
#+kindex: R
#+findex: org-agenda-clockreport-mode
#+vindex: org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
#+vindex: org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly
agenda always shows a table with the clocked times for the time
span and file scope covered by the current agenda view. The
initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set
with the variable ~org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode~. By
using a prefix argument when toggling this mode (i.e., {{{kbd(C-u
R)}}}), the clock table does not show contributions from entries
that are hidden by agenda filtering[fn:96]. See also the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
variable ~org-clock-report-include-clocking-task~.
- {{{kbd(v c)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: v c
#+vindex: org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking
problems in the current agenda range. You can then visit
clocking lines and fix them manually. See the variable
~org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks~ for information on how to
customize the definition of what constituted a clocking problem.
To return to normal agenda display, press {{{kbd(l)}}} to exit
Logbook mode.
- {{{kbd(v E)}}} or short {{{kbd(E)}}} (~org-agenda-entry-text-mode~) ::
#+kindex: v E
#+kindex: E
#+findex: org-agenda-entry-text-mode
#+vindex: org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
#+vindex: org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines
from the Org outline node referenced by an agenda line are
displayed below the line. The maximum number of lines is given
by the variable ~org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines~. Calling this
command with a numeric prefix argument temporarily modifies that
number to the prefix value.
- {{{kbd(G)}}} (~org-agenda-toggle-time-grid~) ::
#+kindex: G
#+vindex: org-agenda-use-time-grid
#+vindex: org-agenda-time-grid
Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
~org-agenda-use-time-grid~ and ~org-agenda-time-grid~.
- {{{kbd(r)}}} (~org-agenda-redo~), {{{kbd(g)}}} ::
#+kindex: r
#+kindex: g
#+findex: org-agenda-redo
Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes
after modification of the timestamps of items with
{{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} and {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}}. When the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix argument is interpreted
to create a selective list for a specific TODO keyword.
- {{{kbd(C-x C-s)}}} or short {{{kbd(s)}}} (~org-save-all-org-buffers~) ::
#+kindex: C-x C-s
#+findex: org-save-all-org-buffers
#+kindex: s
Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the
locations of IDs.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-c)}}} (~org-agenda-columns~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-c
#+findex: org-agenda-columns
#+vindex: org-columns-default-format
Invoke column view (see [[*Column View]]) in the agenda buffer. The
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
column view format is taken from the entry at point, or, if there
is no entry at point, from the first entry in the agenda view.
So whatever the format for that entry would be in the original
buffer (taken from a property, from a =COLUMNS= keyword, or from
the default variable ~org-columns-default-format~) is used in the
agenda.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x >)}}} (~org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x >
#+findex: org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock
Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently
restricted to a file or subtree (see [[*Agenda Files]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-UP)}}} (~org-agenda-drag-line-backward~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-drag-line-backward
Drag the line at point backward one line. With a numeric prefix
argument, drag backward by that many lines.
Moving agenda lines does not persist after an agenda refresh and
does not modify the contributing Org files.
- {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} (~org-agenda-drag-line-forward~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-drag-line-forward
Drag the line at point forward one line. With a numeric prefix
argument, drag forward by that many lines.
*** Remote editing
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: remote editing, from agenda
- {{{kbd(0--9)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Digit argument.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-_)}}} (~org-agenda-undo~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-_
#+findex: org-agenda-undo
#+cindex: undoing remote-editing events
#+cindex: remote editing, undo
Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is
undone both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(t)}}} (~org-agenda-todo~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: t
#+findex: org-agenda-todo
Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
original Org file.
- {{{kbd(C-S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-agenda-todo-nextset~) ::
#+kindex: C-S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-todo-nextset
Switch to the next set of TODO keywords.
- {{{kbd(C-S-LEFT)}}}, ~org-agenda-todo-previousset~ ::
#+kindex: C-S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Switch to the previous set of TODO keywords.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-k)}}} (~org-agenda-kill~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-k
#+findex: org-agenda-kill
#+vindex: org-agenda-confirm-kill
Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree
belonging to it in the original Org file. If the text to be
deleted remotely is longer than one line, the kill needs to be
confirmed by the user. See variable ~org-agenda-confirm-kill~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-w)}}} (~org-agenda-refile~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-w
#+findex: org-agenda-refile
Refile the entry at point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-a)}}} or short {{{kbd(a)}}} (~org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-a
#+kindex: a
#+findex: org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation
#+vindex: org-archive-default-command
Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the
default archiving command set in ~org-archive-default-command~.
When using the {{{kbd(a)}}} key, confirmation is required.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x a)}}} (~org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x a
#+findex: org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag
Toggle the archive tag (see [[*Internal archiving]]) for the current
headline.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x A)}}} (~org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x A
#+findex: org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling
Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its
/archive sibling/.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-s)}}} or short {{{kbd($)}}} (~org-agenda-archive~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-s
#+kindex: $
#+findex: org-agenda-archive
Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This
means the entry is moved to the configured archive location, most
likely a different file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(T)}}} (~org-agenda-show-tags~) ::
#+kindex: T
#+findex: org-agenda-show-tags
#+vindex: org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful
if you have turned off ~org-agenda-show-inherited-tags~, but
still want to see all tags of a headline occasionally.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(:)}}} (~org-agenda-set-tags~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: :
#+findex: org-agenda-set-tags
Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region
in the agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(\,)}}} (~org-agenda-priority~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: ,
#+findex: org-agenda-priority
Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the
priority character. If you reply with {{{kbd(SPC)}}}, the
priority cookie is removed from the entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(P)}}} (~org-agenda-show-priority~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: P
#+findex: org-agenda-show-priority
Display weighted priority of current item.
- {{{kbd(+)}}} or {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} (~org-agenda-priority-up~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: +
#+kindex: S-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-priority-up
Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is
changed in the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted.
Use the {{{kbd(r)}}} key for this.
- {{{kbd(-)}}} or {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} (~org-agenda-priority-down~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: -
#+kindex: S-DOWN
#+findex: org-agenda-priority-down
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Decrease the priority of the current item.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-z)}}} or short {{{kbd(z)}}} (~org-agenda-add-note~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: z
#+kindex: C-c C-z
#+findex: org-agenda-add-note
#+vindex: org-log-into-drawer
Add a note to the entry. This note is recorded, and then filed
to the same location where state change notes are put. Depending
on ~org-log-into-drawer~, this may be inside a drawer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-a)}}} (~org-attach~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-a
#+findex: org-attach
Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-s)}}} (~org-agenda-schedule~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-s
#+findex: org-agenda-schedule
Schedule this item. With a prefix argument, remove the
scheduling timestamp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-d)}}} (~org-agenda-deadline~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-d
#+findex: org-agenda-deadline
Set a deadline for this item. With a prefix argument, remove the
deadline.
- {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} (~org-agenda-do-date-later~) ::
#+kindex: S-RIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-do-date-later
Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
into the future. If the date is in the past, the first call to
this command moves it to today. With a numeric prefix argument,
change it by that many days. For example, {{{kbd(3
6 5 S-RIGHT)}}} changes it by a year. With a {{{kbd(C-u)}}}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat
the command, it will continue to change hours even without the
prefix argument. With a double {{{kbd(C-u C-u)}}} prefix, do the
same for changing minutes. The stamp is changed in the original
Org file, but the change is not directly reflected in the agenda
buffer. Use {{{kbd(r)}}} or {{{kbd(g)}}} to update the buffer.
- {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} (~org-agenda-do-date-earlier~) ::
#+kindex: S-LEFT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-agenda-do-date-earlier
Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
into the past.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(>)}}} (~org-agenda-date-prompt~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: >
#+findex: org-agenda-date-prompt
Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key
{{{kbd(>)}}} has been chosen, because it is the same as
{{{kbd(S-.)}}} on my keyboard.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(I)}}} (~org-agenda-clock-in~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: I
#+findex: org-agenda-clock-in
Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running
already, it is stopped first.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(O)}}} (~org-agenda-clock-out~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: O
#+findex: org-agenda-clock-out
Stop the previously started clock.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(X)}}} (~org-agenda-clock-cancel~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: X
#+findex: org-agenda-clock-cancel
Cancel the currently running clock.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(J)}}} (~org-agenda-clock-goto~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: J
#+findex: org-agenda-clock-goto
Jump to the running clock in another window.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(k)}}} (~org-agenda-capture~) ::
#+kindex: k
#+findex: org-agenda-capture
#+cindex: capturing, from agenda
#+vindex: org-capture-use-agenda-date
Like ~org-capture~, but use the date at point as the default date
for the capture template. See ~org-capture-use-agenda-date~ to
make this the default behavior of ~org-capture~.
*** Bulk remote editing selected entries
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: remote editing, bulk, from agenda
#+vindex: org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(m)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-mark~) ::
#+kindex: m
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-mark
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mark the entry at point for bulk action. If there is an active
region in the agenda, mark the entries in the region. With
numeric prefix argument, mark that many successive entries.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(*)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-mark-all~) ::
#+kindex: *
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-mark-all
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mark all visible agenda entries for bulk action.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(u)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-unmark~) ::
#+kindex: u
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-unmark
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Unmark entry for bulk action.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(U)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks~) ::
#+kindex: U
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-m)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-toggle~) ::
#+kindex: M-m
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-toggle
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Toggle mark of the entry at point for bulk action.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-*)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all~) ::
#+kindex: M-*
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(%)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp~) ::
#+kindex: %
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(B)}}} (~org-agenda-bulk-action~) ::
#+kindex: B
#+findex: org-agenda-bulk-action
#+vindex: org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This
prompts for another key to select the action to be applied. The
prefix argument to {{{kbd(B)}}} is passed through to the
{{{kbd(s)}}} and {{{kbd(d)}}} commands, to bulk-remove these
special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the
bulk. If you want them to persist, set
~org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks~ to ~t~ or hit {{{kbd(p)}}} at
the prompt.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(*)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Toggle persistent marks.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd($)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Archive all selected entries.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(A)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive
siblings.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(t)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and
changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking
and suppressing logging notes---but not timestamps.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(+)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Add a tag to all selected entries.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(-)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Remove a tag from all selected entries.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(s)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule
dates by a fixed number of days, use something starting with
double plus at the prompt, for example =++8d= or =++2w=.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(d)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set deadline to a specific date.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(r)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The
entries are no longer in the agenda; refresh ({{{kbd(g)}}}) to
bring them back.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(S)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N is prompted for.
With a prefix argument ({{{kbd(C-u B S)}}}), scatter only
across weekdays.
2018-03-28 09:56:09 -04:00
- {{{kbd(f)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
Apply a function[fn:97] to marked entries. For example, the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
function below sets the =CATEGORY= property of the entries to
=web=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun set-category ()
(interactive "P")
(let ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)
(org-agenda-error))))
(org-with-point-at marker
(org-back-to-heading t)
(org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Calendar commands
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: calendar commands, from agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(c)}}} (~org-agenda-goto-calendar~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: c
#+findex: org-agenda-goto-calendar
Open the Emacs calendar and go to the date at point in the
agenda.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(c)}}} (~org-calendar-goto-agenda~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: c
#+findex: org-calendar-goto-agenda
When in the calendar, compute and show the Org agenda for the
date at point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(i)}}} (~org-agenda-diary-entry~) ::
#+kindex: i
#+findex: org-agenda-diary-entry
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: diary entries, creating from agenda
Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at point and
(for block entries) the date at the mark. This adds to the Emacs
diary file[fn:98], in a way similar to the {{{kbd(i)}}} command
in the calendar. The diary file pops up in another window, where
you can add the entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-diary-file
If you configure ~org-agenda-diary-file~ to point to an Org file,
Org creates entries in that file instead. Most entries are
stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it easy
to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree is
built under an entry with a =DATE_TREE= property, or else with
years as top-level entries. Emacs prompts you for the entry
text---if you specify it, the entry is created in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-agenda-diary-file~ without further interaction. If you
directly press {{{kbd(RET)}}} at the prompt without typing text,
the target file is shown in another window for you to finish the
entry there. See also the {{{kbd(k r)}}} command.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M)}}} (~org-agenda-phases-of-moon~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: M
#+findex: org-agenda-phases-of-moon
Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current
date.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(S)}}} (~org-agenda-sunrise-sunset~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: S
#+findex: org-agenda-sunrise-sunset
Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be
set with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs
calendar.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C)}}} (~org-agenda-convert-date~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C
#+findex: org-agenda-convert-date
Convert the date at point into many other cultural and historic
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
calendars.
- {{{kbd(H)}}} (~org-agenda-holidays~) ::
#+kindex: H
#+findex: org-agenda-holidays
Show holidays for three months around point date.
*** Quit and exit
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(q)}}} (~org-agenda-quit~) ::
#+kindex: q
#+findex: org-agenda-quit
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(x)}}} (~org-agenda-exit~) ::
#+kindex: x
#+findex: org-agenda-exit
#+cindex: agenda files, removing buffers
Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by
Emacs for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the
user to visit Org files are not removed.
** Custom Agenda Views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Defining special searches and views.
:END:
#+cindex: custom agenda views
#+cindex: agenda views, custom
Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special
composite agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands are accessible
through the dispatcher (see [[*The Agenda Dispatcher]]), just like the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
default commands.
*** Storing searches
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Type once, use often.
:END:
The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the
current buffer).
#+kindex: C @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
#+vindex: org-agenda-custom-commands
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: agenda views, main example
#+cindex: agenda, as an agenda views
#+cindex: agenda*, as an agenda views
#+cindex: tags, as an agenda view
#+cindex: todo, as an agenda view
#+cindex: tags-todo
#+cindex: todo-tree
#+cindex: occur-tree
#+cindex: tags-tree
Custom commands are configured in the variable
~org-agenda-custom-commands~. You can customize this variable, for
example by pressing {{{kbd(C)}}} from the agenda dispatcher (see [[*The
Agenda Dispatcher]]). You can also directly set it with Emacs Lisp in
the Emacs init file. The following example contains all valid agenda
views:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("x" agenda)
("y" agenda*)
("w" todo "WAITING")
("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ;description for "h" prefix
("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
after the dispatcher command in order to access the command. Usually
this will be just a single character, but if you have many similar
commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the first
character is the same in several combinations and serves as a prefix
key[fn:99]. The second parameter is the search type, followed by the
string or regular expression to be used for the matching. The example
above will therefore define:
- {{{kbd(x)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as a global search for agenda entries planned[fn:100] this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
week/day.
- {{{kbd(y)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as the same search, but only for entries with an hour
specification like =[h]h:mm=---think of them as appointments.
- {{{kbd(w)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as a global search for TODO entries with =WAITING= as the TODO
keyword.
- {{{kbd(W)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying
the results as a sparse tree.
- {{{kbd(u)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as a global tags search for headlines tagged =boss= but not
=urgent=.
- {{{kbd(v)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The same search, but limiting it to headlines that are also TODO
items.
- {{{kbd(U)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying
the result as a sparse tree.
- {{{kbd(f)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to create a sparse tree (again, current buffer only) with all
entries containing the word =FIXME=.
- {{{kbd(h)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
as a prefix command for a =HOME= tags search where you have to
press an additional key ({{{kbd(l)}}}, {{{kbd(p)}}} or
{{{kbd(k)}}}) to select a name (Lisa, Peter, or Kim) as
additional tag to match.
Note that ~*-tree~ agenda views need to be called from an Org buffer
as they operate on the current buffer only.
*** Block agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: All the stuff you need in a single buffer.
:END:
#+cindex: block agenda
#+cindex: agenda, with block views
Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
the results of /several/ commands, each of which creates a block in
the agenda buffer. The available commands include ~agenda~ for the
daily or weekly agenda (as created with {{{kbd(a)}}}) , ~alltodo~ for
the global TODO list (as constructed with {{{kbd(t)}}}), and the
matching commands discussed above: ~todo~, ~tags~, and ~tags-todo~.
Here are two examples:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
((agenda "")
(tags-todo "home")
(tags "garden")))
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
((agenda "")
(tags-todo "work")
(tags "office")))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
This defines {{{kbd(h)}}} to create a multi-block view for stuff you
need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer contains your
agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag =home=,
and also all lines tagged with =garden=. Finally the command
{{{kbd(o)}}} provides a similar view for office tasks.
*** Setting options for custom commands
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Changing the rules.
:ALT_TITLE: Setting options
:END:
#+cindex: options, for custom agenda views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-custom-commands
Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to
change some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so.
Setting options requires inserting a list of variable names and values
at the right spot in ~org-agenda-custom-commands~. For example:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("w" todo "WAITING"
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
(org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
((org-show-context-detail 'minimal)))
("N" search ""
((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
(org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
Now the {{{kbd(w)}}} command sorts the collected entries only by
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say =Mixed:=
instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
{{{kbd(U)}}} now turns out ultra-compact, because neither the headline
hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match are
shown. The command {{{kbd(N)}}} does a text search limited to only
a single file.
For command sets creating a block agenda, ~org-agenda-custom-commands~
has two separate spots for setting options. You can add options that
should be valid for just a single command in the set, and options that
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
should be valid for all commands in the set. The former are just
added to the command entry; the latter must come after the list of
command entries. Going back to the block agenda example (see [[*Block
agenda]]), let's change the sorting strategy for the {{{kbd(h)}}}
commands to ~priority-down~, but let's sort the results for =garden=
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
tags query in the opposite order, ~priority-up~. This would look like
this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
((agenda)
(tags-todo "home")
(tags "garden"
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
((agenda)
(tags-todo "work")
(tags "office")))))
#+end_src
As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options
in this interface, the /values/ are just Lisp expressions. So if the
value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
yourself.
#+vindex: org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from
a specific context, you can customize
~org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts~. Let's say for example that you
have an agenda command {{{kbd(o)}}} displaying a view that you only
need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option like
this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
'(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can also tell that the command key {{{kbd(o)}}} should refer to
another command key {{{kbd(r)}}}. In that case, add this command key
like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
'(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
#+end_src
See the docstring of the variable for more information.
** Exporting Agenda Views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Writing a view to a file.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda views, exporting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have
a printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can
export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML[fn:101], Postscript,
PDF[fn:102], and iCalendar files. If you want to do this only
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
occasionally, use the following command:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-x C-w)}}} (~org-agenda-write~) ::
#+kindex: C-x C-w
#+findex: org-agenda-write
#+cindex: exporting agenda views
#+cindex: agenda views, exporting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-exporter-settings
Write the agenda view to a file.
If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can
associate any custom agenda command with a list of output file
names[fn:103]. Here is an example that first defines custom commands
for the agenda and the global TODO list, together with a number of
files to which to export them. Then we define two block agenda
commands and specify file names for them as well. File names can be
relative to the current working directory, or absolute.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
((agenda "")
(tags-todo "home")
(tags "garden"))
nil
("~/views/home.html"))
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
((agenda)
(tags-todo "work")
(tags "office"))
nil
("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it
is =.html=, Org mode uses the htmlize package to convert the buffer to
HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is =.ps=,
~ps-print-buffer-with-faces~ is used to produce Postscript output. If
the extension is =.ics=, iCalendar export is run export over all files
that were used to construct the agenda, and limit the export to
entries listed in the agenda. Any other extension produces a plain
ASCII file.
The export files are /not/ created when you use one of those
commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
Instead, there is a special command to produce /all/ specified
files in one step:
- {{{kbd(e)}}} (~org-store-agenda-views~) ::
#+kindex: e @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
#+findex: org-store-agenda-views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export all agenda views that have export file names associated
with them.
You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
set options for the export commands. For example:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("X" agenda ""
((ps-number-of-columns 2)
(ps-landscape-mode t)
(org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
(org-agenda-with-colors nil)
(org-agenda-remove-tags t))
("theagenda.ps"))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
#+texinfo: @noindent
#+vindex: org-agenda-exporter-settings
This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
cut in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings
modify the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information,
and instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the
tags to make the lines compact, and we do not want to use colors for
the black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
~org-agenda-exporter-settings~ also apply, e.g.,
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
'((ps-number-of-columns 2)
(ps-landscape-mode t)
(org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
(htmlize-output-type 'css)))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
but the settings in ~org-agenda-custom-commands~ take precedence.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
From the command line you may also use:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src shell
emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or, if you need to modify some parameters[fn:104]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src shell
emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
org-agenda-span (quote month) \
org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
org-agenda-include-diary nil \
org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
-kill
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
which creates the agenda views restricted to the file
=~/org/project.org=, without diary entries and with a 30-day extent.
You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
processing by other programs. See [[*Extracting Agenda Information]], for
more information.
** Using Column View in the Agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Using column view for collected entries.
:ALT_TITLE: Agenda Column View
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: column view, in agenda
#+cindex: agenda, column view
Column view (see [[*Column View]]) is normally used to view and edit
properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It
can be quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where
entries are collected by certain criteria.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-c)}}} (~org-agenda-columns~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-c
#+findex: org-agenda-columns
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Turn on column view in the agenda.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize
that the entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline
environment. This causes the following issues:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
1.
#+vindex: org-columns-default-format
#+vindex: org-overriding-columns-format
Org needs to make a decision which columns format to use. Since
the entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
different files may have different columns formats, this is
a non-trivial problem. Org first checks if the variable
~org-agenda-overriding-columns-format~ is currently set, and if so,
takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes the format
associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item does
not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file),
it uses ~org-columns-default-format~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2.
#+cindex: @samp{CLOCKSUM}, special property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If any of the columns has a summary type defined (see [[*Column
attributes]]), turning on column view in the agenda visits all
relevant agenda files and make sure that the computations of this
property are up to date. This is also true for the special
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=CLOCKSUM= property. Org then sums the values displayed in the
agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums cover a single day;
in all other views they cover the entire block.
It is important to realize that the agenda may show the same entry
/twice/---for example as scheduled and as a deadline---and it may
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
show two entries from the same hierarchy (for example a /parent/
and its /child/). In these cases, the summation in the agenda
leads to incorrect results because some values count double.
3. When the column view in the agenda shows the =CLOCKSUM= property,
that is always the entire clocked time for this item. So even in
the daily/weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view may
originate from times outside the current view. This has the
advantage that you can compare these values with a column listing
the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
applications for column view in the agenda. If you want
information about clocked time in the displayed period use clock
table mode (press {{{kbd(R)}}} in the agenda).
4.
#+cindex: @samp{CLOCKSUM_T}, special property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When the column view in the agenda shows the =CLOCKSUM_T= property,
that is always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the
weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view only originates
from today. This lets you compare the time you spent on a task for
today, with the time already spent---via =CLOCKSUM=---and with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the planned total effort for it.
* Markup for Rich Contents
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Compose beautiful documents.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
Org is primarily about organizing and searching through your
plain-text notes. However, it also provides a lightweight yet robust
markup language for rich text formatting and more. For instance, you
may want to center or emphasize text. Or you may need to insert
a formula or image in your writing. Org offers syntax for all of this
and more. Used in conjunction with the export framework (see
[[*Exporting]]), you can author beautiful documents in Org---like the fine
manual you are currently reading.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Paragraphs
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The basic unit of text.
:END:
#+cindex: paragraphs, markup rules
Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to
enforce a line break within a paragraph, use =\\= at the end of
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a line.
#+cindex: line breaks, markup rules
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To preserve the line breaks, indentation and blank lines in a region,
but otherwise use normal formatting, you can use this construct, which
can also be used to format poetry.
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_VERSE}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: verse blocks
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_VERSE
Great clouds overhead
Tiny black birds rise and fall
Snow covers Emacs
---AlexSchroeder
,#+END_VERSE
#+end_example
When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to
format this as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
right margin. You can include quotations in Org documents like this:
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_QUOTE}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: quote blocks
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_QUOTE
Everything should be made as simple as possible,
but not any simpler ---Albert Einstein
,#+END_QUOTE
#+end_example
If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_CENTER}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: center blocks
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_CENTER
Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
but not any simpler
,#+END_CENTER
#+end_example
** Emphasis and Monospace
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Bold, italic, etc.
:END:
#+cindex: underlined text, markup rules
#+cindex: bold text, markup rules
#+cindex: italic text, markup rules
#+cindex: verbatim text, markup rules
#+cindex: code text, markup rules
#+cindex: strike-through text, markup rules
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
You can make words =*bold*=, =/italic/=, =_underlined_=, ==verbatim==
and =~code~=, and, if you must, =+strike-through+=. Text in the code
and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific syntax; it
is exported verbatim.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-fontify-emphasized-text
To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set
~org-fontify-emphasized-text~ to ~nil~. To narrow down the list of
available markup syntax, you can customize ~org-emphasis-alist~.
** Subscripts and Superscripts
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: subscript
#+cindex: superscript
=^= and =_= are used to indicate super- and subscripts. To increase
the readability of ASCII text, it is not necessary, but OK, to
surround multi-character sub- and superscripts with curly braces. For
example
#+begin_example
The radius of the sun is R_sun = 6.96 x 10^8 m. On the other hand,
the radius of Alpha Centauri is R_{Alpha Centauri} = 1.28 x R_{sun}.
#+end_example
#+vindex: org-use-sub-superscripts
If you write a text where the underscore is often used in a different
context, Org's convention to always interpret these as subscripts can
get in your way. Configure the variable ~org-use-sub-superscripts~ to
change this convention. For example, when setting this variable to
~{}~, =a_b= is not interpreted as a subscript, but =a_{b}= is.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x \)}}} (~org-toggle-pretty-entities~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x \
#+findex: org-toggle-pretty-entities
This command formats sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
** Special Symbols
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Greek letters and other symbols.
:END:
#+cindex: math symbols
#+cindex: special symbols
#+cindex: entities
You can use LaTeX-like syntax to insert special symbols---named
entities---like =\alpha= to indicate the Greek letter, or =\to= to indicate
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
an arrow. Completion for these symbols is available, just type =\=
and maybe a few letters, and press {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} to see possible
completions. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
with a pair of curly brackets. For example
#+begin_example
Pro tip: Given a circle \Gamma of diameter d, the length of its
circumference is \pi{}d.
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-entities-help
#+vindex: org-entities-user
A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
HTML and LaTeX; you can comfortably browse the complete list from
a dedicated buffer using the command ~org-entities-help~. It is also
possible to provide your own special symbols in the variable
~org-entities-user~.
During export, these symbols are transformed into the native format of
the exporter back-end. Strings like =\alpha= are exported as =&alpha;= in
the HTML output, and as =\(\alpha\)= in the LaTeX output. Similarly, =\nbsp=
becomes =&nbsp;= in HTML and =~= in LaTeX.
#+cindex: special symbols, in-buffer display
If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF-8 characters, use
the following command[fn:105]:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x \)}}} (~org-toggle-pretty-entities~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x \
#+findex: org-toggle-pretty-entities
Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not
change the buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it
overlays the UTF-8 character for display purposes only.
#+cindex: shy hyphen, special symbol
#+cindex: dash, special symbol
#+cindex: ellipsis, special symbol
In addition to regular entities defined above, Org exports in
a special way[fn:106] the following commonly used character
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
combinations: =\-= is treated as a shy hyphen, =--= and =---= are
converted into dashes, and =...= becomes a compact set of dots.
** Embedded LaTeX
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents.
:END:
#+cindex: @TeX{} interpretation
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} interpretation
Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking.
Exceptions include scientific notes, which often require mathematical
symbols and the occasional formula. LaTeX[fn:107] is widely used to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
typeset scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding LaTeX code
into its files, because many academics are used to writing and reading
LaTeX source code, and because it can be readily processed to produce
pretty output for a number of export back-ends.
*** LaTeX fragments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Complex formulas made easy.
:END:
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} fragments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-format-latex-header
Org mode can contain LaTeX math fragments, and it supports ways to
process these for several export back-ends. When exporting to LaTeX,
the code is left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org can use either
[[http://www.mathjax.org][MathJax]] (see [[*Math formatting in HTML export]]) or transcode the math
into images (see [[*Previewing LaTeX fragments]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
LaTeX fragments do not need any special marking at all. The following
snippets are identified as LaTeX source code:
- Environments of any kind[fn:108]. The only requirement is that the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=\begin= statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
whitespace.
- Text within the usual LaTeX math delimiters. To avoid conflicts
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
with currency specifications, single =$= characters are only
recognized as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most
two line breaks, is directly attached to the =$= characters with no
whitespace in between, and if the closing =$= is followed by
whitespace, punctuation or a dash. For the other delimiters, there
is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use =\(...\)= as inline
math delimiters.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
For example:
#+begin_example
\begin{equation} % arbitrary environments,
x=\sqrt{b} % even tables, figures
\end{equation} % etc
If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
either $$ a=+\sqrt{2} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt{2} \].
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-latex
LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-export-with-latex~. The default setting is ~t~ which means
MathJax for HTML, and no processing for ASCII and LaTeX back-ends.
You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one of these
lines:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| =#+OPTIONS: tex:t= | Do the right thing automatically (MathJax) |
| =#+OPTIONS: tex:nil= | Do not process LaTeX fragments at all |
| =#+OPTIONS: tex:verbatim= | Verbatim export, for jsMath or so |
*** Previewing LaTeX fragments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: What will this snippet look like?
:END:
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-preview-latex-default-process
If you have a working LaTeX installation and =dvipng=, =dvisvgm= or
=convert= installed[fn:109], LaTeX fragments can be processed to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
produce images of the typeset expressions to be used for inclusion
while exporting to HTML (see [[*LaTeX fragments]]), or for inline
previewing within Org mode.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-format-latex-options
#+vindex: org-format-latex-header
You can customize the variables ~org-format-latex-options~ and
~org-format-latex-header~ to influence some aspects of the preview.
In particular, the ~:scale~ (and for HTML export, ~:html-scale~)
property of the former can be used to adjust the size of the preview
images.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-l)}}} (~org-toggle-latex-fragment~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-l
#+findex: org-toggle-latex-fragment
Produce a preview image of the LaTeX fragment at point and
overlay it over the source code. If there is no fragment at
point, process all fragments in the current entry (between two
headlines). When called with a prefix argument, process the
entire subtree. When called with two prefix arguments, or when
point is before the first headline, process the entire buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-with-latex-preview
You can turn on the previewing of all LaTeX fragments in a file with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+STARTUP: latexpreview
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To disable it, simply use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Using CDLaTeX to enter math
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Speed up entering of formulas.
:ALT_TITLE: CDLaTeX mode
:END:
#+cindex: CD@LaTeX{}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with
a major LaTeX mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of
environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install
=cdlatex.el= and =texmathp.el= (the latter comes also with AUCTeX)
from [[http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex]]. Do not use
CDLaTeX mode itself under Org mode, but use the light version
~org-cdlatex-mode~ that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it on for the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
current buffer with {{{kbd(M-x org-cdlatex-mode)}}}, or for all Org
files with
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
2018-03-03 04:03:45 -05:00
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for
more details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode):
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-c {)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c @{
Insert an environment template.
- {{{kbd(TAB)}}} ::
#+kindex: TAB
The {{{kbd(TAB)}}} key expands the template if point is inside
a LaTeX fragment[fn:110]. For example, {{{kbd(TAB)}}} expands
=fr= to =\frac{}{}= and position point correctly inside the first
brace. Another {{{kbd(TAB)}}} gets you into the second brace.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Even outside fragments, {{{kbd(TAB)}}} expands environment
abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if you
write =equ= at the beginning of a line and press {{{kbd(TAB)}}},
this abbreviation is expanded to an =equation= environment. To
get a list of all abbreviations, type {{{kbd(M-x
cdlatex-command-help)}}}.
- {{{kbd(^)}}}, {{{kbd(_)}}} ::
#+kindex: _
#+kindex: ^
#+vindex: cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
Pressing {{{kbd(_)}}} and {{{kbd(^)}}} inside a LaTeX fragment
inserts these characters together with a pair of braces. If you
use {{{kbd(TAB)}}} to move out of the braces, and if the braces
surround only a single character or macro, they are removed again
(depending on the variable ~cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts~).
- {{{kbd(`)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: `
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Pressing the backquote followed by a character inserts math
macros, also outside LaTeX fragments. If you wait more than 1.5
seconds after the backquote, a help window pops up.
- {{{kbd(')}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: '
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Pressing the single-quote followed by another character modifies
the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait
more than 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window pops
up. Character modification works only inside LaTeX fragments;
outside the quote is normal.
** Literal Examples
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Source code examples with special formatting.
:END:
#+cindex: literal examples, markup rules
#+cindex: code line references, markup rules
You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
markup. Such examples are typeset in monospace, so this is well
suited for source code and similar examples.
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_EXAMPLE}
#+cindex: example block
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
Some example from a text file.
,#+END_EXAMPLE
#+end_example
Note that such blocks may be /indented/ in order to align nicely with
indented text and in particular with plain list structure (see
[[*Plain Lists]]). For simplicity when using small examples, you can
also start the example lines with a colon followed by a space. There
may also be additional whitespace before the colon:
#+begin_example
Here is an example
: Some example from a text file.
#+end_example
#+cindex: formatting source code, markup rules
#+vindex: org-latex-listings
If the example is source code from a programming language, or any
other text that can be marked up by Font Lock in Emacs, you can ask
for the example to look like the fontified Emacs buffer[fn:111]. This
is done with the code block, where you also need to specify the name
of the major mode that should be used to fontify the example[fn:112],
see [[*Structure Templates]] for shortcuts to easily insert code blocks.
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_SRC}
#+cindex: source block
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
(defun org-xor (a b)
"Exclusive or."
(if a (not b) b))
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
Both in =example= and in =src= snippets, you can add a =-n= switch to
the end of the =#+BEGIN= line, to get the lines of the example
numbered. The =-n= takes an optional numeric argument specifying the
starting line number of the block. If you use a =+n= switch, the
numbering from the previous numbered snippet is continued in the
current one. The =+n= switch can also take a numeric argument. This
adds the value of the argument to the last line of the previous block
to determine the starting line number.
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n 20
;; This exports with line number 20.
(message "This is line 21")
,#+END_SRC
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp +n 10
;; This is listed as line 31.
(message "This is line 32")
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
In literal examples, Org interprets strings like =(ref:name)= as
labels, and use them as targets for special hyperlinks like
=[[(name)]]=---i.e., the reference name enclosed in single parenthesis.
In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a link remote-highlights the
corresponding code line, which is kind of cool.
You can also add a =-r= switch which /removes/ the labels from the
source code[fn:113]. With the =-n= switch, links to these references
are labeled by the line numbers from the code listing. Otherwise
links use the labels with no parentheses. Here is an example:
#+begin_example -l "(dumb-reference:%s)"
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
(save-excursion (ref:sc)
(goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
,#+END_SRC
In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
jumps to point-min.
#+end_example
#+cindex: indentation, in source blocks
Finally, you can use =-i= to preserve the indentation of a specific
code block (see [[*Editing Source Code]]).
#+vindex: org-coderef-label-format
If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax,
use a =-l= switch to change the format, for example
: #+BEGIN_SRC pascal -n -r -l "((%s))"
#+texinfo: @noindent
See also the variable ~org-coderef-label-format~.
HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (see
[[*Text areas in HTML export]]).
Because the =#+BEGIN= ... =#+END= patterns need to be added so often,
a shortcut is provided (see [[*Structure Templates]]).
- {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} (~org-edit-special~) ::
#+kindex: C-c '
#+findex: org-edit-special
Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This
works by switching to a temporary buffer with the source code.
You need to exit by pressing {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} again[fn:114]. The
edited version then replaces the old version in the Org buffer.
Fixed-width regions---where each line starts with a colon
followed by a space---are edited using ~artist-mode~[fn:115] to
allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an
empty line creates a new fixed-width region.
#+cindex: storing link, in a source code buffer
Calling ~org-store-link~ (see [[*Handling Links]]) while editing a source
code example in a temporary buffer created with {{{kbd(C-c ')}}}
prompts for a label. Make sure that it is unique in the current
buffer, and insert it with the proper formatting like =(ref:label)= at
the end of the current line. Then the label is stored as a link
=(label)=, for retrieval with {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}}.
** Images
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Display an image.
:END:
#+cindex: inlining images
#+cindex: images, markup rules
An image is a link to an image file[fn:116] that does not have
a description part, for example
: ./img/cat.jpg
If you wish to define a caption for the image (see [[*Captions]]) and
maybe a label for internal cross references (see [[*Internal Links]]),
make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede it with
=CAPTION= and =NAME= keywords as follows:
#+begin_example
,#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
,#+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049
[[./img/a.jpg]]
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
Such images can be displayed within the buffer with the following
command:
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-v)}}} (~org-toggle-inline-images~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-v
#+findex: org-toggle-inline-images
#+vindex: org-startup-with-inline-images
Toggle the inline display of linked images. When called with
a prefix argument, also display images that do have a link
description. You can ask for inline images to be displayed at
startup by configuring the variable
~org-startup-with-inline-images~[fn:117].
** Captions
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Describe tables, images...
:END:
#+cindex: captions, markup rules
#+cindex: @samp{CAPTION}, keyword
You can assign a caption to a specific part of a document by inserting
a =CAPTION= keyword immediately before it:
#+begin_example
,#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
| ... | ... |
|-----+-----|
#+end_example
Optionally, the caption can take the form:
: #+CAPTION[Short caption]: Longer caption.
Even though images and tables are prominent examples of captioned
structures, the same caption mechanism can apply to many
others---e.g., LaTeX equations, source code blocks. Depending on the
export back-end, those may or may not be handled.
** Horizontal Rules
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Make a line.
:END:
#+cindex: horizontal rules, markup rules
A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, is exported
as a horizontal line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
* Exporting
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Sharing and publishing notes.
:END:
#+cindex: exporting
At some point you might want to print your notes, publish them on the
web, or share them with people not using Org. Org can convert and
export documents to a variety of other formats while retaining as much
structure (see [[*Document Structure]]) and markup (see [[*Markup for Rich
Contents]]) as possible.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: export back-end
The libraries responsible for translating Org files to other formats
are called /back-ends/. Org ships with support for the following
back-ends:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /ascii/ (ASCII format)
- /beamer/ (LaTeX Beamer format)
- /html/ (HTML format)
- /icalendar/ (iCalendar format)
- /latex/ (LaTeX format)
- /md/ (Markdown format)
- /odt/ (OpenDocument Text format)
- /org/ (Org format)
- /texinfo/ (Texinfo format)
- /man/ (Man page format)
Users can install libraries for additional formats from the Emacs
packaging system. For easy discovery, these packages have a common
naming scheme: ~ox-NAME~, where {{{var(NAME)}}} is a format. For
example, ~ox-koma-letter~ for /koma-letter/ back-end. More libraries
can be found in the =contrib/= directory (see [[*Installation]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-backends
Org only loads back-ends for the following formats by default: ASCII,
HTML, iCalendar, LaTeX, and ODT. Additional back-ends can be loaded
in either of two ways: by configuring the ~org-export-backends~
variable, or by requiring libraries in the Emacs init file. For
example, to load the Markdown back-end, add this to your Emacs config:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(require 'ox-md)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
** The Export Dispatcher
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The main interface.
:END:
#+cindex: dispatcher, for export commands
#+cindex: export, dispatcher
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The export dispatcher is the main interface for Org's exports.
A hierarchical menu presents the currently configured export formats.
Options are shown as easy toggle switches on the same screen.
#+vindex: org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui
Org also has a minimal prompt interface for the export dispatcher.
When the variable ~org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui~ is set to
a non-~nil~ value, Org prompts in the minibuffer. To switch back to
the hierarchical menu, press {{{kbd(?)}}}.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e)}}} (~org-export~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e
#+findex: org-export
Invokes the export dispatcher interface. The options show
default settings. The {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument preserves
options from the previous export, including any sub-tree
selections.
Org exports the entire buffer by default. If the Org buffer has an
active region, then Org exports just that region.
Within the dispatcher interface, the following key combinations can
further alter what is exported, and how.
- {{{kbd(C-a)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e C-a
Toggle asynchronous export. Asynchronous export uses an external
Emacs process with a specially configured initialization file to
complete the exporting process in the background, without tying-up
Emacs. This is particularly useful when exporting long documents.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Output from an asynchronous export is saved on the /export
stack/. To view this stack, call the export dispatcher with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a double {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument. If already in the
export dispatcher menu, {{{kbd(&)}}} displays the stack.
#+vindex: org-export-in-background
You can make asynchronous export the default by setting
~org-export-in-background~.
#+vindex: org-export-async-init-file
You can set the initialization file used by the background process
by setting ~org-export-async-init-file~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-b)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e C-b
Toggle body-only export. Useful for excluding headers and
footers in the export. Affects only those back-end formats that
have sections like =<head>...</head>= in HTML.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2018-05-11 16:01:18 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-s)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e C-s
Toggle sub-tree export. When turned on, Org exports only the
sub-tree starting from point position at the time the export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
dispatcher was invoked. Org uses the top heading of this
sub-tree as the document's title. If point is not on a heading,
Org uses the nearest enclosing header. If point is in the
document preamble, Org signals an error and aborts export.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-initial-scope
To make sub-tree export the default, customize the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-export-initial-scope~.
- {{{kbd(C-v)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e C-v
Toggle visible-only export. This is useful for exporting only certain
parts of an Org document by adjusting the visibility
of particular headings.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Export Settings
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Common export settings.
:END:
#+cindex: options, for export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: Export, settings
#+cindex: @samp{OPTIONS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export options can be set: globally with variables; for an individual
file by making variables buffer-local with in-buffer settings (see
[[*Summary of In-Buffer Settings]]); by setting individual keywords or
specifying them in compact form with the =OPTIONS= keyword; or for
a tree by setting properties (see [[*Properties and Columns]]). Options
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
set at a specific level override options set at a more general level.
#+cindex: @samp{SETUPFILE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In-buffer settings may appear anywhere in the file, either directly or
indirectly through a file included using =#+SETUPFILE: filename or
URL= syntax. Option keyword sets tailored to a particular back-end
can be inserted from the export dispatcher (see [[*The Export
Dispatcher]]) using the =Insert template= command by pressing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{kbd(#)}}}. To insert keywords individually, a good way to make
sure the keyword is correct is to type =#+= and then to use
{{{kbd(M-TAB)}}}[fn:16] for completion.
The export keywords available for every back-end, and their equivalent
global variables, include:
- =AUTHOR= ::
#+cindex: @samp{AUTHOR}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: user-full-name
The document author (~user-full-name~).
- =CREATOR= ::
#+cindex: @samp{CREATOR}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-expot-creator-string
Entity responsible for output generation
(~org-export-creator-string~).
- =DATE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{DATE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-date-timestamp-format
A date or a time-stamp[fn:118].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =EMAIL= ::
#+cindex: @samp{EMAIL}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: user-mail-address
The email address (~user-mail-address~).
- =LANGUAGE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LANGUAGE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-default-language
Language to use for translating certain strings
(~org-export-default-language~). With =#+LANGUAGE: fr=, for
example, Org translates =Table of contents= to the French =Table
des matières=[fn:119].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SELECT_TAGS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SELECT_TAGS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-select-tags
The default value is =("export")=. When a tree is tagged with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=export= (~org-export-select-tags~), Org selects that tree and
its sub-trees for export. Org excludes trees with =noexport=
tags, see below. When selectively exporting files with =export=
tags set, Org does not export any text that appears before the
first headline.
- =EXCLUDE_TAGS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{EXCLUDE_TAGS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-exclude-tags
The default value is =("noexport")=. When a tree is tagged with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=noexport= (~org-export-exclude-tags~), Org excludes that tree
and its sub-trees from export. Entries tagged with =noexport=
are unconditionally excluded from the export, even if they have
an =export= tag. Even if a sub-tree is not exported, Org
executes any code blocks contained there.
- =TITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: document title
Org displays this title. For long titles, use multiple =#+TITLE=
lines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =EXPORT_FILE_NAME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The name of the output file to be generated. Otherwise, Org
generates the file name based on the buffer name and the
extension based on the back-end format.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =OPTIONS= keyword is a compact form. To configure multiple
options, use several =OPTIONS= lines. =OPTIONS= recognizes the
following arguments.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~'~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-smart-quotes
Toggle smart quotes (~org-export-with-smart-quotes~). Depending
on the language used, when activated, Org treats pairs of double
quotes as primary quotes, pairs of single quotes as secondary
quotes, and single quote marks as apostrophes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~*~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-emphasize
Toggle emphasized text (~org-export-with-emphasize~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~-~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-special-strings
Toggle conversion of special strings
(~org-export-with-special-strings~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~:~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-fixed-width
Toggle fixed-width sections (~org-export-with-fixed-width~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~<~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-timestamps
Toggle inclusion of time/date active/inactive stamps
(~org-export-with-timestamps~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~\n~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-preserve-breaks
Toggles whether to preserve line breaks
(~org-export-preserve-breaks~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~^~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-sub-superscripts
Toggle TeX-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If you write
=^:{}=, =a_{b}= is interpreted, but the simple =a_b= is left as
it is (~org-export-with-sub-superscripts~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~arch~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-archived-trees
Configure how archived trees are exported. When set to
~headline~, the export process skips the contents and processes
only the headlines (~org-export-with-archived-trees~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~author~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-author
Toggle inclusion of author name into exported file
(~org-export-with-author~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~broken-links~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-broken-links
Toggles if Org should continue exporting upon finding a broken
internal link. When set to ~mark~, Org clearly marks the problem
link in the output (~org-export-with-broken-links~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~c~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-clocks
Toggle inclusion of CLOCK keywords (~org-export-with-clocks~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~creator~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-creator
Toggle inclusion of creator information in the exported file
(~org-export-with-creator~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~d~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-drawers
Toggles inclusion of drawers, or list of drawers to include, or
list of drawers to exclude (~org-export-with-drawers~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~date~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-date
Toggle inclusion of a date into exported file
(~org-export-with-date~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~e~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-entities
Toggle inclusion of entities (~org-export-with-entities~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~email~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-email
Toggle inclusion of the author's e-mail into exported file
(~org-export-with-email~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~f~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-footnotes
Toggle the inclusion of footnotes (~org-export-with-footnotes~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~H~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-headline-levels
Set the number of headline levels for export
(~org-export-headline-levels~). Below that level, headlines are
treated differently. In most back-ends, they become list items.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~inline~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-inlinetasks
Toggle inclusion of inlinetasks (~org-export-with-inlinetasks~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~num~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-section-numbers
#+cindex: @samp{UNNUMBERED}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Toggle section-numbers (~org-export-with-section-numbers~). When
set to number N, Org numbers only those headlines at level N or
above. Set =UNNUMBERED= property to non-~nil~ to disable
numbering of heading and subheadings entirely. Moreover, when
the value is =notoc= the headline, and all its children, do not
appear in the table of contents either (see [[*Table of Contents]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~p~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-planning
Toggle export of planning information
(~org-export-with-planning~). "Planning information" comes from
lines located right after the headline and contain any
combination of these cookies: =SCHEDULED=, =DEADLINE=, or
=CLOSED=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~pri~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-priority
Toggle inclusion of priority cookies
(~org-export-with-priority~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~prop~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-properties
Toggle inclusion of property drawers, or list the properties to
include (~org-export-with-properties~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~stat~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-statistics-cookies
Toggle inclusion of statistics cookies
(~org-export-with-statistics-cookies~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~tags~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-tags
Toggle inclusion of tags, may also be ~not-in-toc~
(~org-export-with-tags~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~tasks~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-tasks
Toggle inclusion of tasks (TODO items); or ~nil~ to remove all
tasks; or ~todo~ to remove DONE tasks; or list the keywords to
keep (~org-export-with-tasks~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~tex~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-latex
~nil~ does not export; ~t~ exports; ~verbatim~ keeps everything
in verbatim (~org-export-with-latex~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~timestamp~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-time-stamp-file
Toggle inclusion of the creation time in the exported file
(~org-export-time-stamp-file~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~title~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-title
Toggle inclusion of title (~org-export-with-title~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~toc~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-toc
Toggle inclusion of the table of contents, or set the level limit
(~org-export-with-toc~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~todo~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-todo-keywords
Toggle inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text
(~org-export-with-todo-keywords~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~|~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-tables
Toggle inclusion of tables (~org-export-with-tables~).
When exporting sub-trees, special node properties can override the
above keywords. These properties have an =EXPORT_= prefix. For
example, =DATE= becomes, =EXPORT_DATE= when used for a specific
sub-tree. Except for =SETUPFILE=, all other keywords listed above
have an =EXPORT_= equivalent.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{BIND}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-allow-bind-keywords
If ~org-export-allow-bind-keywords~ is non-~nil~, Emacs variables can
become buffer-local during export by using the =BIND= keyword. Its
syntax is =#+BIND: variable value=. This is particularly useful for
in-buffer settings that cannot be changed using keywords.
** Table of Contents
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The if and where of the table of contents.
:END:
#+cindex: table of contents
#+cindex: list of tables
#+cindex: list of listings
#+cindex: @samp{toc}, in @samp{OPTIONS} keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-with-toc
The table of contents includes all headlines in the document. Its
depth is therefore the same as the headline levels in the file. If
you need to use a different depth, or turn it off entirely, set the
~org-export-with-toc~ variable accordingly. You can achieve the same
on a per file basis, using the following =toc= item in =OPTIONS=
keyword:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only include two levels in TOC)
,#+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no default TOC at all)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: excluding entries from table of contents
#+cindex: table of contents, exclude entries
Org includes both numbered and unnumbered headlines in the table of
contents[fn:120]. If you need to exclude an unnumbered headline,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
along with all its children, set the =UNNUMBERED= property to =notoc=
value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Subtree not numbered, not in table of contents either
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+cindex: @samp{TOC}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org normally inserts the table of contents directly before the first
headline of the file. To move the table of contents to a different
location, first turn off the default with ~org-export-with-toc~
variable or with =#+OPTIONS: toc:nil=. Then insert =#+TOC: headlines
N= at the desired location(s).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+OPTIONS: toc:nil
...
,#+TOC: headlines 2
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To adjust the table of contents depth for a specific section of the
Org document, append an additional =local= parameter. This parameter
becomes a relative depth for the current level. The following example
inserts a local table of contents, with direct children only.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Section
,#+TOC: headlines 1 local
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that for this feature to work properly in LaTeX export, the Org
file requires the inclusion of the titletoc package. Because of
compatibility issues, titletoc has to be loaded /before/ hyperref.
Customize the ~org-latex-default-packages-alist~ variable.
Use the =TOC= keyword to generate list of tables---respectively, all
listings---with captions.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+TOC: listings
,#+TOC: tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+cindex: @samp{ALT_TITLE}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Normally Org uses the headline for its entry in the table of contents.
But with =ALT_TITLE= property, a different entry can be specified for
the table of contents.
** Include Files
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Include additional files into a document.
:END:
#+cindex: include files, during export
#+cindex: export, include files
#+cindex: @samp{INCLUDE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
During export, you can include the content of another file. For
example, to include your =.emacs= file, you could use:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The first parameter is the file name to include. The optional second
parameter specifies the block type: =example=, =export= or =src=. The
optional third parameter specifies the source code language to use for
formatting the contents. This is relevant to both =export= and =src=
block types.
If an included file is specified as having a markup language, Org
neither checks for valid syntax nor changes the contents in any way.
For example and source blocks, Org code-escapes the contents before
inclusion.
#+cindex: @samp{minlevel}, include
If an included file is not specified as having any markup language,
Org assumes it be in Org format and proceeds as usual with a few
exceptions. Org makes the footnote labels (see [[*Creating Footnotes]])
in the included file local to that file. The contents of the included
file belong to the same structure---headline, item---containing the
=INCLUDE= keyword. In particular, headlines within the file become
children of the current section. That behavior can be changed by
providing an additional keyword parameter, =:minlevel=. It shifts the
headlines in the included file to become the lowest level. For
example, this syntax makes the included file a sibling of the current
top-level headline:
: #+INCLUDE: "~/my-book/chapter2.org" :minlevel 1
#+cindex: @samp{lines}, include
Inclusion of only portions of files are specified using ranges
parameter with =:lines= keyword. The line at the upper end of the
range will not be included. The start and/or the end of the range may
be omitted to use the obvious defaults.
| =#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10"= | Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded |
| =#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10"= | Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded |
| =#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-"= | Include lines from 10 to EOF |
Inclusions may specify a file-link to extract an object matched by
~org-link-search~[fn:121] (see [[*Search Options in File Links]]). The
ranges for =:lines= keyword are relative to the requested element.
Therefore,
: #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::*conclusion" :lines 1-20
#+texinfo: @noindent
includes the first 20 lines of the headline named =conclusion=.
#+cindex: @samp{only-contents}, include
To extract only the contents of the matched object, set
=:only-contents= property to non-~nil~. This omits any planning lines
or property drawers. For example, to include the body of the heading
with the custom ID =theory=, you can use
: #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::#theory" :only-contents t
The following command allows navigating back and forth to the included
document:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} (~org-edit~special~) ::
#+kindex: C-c '
#+findex: org-edit-special
Visit the included file at point.
** Macro Replacement
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Use macros to create templates.
:END:
#+cindex: macro replacement, during export
#+cindex: @samp{MACRO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-global-macros
Macros replace text snippets during export. Macros are defined
globally in ~org-export-global-macros~, or document-wise with the
following syntax:
: #+MACRO: name replacement text; $1, $2 are arguments
#+texinfo: @noindent
which can be referenced using ={{{name(arg1, arg2)}}}=[fn:122]. For
example
#+begin_example
,#+MACRO: poem The rose is $1, The violet's $2. Life's ordered: Org assists you.
{{{poem(red,blue)}}}
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
becomes
: The rose is red, The violet's blue. Life's ordered: Org assists you.
As a special case, Org parses any replacement text starting with
=(eval= as an Emacs Lisp expression and evaluates it accordingly.
Within such templates, arguments become strings. Thus, the following
macro
: #+MACRO: gnucheck (eval (concat "GNU/" (capitalize $1)))
#+texinfo: @noindent
turns ={{{gnucheck(linux)}}}= into =GNU/Linux= during export.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org recognizes macro references in following Org markup areas:
paragraphs, headlines, verse blocks, tables cells and lists. Org also
recognizes macro references in keywords, such as =CAPTION=, =TITLE=,
=AUTHOR=, =DATE=, and for some back-end specific export options.
Org comes with following pre-defined macros:
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ;
- ={{{keyword(NAME)}}}=; ={{{title}}}=; ={{{author}}}=; ={{{email}}}= ::
#+cindex: @samp{keyword}, macro
#+cindex: @samp{title}, macro
#+cindex: @samp{author}, macro
#+cindex: @samp{email}, macro
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =keyword= macro collects all values from {{{var(NAME)}}}
keywords throughout the buffer, separated with white space.
=title=, =author= and =email= macros are shortcuts for,
respectively, ={{{keyword(TITLE)}}}=, ={{{keyword(AUTHOR)}}}= and
={{{keyword(EMAIL)}}}=.
- ={{{date}}}=; ={{{date(FORMAT)}}}= ::
#+cindex: @samp{date}, macro
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This macro refers to the =DATE= keyword. {{{var(FORMAT)}}} is an
optional argument to the =date= macro that is used only if =DATE=
is a single timestamp. {{{var(FORMAT)}}} should be a format
string understood by ~format-time-string~.
- ={{{time(FORMAT)}}}=; ={{{modification-time(FORMAT, VC)}}}= ::
#+cindex: @samp{time}, macro
#+cindex: @samp{modification-time}, macro
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
These macros refer to the document's date and time of export and
date and time of modification. {{{var(FORMAT)}}} is a string
understood by ~format-time-string~. If the second argument to
the ~modification-time~ macro is non-~nil~, Org uses =vc.el= to
retrieve the document's modification time from the version
control system. Otherwise Org reads the file attributes.
- ={{{input-file}}}= ::
#+cindex: @samp{input-file}, macro
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This macro refers to the filename of the exported file.
- ={{{property(PROPERTY-NAME)}}}=; ={{{property(PROPERTY-NAME, SEARCH OPTION)}}}= ::
#+cindex: @samp{property}, macro
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This macro returns the value of property {{{var(PROPERTY-NAME)}}}
in the current entry. If {{{var(SEARCH-OPTION)}}} (see [[*Search
Options in File Links]]) refers to a remote entry, use it instead.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ={{{n}}}=; ={{{n(NAME)}}}=; ={{{n(NAME, ACTION)}}}= ::
#+cindex: @samp{n}, macro
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: counter, macro
This macro implements custom counters by returning the number of
times the macro has been expanded so far while exporting the
buffer. You can create more than one counter using different
{{{var(NAME)}}} values. If {{{var(ACTION)}}} is =-=, previous
value of the counter is held, i.e., the specified counter is not
incremented. If the value is a number, the specified counter is
set to that value. If it is any other non-empty string, the
specified counter is reset to 1. You may leave {{{var(NAME)}}}
empty to reset the default counter.
#+cindex: @samp{results}, macro
Moreover, inline source blocks (see [[*Structure of Code Blocks]]) use the
special =results= macro to mark their output. As such, you are
advised against re-defining it, unless you know what you are doing.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-hide-macro-markers
The surrounding brackets can be made invisible by setting
~org-hide-macro-markers~ to a non-~nil~ value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org expands macros at the very beginning of the export process.
** Comment Lines
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: What will not be exported.
:END:
#+cindex: exporting, not
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: comment lines
Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
=#= and a whitespace are treated as comments and, as such, are not
exported.
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_COMMENT}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: comment block
Likewise, regions surrounded by =#+BEGIN_COMMENT= ... =#+END_COMMENT=
are not exported.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: comment trees
Finally, a =COMMENT= keyword at the beginning of an entry, but after
any other keyword or priority cookie, comments out the entire subtree.
In this case, the subtree is not exported and no code block within it
is executed either[fn:123]. The command below helps changing the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
comment status of a headline.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ;)}}} (~org-toggle-comment~) ::
#+kindex: C-c ;
#+findex: org-toggle-comment
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Toggle the =COMMENT= keyword at the beginning of an entry.
** ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to flat files with encoding.
:END:
#+cindex: ASCII export
#+cindex: Latin-1 export
#+cindex: UTF-8 export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
ASCII export produces an output file containing only plain ASCII
characters. This is the simplest and most direct text output. It
does not contain any Org markup. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export use
additional characters and symbols available in these encoding
standards. All three of these export formats offer the most basic of
text output for maximum portability.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-ascii-text-width
On export, Org fills and justifies text according to the text width
set in ~org-ascii-text-width~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-ascii-links-to-notes
Org exports links using a footnote-like style where the descriptive
part is in the text and the link is in a note before the next heading.
See the variable ~org-ascii-links-to-notes~ for details.
*** ASCII export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e t a)}}} (~org-ascii-export-to-ascii~), {{{kbd(C-c C-e t l)}}}, {{{kbd(C-c C-e t u)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e t a
#+kindex: C-c C-e t l
#+kindex: C-c C-e t u
#+findex: org-ascii-export-to-ascii
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export as an ASCII file with a =.txt= extension. For
=myfile.org=, Org exports to =myfile.txt=, overwriting without
warning. For =myfile.txt=, Org exports to =myfile.txt.txt= in
order to prevent data loss.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e t A)}}} (~org-ascii-export-to-ascii~), {{{kbd(C-c C-e t L)}}}, {{{kbd(C-c C-e t U)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e t A
#+kindex: C-c C-e t L
#+kindex: C-c C-e t U
#+findex: org-ascii-export-to-ascii
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ASCII specific export settings
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ASCII export back-end has one extra keyword for customizing ASCII
output. Setting this keyword works similar to the general options
(see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SUBTITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The document subtitle. For long subtitles, use multiple
=#+SUBTITLE= lines in the Org file. Org prints them on one
continuous line, wrapping into multiple lines if necessary.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Header and sectioning structure
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org converts the first three outline levels into headlines for ASCII
export. The remaining levels are turned into lists. To change this
cut-off point where levels become lists, see [[*Export Settings]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Quoting ASCII text
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To insert text within the Org file by the ASCII back-end, use one the
following constructs, inline, keyword, or export block:
#+cindex: @samp{ASCII}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT ascii}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
Inline text @@ascii:and additional text@@ within a paragraph.
,#+ASCII: Some text
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii
Org exports text in this block only when using ASCII back-end.
,#+END_EXPORT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ASCII specific attributes
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_ASCII}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: horizontal rules, in ASCII export
ASCII back-end recognizes only one attribute, =:width=, which
specifies the width of a horizontal rule in number of characters. The
keyword and syntax for specifying widths is:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ASCII: :width 10
-----
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ASCII special blocks
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: special blocks, in ASCII export
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT}
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Besides =#+BEGIN_CENTER= blocks (see [[*Paragraphs]]), ASCII back-end has
these two left and right justification blocks:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT
It's just a jump to the left...
,#+END_JUSTIFYLEFT
,#+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT
...and then a step to the right.
,#+END_JUSTIFYRIGHT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** Beamer Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: Beamer export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org uses Beamer export to convert an Org file tree structure into
high-quality interactive slides for presentations. Beamer is a LaTeX
document class for creating presentations in PDF, HTML, and other
popular display formats.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Beamer export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For creating Beamer documents.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l b)}}} (~org-beamer-export-to-latex~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e l b
#+findex: org-beamer-export-to-latex
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export as LaTeX file with a =.tex= extension. For =myfile.org=,
Org exports to =myfile.tex=, overwriting without warning.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l B)}}} (~org-beamer-export-as-latex~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e l B
#+findex: org-beamer-export-as-latex
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l P)}}} (~org-beamer-export-to-pdf~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e l P
#+findex: org-beamer-export-to-pdf
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export as LaTeX file and then convert it to PDF format.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l O)}}} ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e l O
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export as LaTeX file, convert it to PDF format, and then open the
PDF file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Beamer specific export settings
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For customizing Beamer export.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Beamer export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing
Beamer output. These keywords work similar to the general options
settings (see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =BEAMER_THEME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_THEME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-beamer-theme
The Beamer layout theme (~org-beamer-theme~). Use square
brackets for options. For example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+BEAMER_THEME: Rochester [height=20pt]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =BEAMER_FONT_THEME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_FONT_THEME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Beamer font theme.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =BEAMER_INNER_THEME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_INNER_THEME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Beamer inner theme.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =BEAMER_OUTER_THEME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_OUTER_THEME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Beamer outer theme.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =BEAMER_HEADER= ::
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_HEADER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Arbitrary lines inserted in the preamble, just before the
=hyperref= settings.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =DESCRIPTION= ::
#+cindex: @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The document description. For long descriptions, use multiple
=DESCRIPTION= keywords. By default, =hyperref= inserts
=DESCRIPTION= as metadata. Use ~org-latex-hyperref-template~ to
configure document metadata. Use ~org-latex-title-command~ to
configure typesetting of description as part of front matter.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =KEYWORDS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The keywords for defining the contents of the document. Use
multiple =KEYWORDS= lines if necessary. By default, =hyperref=
inserts =KEYWORDS= as metadata. Use
~org-latex-hyperref-template~ to configure document metadata.
Use ~org-latex-title-command~ to configure typesetting of
keywords as part of front matter.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SUBTITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Document's subtitle. For typesetting, use
~org-beamer-subtitle-format~ string. Use
~org-latex-hyperref-template~ to configure document metadata.
Use ~org-latex-title-command~ to configure typesetting of
subtitle as part of front matter.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Frames and Blocks in Beamer
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For composing Beamer slides.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org transforms heading levels into Beamer's sectioning elements,
frames and blocks. Any Org tree with a not-too-deep-level nesting
should in principle be exportable as a Beamer presentation.
-
#+vindex: org-beamer-frame-level
Org headlines become Beamer frames when the heading level in Org is
equal to ~org-beamer-frame-level~ or =H= value in a =OPTIONS= line
(see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_ENV}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org overrides headlines to frames conversion for the current tree of
an Org file if it encounters the =BEAMER_ENV= property set to
=frame= or =fullframe=. Org ignores whatever
~org-beamer-frame-level~ happens to be for that headline level in
the Org tree. In Beamer terminology, a full frame is a frame
without its title.
- Org exports a Beamer frame's objects as block environments. Org can
enforce wrapping in special block types when =BEAMER_ENV= property
is set[fn:124]. For valid values see
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-beamer-environments-default~. To add more values, see
~org-beamer-environments-extra~.
#+vindex: org-beamer-environments-default
#+vindex: org-beamer-environments-extra
-
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_REF}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If =BEAMER_ENV= is set to =appendix=, Org exports the entry as an
appendix. When set to =note=, Org exports the entry as a note
within the frame or between frames, depending on the entry's heading
level. When set to =noteNH=, Org exports the entry as a note
without its title. When set to =againframe=, Org exports the entry
with =\againframe= command, which makes setting the =BEAMER_REF=
property mandatory because =\againframe= needs frame to resume.
When =ignoreheading= is set, Org export ignores the entry's headline
but not its content. This is useful for inserting content between
frames. It is also useful for properly closing a =column=
environment. @end itemize
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_ACT}, property
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_OPT}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When =BEAMER_ACT= is set for a headline, Org export translates that
headline as an overlay or action specification. When enclosed in
square brackets, Org export makes the overlay specification
a default. Use =BEAMER_OPT= to set any options applicable to the
current Beamer frame or block. The Beamer export back-end wraps
with appropriate angular or square brackets. It also adds the
=fragile= option for any code that may require a verbatim block.
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER_COL}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To create a column on the Beamer slide, use the =BEAMER_COL=
property for its headline in the Org file. Set the value of
=BEAMER_COL= to a decimal number representing the fraction of the
total text width. Beamer export uses this value to set the column's
width and fills the column with the contents of the Org entry. If
the Org entry has no specific environment defined, Beamer export
ignores the heading. If the Org entry has a defined environment,
Beamer export uses the heading as title. Behind the scenes, Beamer
export automatically handles LaTeX column separations for contiguous
headlines. To manually adjust them for any unique configurations
needs, use the =BEAMER_ENV= property.
*** Beamer specific syntax
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For using in Org documents.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Since Org's Beamer export back-end is an extension of the LaTeX
back-end, it recognizes other LaTeX specific syntax---for example,
=#+LATEX:= or =#+ATTR_LATEX:=. See [[*LaTeX Export]], for details.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Beamer export wraps the table of contents generated with =toc:t=
=OPTION= keyword in a =frame= environment. Beamer export does not
wrap the table of contents generated with =TOC= keyword (see [[*Table of
Contents]]). Use square brackets for specifying options.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+TOC: headlines [currentsection]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Insert Beamer-specific code using the following constructs:
#+cindex: @samp{BEAMER}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT beamer}
#+begin_example
,#+BEAMER: \pause
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer
Only Beamer export back-end exports this.
,#+END_BEAMER
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Text @@beamer:some code@@ within a paragraph.
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Inline constructs, such as the last one above, are useful for adding
overlay specifications to objects with ~bold~, ~item~, ~link~,
~radio-target~ and ~target~ types. Enclose the value in angular
brackets and place the specification at the beginning of the object as
shown in this example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: A *@@beamer:<2->@@useful* feature
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_BEAMER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Beamer export recognizes the =ATTR_BEAMER= keyword with the following
attributes from Beamer configurations: =:environment= for changing
local Beamer environment, =:overlay= for specifying Beamer overlays in
angular or square brackets, and =:options= for inserting optional
arguments.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_BEAMER: :environment nonindentlist
- item 1, not indented
- item 2, not indented
- item 3, not indented
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_BEAMER: :overlay <+->
- item 1
- item 2
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_BEAMER: :options [Lagrange]
Let $G$ be a finite group, and let $H$ be
a subgroup of $G$. Then the order of $H$ divides the order of $G$.
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Editing support
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Editing support.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ~org-beamer-mode~ is a special minor mode for faster editing of
Beamer documents.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+STARTUP: beamer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-b)}}} (~org-beamer-select-environment~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-b
#+findex: org-beamer-select-environment
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ~org-beamer-mode~ provides this key for quicker selections in
Beamer normal environments, and for selecting the =BEAMER_COL=
property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** A Beamer example
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: A complete presentation.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Here is an example of an Org document ready for Beamer export.
#+begin_example
;#+TITLE: Example Presentation
;#+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
;#+OPTIONS: H:2 toc:t num:t
;#+LATEX_CLASS: beamer
;#+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
;#+BEAMER_THEME: Madrid
;#+COLUMNS: %45ITEM %10BEAMER_ENV(Env) %10BEAMER_ACT(Act) %4BEAMER_COL(Col) %8BEAMER_OPT(Opt)
,* This is the first structural section
,** Frame 1
,*** Thanks to Eric Fraga :B_block:
:PROPERTIES:
:BEAMER_COL: 0.48
:BEAMER_ENV: block
:END:
for the first viable Beamer setup in Org
,*** Thanks to everyone else :B_block:
:PROPERTIES:
:BEAMER_COL: 0.48
:BEAMER_ACT: <2->
:BEAMER_ENV: block
:END:
for contributing to the discussion
,**** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
:PROPERTIES:
:BEAMER_env: note
:END:
,** Frame 2 (where we will not use columns)
,*** Request
Please test this stuff!
#+end_example
** HTML Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to HTML.
:END:
#+cindex: HTML export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode contains an HTML exporter with extensive HTML formatting
compatible with XHTML 1.0 strict standard.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** HTML export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Invoking HTML export.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e h h)}}} (~org-html-export-to-html~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e h h
#+kindex: C-c C-e h o
#+findex: org-html-export-to-html
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export as HTML file with a =.html= extension. For =myfile.org=,
Org exports to =myfile.html=, overwriting without warning.
{{{kbd{C-c C-e h o)}}} exports to HTML and opens it in a web
browser.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e h H)}}} (~org-html-export-as-html~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e h H
#+findex: org-html-export-as-html
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Exports to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** HTML specific export settings
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Settings for HTML export.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
HTML export has a number of keywords, similar to the general options
settings described in [[*Export Settings]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =DESCRIPTION= ::
#+cindex: @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This is the document's description, which the HTML exporter
inserts it as a HTML meta tag in the HTML file. For long
descriptions, use multiple =DESCRIPTION= lines. The exporter
takes care of wrapping the lines properly.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_DOCTYPE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_DOCTYPE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-doctype
Specify the document type, for example: HTML5
(~org-html-doctype~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_CONTAINER= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_CONTAINER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-container-element
Specify the HTML container, such as =div=, for wrapping sections
and elements (~org-html-container-element~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_LINK_HOME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_LINK_HOME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-link-home
The URL for home link (~org-html-link-home~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_LINK_UP= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_LINK_UP}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-link-up
The URL for the up link of exported HTML pages
(~org-html-link-up~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_MATHJAX= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_MATHJAX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-mathjax-options
Options for MathJax (~org-html-mathjax-options~). MathJax is
used to typeset LaTeX math in HTML documents. See [[*Math
formatting in HTML export]], for an example.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_HEAD= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_HEAD}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-head
Arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head
(~org-html-head~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =HTML_HEAD_EXTRA= ::
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_HEAD_EXTRA}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-head-extra
More arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head
(~org-html-head-extra~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =KEYWORDS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Keywords to describe the document's content. HTML exporter
inserts these keywords as HTML meta tags. For long keywords, use
multiple =KEYWORDS= lines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =LATEX_HEADER= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_HEADER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Arbitrary lines for appending to the preamble; HTML exporter
appends when transcoding LaTeX fragments to images (see [[*Math
formatting in HTML export]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SUBTITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The document's subtitle. HTML exporter formats subtitle if
document type is =HTML5= and the CSS has a =subtitle= class.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Some of these keywords are explained in more detail in the following
sections of the manual.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** HTML doctypes
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors.
#+vindex: org-html-doctype
#+vindex: org-html-doctype-alist
Set the ~org-html-doctype~ variable for different (X)HTML variants.
Depending on the variant, the HTML exporter adjusts the syntax of HTML
conversion accordingly. Org includes the following ready-made
variants:
- ~"html4-strict"~
- ~"html4-transitional"~
- ~"html4-frameset"~
- ~"xhtml-strict"~
- ~"xhtml-transitional"~
- ~"xhtml-frameset"~
- ~"xhtml-11"~
- ~"html5"~
- ~"xhtml5"~
#+texinfo: @noindent
See the variable ~org-html-doctype-alist~ for details. The default is
~"xhtml-strict"~.
#+vindex: org-html-html5-fancy
#+cindex: @samp{HTML5}, export new elements
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org's HTML exporter does not by default enable new block elements
introduced with the HTML5 standard. To enable them, set
~org-html-html5-fancy~ to non-~nil~. Or use an =OPTIONS= line in the
file to set =html5-fancy=.
HTML5 documents can now have arbitrary =#+BEGIN= ... =#+END= blocks.
For example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_aside
Lorem ipsum
,#+END_aside
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
exports to:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src html
<aside>
<p>Lorem ipsum</p>
</aside>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
while this:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_HTML: :controls controls :width 350
,#+BEGIN_video
,#+HTML: <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4">
,#+HTML: <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg">
Your browser does not support the video tag.
,#+END_video
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
exports to:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src html
<video controls="controls" width="350">
<source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4">
<source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg">
<p>Your browser does not support the video tag.</p>
</video>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-html5-elements
When special blocks do not have a corresponding HTML5 element, the
HTML exporter reverts to standard translation (see
~org-html-html5-elements~). For example, =#+BEGIN_lederhosen= exports
to ~<div class="lederhosen">~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Special blocks cannot have headlines. For the HTML exporter to wrap
the headline and its contents in ~<section>~ or ~<article>~ tags, set
the =HTML_CONTAINER= property for the headline.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** HTML preamble and postamble
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Inserting preamble and postamble.
:END:
#+vindex: org-html-preamble
#+vindex: org-html-postamble
#+vindex: org-html-preamble-format
#+vindex: org-html-postamble-format
#+vindex: org-html-validation-link
#+vindex: org-export-creator-string
#+vindex: org-export-time-stamp-file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML exporter has delineations for preamble and postamble. The
default value for ~org-html-preamble~ is ~t~, which makes the HTML
exporter insert the preamble. See the variable
~org-html-preamble-format~ for the format string.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set ~org-html-preamble~ to a string to override the default format
string. If the string is a function, the HTML exporter expects the
function to return a string upon execution. The HTML exporter inserts
this string in the preamble. The HTML exporter does not insert
a preamble if ~org-html-preamble~ is set ~nil~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The default value for ~org-html-postamble~ is ~auto~, which makes the
HTML exporter build a postamble from looking up author's name, email
address, creator's name, and date. Set ~org-html-postamble~ to ~t~ to
insert the postamble in the format specified in the
~org-html-postamble-format~ variable. The HTML exporter does not
insert a postamble if ~org-html-postamble~ is set to ~nil~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Quoting HTML tags
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Using direct HTML in Org files.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end transforms =<= and =>= to =&lt;= and =&gt;=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To include raw HTML code in the Org file so the HTML export back-end
can insert that HTML code in the output, use this inline syntax:
=@@html:...@@=. For example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: @@html:<b>@@bold text@@html:</b>@@
#+cindex: @samp{HTML}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT html}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For larger raw HTML code blocks, use these HTML export code blocks:
#+begin_example
,#+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT html
All lines between these markers are exported literally
,#+END_EXPORT
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Links in HTML export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Inserting and formatting links.
:END:
#+cindex: links, in HTML export
#+cindex: internal links, in HTML export
#+cindex: external links, in HTML export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end transforms Org's internal links (see
[[*Internal Links]]) to equivalent HTML links in the output. The back-end
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
similarly handles Org's automatic links created by radio targets (see
[[*Radio Targets]]) similarly. For Org links to external files, the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
back-end transforms the links to /relative/ paths.
#+vindex: org-html-link-org-files-as-html
For Org links to other =.org= files, the back-end automatically
changes the file extension to =.html= and makes file paths relative.
If the =.org= files have an equivalent =.html= version at the same
location, then the converted links should work without any further
manual intervention. However, to disable this automatic path
translation, set ~org-html-link-org-files-as-html~ to ~nil~. When
disabled, the HTML export back-end substitutes the ID-based links in
the HTML output. For more about linking files when publishing to
a directory, see [[*Publishing links]].
Org files can also have special directives to the HTML export
back-end. For example, by using =#+ATTR_HTML= lines to specify new
format attributes to ~<a>~ or ~<img>~ tags. This example shows
changing the link's title and style:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_HTML}, keyword
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_HTML: :title The Org mode homepage :style color:red;
[[https://orgmode.org]]
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Tables in HTML export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to modify the formatting of tables.
:END:
#+cindex: tables, in HTML
#+vindex: org-export-html-table-tag
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end uses ~org-html-table-default-attributes~ when
exporting Org tables to HTML. By default, the exporter does not draw
frames and cell borders. To change for this for a table, use the
following lines before the table in the Org file:
#+cindex: @samp{CAPTION}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_HTML}, keyword
#+begin_example
,#+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
,#+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end preserves column groupings in Org tables (see
[[*Column Groups]]) when exporting to HTML.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Additional options for customizing tables for HTML export.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-align-individual-fields~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-align-individual-fields
Non-~nil~ attaches style attributes for alignment to each table
field.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-caption-above~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-caption-above
Non-~nil~ places caption string at the beginning of the table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-data-tags~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-data-tags
Opening and ending tags for table data fields.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-default-attributes~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-default-attributes
Default attributes and values for table tags.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-header-tags~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-header-tags
Opening and ending tags for table's header fields.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-row-tags~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-row-tags
Opening and ending tags for table rows.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column
Non-~nil~ formats column one in tables with header tags.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Images in HTML export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to insert figures into HTML output.
:END:
#+cindex: images, inline in HTML
#+cindex: inlining images in HTML
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end has features to convert Org image links to
HTML inline images and HTML clickable image links.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-inline-images
When the link in the Org file has no description, the HTML export
back-end by default in-lines that image. For example:
=[[file:myimg.jpg]]= is in-lined, while =[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]= links to the text,
=the image=. For more details, see the variable
~org-html-inline-images~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
On the other hand, if the description part of the Org link is itself
another link, such as =file:= or =http:= URL pointing to an image, the
HTML export back-end in-lines this image and links to the main image.
This Org syntax enables the back-end to link low-resolution thumbnail
to the high-resolution version of the image, as shown in this example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To change attributes of in-lined images, use =#+ATTR_HTML= lines in
the Org file. This example shows realignment to right, and adds ~alt~
and ~title~ attributes in support of text viewers and modern web
accessibility standards.
#+cindex: @samp{CAPTION}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_HTML}, keyword
#+begin_example
,#+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
,#+ATTR_HTML: :alt cat/spider image :title Action! :align right
[[./img/a.jpg]]
#+end_example
The HTML export back-end copies the =http= links from the Org file
as-is.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Math formatting in HTML export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Beautiful math also on the web.
:END:
#+cindex: MathJax
#+cindex: dvipng
#+cindex: dvisvgm
#+cindex: ImageMagick
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-mathjax-options~
LaTeX math snippets (see [[*LaTeX fragments]]) can be displayed in two
different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the [[http://www.mathjax.org][MathJax]],
which should work out of the box with Org[fn:125][fn:126]. Some MathJax
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
display options can be configured via ~org-html-mathjax-options~, or
in the buffer. For example, with the following settings,
#+begin_example
,#+HTML_MATHJAX: align: left indent: 5em tagside: left font: Neo-Euler
,#+HTML_MATHJAX: cancel.js noErrors.js
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
equation labels are displayed on the left margin and equations are
five em from the left margin. In addition, it loads the two MathJax
extensions =cancel.js= and =noErrors.js=[fn:127].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-mathjax-template
See the docstring of ~org-html-mathjax-options~ for all supported
variables. The MathJax template can be configure via
~org-html-mathjax-template~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you prefer, you can also request that LaTeX fragments are processed
into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before
the availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org
files. This method requires that the dvipng program, dvisvgm or
ImageMagick suite is available on your system. You can still get this
processing with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Text areas in HTML export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: An alternate way to show an example.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: text areas, in HTML
Before Org mode's Babel, one popular approach to publishing code in
HTML was by using =:textarea=. The advantage of this approach was
that copying and pasting was built into browsers with simple
JavaScript commands. Even editing before pasting was made simple.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end can create such text areas. It requires an
=#+ATTR_HTML= line as shown in the example below with the =:textarea=
option. This must be followed by either an example or a source code
block. Other Org block types do not honor the =:textarea= option.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
By default, the HTML export back-end creates a text area 80 characters
wide and height just enough to fit the content. Override these
defaults with =:width= and =:height= options on the =#+ATTR_HTML=
line.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_HTML: :textarea t :width 40
,#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
(defun org-xor (a b)
"Exclusive or."
(if a (not b) b))
,#+END_EXAMPLE
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** CSS support
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Changing the appearance of the output.
:END:
#+cindex: CSS, for HTML export
#+cindex: HTML export, CSS
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
#+vindex: org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
You can modify the CSS style definitions for the exported file. The
HTML exporter assigns the following special CSS classes[fn:128] to
appropriate parts of the document---your style specifications may
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
change these, in addition to any of the standard classes like for
headlines, tables, etc.
| ~p.author~ | author information, including email |
| ~p.date~ | publishing date |
| ~p.creator~ | creator info, about org mode version |
| ~.title~ | document title |
| ~.subtitle~ | document subtitle |
| ~.todo~ | TODO keywords, all not-done states |
| ~.done~ | the DONE keywords, all states that count as done |
| ~.WAITING~ | each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself |
| ~.timestamp~ | timestamp |
| ~.timestamp-kwd~ | keyword associated with a timestamp, like =SCHEDULED= |
| ~.timestamp-wrapper~ | span around keyword plus timestamp |
| ~.tag~ | tag in a headline |
| ~._HOME~ | each tag uses itself as a class, "@" replaced by "_" |
| ~.target~ | target for links |
| ~.linenr~ | the line number in a code example |
| ~.code-highlighted~ | for highlighting referenced code lines |
| ~div.outline-N~ | div for outline level N (headline plus text) |
| ~div.outline-text-N~ | extra div for text at outline level N |
| ~.section-number-N~ | section number in headlines, different for each level |
| ~.figure-number~ | label like "Figure 1:" |
| ~.table-number~ | label like "Table 1:" |
| ~.listing-number~ | label like "Listing 1:" |
| ~div.figure~ | how to format an in-lined image |
| ~pre.src~ | formatted source code |
| ~pre.example~ | normal example |
| ~p.verse~ | verse paragraph |
| ~div.footnotes~ | footnote section headline |
| ~p.footnote~ | footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote |
| ~.footref~ | a footnote reference number (always a <sup>) |
| ~.footnum~ | footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>) |
| ~.org-svg~ | default class for a linked =.svg= image |
#+vindex: org-html-style-default
#+vindex: org-html-head
#+vindex: org-html-head-extra
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_INCLUDE_STYLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The HTML export back-end includes a compact default style in each
exported HTML file. To override the default style with another style,
use these keywords in the Org file. They will replace the global
defaults the HTML exporter uses.
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_HEAD}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_HEAD_EXTRA}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+HTML_HEAD: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style1.css" />
,#+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: <link rel="alternate stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style2.css" />
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-html-head-include-default-style
To just turn off the default style, customize
~org-html-head-include-default-style~ variable, or use this option
line in the Org file.
#+cindex: @samp{html-style}, @samp{OPTIONS} item
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+OPTIONS: html-style:nil
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For longer style definitions, either use several =HTML_HEAD= and
=HTML_HEAD_EXTRA= keywords, or use ~<style> ... </style>~ blocks
around them. Both of these approaches can avoid referring to an
external file.
#+cindex: @samp{HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In order to add styles to a sub-tree, use the =HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS=
property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS
styles for a particular headline, you can use the ID specified in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a =CUSTOM_ID= property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Never change the ~org-html-style-default~ constant. Instead use other
simpler ways of customizing as described above.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** JavaScript supported display of web pages
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Info and folding in a web browser.
:ALT_TITLE: JavaScript support
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org.
This program enhances large files in two different ways of viewing.
One is an /Info/-like mode where each section is displayed separately
and navigation can be done with the {{{kbd(n)}}} and {{{kbd(p)}}}
keys, and some other keys as well, press {{{kbd(?)}}} for an overview
of the available keys. The second one has a /folding/ view, much like
Org provides inside Emacs. The script is available at
https://orgmode.org/org-info.js and the documentation at
https://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/. The script is hosted on
https://orgmode.org, but for reliability, prefer installing it on your
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
own web server.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To use this program, just add this line to the Org file:
#+cindex: @samp{INFOJS_OPT}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The HTML header now has the code needed to automatically invoke the
script. For setting options, use the syntax from the above line for
options described below:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =path:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from
[[https://orgmode.org/org-info.js]], but you might want to have
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a local copy and use a path like =../scripts/org-info.js=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =view:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| =info= | Info-like interface with one section per page |
| =overview= | Folding interface, initially showing only top-level |
| =content= | Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible |
| =showall= | Folding interface, all headlines and text visible |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =sdepth:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Maximum headline level still considered as an independent section
for info and folding modes. The default is taken from
~org-export-headline-levels~, i.e., the =H= switch in =OPTIONS=.
If this is smaller than in ~org-export-headline-levels~, each
info/folding section can still contain child headlines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =toc:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Should the table of contents /initially/ be visible? Even when
=nil=, you can always get to the "toc" with {{{kbd(i)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =tdepth:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from
the variables ~org-export-headline-levels~ and
~org-export-with-toc~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =ftoc:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?
If yes, the toc is displayed as a section.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =ltoc:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Should there be short contents (children) in each section? Make
this =above= if the section should be above initial text.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =mouse:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be
=underline= (default) or a background color like =#cccccc=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =buttons:= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When =nil= (the
default), only one such button is present.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-infojs-options
#+vindex: org-export-html-use-infojs
You can choose default values for these options by customizing the
variable ~org-infojs-options~. If you always want to apply the script
to your pages, configure the variable ~org-export-html-use-infojs~.
** LaTeX Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to @LaTeX{} and processing to PDF.
:END:
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: PDF export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end can handle complex documents, incorporate
standard or custom LaTeX document classes, generate documents using
alternate LaTeX engines, and produce fully linked PDF files with
indexes, bibliographies, and tables of contents, destined for
interactive online viewing or high-quality print publication.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
While the details are covered in-depth in this section, here are some
quick references to variables for the impatient: for engines, see
~org-latex-compiler~; for build sequences, see
~org-latex-pdf-process~; for packages, see
~org-latex-default-packages-alist~ and ~org-latex-packages-alist~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
An important note about the LaTeX export back-end: it is sensitive to
blank lines in the Org document. That's because LaTeX itself depends
on blank lines to tell apart syntactical elements, such as paragraphs.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** LaTeX/PDF export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For producing @LaTeX{} and PDF documents.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l l)}}} (~org-latex-export-to-latex~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e l l
#+findex: org-latex-export-to-latex~
Export to a LaTeX file with a =.tex= extension. For
=myfile.org=, Org exports to =myfile.tex=, overwriting without
warning.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l L)}}} (~org-latex-export-as-latex~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e l L
#+findex: org-latex-export-as-latex
Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l p)}}} (~org-latex-export-to-pdf~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e l p
#+findex: org-latex-export-to-pdf
Export as LaTeX file and convert it to PDF file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e l o)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e l o
Export as LaTeX file and convert it to PDF, then open the PDF
using the default viewer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-x org-export-region-as-latex)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Convert the region to LaTeX under the assumption that it was in Org
mode syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in
any buffer.
#+vindex: org-latex-compiler
#+vindex: org-latex-bibtex-compiler
#+vindex: org-latex-default-packages-alist
#+cindex: pdflatex
#+cindex: xelatex
#+cindex: lualatex
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_COMPILER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end can use any of these LaTeX engines:
=pdflatex=, =xelatex=, and =lualatex=. These engines compile LaTeX
files with different compilers, packages, and output options. The
LaTeX export back-end finds the compiler version to use from
~org-latex-compiler~ variable or the =#+LATEX_COMPILER= keyword in the
Org file. See the docstring for the
~org-latex-default-packages-alist~ for loading packages with certain
compilers. Also see ~org-latex-bibtex-compiler~ to set the
bibliography compiler[fn:129].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** LaTeX specific export settings
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Unique to this @LaTeX{} back-end.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end has several additional keywords for
customizing LaTeX output. Setting these keywords works similar to the
general options (see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- =DESCRIPTION= ::
#+cindex: @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-hyperref-template
#+vindex: org-latex-title-command
The document's description. The description along with author
name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the
output file by the hyperref package. See
~org-latex-hyperref-template~ for customizing metadata items.
See ~org-latex-title-command~ for typesetting description into
the document's front matter. Use multiple =DESCRIPTION= keywords
for long descriptions.
- =LANGUAGE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LANGUAGE}, keyword
#+vindex: org-latex-package-alist
In order to be effective, the =babel= or =polyglossia=
packages---according to the LaTeX compiler used---must be loaded
with the appropriate language as argument. This can be
accomplished by modifying the =org-latex-package-alist= variable,
e.g., with the following snippet:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-to-list org-latex-package-alist
'("AUTO" "babel" t ("pdflatex")))
(add-to-list org-latex-package-alist
'("AUTO" "polyglossia" t ("xelatex" "lualatex")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =LATEX_CLASS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_CLASS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-default-class
#+vindex: org-latex-classes
This is LaTeX document class, such as /article/, /report/,
/book/, and so on, which contain predefined preamble and headline
level mapping that the LaTeX export back-end needs. The back-end
reads the default class name from the ~org-latex-default-class~
variable. Org has /article/ as the default class. A valid
default class must be an element of ~org-latex-classes~.
- =LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Options the LaTeX export back-end uses when calling the LaTeX
document class.
- =LATEX_COMPILER= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_COMPILER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-compiler
The compiler, such as =pdflatex=, =xelatex=, =lualatex=, for
producing the PDF. See ~org-latex-compiler~.
- =LATEX_HEADER=, =LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_HEADER}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-classes
Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the
hyperref settings. See ~org-latex-classes~ for adjusting the
structure and order of the LaTeX headers.
- =KEYWORDS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-hyperref-template
#+vindex: org-latex-title-command
The keywords for the document. The description along with author
name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the
output file by the hyperref package. See
~org-latex-hyperref-template~ for customizing metadata items.
See ~org-latex-title-command~ for typesetting description into
the document's front matter. Use multiple =KEYWORDS= lines if
necessary.
- =SUBTITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-subtitle-separate
#+vindex: org-latex-subtitle-format
The document's subtitle. It is typeset as per
~org-latex-subtitle-format~. If ~org-latex-subtitle-separate~ is
non-~nil~, it is typed as part of the ~\title~ macro. See
~org-latex-hyperref-template~ for customizing metadata items.
See ~org-latex-title-command~ for typesetting description
into the document's front matter.
The following sections have further details.
*** LaTeX header and sectioning structure
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Setting up the export file structure.
:ALT_TITLE: LaTeX header and sectioning
:END:
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} class
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
#+cindex: @LaTeX{} header
#+cindex: header, for @LaTeX{} files
#+cindex: sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end converts the first three of Org's outline
levels into LaTeX headlines. The remaining Org levels are exported as
lists. To change this globally for the cut-off point between levels
and lists, (see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
By default, the LaTeX export back-end uses the /article/ class.
#+vindex: org-latex-default-class
#+vindex: org-latex-classes
#+vindex: org-latex-default-packages-alist
#+vindex: org-latex-packages-alist
To change the default class globally, edit ~org-latex-default-class~.
To change the default class locally in an Org file, add option lines
=#+LATEX_CLASS: myclass=. To change the default class for just a part
of the Org file, set a sub-tree property, =EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS=. The
class name entered here must be valid member of ~org-latex-classes~.
This variable defines a header template for each class into which the
exporter splices the values of ~org-latex-default-packages-alist~ and
~org-latex-packages-alist~. Use the same three variables to define
custom sectioning or custom classes.
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_CLASS}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS}, property
#+cindex: @samp{EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end sends the =LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS= keyword and
=EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS= property as options to the LaTeX
~\documentclass~ macro. The options and the syntax for specifying
them, including enclosing them in square brackets, follow LaTeX
conventions.
: #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper,11pt,twoside,twocolumn]
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_HEADER}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end appends values from =LATEX_HEADER= and
=LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA= keywords to the LaTeX header. The docstring for
~org-latex-classes~ explains in more detail. Also note that LaTeX
export back-end does not append =LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA= to the header
when previewing LaTeX snippets (see [[*Previewing LaTeX fragments]]).
A sample Org file with the above headers:
#+begin_example
,#+LATEX_CLASS: article
,#+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
,#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage{xyz}
,* Headline 1
some text
,* Headline 2
some more text
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Quoting LaTeX code
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end can insert any arbitrary LaTeX code, see
[[*Embedded LaTeX]]. There are three ways to embed such code in the Org
file and they all use different quoting syntax.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: inline, in @LaTeX{} export
Inserting in-line quoted with @ symbols:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: Code embedded in-line @@latex:any arbitrary LaTeX code@@ in a paragraph.
#+cindex: @samp{LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Inserting as one or more keyword lines in the Org file:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+LATEX: any arbitrary LaTeX code
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT latex}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Inserting as an export block in the Org file, where the back-end
exports any code between begin and end markers:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT latex
any arbitrary LaTeX code
,#+END_EXPORT
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Tables in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}.
:END:
#+cindex: tables, in @LaTeX{} export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end can pass several LaTeX attributes for table
contents and layout. Besides specifying a label (see [[*Internal Links]])
and a caption (see [[*Captions]]), the other valid LaTeX attributes
include:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- =:mode= ::
#+vindex: org-latex-default-table-mode
The LaTeX export back-end wraps the table differently depending
on the mode for accurate rendering of math symbols. Mode is
either =table=, =math=, =inline-math= or =verbatim=.
For =math= or =inline-math= mode, LaTeX export back-end wraps the
table in a math environment, but every cell in it is exported
as-is. The LaTeX export back-end determines the default mode
from ~org-latex-default-table-mode~. The LaTeX export back-end
merges contiguous tables in the same mode into a single
environment.
- =:environment= ::
#+vindex: org-latex-default-table-environment
Set the default LaTeX table environment for the LaTeX export
back-end to use when exporting Org tables. Common LaTeX table
environments are provided by these packages: tabularx, longtable,
array, tabu, and bmatrix. For packages, such as tabularx and
tabu, or any newer replacements, include them in the
~org-latex-packages-alist~ variable so the LaTeX export back-end
can insert the appropriate load package headers in the converted
LaTeX file. Look in the docstring for the
~org-latex-packages-alist~ variable for configuring these
packages for LaTeX snippet previews, if any.
- =:caption= ::
Use =CAPTION= keyword to set a simple caption for a table (see
[[*Captions]]). For custom captions, use =:caption= attribute, which
accepts raw LaTeX code. =:caption= value overrides =CAPTION=
value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:float=, =:placement= ::
The table environments by default are not floats in LaTeX. To
make them floating objects use =:float= with one of the following
options: =sideways=, =multicolumn=, =t=, and =nil=.
LaTeX floats can also have additional layout =:placement=
attributes. These are the usual =[h t b p ! H]= permissions
specified in square brackets. Note that for =:float sideways=
tables, the LaTeX export back-end ignores =:placement=
attributes.
- =:align=, =:font=, =:width= ::
The LaTeX export back-end uses these attributes for regular
tables to set their alignments, fonts, and widths.
- =:spread= ::
When =:spread= is non-~nil~, the LaTeX export back-end spreads or
shrinks the table by the =:width= for tabu and longtabu
environments. =:spread= has no effect if =:width= is not set.
- =:booktabs=, =:center=, =:rmlines= ::
#+vindex: org-latex-tables-booktabs
#+vindex: org-latex-tables-centered
All three commands are toggles. =:booktabs= brings in modern
typesetting enhancements to regular tables. The booktabs package
has to be loaded through ~org-latex-packages-alist~. =:center=
is for centering the table. =:rmlines= removes all but the very
first horizontal line made of ASCII characters from "table.el"
tables only.
- =:math-prefix=, =:math-suffix=, =:math-arguments= ::
The LaTeX export back-end inserts =:math-prefix= string value in
a math environment before the table. The LaTeX export back-end
inserts =:math-suffix= string value in a math environment after
the table. The LaTeX export back-end inserts =:math-arguments=
string value between the macro name and the table's contents.
=:math-arguments= comes in use for matrix macros that require
more than one argument, such as =qbordermatrix=.
LaTeX table attributes help formatting tables for a wide range of
situations, such as matrix product or spanning multiple pages:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :environment longtable :align l|lp{3cm}r|l
| ... | ... |
| ... | ... |
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix :math-suffix \times
| a | b |
| c | d |
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix
| 1 | 2 |
| 3 | 4 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set the caption with the LaTeX command
=\bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB}=:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB}
| ... | ... |
| ... | ... |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Images in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output.
:END:
#+cindex: images, inline in LaTeX
#+cindex: inlining images in LaTeX
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end processes image links in Org files that do
not have descriptions, such as these links =[[file:img.jpg]]= or
=[[./img.jpg]]=, as direct image insertions in the final PDF output. In
the PDF, they are no longer links but actual images embedded on the
page. The LaTeX export back-end uses =\includegraphics= macro to
insert the image. But for TikZ (http://sourceforge.net/projects/pgf/)
images, the back-end uses an ~\input~ macro wrapped within
a ~tikzpicture~ environment.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For specifying image =:width=, =:height=, and other =:options=, use
this syntax:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :width 5cm :options angle=90
[[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For custom commands for captions, use the =:caption= attribute. It
overrides the default =#+CAPTION= value:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB}
[[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
When captions follow the method as described in [[*Captions]], the LaTeX
export back-end wraps the picture in a floating =figure= environment.
To float an image without specifying a caption, set the =:float=
attribute to one of the following:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =t= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For a standard =figure= environment; used by default whenever an
image has a caption.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =multicolumn= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To span the image across multiple columns of a page; the back-end
wraps the image in a =figure*= environment.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =wrap= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For text to flow around the image on the right; the figure
occupies the left half of the page.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =sideways= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For a new page with the image sideways, rotated ninety degrees,
in a =sidewaysfigure= environment; overrides =:placement=
setting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nil= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To avoid a =:float= even if using a caption.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Use the =placement= attribute to modify a floating environment's
placement.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :float wrap :width 0.38\textwidth :placement {r}{0.4\textwidth}
[[./img/hst.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-images-centered
#+cindex: center image in LaTeX export
#+cindex: image, centering in LaTeX export
The LaTeX export back-end centers all images by default. Setting
=:center= to =nil= disables centering. To disable centering globally,
set ~org-latex-images-centered~ to =t=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set the =:comment-include= attribute to non-~nil~ value for the LaTeX
export back-end to comment out the =\includegraphics= macro.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Plain lists in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Attributes specific to lists.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: plain lists, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end accepts the =environment= and =options=
attributes for plain lists. Both attributes work together for
customizing lists, as shown in the examples:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage[inline]{enumitem}
Some ways to say "Hello":
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :environment itemize*
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :options [label={}, itemjoin={,}, itemjoin*={, and}]
- Hola
- Bonjour
- Guten Tag.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Since LaTeX supports only four levels of nesting for lists, use an
external package, such as =enumitem= in LaTeX, for levels deeper than
four:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage{enumitem}
,#+LATEX_HEADER: \renewlist{itemize}{itemize}{9}
,#+LATEX_HEADER: \setlist[itemize]{label=$\circ$}
- One
- Two
- Three
- Four
- Five
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Source blocks in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Attributes specific to source code blocks.
:END:
#+cindex: source blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end can make source code blocks into floating
objects through the attributes =:float= and =:options=. For =:float=:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =t= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Makes a source block float; by default floats any source block
with a caption.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =multicolumn= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Spans the source block across multiple columns of a page.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nil= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Avoids a =:float= even if using a caption; useful for source code
blocks that may not fit on a page.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :float nil
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
Lisp code that may not fit in a single page.
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-listings-options
#+vindex: org-latex-minted-options
The LaTeX export back-end passes string values in =:options= to LaTeX
packages for customization of that specific source block. In the
example below, the =:options= are set for Minted. Minted is a source
code highlighting LaTeX package with many configurable options.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :options commentstyle=\bfseries
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
(defun Fib (n)
(if (< n 2) n (+ (Fib (- n 1)) (Fib (- n 2)))))
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To apply similar configuration options for all source blocks in
a file, use the ~org-latex-listings-options~ and
~org-latex-minted-options~ variables.
*** Example blocks in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Attributes specific to example blocks.
:END:
#+cindex: example blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: verbatim blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end wraps the contents of example blocks in
a =verbatim= environment. To change this behavior to use another
environment globally, specify an appropriate export filter (see
[[*Advanced Export Configuration]]). To change this behavior to use
another environment for each block, use the =:environment= parameter
to specify a custom environment.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :environment myverbatim
,#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
This sentence is false.
,#+END_EXAMPLE
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Special blocks in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Attributes specific to special blocks.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: special blocks, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: abstract, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: proof, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For other special blocks in the Org file, the LaTeX export back-end
makes a special environment of the same name. The back-end also takes
=:options=, if any, and appends as-is to that environment's opening
string. For example:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_abstract
We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem.
,#+END_abstract
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :options [Proof of important theorem]
,#+BEGIN_proof
...
Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes.
,#+END_proof
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
exports to
#+begin_example
\begin{abstract}
We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem.
\end{abstract}
\begin{proof}[Proof of important theorem]
...
Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes.
\end{proof}
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If you need to insert a specific caption command, use =:caption=
attribute. It overrides standard =CAPTION= value, if any. For
example:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \MyCaption{HeadingA}
,#+BEGIN_proof
...
,#+END_proof
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Horizontal rules in LaTeX export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Attributes specific to horizontal rules.
:END:
#+cindex: horizontal rules, in @LaTeX{} export
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_LATEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The LaTeX export back-end converts horizontal rules by the specified
=:width= and =:thickness= attributes. For example:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_LATEX: :width .6\textwidth :thickness 0.8pt
-----
#+end_example
** Markdown Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to Markdown.
:END:
#+cindex: Markdown export
The Markdown export back-end, "md", converts an Org file to Markdown
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
format, as defined at http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/.
Since it is built on top of the HTML back-end (see [[*HTML Export]]), it
converts every Org construct not defined in Markdown syntax, such as
tables, to HTML.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Markdown export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e m m)}}} (~org-md-export-to-markdown~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c m m
#+findex: org-md-export-to-markdown
Export to a text file with Markdown syntax. For =myfile.org=,
Org exports to =myfile.md=, overwritten without warning.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e m M)}}} (~org-md-export-as-markdown~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c m M
#+findex: org-md-export-as-markdown
Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e m o)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e m o
Export as a text file with Markdown syntax, then open it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Header and sectioning structure
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-md-headline-style
Based on ~org-md-headline-style~, Markdown export can generate
headlines of both /atx/ and /setext/ types. /atx/ limits headline
levels to two whereas /setext/ limits headline levels to six. Beyond
these limits, the export back-end converts headlines to lists. To set
a limit to a level before the absolute limit (see [[*Export Settings]]).
** OpenDocument Text Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to OpenDocument Text.
:END:
#+cindex: ODT
#+cindex: OpenDocument
#+cindex: export, OpenDocument
#+cindex: LibreOffice
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end handles creating of OpenDocument Text (ODT)
format. Documents created by this exporter use the
{{{cite(OpenDocument-v1.2 specification)}}}[fn:130] and are compatible
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
with LibreOffice 3.4.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Pre-requisites for ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Required packages.
:END:
#+cindex: zip
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end relies on the zip program to create the final
compressed ODT output. Check if =zip= is locally available and
executable. Without it, export cannot finish.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ODT export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Invoking export.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e o o)}}} (~org-export-to-odt~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e o o
#+findex: org-export-to-odt
Export as OpenDocument Text file.
#+cindex: @samp{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-odt-preferred-output-format
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If ~org-odt-preferred-output-format~ is specified, the ODT export
back-end automatically converts the exported file to that format.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For =myfile.org=, Org exports to =myfile.odt=, overwriting
without warning. The ODT export back-end exports a region only
if a region was active.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If the selected region is a single tree, the ODT export back-end
makes the tree head the document title. Incidentally, {{{kbd(C-c
@)}}} selects the current sub-tree. If the tree head entry has,
or inherits, an =EXPORT_FILE_NAME= property, the ODT export
back-end uses that for file name.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e o O)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e o O
Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
If ~org-export-odt-preferred-output-format~ is specified, open
the converted file instead. See [[*Automatically exporting to
other formats]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** ODT specific export settings
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Configuration options.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end has several additional keywords for
customizing ODT output. Setting these keywords works similar to the
general options (see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =DESCRIPTION= ::
#+cindex: @samp{DESCRIPTION}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This is the document's description, which the ODT export back-end
inserts as document metadata. For long descriptions, use
multiple lines, prefixed with =DESCRIPTION=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =KEYWORDS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{KEYWORDS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The keywords for the document. The ODT export back-end inserts
the description along with author name, keywords, and related
file metadata as metadata in the output file. Use multiple
=KEYWORDS= if necessary.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =ODT_STYLES_FILE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{ODT_STYLES_FILE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-odt-styles-file
The ODT export back-end uses the ~org-odt-styles-file~ by
default. See [[*Applying custom styles]] for details.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SUBTITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The document subtitle.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Extending ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Producing DOC, PDF files.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end can produce documents in other formats besides
ODT using a specialized ODT converter process. Its common interface
works with popular converters to produce formats such as =doc=, or
convert a document from one format, say =csv=, to another format, say
=xls=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @file{unoconv}
#+vindex: org-odt-convert-process
Customize ~org-odt-convert-process~ variable to point to =unoconv=,
which is the ODT's preferred converter. Working installations of
LibreOffice would already have =unoconv= installed. Alternatively,
other converters may be substituted here. See [[*Configuring
a document converter]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Automatically exporting to other formats
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-odt-preferred-output-format
If ODT format is just an intermediate step to get to other formats,
such as =doc=, =docx=, =rtf=, or =pdf=, etc., then extend the ODT
export back-end to directly produce that format. Specify the final
format in the ~org-odt-preferred-output-format~ variable. This is one
way to extend (see [[*ODT export commands]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Converting between document formats
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Org export back-end is made to be inter-operable with a wide range
of text document format converters. Newer generation converters, such
as LibreOffice and Pandoc, can handle hundreds of formats at once.
Org provides a consistent interaction with whatever converter is
installed. Here are some generic commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(M-x org-odt-convert)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-odt-convert
Convert an existing document from one format to another. With
a prefix argument, opens the newly produced file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Applying custom styles
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Styling the output.
:END:
#+cindex: styles, custom
#+cindex: template, custom
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end comes with many OpenDocument styles (see
[[*Working with OpenDocument style files]]). To expand or further
customize these built-in style sheets, either edit the style sheets
directly or generate them using an application such as LibreOffice.
The example here shows creating a style using LibreOffice.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Applying custom styles: the easy way
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
1. Create a sample =example.org= file with settings as shown below,
and export it to ODT format.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2. Open the above =example.odt= using LibreOffice. Use the /Stylist/
to locate the target styles, which typically have the "Org" prefix.
Open one, modify, and save as either OpenDocument Text (ODT) or
OpenDocument Template (OTT) file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
3.
#+vindex: org-odt-styles-file
Customize the variable ~org-odt-styles-file~ and point it to the
newly created file. For additional configuration options, see
[[x-overriding-factory-styles][Overriding factory styles]].
#+cindex: @samp{ODT_STYLES_FILE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To apply an ODT style to a particular file, use the
=ODT_STYLES_FILE= keyword as shown in the example below:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Using third-party styles and templates
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end relies on many templates and style names.
Using third-party styles and templates can lead to mismatches.
Templates derived from built in ODT templates and styles seem to have
fewer problems.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Links in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Handling and formatting links.
:END:
#+cindex: links, in ODT export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It
creates Internet-style links for all other links.
A link with no description and pointing to a regular, un-itemized,
outline heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number
of the heading.
A =\ref{label}=-style reference to an image, table etc., is replaced
with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity. See
[[*Labels and captions in ODT export]].
*** Tables in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Org tables conversions.
:END:
#+cindex: tables, in ODT export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end handles native Org mode tables (see [[*Tables]])
and simple =table.el= tables. Complex =table.el= tables having column
or row spans are not supported. Such tables are stripped from the
exported document.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
By default, the ODT export back-end exports a table with top and
bottom frames and with ruled lines separating row and column groups
(see [[*Column Groups]]). All tables are typeset to occupy the same
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
width. The ODT export back-end honors any table alignments and
relative widths for columns (see [[*Column Width and Alignment]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that the ODT export back-end interprets column widths as weighted
ratios, the default weight being 1.
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Specifying =:rel-width= property on an =ATTR_ODT= line controls the
width of the table. For example:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
| Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
|---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
| / | < | | | < |
| <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
| North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
| Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
| Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
|---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
| Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
On export, the above table takes 50% of text width area. The exporter
sizes the columns in the ratio: 13:5:5:5:6. The first column is
left-aligned and rest of the columns, right-aligned. Vertical rules
separate the header and the last column. Horizontal rules separate
the header and the last row.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For even more customization, create custom table styles and associate
them with a table using the =ATTR_ODT= keyword. See [[*Customizing
tables in ODT export]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Images in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Inserting images.
:END:
#+cindex: images, embedding in ODT
#+cindex: embedding images in ODT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Embedding images
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not
have descriptions, such as these links =[[file:img.jpg]]= or =[[./img.jpg]]=,
as direct image insertions in the final output. Either of these
examples works:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[file:img.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[./img.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Embedding clickable images
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For clickable images, provide a link whose description is another link
2018-02-18 16:48:32 -05:00
to an image file. For example, to embed an image
=org-mode-unicorn.png= which when clicked jumps to https://orgmode.org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
website, do the following
: [[https://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Sizing and scaling of embedded images
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Control the size and scale of the embedded images with the =ATTR_ODT=
attribute.
#+cindex: identify, ImageMagick
#+vindex: org-odt-pixels-per-inch
The ODT export back-end starts with establishing the size of the image
in the final document. The dimensions of this size are measured in
centimeters. The back-end then queries the image file for its
dimensions measured in pixels. For this measurement, the back-end
relies on ImageMagick's identify program or Emacs ~create-image~ and
~image-size~ API. ImageMagick is the preferred choice for large file
sizes or frequent batch operations. The back-end then converts the
pixel dimensions using ~org-odt-pixels-per-inch~ into the familiar 72
dpi or 96 dpi. The default value for this is in
~display-pixels-per-inch~, which can be tweaked for better results
based on the capabilities of the output device. Here are some common
image scaling operations:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Explicitly size the image ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To embed =img.png= as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
[[./img.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Scale the image ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To embed =img.png= at half its size, do the following:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
[[./img.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Scale the image to a specific width ::
To embed =img.png= with a width of 10 cm while retaining the
original height:width ratio, do the following:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
[[./img.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Scale the image to a specific height ::
To embed =img.png= with a height of 10 cm while retaining the
original height:width ratio, do the following:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
[[./img.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
**** Anchoring of images
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword
The ODT export back-end can anchor images to =as-char=, =paragraph=,
or =page=. Set the preferred anchor using the =:anchor= property of
the =ATTR_ODT= line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To create an image that is anchored to a page:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :anchor page
[[./img.png]]
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Math formatting in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Formatting @LaTeX{} fragments.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
**** LaTeX math snippets
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Embedding in @LaTeX{} format.
:END:
LaTeX math snippets (see [[*LaTeX fragments]]) can be embedded in the ODT
document in one of the following ways:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- MathML ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: MathML
Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on
a per-file basis.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+OPTIONS: tex:t
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
With this option, LaTeX fragments are first converted into MathML
fragments using an external LaTeX-to-MathML converter program.
The resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an
OpenDocument Formula in the exported document.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
#+vindex: org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
You can specify the LaTeX-to-MathML converter by customizing the
variables ~org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command~ and
~org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file~.
If you prefer to use MathToWeb[fn:131] as your converter, you can
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
configure the above variables as shown below.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
"java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
"/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
#+texinfo: @noindent
or, to use LaTeXML[fn:132] instead,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
"latexmlmath \"%i\" --presentationmathml=%o")
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
To quickly verify the reliability of the LaTeX-to-MathML
converter, use the following commands:
- {{{kbd(M-x org-export-as-odf)}}} ::
Convert a LaTeX math snippet to an OpenDocument formula
(=.odf=) file.
- {{{kbd(M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open)}}} ::
Convert a LaTeX math snippet to an OpenDocument formula
(=.odf=) file and open the formula file with the
system-registered application.
- PNG images ::
#+cindex: dvipng
#+cindex: dvisvgm
#+cindex: ImageMagick
Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on
a per-file basis.
: #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng
: #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm
#+texinfo: @noindent
or
: #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick
Under this option, LaTeX fragments are processed into PNG or SVG
images and the resulting images are embedded in the exported
document. This method requires dvipng program, dvisvgm or
ImageMagick programs.
**** MathML and OpenDocument formula files
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Embedding in native format.
:END:
When embedding LaTeX math snippets in ODT documents is not reliable,
there is one more option to try. Embed an equation by linking to its
MathML (=.mml=) source or its OpenDocument formula (=.odf=) file as
shown below:
: [[./equation.mml]]
#+texinfo: @noindent
or
: [[./equation.odf]]
*** Labels and captions in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Rendering objects.
:END:
ODT format handles labeling and captioning of objects based on their
types. Inline images, tables, LaTeX fragments, and Math formulas are
numbered and captioned separately. Each object also gets a unique
sequence number based on its order of first appearance in the Org
file. Each category has its own sequence. A caption is just a label
applied to these objects.
#+begin_example
,#+CAPTION: Bell curve
,#+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049
[[./img/a.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
When rendered, it may show as follows in the exported document:
: Figure 2: Bell curve
#+vindex: org-odt-category-map-alist
To modify the category component of the caption, customize the option
~org-odt-category-map-alist~. For example, to tag embedded images
with the string "Illustration" instead of the default string "Figure",
use the following setting:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-odt-category-map-alist
'(("__Figure__" "Illustration" "value" "Figure" org-odt--enumerable-image-p)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
With the above modification, the previous example changes to:
: Illustration 2: Bell curve
*** Literal examples in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For source code and example blocks.
:END:
The ODT export back-end supports literal examples (see [[*Literal
Examples]]) with full fontification. Internally, the ODT export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
back-end relies on =htmlfontify.el= to generate the style definitions
needed for fancy listings. The auto-generated styles get =OrgSrc=
prefix and inherit colors from the faces used by Emacs Font Lock
library for that source language.
#+vindex: org-odt-fontify-srcblocks
For custom fontification styles, customize the
~org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks~ option.
#+vindex: org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
To turn off fontification of literal examples, customize the
~org-odt-fontify-srcblocks~ option.
*** Advanced topics in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For power users.
:END:
The ODT export back-end has extensive features useful for power users
and frequent uses of ODT formats.
**** Configuring a document converter
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Registering a document converter.
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: convert
#+cindex: doc, docx, rtf
#+cindex: converter
The ODT export back-end works with popular converters with little or
no extra configuration. See [[*Extending ODT export]]. The following is
for unsupported converters or tweaking existing defaults.
- Register the converter ::
#+vindex: org-export-odt-convert-processes
Add the name of the converter to the ~org-odt-convert-processes~
variable. Note that it also requires how the converter is
invoked on the command line. See the variable's docstring for
details.
- Configure its capabilities ::
#+vindex: org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
Specify which formats the converter can handle by customizing the
variable ~org-odt-convert-capabilities~. Use the entry for the
default values in this variable for configuring the new
converter. Also see its docstring for details.
- Choose the converter ::
#+vindex: org-export-odt-convert-process
Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by
customizing the option ~org-odt-convert-process~.
**** Working with OpenDocument style files
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exploring internals.
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: styles, custom
#+cindex: template, custom
This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter; the means by which
it produces styled documents; the use of automatic and custom OpenDocument
styles.
The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output. These
files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
by the variable ~org-odt-styles-dir~. The two files are:
- =OrgOdtStyles.xml= <<x-orgodtstyles-xml>> ::
This file contributes to the =styles.xml= file of the final ODT
document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
1. To control outline numbering based on user settings;
2. To add styles generated by =htmlfontify.el= for fontification of
code blocks.
- =OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml= <<x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml>> ::
This file contributes to the =content.xml= file of the final ODT
document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
=<office:text>= ... =</office:text>= elements of this file.
Apart from serving as a template file for the final =content.xml=,
the file serves the following purposes:
1. It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are
referenced by the exporter;
2. It contains =<text:sequence-decl>= ... =</text:sequence-decl>=
elements that control numbering of tables, images, equations, and
similar entities.
<<x-overriding-factory-styles>> The following two variables control
the location from where the ODT exporter picks up the custom styles
and content template files. Customize these variables to override the
factory styles used by the exporter.
- ~org-odt-styles-file~ ::
The ODT export back-end uses the file pointed to by this
variable, such as =styles.xml=, for the final output. It can
take one of the following values:
- =FILE.xml= ::
Use this file instead of the default =styles.xml=
- =FILE.odt= or =FILE.ott= ::
Use the =styles.xml= contained in the specified OpenDocument
Text or Template file
- =FILE.odt= or =FILE.ott= and a subset of included files ::
Use the =styles.xml= contained in the specified OpenDocument
Text or Template file. Additionally extract the specified
member files and embed those within the final ODT document.
Use this option if the =styles.xml= file references additional
files like header and footer images.
- ~nil~ ::
Use the default =styles.xml=.
- ~org-odt-content-template-file~ ::
Use this variable to specify the blank =content.xml= used in the
final output.
**** Creating one-off styles
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Customizing styles, highlighting...
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
The ODT export back-end can read embedded raw OpenDocument XML from
the Org file. Such direct formatting is useful for one-off instances.
- Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text ::
Enclose OpenDocument syntax in =@@odt:...@@= for inline markup.
For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
#+begin_example
@@odt:<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is highlighted
text</text:span>@@. But this is regular text.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*Hint:* To see the above example in action, edit the =styles.xml=
(see [[x-orgodtstyles-xml][Factory styles]]) and add a custom /Highlight/ style as shown
below:
#+begin_example
<style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
<style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
</style:style>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML ::
#+cindex: @samp{ODT}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ODT export back-end can read one-liner options with =#+ODT:=
in the Org file. For example, to force a page break:
#+begin_example
,#+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*Hint:* To see the above example in action, edit your
=styles.xml= (see [[x-orgodtstyles-xml][Factory styles]]) and add a custom =PageBreak=
style as shown below.
#+begin_example
<style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
<style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
</style:style>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML ::
The ODT export back-end can also read ODT export blocks for
OpenDocument XML. Such blocks use the =#+BEGIN_EXPORT odt=
... =#+END_EXPORT= constructs.
For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text,
do the following:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT odt
<text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
</text:p>
,#+END_EXPORT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
**** Customizing tables in ODT export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Defining table templates.
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: tables, in ODT export
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_ODT}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Override the default table format by specifying a custom table style
with the =#+ATTR_ODT= line. For a discussion on default formatting of
tables, see [[*Tables in ODT export]].
This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
OpenDocument-v1.2 specification[fn:133].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-odt-table-styles
For quick preview of this feature, install the settings below and export the
table that follows:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-export-odt-table-styles
(append org-export-odt-table-styles
'(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
((use-first-row-styles . t)
(use-first-column-styles . t)))
("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
((use-first-row-styles . t)
(use-last-row-styles . t))))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn
| Name | Phone | Age |
| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
The example above used =Custom= template and installed two table
styles =TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn= and
=TableWithFirstRowandLastRow=. *Important:* The OpenDocument styles
needed for producing the above template were pre-defined. They are
available in the section marked =Custom Table Template= in
=OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml= (see [[x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml][Factory styles]]). For adding new
templates, define new styles there.
To use this feature proceed as follows:
1. Create a table template[fn:134].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A table template is set of =table-cell= and =paragraph= styles for
each of the following table cell categories:
- Body
- First column
- Last column
- First row
- Last row
- Even row
- Odd row
- Even column
- Odd Column
The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of
the table template using a well-defined convention.
The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For
a table template with the name =Custom=, the needed style names are
listed in the following table.
| Cell type | Cell style | Paragraph style |
|--------------+------------------------------+-----------------------------------|
| Body | =CustomTableCell= | =CustomTableParagraph= |
| First column | =CustomFirstColumnTableCell= | =CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph= |
| Last column | =CustomLastColumnTableCell= | =CustomLastColumnTableParagraph= |
| First row | =CustomFirstRowTableCell= | =CustomFirstRowTableParagraph= |
| Last row | =CustomLastRowTableCell= | =CustomLastRowTableParagraph= |
| Even row | =CustomEvenRowTableCell= | =CustomEvenRowTableParagraph= |
| Odd row | =CustomOddRowTableCell= | =CustomOddRowTableParagraph= |
| Even column | =CustomEvenColumnTableCell= | =CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph= |
| Odd column | =CustomOddColumnTableCell= | =CustomOddColumnTableParagraph= |
To create a table template with the name =Custom=, define the above
styles in the =<office:automatic-styles>= ...
=</office:automatic-styles>= element of the content template file
(see [[x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml][Factory styles]]).
2. Define a table style[fn:135].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-odt-table-styles
To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the
variable ~org-odt-table-styles~ and specify the following:
- the name of the table template created in step (1),
- the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated.
For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
=TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn= and =TableWithFirstRowandLastRow=
based on the same template =Custom=. The styles achieve their
intended effect by selectively activating the individual cell
styles in that template.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-export-odt-table-styles
(append org-export-odt-table-styles
'(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
((use-first-row-styles . t)
(use-first-column-styles . t)))
("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
((use-first-row-styles . t)
(use-last-row-styles . t))))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
3. Associate a table with the table style.
To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
the =ATTR_ODT= line as shown below.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn
| Name | Phone | Age |
| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
**** Validating OpenDocument XML
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files.
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
Sometimes ODT format files may not open due to =.odt= file corruption.
To verify if such a file is corrupt, validate it against the
OpenDocument Relax NG Compact (RNC) syntax schema. But first the
=.odt= files have to be decompressed using =zip=. Note that =.odt=
files are ZIP archives: [[info:emacs::File Archives]]. The contents of
ODT files are in XML. For general help with validation---and
schema-sensitive editing---of XML files:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[[info:nxml-mode::Introduction]].
#+vindex: org-export-odt-schema-dir
Customize ~org-odt-schema-dir~ to point to a directory with
OpenDocument RNC files and the needed schema-locating rules. The ODT
export back-end takes care of updating the
~rng-schema-locating-files~.
** Org Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to Org.
:END:
#+cindex: Org export
/org/ export back-end creates a normalized version of the Org document
in current buffer. The exporter evaluates Babel code (see [[*Evaluating
Code Blocks]]) and removes content specific to other back-ends.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Org export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e O o)}}} (~org-org-export-to-org~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e O o
#+findex: org-org-export-to-org
Export as an Org file with a =.org= extension. For =myfile.org=,
Org exports to =myfile.org.org=, overwriting without warning.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e O v)}}} (~~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e O v
Export to an Org file, then open it.
** Texinfo Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to Texinfo.
:END:
*** Texinfo export commands
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Invoking commands.
:END:
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e i t)}}} (~org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e i t
#+findex: org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo
Export as a Texinfo file with =.texi= extension. For
=myfile.org=, Org exports to =myfile.texi=, overwriting without
warning.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e i i)}}} (~org-texinfo-export-to-info~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e i i
#+findex: org-texinfo-export-to-info
#+vindex: org-texinfo-info-process
Export to Texinfo format first and then process it to make an
Info file. To generate other formats, such as DocBook, customize
the ~org-texinfo-info-process~ variable.
*** Texinfo specific export settings
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Setting the environment.
:END:
The Texinfo export back-end has several additional keywords for
customizing Texinfo output. Setting these keywords works similar to
the general options (see [[*Export Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =SUBTITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBTITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The document subtitle.
- =SUBAUTHOR= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SUBAUTHOR}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Additional authors for the document.
- =TEXINFO_FILENAME= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_FILENAME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Texinfo filename.
- =TEXINFO_CLASS= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-texinfo-default-class
The default document class (~org-texinfo-default-class~), which
must be a member of ~org-texinfo-classes~.
- =TEXINFO_HEADER= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_HEADER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Arbitrary lines inserted at the end of the header.
- =TEXINFO_POST_HEADER= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_POST_HEADER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Arbitrary lines inserted after the end of the header.
- =TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The directory category of the document.
- =TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The directory title of the document.
- =TEXINFO_DIR_DESC= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_DESC}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The directory description of the document.
- =TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The printed title of the document.
*** Texinfo file header
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Generating the header.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_FILENAME}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
After creating the header for a Texinfo file, the Texinfo back-end
automatically generates a name and destination path for the Info file.
To override this default with a more sensible path and name, specify
the =TEXINFO_FILENAME= keyword.
#+vindex: org-texinfo-coding-system
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_HEADER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Along with the output's file name, the Texinfo header also contains
language details (see [[*Export Settings]]) and encoding system as set in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the ~org-texinfo-coding-system~ variable. Insert =TEXINFO_HEADER=
keywords for each additional command in the header, for example:
: #+TEXINFO_HEADER: @synindex
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-texinfo-classes
Instead of repeatedly installing the same set of commands, define
a class in ~org-texinfo-classes~ once, and then activate it in the
document by setting the =TEXINFO_CLASS= keyword to that class.
*** Texinfo title and copyright page
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Creating preamble pages.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The default template for hard copy output has a title page with
=TITLE= and =AUTHOR= keywords (see [[*Export Settings]]). To replace the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
regular title with something different for the printed version, use
the =TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE= and =SUBTITLE= keywords. Both expect raw
Texinfo code for setting their values.
#+cindex: @samp{SUBAUTHOR}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If one =AUTHOR= line is not sufficient, add multiple =SUBAUTHOR=
keywords. They have to be set in raw Texinfo code.
#+begin_example
,#+AUTHOR: Jane Smith
,#+SUBAUTHOR: John Doe
,#+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: This Long Title@@inlinefmt{tex,@*} Is Broken in @TeX{}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+cindex: @samp{COPYING}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Copying material is defined in a dedicated headline with a non-~nil~
=COPYING= property. The back-end inserts the contents within
a =@copying= command at the beginning of the document. The heading
itself does not appear in the structure of the document.
Copyright information is printed on the back of the title page.
#+begin_example
,* Legalese
:PROPERTIES:
:COPYING: t
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file, version 1.0.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Info directory file
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{dir} file, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: Info directory file, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @code{install-info}, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_DIR_DESC}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The end result of the Texinfo export process is the creation of an
Info file. This Info file's metadata has variables for category,
title, and description: =TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY=, =TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE=,
and =TEXINFO_DIR_DESC= keywords that establish where in the Info
hierarchy the file fits.
Here is an example that writes to the Info directory file:
#+begin_example
,#+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Emacs
,#+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Org Mode: (org)
,#+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Outline-based notes management and organizer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Headings and sectioning structure
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Building document structure.
:END:
#+vindex: org-texinfo-classes
#+vindex: org-texinfo-default-class
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO_CLASS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Texinfo export back-end uses a pre-defined scheme to convert Org
headlines to equivalent Texinfo structuring commands. A scheme like
this maps top-level headlines to numbered chapters tagged as
~@chapter~ and lower-level headlines to unnumbered chapters tagged as
~@unnumbered~. To override such mappings to introduce ~@part~ or
other Texinfo structuring commands, define a new class in
~org-texinfo-classes~. Activate the new class with the
=TEXINFO_CLASS= keyword. When no new class is defined and activated,
the Texinfo export back-end defaults to the
~org-texinfo-default-class~.
If an Org headline's level has no associated Texinfo structuring
command, or is below a certain threshold (see [[*Export Settings]]), then
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the Texinfo export back-end makes it into a list item.
#+cindex: @samp{APPENDIX}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Texinfo export back-end makes any headline with a non-~nil~
=APPENDIX= property into an appendix. This happens independent of the
Org headline level or the =TEXINFO_CLASS= keyword.
#+cindex: @samp{ALT_TITLE}, property
#+cindex: @samp{DESCRIPTION}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Texinfo export back-end creates a menu entry after the Org
headline for each regular sectioning structure. To override this with
a shorter menu entry, use the =ALT_TITLE= property (see [[*Table of
Contents]]). Texinfo menu entries also have an option for a longer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=DESCRIPTION= property. Here's an example that uses both to override
the default menu entry:
#+begin_example
,* Controlling Screen Display
:PROPERTIES:
:ALT_TITLE: Display
:DESCRIPTION: Controlling Screen Display
:END:
#+end_example
#+cindex: Top node, in Texinfo export
The text before the first headline belongs to the /Top/ node, i.e.,
the node in which a reader enters an Info manual. As such, it is
expected not to appear in printed output generated from the =.texi=
file. See [[info:texinfo::The%20Top%20Node]], for more information.
*** Indices
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Creating indices.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{CINDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: concept index, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @samp{FINDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: function index, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @samp{KINDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: keystroke index, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @samp{PINDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: program index, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @samp{TINDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: data type index, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: @samp{VINDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: variable index, in Texinfo export
The Texinfo export back-end recognizes these indexing keywords if used
in the Org file: =CINDEX=, =FINDEX=, =KINDEX=, =PINDEX=, =TINDEX= and
=VINDEX=. Write their value as verbatim Texinfo code; in particular,
={=, =}= and =@= characters need to be escaped with =@= if they do not
belong to a Texinfo command.
: #+CINDEX: Defining indexing entries
#+cindex: @samp{INDEX}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For the back-end to generate an index entry for a headline, set the
=INDEX= property to =cp= or =vr=. These abbreviations come from
Texinfo that stand for concept index and variable index. The Texinfo
manual has abbreviations for all other kinds of indexes. The back-end
exports the headline as an unnumbered chapter or section command, and
then inserts the index after its contents.
#+begin_example
,* Concept Index
:PROPERTIES:
:INDEX: cp
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Quoting Texinfo code
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Incorporating literal Texinfo code.
:END:
Use any of the following three methods to insert or escape raw Texinfo
code:
#+cindex: @samp{TEXINFO}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
Richard @@texinfo:@sc{@@Stallman@@texinfo:}@@ commence' GNU.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+TEXINFO: @need800
This paragraph is preceded by...
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo
@auindex Johnson, Mark
@auindex Lakoff, George
,#+END_EXPORT
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Plain lists in Texinfo export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: List attributes.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: two-column tables, in Texinfo export
#+cindex: table types, in Texinfo export
The Texinfo export back-end by default converts description lists in
the Org file using the default command =@table=, which results in
a table with two columns. To change this behavior, specify
=:table-type= with =ftable= or =vtable= attributes. For more
information, see [[info:texinfo::Two-column Tables]].
#+vindex: org-texinfo-table-default-markup
The Texinfo export back-end by default also applies a text highlight
based on the defaults stored in ~org-texinfo-table-default-markup~.
To override the default highlight command, specify another one with
the =:indic= attribute.
#+cindex: multiple items in Texinfo lists
Org syntax is limited to one entry per list item. Nevertheless, the
Texinfo export back-end can split that entry according to any text
provided through the =:sep= attribute. Each part then becomes a new
entry in the first column of the table.
The following example illustrates all the attributes above:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_TEXINFO: :table-type vtable :sep , :indic asis
- foo, bar :: This is the common text for variables foo and bar.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
becomes
#+begin_example
@vtable @asis
@item foo
@itemx bar
This is the common text for variables foo and bar.
@end table
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Tables in Texinfo export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Table attributes.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When exporting tables, the Texinfo export back-end uses the widest
cell width in each column. To override this and instead specify as
fractions of line length, use the =:columns= attribute. See example
below.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_TEXINFO: :columns .5 .5
| a cell | another cell |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Images in Texinfo export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Image attributes.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Insert a file link to the image in the Org file, and the Texinfo
export back-end inserts the image. These links must have the usual
supported image extensions and no descriptions. To scale the image,
use =:width= and =:height= attributes. For alternate text, use =:alt=
and specify the text using Texinfo code, as shown in the example:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_TEXINFO: :width 1in :alt Alternate @i{text}
[[ridt.pdf]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Quotations in Texinfo export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Quote block attributes.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword
You can write the text of a quotation within a quote block (see
[[*Paragraphs]]). You may also emphasize some text at the beginning of
the quotation with the =:tag= attribute.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_TEXINFO: :tag Warning
,#+BEGIN_QUOTE
Striking your thumb with a hammer may cause severe pain and discomfort.
,#+END_QUOTE
#+end_example
To specify the author of the quotation, use the =:author= attribute.
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_TEXINFO: :author King Arthur
,#+BEGIN_QUOTE
The Lady of the Lake, her arm clad in the purest shimmering samite,
held aloft Excalibur from the bosom of the water, signifying by divine
providence that I, Arthur, was to carry Excalibur. That is why I am
your king.
,#+END_QUOTE
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Special blocks in Texinfo export
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Special block attributes.
:END:
#+cindex: @samp{ATTR_TEXINFO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Texinfo export back-end converts special blocks to commands with
the same name. It also adds any =:options= attributes to the end of
the command, as shown in this example:
#+begin_example
,#+ATTR_TEXINFO: :options org-org-export-to-org ...
,#+BEGIN_defun
A somewhat obsessive function name.
,#+END_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
becomes
#+begin_example
@defun org-org-export-to-org ...
A somewhat obsessive function name.
@end defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** A Texinfo example
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Processing Org to Texinfo.
:END:
Here is a more detailed example Org file. See
[[info:texinfo::GNU%20Sample%20Texts]] for an equivalent example using
Texinfo code.
#+begin_example
,#+TITLE: GNU Sample {{{version}}}
,#+SUBTITLE: for version {{{version}}}, {{{updated}}}
,#+AUTHOR: A.U. Thor
,#+EMAIL: bug-sample@gnu.org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+OPTIONS: ':t toc:t author:t email:t
,#+LANGUAGE: en
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+MACRO: version 2.0
,#+MACRO: updated last updated 4 March 2014
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+TEXINFO_FILENAME: sample.info
,#+TEXINFO_HEADER: @syncodeindex pg cp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo documentation system
,#+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: sample: (sample)
,#+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Invoking sample
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: GNU Sample
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This manual is for GNU Sample (version {{{version}}},
{{{updated}}}).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,* Copying
:PROPERTIES:
:COPYING: t
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This manual is for GNU Sample (version {{{version}}},
{{{updated}}}), which is an example in the Texinfo documentation.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+BEGIN_QUOTE
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this
document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software
Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts,
and with no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in
the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License".
,#+END_QUOTE
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,* Invoking sample
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+PINDEX: sample
,#+CINDEX: invoking @command{sample}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This is a sample manual. There is no sample program to invoke, but
if there were, you could see its basic usage and command line
options here.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,* GNU Free Documentation License
:PROPERTIES:
:APPENDIX: t
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+TEXINFO: @include fdl.texi
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,* Index
:PROPERTIES:
:INDEX: cp
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** iCalendar Export
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to iCalendar.
:END:
#+cindex: iCalendar export
A large part of Org mode's interoperability success is its ability to
easily export to or import from external applications. The iCalendar
export back-end takes calendar data from Org files and exports to the
standard iCalendar format.
#+vindex: org-icalendar-include-todo
#+vindex: org-icalendar-use-deadline
#+vindex: org-icalendar-use-scheduled
The iCalendar export back-end can also incorporate TODO entries based
on the configuration of the ~org-icalendar-include-todo~ variable.
The back-end exports plain timestamps as =VEVENT=, TODO items as
=VTODO=, and also create events from deadlines that are in non-TODO
items. The back-end uses the deadlines and scheduling dates in Org
TODO items for setting the start and due dates for the iCalendar TODO
entry. Consult the ~org-icalendar-use-deadline~ and
~org-icalendar-use-scheduled~ variables for more details.
#+vindex: org-icalendar-categories
#+vindex: org-icalendar-alarm-time
For tags on the headline, the iCalendar export back-end makes them
into iCalendar categories. To tweak the inheritance of tags and TODO
states, configure the variable ~org-icalendar-categories~. To assign
clock alarms based on time, configure the ~org-icalendar-alarm-time~
variable.
#+vindex: org-icalendar-store-UID
#+cindex: @samp{ID}, property
The iCalendar format standard requires globally unique identifier---or
UID---for each entry. The iCalendar export back-end creates UIDs
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
during export. To save a copy of the UID in the Org file set the
variable ~org-icalendar-store-UID~. The back-end looks for the =ID=
property of the entry for re-using the same UID for subsequent
exports.
Since a single Org entry can result in multiple iCalendar
entries---timestamp, deadline, scheduled item, or TODO item---Org adds
prefixes to the UID, depending on which part of the Org entry
triggered the creation of the iCalendar entry. Prefixing ensures UIDs
remains unique, yet enable synchronization programs trace the
connections.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e c f)}}} (~org-icalendar-export-to-ics~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e c f
#+findex: org-icalendar-export-to-ics
Create iCalendar entries from the current Org buffer and store
them in the same directory, using a file extension =.ics=.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e c a)}}} (~org-icalendar-export-agenda-files~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e c a
#+findex: org-icalendar-export-agenda-files
Create iCalendar entries from Org files in ~org-agenda-files~ and
store in a separate iCalendar file for each Org file.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e c c)}}} (~org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files~) ::
#+kindex: C-c C-e c c
#+findex: org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
#+vindex: org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file
Create a combined iCalendar file from Org files in
~org-agenda-files~ and write it to
~org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file~ file name.
#+cindex: @samp{SUMMARY}, property
#+cindex: @samp{DESCRIPTION}, property
#+cindex: @samp{LOCATION}, property
#+cindex: @samp{TIMEZONE}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The iCalendar export back-end includes =SUMMARY=, =DESCRIPTION=,
=LOCATION= and =TIMEZONE= properties from the Org entries when
exporting. To force the back-end to inherit the =LOCATION= and
=TIMEZONE= properties, configure the ~org-use-property-inheritance~
variable.
#+vindex: org-icalendar-include-body
When Org entries do not have =SUMMARY=, =DESCRIPTION= and =LOCATION=
properties, the iCalendar export back-end derives the summary from the
headline, and derives the description from the body of the Org item.
The ~org-icalendar-include-body~ variable limits the maximum number of
characters of the content are turned into its description.
The =TIMEZONE= property can be used to specify a per-entry time zone,
and is applied to any entry with timestamp information. Time zones
should be specified as per the IANA time zone database format, e.g.,
=Asia/Almaty=. Alternately, the property value can be =UTC=, to force
UTC time for this entry only.
Exporting to iCalendar format depends in large part on the
capabilities of the destination application. Some are more lenient
than others. Consult the Org mode FAQ for advice on specific
applications.
** Other Built-in Back-ends
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Exporting to a man page.
:END:
Other export back-ends included with Org are:
- =ox-man.el=: Export to a man page.
To activate such back-ends, either customize ~org-export-backends~ or
load directly with =(require 'ox-man)=. On successful load, the
back-end adds new keys in the export dispatcher (see [[*The Export
Dispatcher]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Follow the comment section of such files, for example, =ox-man.el=,
for usage and configuration details.
** Advanced Export Configuration
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Fine-tuning the export output.
:END:
*** Hooks
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+vindex: org-export-before-processing-hook
#+vindex: org-export-before-parsing-hook
The export process executes two hooks before the actual exporting
begins. The first hook, ~org-export-before-processing-hook~, runs
before any expansions of macros, Babel code, and include keywords in
the buffer. The second hook, ~org-export-before-parsing-hook~, runs
before the buffer is parsed.
Functions added to these hooks are called with a single argument: the
export back-end actually used, as a symbol. You may use them for
heavy duty structural modifications of the document. For example, you
can remove every headline in the buffer during export like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun my-headline-removal (backend)
"Remove all headlines in the current buffer.
BACKEND is the export back-end being used, as a symbol."
(org-map-entries
(lambda () (delete-region (point) (line-beginning-position 2)))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
(add-hook 'org-export-before-parsing-hook 'my-headline-removal)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
*** Filters
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: Filters, exporting
Filters are lists of functions to be applied to certain parts for
a given back-end. The output from the first function in the filter is
passed on to the next function in the filter. The final output is the
output from the final function in the filter.
The Org export process has many filter sets applicable to different
types of objects, plain text, parse trees, export options, and final
output formats. The filters are named after the element type or
object type: ~org-export-filter-TYPE-functions~, where {{{var(TYPE)}}}
is the type targeted by the filter. Valid types are:
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.33 0.33 0.33
| body | bold | babel-call |
| center-block | clock | code |
| diary-sexp | drawer | dynamic-block |
| entity | example-block | export-block |
| export-snippet | final-output | fixed-width |
| footnote-definition | footnote-reference | headline |
| horizontal-rule | inline-babel-call | inline-src-block |
| inlinetask | italic | item |
| keyword | latex-environment | latex-fragment |
| line-break | link | node-property |
| options | paragraph | parse-tree |
| plain-list | plain-text | planning |
| property-drawer | quote-block | radio-target |
| section | special-block | src-block |
| statistics-cookie | strike-through | subscript |
| superscript | table | table-cell |
| table-row | target | timestamp |
| underline | verbatim | verse-block |
Here is an example filter that replaces non-breaking spaces ~ ~ in the
Org buffer with =~= for the LaTeX back-end.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun my-latex-filter-nobreaks (text backend info)
"Ensure \" \" are properly handled in LaTeX export."
(when (org-export-derived-backend-p backend 'latex)
(replace-regexp-in-string " " "~" text)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
(add-to-list 'org-export-filter-plain-text-functions
'my-latex-filter-nobreaks)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
A filter requires three arguments: the code to be transformed, the
name of the back-end, and some optional information about the export
process. The third argument can be safely ignored. Note the use of
~org-export-derived-backend-p~ predicate that tests for /latex/
back-end or any other back-end, such as /beamer/, derived from
/latex/.
*** Defining filters for individual files
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
The Org export can filter not just for back-ends, but also for
specific files through the =BIND= keyword. Here is an example with
two filters; one removes brackets from time stamps, and the other
removes strike-through text. The filter functions are defined in
a code block in the same Org file, which is a handy location for
debugging.
#+begin_example
,#+BIND: org-export-filter-timestamp-functions (tmp-f-timestamp)
,#+BIND: org-export-filter-strike-through-functions (tmp-f-strike-through)
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :exports results :results none
(defun tmp-f-timestamp (s backend info)
(replace-regexp-in-string "&[lg]t;\\|[][]" "" s))
(defun tmp-f-strike-through (s backend info) "")
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
*** Extending an existing back-end
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
Some parts of the conversion process can be extended for certain
elements so as to introduce a new or revised translation. That is how
the HTML export back-end was extended to handle Markdown format. The
extensions work seamlessly so any aspect of filtering not done by the
extended back-end is handled by the original back-end. Of all the
export customization in Org, extending is very powerful as it operates
at the parser level.
For this example, make the /ascii/ back-end display the language used
in a source code block. Also make it display only when some attribute
is non-~nil~, like the following:
: #+ATTR_ASCII: :language t
2018-03-28 10:09:15 -04:00
Then extend ASCII back-end with a custom "my-ascii" back-end.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun my-ascii-src-block (src-block contents info)
"Transcode a SRC-BLOCK element from Org to ASCII.
CONTENTS is nil. INFO is a plist used as a communication
channel."
(if (not (org-export-read-attribute :attr_ascii src-block :language))
(org-export-with-backend 'ascii src-block contents info)
(concat
(format ",--[ %s ]--\n%s`----"
(org-element-property :language src-block)
(replace-regexp-in-string
"^" "| "
(org-element-normalize-string
(org-export-format-code-default src-block info)))))))
(org-export-define-derived-backend 'my-ascii 'ascii
:translate-alist '((src-block . my-ascii-src-block)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The ~my-ascii-src-block~ function looks at the attribute above the
current element. If not true, hands over to /ascii/ back-end. If
true, which it is in this example, it creates a box around the code
and leaves room for the inserting a string for language. The last
form creates the new back-end that springs to action only when
translating ~src-block~ type elements.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To use the newly defined back-end, evaluate the following from an Org
buffer:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(org-export-to-buffer 'my-ascii "*Org MY-ASCII Export*")
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Further steps to consider would be an interactive function,
self-installing an item in the export dispatcher menu, and other
user-friendly improvements.
** Export in Foreign Buffers
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Author tables and lists in Org syntax.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The export back-ends in Org often include commands to convert selected
regions. A convenient feature of this in-place conversion is that the
exported output replaces the original source. Here are such
functions:
- ~org-ascii-convert-region-to-ascii~ ::
#+findex: org-ascii-convert-region-to-ascii
Convert the selected region into ASCII.
- ~org-ascii-convert-region-to-utf8~ ::
#+findex: org-ascii-convert-region-to-utf8
Convert the selected region into UTF-8.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-html-convert-region-to-html~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-html-convert-region-to-html
Convert the selected region into HTML.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-latex-convert-region-to-latex~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-latex-convert-region-to-latex
Convert the selected region into LaTeX.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo
Convert the selected region into Texinfo.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-md-convert-region-to-md~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-md-convert-region-to-md
Convert the selected region into Markdown.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In-place conversions are particularly handy for quick conversion of
tables and lists in foreign buffers. For example, in an HTML buffer,
write a list in Org syntax, select it, and convert it to HTML with
{{{kbd(M-x org-html-convert-region-to-html)}}}.
* Publishing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Create a web site of linked Org files.
:END:
#+cindex: publishing
Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to
configure automatic HTML conversion of /projects/ composed of
2018-01-18 18:15:34 -05:00
interlinked Org files. You can also configure Org to automatically
upload your exported HTML pages and related attachments, such as
images and source code files, to a web server.
You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML
and PDF conversion so that files are available in both formats on the
server.
Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
** Configuration
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Defining projects.
:END:
Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files,
destination and many other properties of a project.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** The variable ~org-publish-project-alist~
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: The central configuration variable.
:ALT_TITLE: Project alist
:END:
#+cindex: projects, for publishing
#+vindex: org-publish-project-alist
Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of
one variable, called ~org-publish-project-alist~. Each element of the
list configures one project, and may be in one of the two following
forms:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values,
or:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
#+end_src
In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A project defines the set of files that are to be published, as well
as the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files.
When a project takes the second form listed above, the individual
members of the ~:components~ property are taken to be sub-projects,
which group together files requiring different publishing options.
When you publish such a "meta-project", all the components are also
published, in the sequence given.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Sources and destinations for files
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: From here to there.
:ALT_TITLE: Sources and destinations
:END:
#+cindex: directories, for publishing
Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files, and
where to put published files.
- ~:base-directory~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Directory containing publishing source files.
- ~:publishing-directory~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Directory where output files are published. You can directly
publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
the Emacs tramp package. Or you can publish to a local directory
and use external tools to upload your website (see [[*Uploading
Files]]).
- ~:preparation-function~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
publishing process, for example, to run =make= for updating files
to be published. Each preparation function is called with
a single argument, the project property list.
- ~:completion-function~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Function or list of functions called after finishing the
publishing process, for example, to change permissions of the
resulting files. Each completion function is called with
a single argument, the project property list.
*** Selecting files
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: What files are part of the project?
:END:
#+cindex: files, selecting for publishing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
By default, all files with extension =.org= in the base directory are
considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
following properties
- ~:base-extension~ ::
Extension---without the dot---of source files. This actually
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
is a regular expression. Set this to the symbol ~any~ if you
want to get all files in ~:base-directory~, even without
extension.
- ~:exclude~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Regular expression to match file names that should not be published,
even though they have been selected on the basis of their extension.
- ~:include~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
List of files to be included regardless of ~:base-extension~ and
~:exclude~.
- ~:recursive~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Non-~nil~ means, check base-directory recursively for files to
publish.
*** Publishing action
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Setting the function doing the publishing.
:END:
#+cindex: action, for publishing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory
and possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation
is to export Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
~org-publish-org-to-html~ which calls the HTML exporter (see [[*HTML
Export]]). But you can also publish your content as PDF files using
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-publish-org-to-pdf~, or as ASCII, Texinfo, etc., using the
corresponding functions.
If you want to publish the Org file as an =.org= file but with
/archived/, /commented/, and /tag-excluded/ trees removed, use
~org-publish-org-to-org~. This produces =file.org= and put it in the
publishing directory. If you want a htmlized version of this file,
set the parameter ~:htmlized-source~ to ~t~. It produces
=file.org.html= in the publishing directory[fn:136].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Other files like images only need to be copied to the publishing
destination; for this you can use ~org-publish-attachment~. For
non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
- ~:publishing-function~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be
a list of functions, which are all called in turn.
- ~:htmlized-source~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Non-~nil~ means, publish htmlized source.
The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing
at least a ~:publishing-directory~ property, the name of the file to
be published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output
file. It should take the specified file, make the necessary
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
transformation, if any, and place the result into the destination
folder.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Options for the exporters
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export.
:ALT_TITLE: Publishing options
:END:
#+cindex: options, for publishing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: publishing options
The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
and LaTeX exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to
user variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for
the respective variable for details.
#+vindex: org-publish-project-alist
When a property is given a value in ~org-publish-project-alist~, its
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable, if
any, during publishing. Options set within a file (see [[*Export
Settings]]), however, override everything.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
**** Generic properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:archived-trees~ | ~org-export-with-archived-trees~ |
| ~:exclude-tags~ | ~org-export-exclude-tags~ |
| ~:headline-levels~ | ~org-export-headline-levels~ |
| ~:language~ | ~org-export-default-language~ |
| ~:preserve-breaks~ | ~org-export-preserve-breaks~ |
| ~:section-numbers~ | ~org-export-with-section-numbers~ |
| ~:select-tags~ | ~org-export-select-tags~ |
| ~:with-author~ | ~org-export-with-author~ |
| ~:with-broken-links~ | ~org-export-with-broken-links~ |
| ~:with-clocks~ | ~org-export-with-clocks~ |
| ~:with-creator~ | ~org-export-with-creator~ |
| ~:with-date~ | ~org-export-with-date~ |
| ~:with-drawers~ | ~org-export-with-drawers~ |
| ~:with-email~ | ~org-export-with-email~ |
| ~:with-emphasize~ | ~org-export-with-emphasize~ |
| ~:with-fixed-width~ | ~org-export-with-fixed-width~ |
| ~:with-footnotes~ | ~org-export-with-footnotes~ |
| ~:with-latex~ | ~org-export-with-latex~ |
| ~:with-planning~ | ~org-export-with-planning~ |
| ~:with-priority~ | ~org-export-with-priority~ |
| ~:with-properties~ | ~org-export-with-properties~ |
| ~:with-special-strings~ | ~org-export-with-special-strings~ |
| ~:with-sub-superscript~ | ~org-export-with-sub-superscripts~ |
| ~:with-tables~ | ~org-export-with-tables~ |
| ~:with-tags~ | ~org-export-with-tags~ |
| ~:with-tasks~ | ~org-export-with-tasks~ |
| ~:with-timestamps~ | ~org-export-with-timestamps~ |
| ~:with-title~ | ~org-export-with-title~ |
| ~:with-toc~ | ~org-export-with-toc~ |
| ~:with-todo-keywords~ | ~org-export-with-todo-keywords~ |
**** ASCII specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:ascii-bullets~ | ~org-ascii-bullets~ |
| ~:ascii-caption-above~ | ~org-ascii-caption-above~ |
| ~:ascii-charset~ | ~org-ascii-charset~ |
| ~:ascii-global-margin~ | ~org-ascii-global-margin~ |
| ~:ascii-format-drawer-function~ | ~org-ascii-format-drawer-function~ |
| ~:ascii-format-inlinetask-function~ | ~org-ascii-format-inlinetask-function~ |
| ~:ascii-headline-spacing~ | ~org-ascii-headline-spacing~ |
| ~:ascii-indented-line-width~ | ~org-ascii-indented-line-width~ |
| ~:ascii-inlinetask-width~ | ~org-ascii-inlinetask-width~ |
| ~:ascii-inner-margin~ | ~org-ascii-inner-margin~ |
| ~:ascii-links-to-notes~ | ~org-ascii-links-to-notes~ |
| ~:ascii-list-margin~ | ~org-ascii-list-margin~ |
| ~:ascii-paragraph-spacing~ | ~org-ascii-paragraph-spacing~ |
| ~:ascii-quote-margin~ | ~org-ascii-quote-margin~ |
| ~:ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines~ | ~org-ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines~ |
| ~:ascii-table-use-ascii-art~ | ~org-ascii-table-use-ascii-art~ |
| ~:ascii-table-widen-columns~ | ~org-ascii-table-widen-columns~ |
| ~:ascii-text-width~ | ~org-ascii-text-width~ |
| ~:ascii-underline~ | ~org-ascii-underline~ |
| ~:ascii-verbatim-format~ | ~org-ascii-verbatim-format~ |
**** Beamer specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:beamer-theme~ | ~org-beamer-theme~ |
| ~:beamer-column-view-format~ | ~org-beamer-column-view-format~ |
| ~:beamer-environments-extra~ | ~org-beamer-environments-extra~ |
| ~:beamer-frame-default-options~ | ~org-beamer-frame-default-options~ |
| ~:beamer-outline-frame-options~ | ~org-beamer-outline-frame-options~ |
| ~:beamer-outline-frame-title~ | ~org-beamer-outline-frame-title~ |
| ~:beamer-subtitle-format~ | ~org-beamer-subtitle-format~ |
**** HTML specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors~ | ~org-html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors~ |
| ~:html-checkbox-type~ | ~org-html-checkbox-type~ |
| ~:html-container~ | ~org-html-container-element~ |
| ~:html-divs~ | ~org-html-divs~ |
| ~:html-doctype~ | ~org-html-doctype~ |
| ~:html-extension~ | ~org-html-extension~ |
| ~:html-footnote-format~ | ~org-html-footnote-format~ |
| ~:html-footnote-separator~ | ~org-html-footnote-separator~ |
| ~:html-footnotes-section~ | ~org-html-footnotes-section~ |
| ~:html-format-drawer-function~ | ~org-html-format-drawer-function~ |
| ~:html-format-headline-function~ | ~org-html-format-headline-function~ |
| ~:html-format-inlinetask-function~ | ~org-html-format-inlinetask-function~ |
| ~:html-head-extra~ | ~org-html-head-extra~ |
| ~:html-head-include-default-style~ | ~org-html-head-include-default-style~ |
| ~:html-head-include-scripts~ | ~org-html-head-include-scripts~ |
| ~:html-head~ | ~org-html-head~ |
| ~:html-home/up-format~ | ~org-html-home/up-format~ |
| ~:html-html5-fancy~ | ~org-html-html5-fancy~ |
| ~:html-indent~ | ~org-html-indent~ |
| ~:html-infojs-options~ | ~org-html-infojs-options~ |
| ~:html-infojs-template~ | ~org-html-infojs-template~ |
| ~:html-inline-image-rules~ | ~org-html-inline-image-rules~ |
| ~:html-inline-images~ | ~org-html-inline-images~ |
| ~:html-link-home~ | ~org-html-link-home~ |
| ~:html-link-org-files-as-html~ | ~org-html-link-org-files-as-html~ |
| ~:html-link-up~ | ~org-html-link-up~ |
| ~:html-link-use-abs-url~ | ~org-html-link-use-abs-url~ |
| ~:html-mathjax-options~ | ~org-html-mathjax-options~ |
| ~:html-mathjax-template~ | ~org-html-mathjax-template~ |
| ~:html-metadata-timestamp-format~ | ~org-html-metadata-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:html-postamble-format~ | ~org-html-postamble-format~ |
| ~:html-postamble~ | ~org-html-postamble~ |
| ~:html-preamble-format~ | ~org-html-preamble-format~ |
| ~:html-preamble~ | ~org-html-preamble~ |
| ~:html-table-align-individual-field~ | ~de{org-html-table-align-individual-fields~ |
| ~:html-table-attributes~ | ~org-html-table-default-attributes~ |
| ~:html-table-caption-above~ | ~org-html-table-caption-above~ |
| ~:html-table-data-tags~ | ~org-html-table-data-tags~ |
| ~:html-table-header-tags~ | ~org-html-table-header-tags~ |
| ~:html-table-row-tags~ | ~org-html-table-row-tags~ |
| ~:html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column~ | ~org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column~ |
| ~:html-tag-class-prefix~ | ~org-html-tag-class-prefix~ |
| ~:html-text-markup-alist~ | ~org-html-text-markup-alist~ |
| ~:html-todo-kwd-class-prefix~ | ~org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix~ |
| ~:html-toplevel-hlevel~ | ~org-html-toplevel-hlevel~ |
| ~:html-use-infojs~ | ~org-html-use-infojs~ |
| ~:html-validation-link~ | ~org-html-validation-link~ |
| ~:html-viewport~ | ~org-html-viewport~ |
| ~:html-xml-declaration~ | ~org-html-xml-declaration~ |
**** LaTeX specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:latex-active-timestamp-format~ | ~org-latex-active-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:latex-caption-above~ | ~org-latex-caption-above~ |
| ~:latex-classes~ | ~org-latex-classes~ |
| ~:latex-class~ | ~org-latex-default-class~ |
| ~:latex-compiler~ | ~org-latex-compiler~ |
| ~:latex-default-figure-position~ | ~org-latex-default-figure-position~ |
| ~:latex-default-table-environment~ | ~org-latex-default-table-environment~ |
| ~:latex-default-table-mode~ | ~org-latex-default-table-mode~ |
| ~:latex-diary-timestamp-format~ | ~org-latex-diary-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:latex-footnote-defined-format~ | ~org-latex-footnote-defined-format~ |
| ~:latex-footnote-separator~ | ~org-latex-footnote-separator~ |
| ~:latex-format-drawer-function~ | ~org-latex-format-drawer-function~ |
| ~:latex-format-headline-function~ | ~org-latex-format-headline-function~ |
| ~:latex-format-inlinetask-function~ | ~org-latex-format-inlinetask-function~ |
| ~:latex-hyperref-template~ | ~org-latex-hyperref-template~ |
| ~:latex-image-default-height~ | ~org-latex-image-default-height~ |
| ~:latex-image-default-option~ | ~org-latex-image-default-option~ |
| ~:latex-image-default-width~ | ~org-latex-image-default-width~ |
| ~:latex-images-centered~ | ~org-latex-images-centered~ |
| ~:latex-inactive-timestamp-format~ | ~org-latex-inactive-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:latex-inline-image-rules~ | ~org-latex-inline-image-rules~ |
| ~:latex-link-with-unknown-path-format~ | ~org-latex-link-with-unknown-path-format~ |
| ~:latex-listings-langs~ | ~org-latex-listings-langs~ |
| ~:latex-listings-options~ | ~org-latex-listings-options~ |
| ~:latex-listings~ | ~org-latex-listings~ |
| ~:latex-minted-langs~ | ~org-latex-minted-langs~ |
| ~:latex-minted-options~ | ~org-latex-minted-options~ |
| ~:latex-prefer-user-labels~ | ~org-latex-prefer-user-labels~ |
| ~:latex-subtitle-format~ | ~org-latex-subtitle-format~ |
| ~:latex-subtitle-separate~ | ~org-latex-subtitle-separate~ |
| ~:latex-table-scientific-notation~ | ~org-latex-table-scientific-notation~ |
| ~:latex-tables-booktabs~ | ~org-latex-tables-booktabs~ |
| ~:latex-tables-centered~ | ~org-latex-tables-centered~ |
| ~:latex-text-markup-alist~ | ~org-latex-text-markup-alist~ |
| ~:latex-title-command~ | ~org-latex-title-command~ |
| ~:latex-toc-command~ | ~org-latex-toc-command~ |
**** Markdown specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:md-footnote-format~ | ~org-md-footnote-format~ |
| ~:md-footnotes-section~ | ~org-md-footnotes-section~ |
| ~:md-headline-style~ | ~org-md-headline-style~ |
**** ODT specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:odt-content-template-file~ | ~org-odt-content-template-file~ |
| ~:odt-display-outline-level~ | ~org-odt-display-outline-level~ |
| ~:odt-fontify-srcblocks~ | ~org-odt-fontify-srcblocks~ |
| ~:odt-format-drawer-function~ | ~org-odt-format-drawer-function~ |
| ~:odt-format-headline-function~ | ~org-odt-format-headline-function~ |
| ~:odt-format-inlinetask-function~ | ~org-odt-format-inlinetask-function~ |
| ~:odt-inline-formula-rules~ | ~org-odt-inline-formula-rules~ |
| ~:odt-inline-image-rules~ | ~org-odt-inline-image-rules~ |
| ~:odt-pixels-per-inch~ | ~org-odt-pixels-per-inch~ |
| ~:odt-styles-file~ | ~org-odt-styles-file~ |
| ~:odt-table-styles~ | ~org-odt-table-styles~ |
| ~:odt-use-date-fields~ | ~org-odt-use-date-fields~ |
**** Texinfo specific properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
| ~:texinfo-active-timestamp-format~ | ~org-texinfo-active-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:texinfo-classes~ | ~org-texinfo-classes~ |
| ~:texinfo-class~ | ~org-texinfo-default-class~ |
| ~:texinfo-table-default-markup~ | ~org-texinfo-table-default-markup~ |
| ~:texinfo-diary-timestamp-format~ | ~org-texinfo-diary-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:texinfo-filename~ | ~org-texinfo-filename~ |
| ~:texinfo-format-drawer-function~ | ~org-texinfo-format-drawer-function~ |
| ~:texinfo-format-headline-function~ | ~org-texinfo-format-headline-function~ |
| ~:texinfo-format-inlinetask-function~ | ~org-texinfo-format-inlinetask-function~ |
| ~:texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format~ | ~org-texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format~ |
| ~:texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format~ | ~org-texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format~ |
| ~:texinfo-node-description-column~ | ~org-texinfo-node-description-column~ |
| ~:texinfo-table-scientific-notation~ | ~org-texinfo-table-scientific-notation~ |
| ~:texinfo-tables-verbatim~ | ~org-texinfo-tables-verbatim~ |
| ~:texinfo-text-markup-alist~ | ~org-texinfo-text-markup-alist~ |
*** Publishing links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Which links keep working after publishing?
:END:
#+cindex: links, publishing
To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something
like =[[file:foo.org][The foo]]= or simply =[[file:foo.org]]= (see [[*External Links]]). When
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
published, this link becomes a link to =foo.html=. You can thus
interlink the pages of your "Org web" project and the links will work
as expected when you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the
Org source file and want to link to it, use an =http= link instead of
a =file:= link, because =file= links are converted to link to the
corresponding =.html= file.
You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are
careful with relative file names, and provided you have also
configured Org to upload the related files, these links will work too.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
See [[*Example: complex publishing configuration]], for an example of this
usage.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Eventually, links between published documents can contain some search
options (see [[*Search Options in File Links]]), which will be resolved to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the appropriate location in the linked file. For example, once
published to HTML, the following links all point to a dedicated anchor
in =foo.html=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
[[file:foo.org::*heading]]
[[file:foo.org::#custom-id]]
[[file:foo.org::target]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Generating a sitemap
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Generating a list of all pages.
:ALT_TITLE: Site map
:END:
#+cindex: sitemap, of published pages
The following properties may be used to control publishing of
a map of files for a given project.
- ~:auto-sitemap~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When non-~nil~, publish a sitemap during
~org-publish-current-project~ or ~org-publish-all~.
- ~:sitemap-filename~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to =sitemap.org=, which
becomes =sitemap.html=.
- ~:sitemap-title~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
- ~:sitemap-format-entry~ ::
#+findex: org-publish-find-date
#+findex: org-publish-find-property
#+findex: org-publish-find-title
With this option one can tell how a site-map entry is formatted
in the site-map. It is a function called with three arguments:
the file or directory name relative to base directory of the
project, the site-map style and the current project. It is
expected to return a string. Default value turns file names into
links and use document titles as descriptions. For specific
formatting needs, one can use ~org-publish-find-date~,
~org-publish-find-title~ and ~org-publish-find-property~, to
retrieve additional information about published documents.
- ~:sitemap-function~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap. It is
called with two arguments: the title of the site-map and
a representation of the files and directories involved in the
project as a nested list, which can further be transformed using
~org-list-to-generic~, ~org-list-to-subtree~ and alike. Default
value generates a plain list of links to all files in the
project.
- ~:sitemap-sort-folders~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to ~first~
(default) or ~last~ to display folders first or last,
respectively. When set to ~ignore~, folders are ignored
altogether. Any other value mixes files and folders. This
variable has no effect when site-map style is ~tree~.
- ~:sitemap-sort-files~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
~alphabetically~ (default), ~chronologically~ or
~anti-chronologically~. ~chronologically~ sorts the files with
older date first while ~anti-chronologically~ sorts the files
with newer date first. ~alphabetically~ sorts the files
alphabetically. The date of a file is retrieved with
~org-publish-find-date~.
- ~:sitemap-ignore-case~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default ~nil~.
- ~:sitemap-file-entry-format~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted
in the sitemap. This is a format string with some escape
sequences: ~%t~ stands for the title of the file, ~%a~ stands for
the author of the file and ~%d~ stands for the date of the file.
The date is retrieved with the ~org-publish-find-date~ function
and formatted with ~org-publish-sitemap-date-format~. Default
~%t~.
- ~:sitemap-date-format~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Format string for the ~format-time-string~ function that tells
how a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property
bypasses ~org-publish-sitemap-date-format~ which defaults to
~%Y-%m-%d~.
*** Generating an index
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: An index that reaches across pages.
:END:
#+cindex: index, in a publishing project
Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
- ~:makeindex~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When non-~nil~, generate in index in the file =theindex.org= and
publish it as =theindex.html=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The file is created when first publishing a project with the
~:makeindex~ set. The file only contains a statement =#+INCLUDE:
"theindex.inc"=. You can then build around this include statement by
adding a title, style information, etc.
#+cindex: @samp{INDEX}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Index entries are specified with =INDEX= keyword. An entry that
contains an exclamation mark creates a sub item.
#+begin_example
,*** Curriculum Vitae
,#+INDEX: CV
,#+INDEX: Application!CV
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** Uploading Files
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to get files up on the server.
:END:
#+cindex: rsync
#+cindex: unison
For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Rsync or Unison, it might be preferable not to use the built-in remote
publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on Tramp. Tramp,
while very useful and powerful, tends not to be so efficient for
multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems under
heavy usage.
Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In
addition to timestamp comparison, they also do content and
permissions/attribute checks. For this reason you might prefer to
publish your web to a local directory---possibly even /in place/ with
your Org files---and then use Unison or Rsync to do the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
synchronization with the remote host.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Since Unison, for example, can be configured as to which files to
transfer to a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the
project publishing definition. Simply keep all files in the correct
location, process your Org files with ~org-publish~ and let the
synchronization tool do the rest. You do not need, in this scenario,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to include attachments such as JPG, CSS or PNG files in the project
definition since the third-party tool syncs them.
Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote
one, so that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects.
If you set ~org-publish-use-timestamps-flag~ to ~nil~, you gain the
main benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
example files you might include with =INCLUDE= keyword. The timestamp
mechanism in Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have
been modified.
** Sample Configuration
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Example projects.
:END:
Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is
a simple project publishing only a set of Org files. The second
example is more complex, with a multi-component project.
*** Example: simple publishing configuration
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: One-component publishing.
:ALT_TITLE: Simple example
:END:
This example publishes a set of Org files to the =public_html=
directory on the local machine.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-publish-project-alist
'(("org"
:base-directory "~/org/"
:publishing-directory "~/public_html"
:section-numbers nil
:table-of-contents nil
:style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
type=\"text/css\"/>")))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Example: complex publishing configuration
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: A multi-component publishing example.
:ALT_TITLE: Complex example
:END:
This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files
are excluded.
To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in =~/org/= and your
publishable images in =~/images/=, you would link to an image with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: file:../images/myimage.png
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the same.
You can accomplish this by setting up an =images/= folder in the right
place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-publish-project-alist
'(("orgfiles"
:base-directory "~/org/"
:base-extension "org"
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/notebook/"
:publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html
:exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
:headline-levels 3
:section-numbers nil
:with-toc nil
:html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
:html-preamble t)
("images"
:base-directory "~/images/"
:base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/images/"
:publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
("other"
:base-directory "~/other/"
:base-extension "css\\|el"
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/other/"
:publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
#+end_src
** Triggering Publication
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Publication commands.
:END:
Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e X)}}} (~org-publish~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e X
#+findex: org-publish
Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong
to it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e P)}}} (~org-publish-current-project~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e P
#+findex: org-publish-current-project
Publish the project containing the current file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e F)}}} (~org-publish-current-file~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e F
#+findex: org-publish-current-file
Publish only the current file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-e E)}}} (~org-publish-all~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-e E
#+findex: org-publish-all
Publish every project.
#+vindex: org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above
functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this
and force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
of the commands above, or by customizing the variable
~org-publish-use-timestamps-flag~. This may be necessary in
particular if files include other files via =SETUPFILE= or =INCLUDE=
keywords.
* Working with Source Code
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks.
:END:
#+cindex: source code, working with
Source code here refers to any plain text collection of computer
instructions, possibly with comments, written using a human-readable
programming language. Org can manage source code in an Org document
when the source code is identified with begin and end markers.
Working with source code begins with identifying source code blocks.
A source code block can be placed almost anywhere in an Org document;
it is not restricted to the preamble or the end of the document.
However, Org cannot manage a source code block if it is placed inside
an Org comment or within a fixed width section.
Here is an example source code block in the Emacs Lisp language:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
(defun org-xor (a b)
"Exclusive or."
(if a (not b) b))
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
Org can manage the source code in the block delimited by =#+BEGIN_SRC=
... =#+END_SRC= in several ways that can simplify housekeeping tasks
essential to modern source code maintenance. Org can edit, format,
extract, export, and publish source code blocks. Org can also compile
and execute a source code block, then capture the results. The Org
mode literature sometimes refers to source code blocks as /live code/
blocks because they can alter the content of the Org document or the
material that it exports. Users can control how live they want each
source code block by tweaking the header arguments (see [[*Using
Header Arguments]]) for compiling, execution, extraction, and
exporting.
Source code blocks are one of many Org block types, which also include
"center", "comment", "dynamic", "example", "export", "quote",
"special", and "verse". This section pertains to blocks between
=#+BEGIN_SRC= and =#+END_SRC=.
For editing and formatting a source code block, Org uses an
appropriate Emacs major mode that includes features specifically
designed for source code in that language.
Org can extract one or more source code blocks and write them to one
or more source files---a process known as /tangling/ in literate
programming terminology.
For exporting and publishing, Org's back-ends can format a source code
block appropriately, often with native syntax highlighting.
For executing and compiling a source code block, the user can
configure Org to select the appropriate compiler. Org provides
facilities to collect the result of the execution or compiler output,
insert it into the Org document, and/or export it. In addition to
text results, Org can insert links to other data types, including
audio, video, and graphics. Org can also link a compiler error
message to the appropriate line in the source code block.
An important feature of Org's management of source code blocks is the
ability to pass variables, functions, and results to one another using
a common syntax for source code blocks in any language. Although most
literate programming facilities are restricted to one language or
another, Org's language-agnostic approach lets the literate programmer
match each programming task with the appropriate computer language and
to mix them all together in a single Org document. This
interoperability among languages explains why Org's source code
management facility was named /Org Babel/ by its originators, Eric
Schulte and Dan Davison.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode fulfills the promise of easy verification and maintenance of
publishing reproducible research by keeping text, data, code,
configuration settings of the execution environment, the results of
the execution, and associated narratives, claims, references, and
internal and external links in a single Org document.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Details of Org's facilities for working with source code are described
in the following sections.
** Structure of Code Blocks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Code block syntax described.
:END:
#+cindex: code block, structure
#+cindex: source code, block structure
#+cindex: @samp{NAME} keyword, in source blocks
#+cindex: @samp{BEGIN_SRC}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org offers two ways to structure source code in Org documents: in
a source code block, and directly inline. Both specifications are
shown below.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A source code block conforms to this structure:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: <name>
,#+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
<body>
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not be put-off by having to remember the source block syntax. Org
mode offers a command for wrapping existing text in a block (see
[[*Structure Templates]]). Org also works with other completion systems
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
in Emacs, some of which predate Org and have custom domain-specific
languages for defining templates. Regular use of templates reduces
errors, increases accuracy, and maintains consistency.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: source code, inline
An inline code block conforms to this structure:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: src_<language>{<body>}
#+texinfo: @noindent
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: src_<language>[<header arguments>]{<body>}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =#+NAME: <name>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Optional. Names the source block so it can be called, like
a function, from other source blocks or inline code to evaluate
or to capture the results. Code from other blocks, other files,
and from table formulas (see [[*The Spreadsheet]]) can use the name
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to reference a source block. This naming serves the same purpose
as naming Org tables. Org mode requires unique names. For
duplicate names, Org mode's behavior is undefined.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =#+BEGIN_SRC= ... =#+END_SRC= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Mandatory. They mark the start and end of a block that Org
requires. The =#+BEGIN_SRC= line takes additional arguments, as
described next.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<language>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: language, in code blocks
Mandatory. It is the identifier of the source code language in
the block. See [[*Languages]], for identifiers of supported
languages.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<switches>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: switches, in code blocks
Optional. Switches provide finer control of the code execution,
export, and format (see the discussion of switches in [[*Literal
Examples]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<header arguments>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: header arguments, in code blocks
Optional. Heading arguments control many aspects of evaluation,
export and tangling of code blocks (see [[*Using Header Arguments]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Using Org's properties feature, header arguments can be
selectively applied to the entire buffer or specific sub-trees of
the Org document.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<body>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Source code in the dialect of the specified language identifier.
** Using Header Arguments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Different ways to set header arguments.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org comes with many header arguments common to all languages. New
header arguments are added for specific languages as they become
available for use in source code blocks. A header argument is
specified with an initial colon followed by the argument's name in
lowercase.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Since header arguments can be set in several ways, Org prioritizes
them in case of overlaps or conflicts by giving local settings
a higher priority. Header values in function calls, for example,
override header values from global defaults.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** System-wide header arguments
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+vindex: org-babel-default-header-args
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-babel-default-header-args
System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the ~org-babel-default-header-args~ variable, which defaults to the
following values:
#+begin_example
:session => "none"
:results => "replace"
:exports => "code"
:cache => "no"
:noweb => "no"
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The example below sets =:noweb= header arguments to =yes=, which makes
Org expand =:noweb= references by default.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-babel-default-header-args
(cons '(:noweb . "yes")
(assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: language specific default header arguments
#+cindex: default header arguments per language
Each language can have separate default header arguments by
customizing the variable ~org-babel-default-header-args:<LANG>~, where
{{{var(<LANG>)}}} is the name of the language. For details, see the
language-specific online documentation at
2018-01-19 12:27:57 -05:00
https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Header arguments in Org mode properties
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For header arguments applicable to the buffer, use =PROPERTY= keyword
anywhere in the Org file (see [[*Property Syntax]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following example makes all the R code blocks execute in the same
session. Setting =:results= to =silent= ignores the results of
executions for all blocks, not just R code blocks; no results inserted
for any block.
#+begin_example
,#+PROPERTY: header-args:R :session *R*
,#+PROPERTY: header-args :results silent
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-use-property-inheritance
Header arguments set through Org's property drawers (see [[*Property
Syntax]]) apply at the sub-tree level on down. Since these property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
drawers can appear anywhere in the file hierarchy, Org uses outermost
call or source block to resolve the values. Org ignores
~org-use-property-inheritance~ setting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In this example, =:cache= defaults to =yes= for all code blocks in the
sub-tree.
#+begin_example
,* sample header
:PROPERTIES:
:header-args: :cache yes
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x p
#+findex: org-set-property
Properties defined through ~org-set-property~ function, bound to
{{{kbd(C-c C-x p)}}}, apply to all active languages. They override
properties set in ~org-babel-default-header-args~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: language specific header arguments properties
#+cindex: header arguments per language
Language-specific header arguments are also read from properties
=header-args:<LANG>= where {{{var(<LANG>)}}} is the language
identifier. For example,
#+begin_example
,* Heading
:PROPERTIES:
:header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-1*
:header-args:R: :session *R*
:END:
,** Subheading
:PROPERTIES:
:header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-2*
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
would force separate sessions for Clojure blocks in =Heading= and
=Subheading=, but use the same session for all R blocks. Blocks in
=Subheading= inherit settings from =Heading=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Code block specific header arguments
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Header arguments are most commonly set at the source code block level,
on the =#+BEGIN_SRC= line. Arguments set at this level take
precedence over those set in the ~org-babel-default-header-args~
variable, and also those set as header properties.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In the following example, setting =:results= to =silent= makes it
ignore results of the code execution. Setting =:exports= to =code=
exports only the body of the code block to HTML or LaTeX.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: factorial
,#+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
fac 0 = 1
fac n = n * fac (n-1)
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The same header arguments in an inline code block:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: src_haskell[:exports both]{fac 5}
#+cindex: @samp{HEADER}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using =#+HEADER:=
on each line. Note that Org currently accepts the plural spelling of
=#+HEADER:= only as a convenience for backward-compatibility. It may
be removed at some point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Multi-line header arguments on an unnamed code block:
#+begin_example
,#+HEADER: :var data1=1
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
(message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
: data1:1, data2:2
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: named-block
,#+HEADER: :var data=2
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
(message "data:%S" data)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: named-block
: data:2
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Header arguments in function calls
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Header arguments in function calls are the most specific and override
all other settings in case of an overlap. They get the highest
priority. Two =#+CALL:= examples are shown below. For the complete
syntax of =CALL= keyword, see [[*Evaluating Code Blocks]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In this example, =:exports results= header argument is applied to the
evaluation of the =#+CALL:= line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In this example, =:session special= header argument is applied to the
evaluation of =factorial= code block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
** Environment of a Code Block
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Arguments, sessions, working directory...
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Passing arguments
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: passing arguments to code blocks
#+cindex: arguments, in code blocks
#+cindex: @samp{var}, header argument
Use =var= for passing arguments to source code blocks. The specifics
of variables in code blocks vary by the source language and are
covered in the language-specific documentation. The syntax for =var=,
however, is the same for all languages. This includes declaring
a variable, and assigning a default value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using
the =var= header argument.
: :var NAME=ASSIGN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
{{{var(NAME)}}} is the name of the variable bound in the code block
body. {{{var(ASSIGN)}}} is a literal value, such as a string,
a number, a reference to a table, a list, a literal example, another
code block---with or without arguments---or the results of evaluating
a code block.
Here are examples of passing values by reference:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- table ::
A table named with a =NAME= keyword.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: example-table
| 1 |
| 2 |
| 3 |
| 4 |
,#+NAME: table-length
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
(length table)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: table-length
: 4
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
When passing a table, you can treat specially the row, or the
column, containing labels for the columns, or the rows, in the
table.
#+cindex: @samp{colnames}, header argument
The =colnames= header argument accepts =yes=, =no=, or =nil=
values. The default value is =nil=: if an input table has column
names---because the second row is a horizontal rule---then Org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
removes the column names, processes the table, puts back the
column names, and then writes the table to the results block.
Using =yes=, Org does the same to the first row, even if the
initial table does not contain any horizontal rule. When set to
=no=, Org does not pre-process column names at all.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: less-cols
| a |
|---|
| b |
| c |
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols :colnames nil
return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| a |
|----|
| b* |
| c* |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+cindex: @samp{rownames}, header argument
Similarly, the =rownames= header argument can take two values:
=yes= or =no=. When set to =yes=, Org removes the first column,
processes the table, puts back the first column, and then writes
the table to the results block. The default is =no=, which means
Org does not pre-process the first column. Note that Emacs Lisp
code blocks ignore =rownames= header argument because of the ease
of table-handling in Emacs.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: with-rownames
| one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
| two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
| two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- list ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A simple named list.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: example-list
- simple
- not
- nested
- list
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
(print x)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| simple | list |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that only the top level list items are passed along. Nested
list items are ignored.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- code block without arguments ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A code block name, as assigned by =NAME= keyword from the example
above, optionally followed by parentheses.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
(* 2 length)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
: 8
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- code block with arguments ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A code block name, as assigned by =NAME= keyword, followed by
parentheses and optional arguments passed within the parentheses.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: double
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
(* 2 input)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: double
: 16
,#+NAME: squared
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
(* input input)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: squared
: 4
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- literal example ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A literal example block named with a =NAME= keyword.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: literal-example
,#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
A literal example
on two lines
,#+END_EXAMPLE
,#+NAME: read-literal-example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
(concatenate #'string x " for you.")
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: read-literal-example
: A literal example
: on two lines for you.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Indexing variable values enables referencing portions of a variable.
Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting backwards from the
end. If an index is separated by commas then each subsequent section
indexes as the next dimension. Note that this indexing occurs
/before/ other table-related header arguments are applied, such as
=hlines=, =colnames= and =rownames=. The following example assigns
the last cell of the first row the table =example-table= to the
variable =data=:
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: example-table
| 1 | a |
| 2 | b |
| 3 | c |
| 4 | d |
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
data
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
: a
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Two integers separated by a colon reference a range of variable
values. In that case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
example the following assigns the middle three rows of =example-table=
to =data=.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: example-table
| 1 | a |
| 2 | b |
| 3 | c |
| 4 | d |
| 5 | 3 |
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
data
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| 2 | b |
| 3 | c |
| 4 | d |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To pick the entire range, use an empty index, or the single character
=*=. =0:-1= does the same thing. Example below shows how to
reference the first column only.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: example-table
| 1 | a |
| 2 | b |
| 3 | c |
| 4 | d |
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
data
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Index referencing can be used for tables and code blocks. Index
referencing can handle any number of dimensions. Commas delimit
multiple dimensions, as shown below.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: 3D
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
'(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
,#+END_SRC
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
data
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| 11 | 14 | 17 |
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that row names and column names are not removed prior to variable
indexing. You need to take them into account, even when =colnames= or
=rownames= header arguments remove them.
Emacs lisp code can also set the values for variables. To
differentiate a value from Lisp code, Org interprets any value
starting with =(=, =[=, ='= or =`= as Emacs Lisp code. The result of
evaluating that code is then assigned to the value of that variable.
The following example shows how to reliably query and pass the file
name of the Org mode buffer to a code block using headers. We need
reliability here because the file's name could change once the code in
the block starts executing.
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
wc -w $filename
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that values read from tables and lists are not mistakenly
evaluated as Emacs Lisp code, as illustrated in the following example.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: table
| (a b c) |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2018-03-28 10:08:29 -04:00
,#+HEADER: :var data=table[0,0]
,#+BEGIN_SRC perl
$data
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
,#+RESULTS:
: (a b c)
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Using sessions
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: using sessions in code blocks
#+cindex: @samp{session}, header argument
Two code blocks can share the same environment. The =session= header
argument is for running multiple source code blocks under one session.
Org runs code blocks with the same session name in the same
interpreter process.
- =none= ::
Default. Each code block gets a new interpreter process to
execute. The process terminates once the block is evaluated.
- {{{var(STRING)}}} ::
Any string besides =none= turns that string into the name of that
session. For example, =:session STRING= names it =STRING=. If
=session= has no value, then the session name is derived from the
source language identifier. Subsequent blocks with the same
source code language use the same session. Depending on the
language, state variables, code from other blocks, and the
overall interpreted environment may be shared. Some interpreted
languages support concurrent sessions when subsequent source code
language blocks change session names.
Only languages that provide interactive evaluation can have session
support. Not all languages provide this support, such as C and ditaa.
Even languages, such as Python and Haskell, that do support
interactive evaluation impose limitations on allowable language
constructs that can run interactively. Org inherits those limitations
for those code blocks running in a session.
*** Choosing a working directory
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
#+cindex: working directory, in a code block
#+cindex: @samp{dir}, header argument
The =dir= header argument specifies the default directory during code
block execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with
the current buffer is used. In other words, supplying =:dir PATH=
temporarily has the same effect as changing the current directory with
{{{kbd(M-x cd PATH)}}}, and then not setting =dir=. Under the
surface, =dir= simply sets the value of the Emacs variable
~default-directory~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For example, to save the plot file in the =Work/= folder of the home
directory---notice tilde is expanded:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To evaluate the code block on a remote machine, supply a remote
directory name using Tramp syntax. For example:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu:
plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org first captures the text results as usual for insertion in the Org
file. Then Org also inserts a link to the remote file, thanks to
Emacs Tramp. Org constructs the remote path to the file name from
=dir= and ~default-directory~, as illustrated here:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[file:/scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When =dir= is used with =session=, Org sets the starting directory for
a new session. But Org does not alter the directory of an already
existing session.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not use =dir= with =:exports results= or with =:exports both= to
avoid Org inserting incorrect links to remote files. That is because
Org does not expand ~default directory~ to avoid some underlying
portability issues.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Inserting headers and footers
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: headers, in code blocks
#+cindex: footers, in code blocks
#+cindex: @samp{prologue}, header argument
The =prologue= header argument is for appending to the top of the code
block for execution, like a reset instruction. For example, you may
use =:prologue "reset"= in a Gnuplot code block or, for every such
block:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-to-list 'org-babel-default-header-args:gnuplot
'((:prologue . "reset")))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{epilogue}, header argument
Likewise, the value of the =epilogue= header argument is for appending
to the end of the code block for execution.
** Evaluating Code Blocks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Place results of evaluation in the Org buffer.
:END:
#+cindex: code block, evaluating
#+cindex: source code, evaluating
#+cindex: @samp{RESULTS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
A note about security: With code evaluation comes the risk of harm.
Org safeguards by prompting for user's permission before executing any
code in the source block. To customize this safeguard, or disable it,
see [[*Code Evaluation and Security Issues]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** How to evaluate source code
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org captures the results of the code block evaluation and inserts them
in the Org file, right after the code block. The insertion point is
after a newline and the =RESULTS= keyword. Org creates the =RESULTS=
keyword if one is not already there.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
By default, Org enables only Emacs Lisp code blocks for execution.
See [[*Languages]] to enable other languages.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+kindex: C-c C-v e
#+findex: org-babel-execute-src-block
Org provides many ways to execute code blocks. {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} or
{{{kbd(C-c C-v e)}}} with the point on a code block[fn:137] calls the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-babel-execute-src-block~ function, which executes the code in the
block, collects the results, and inserts them in the buffer.
#+cindex: @samp{CALL}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-babel-inline-result-wrap
By calling a named code block[fn:138] from an Org mode buffer or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a table. Org can call the named code blocks from the current Org mode
buffer or from the "Library of Babel" (see [[*Library of Babel]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The syntax for =CALL= keyword is:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
,#+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The syntax for inline named code blocks is:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When inline syntax is used, the result is wrapped based on the
variable ~org-babel-inline-result-wrap~, which by default is set to
~"=%s="~ to produce verbatim text suitable for markup.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<name>= ::
This is the name of the code block (see [[*Structure of Code
Blocks]]) to be evaluated in the current document. If the block is
located in another file, start =<name>= with the file name
followed by a colon. For example, in order to execute a block
named =clear-data= in =file.org=, you can write the following:
2018-01-22 14:53:29 -05:00
: #+CALL: file.org:clear-data()
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<arguments>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org passes arguments to the code block using standard function
call syntax. For example, a =#+CALL:= line that passes =4= to
a code block named =double=, which declares the header argument
=:var n=2=, would be written as:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+CALL: double(n=4)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
Note how this function call syntax is different from the header
argument syntax.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<inside header arguments>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org passes inside header arguments to the named code block using
the header argument syntax. Inside header arguments apply to
code block evaluation. For example, =[:results output]= collects
results printed to stdout during code execution of that block.
Note how this header argument syntax is different from the
function call syntax.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =<end header arguments>= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
End header arguments affect the results returned by the code
block. For example, =:results html= wraps the results in
a =#+BEGIN_EXPORT html= block before inserting the results in the
Org buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Limit code block evaluation
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{eval}, header argument
#+cindex: control code block evaluation
The =eval= header argument can limit evaluation of specific code
blocks and =CALL= keyword. It is useful for protection against
evaluating untrusted code blocks by prompting for a confirmation.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =never= or =no= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org never evaluates the source code.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =query= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate the source code.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =never-export= or =no-export= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org does not evaluate the source code when exporting, yet the
user can evaluate it interactively.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =query-export= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate the source code
during export.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If =eval= header argument is not set, then Org determines whether to
evaluate the source code from the ~org-confirm-babel-evaluate~
variable (see [[*Code Evaluation and Security Issues]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Cache results of evaluation
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{cache}, header argument
#+cindex: cache results of code evaluation
The =cache= header argument is for caching results of evaluating code
blocks. Caching results can avoid re-evaluating a code block that
have not changed since the previous run. To benefit from the cache
and avoid redundant evaluations, the source block must have a result
already present in the buffer, and neither the header
arguments---including the value of =var= references---nor the text of
the block itself has changed since the result was last computed. This
feature greatly helps avoid long-running calculations. For some edge
cases, however, the cached results may not be reliable.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The caching feature is best for when code blocks are pure functions,
that is functions that return the same value for the same input
arguments (see [[*Environment of a Code Block]]), and that do not have
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
side effects, and do not rely on external variables other than the
input arguments. Functions that depend on a timer, file system
objects, and random number generators are clearly unsuitable for
caching.
A note of warning: when =cache= is used in a session, caching may
cause unexpected results.
When the caching mechanism tests for any source code changes, it does
not expand Noweb style references (see [[*Noweb Reference Syntax]]). For
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
reasons why, see http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.emacs.orgmode/79046.
The =cache= header argument can have one of two values: =yes= or =no=.
- =no= ::
Default. No caching of results; code block evaluated every
time.
- =yes= ::
Whether to run the code or return the cached results is
determined by comparing the SHA1 hash value of the combined code
block and arguments passed to it. This hash value is packed on
the =#+RESULTS:= line from previous evaluation. When hash values
match, Org does not evaluate the code block. When hash values
mismatch, Org evaluates the code block, inserts the results,
recalculates the hash value, and updates =#+RESULTS:= line.
In this example, both functions are cached. But =caller= runs only if
the result from =random= has changed since the last run.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: random
,#+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
runif(1)
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
0.4659510825295
,#+NAME: caller
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
x
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
0.254227238707244
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** Results of Evaluation
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Choosing a results type, post-processing...
:END:
#+cindex: code block, results of evaluation
#+cindex: source code, results of evaluation
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{results}, header argument
How Org handles results of a code block execution depends on many
header arguments working together. The primary determinant, however,
is the =results= header argument. It accepts four classes of options.
Each code block can take only one option per class:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- collection ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For how the results should be collected from the code block;
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- type ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For which type of result the code block will return; affects how
Org processes and inserts results in the Org buffer;
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- format ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For the result; affects how Org processes and inserts results in
the Org buffer;
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- handling ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For processing results after evaluation of the code block;
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Collection
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Collection options specify the results. Choose one of the options;
they are mutually exclusive.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =value= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Default. Functional mode. Org gets the value by wrapping the
code in a function definition in the language of the source
block. That is why when using =:results value=, code should
execute like a function and return a value. For languages like
Python, an explicit ~return~ statement is mandatory when using
=:results value=. Result is the value returned by the last
statement in the code block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When evaluating the code block in a session (see [[*Environment of
a Code Block]]), Org passes the code to an interpreter running as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org gets the value from
the source code interpreter's last statement output. Org has to
use language-specific methods to obtain the value. For example,
from the variable ~_~ in Python and Ruby, and the value of
~.Last.value~ in R.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =output= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Scripting mode. Org passes the code to an external process
running the interpreter. Org returns the contents of the
standard output stream as text results.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When using a session, Org passes the code to the interpreter
running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org
concatenates any text output from the interpreter and returns the
collection as a result.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that this collection is not the same as that would be
collected from stdout of a non-interactive interpreter running as
an external process. Compare for example these two blocks:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
print "hello"
2
print "bye"
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
: hello
: bye
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In the above non-session mode, the "2" is not printed; so it does
not appear in results.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
print "hello"
2
print "bye"
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
: hello
: 2
: bye
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In the above session, the interactive interpreter receives and
prints "2". Results show that.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Type
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Type tells what result types to expect from the execution of the code
block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The
default behavior is to automatically determine the result type.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- =table=, =vector= ::
Interpret the results as an Org table. If the result is a single
value, create a table with one row and one column. Usage
example: =:results value table=.
#+cindex: @samp{hlines}, header argument
In-between each table row or below the table headings, sometimes
results have horizontal lines, which are also known as "hlines".
The =hlines= argument with the default =no= value strips such
lines from the input table. For most code, this is desirable, or
else those =hline= symbols raise unbound variable errors.
A =yes= accepts such lines, as demonstrated in the following
example.
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: many-cols
| a | b | c |
|---+---+---|
| d | e | f |
|---+---+---|
| g | h | i |
,#+NAME: no-hline
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines no
return tab
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: no-hline
| a | b | c |
| d | e | f |
| g | h | i |
,#+NAME: hlines
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
return tab
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS: hlines
| a | b | c |
|---+---+---|
| d | e | f |
|---+---+---|
| g | h | i |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
- =list= ::
Interpret the results as an Org list. If the result is a single
value, create a list of one element.
- =scalar=, =verbatim= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Interpret literally and insert as quoted text. Do not create
a table. Usage example: =:results value verbatim=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =file= ::
Interpret as a filename. Save the results of execution of the
code block to that file, then insert a link to it. You can
control both the filename and the description associated to the
link.
#+cindex: @samp{file}, header argument
#+cindex: @samp{output-dir}, header argument
Org first tries to generate the filename from the value of the
=file= header argument and the directory specified using the
=output-dir= header arguments. If =output-dir= is not specified,
Org assumes it is the current directory.
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC asymptote :results value file :file circle.pdf :output-dir img/
size(2cm);
draw(unitcircle);
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{file-ext}, header argument
If =file= is missing, Org generates the base name of the output
file from the name of the code block, and its extension from the
=file-ext= header argument. In that case, both the name and the
extension are mandatory[fn:139].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+name: circle
,#+BEGIN_SRC asymptote :results value file :file-ext pdf
size(2cm);
draw(unitcircle);
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{file-desc}, header argument
The =file-desc= header argument defines the description (see
[[*Link Format]]) for the link. If =file-desc= has no value, Org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
uses the generated file name for both the "link" and
"description" parts of the link.
#+cindex: @samp{sep}, header argument
By default, Org assumes that a table written to a file has
TAB-delimited output. You can choose a different separator with
the =sep= header argument.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Format
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Format pertains to the type of the result returned by the code block.
Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default
follows from the type specified above.
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- =code= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Result enclosed in a code block. Useful for parsing. Usage
example: =:results value code=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =drawer= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Result wrapped in a =RESULTS= drawer. Useful for containing
=raw= or =org= results for later scripting and automated
processing. Usage example: =:results value drawer=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =html= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Results enclosed in a =BEGIN_EXPORT html= block. Usage example:
=:results value html=.
- =latex= ::
Results enclosed in a =BEGIN_EXPORT latex= block. Usage example:
=:results value latex=.
- =link=, =graphics= ::
Result is a link to the file specified in =:file= header
argument. However, unlike plain =:file=, nothing is written to
the disk. The block is used for its side-effects only, as in the
following example:
#+begin_example
,#+begin_src shell :results link :file "download.tar.gz"
wget -c "http://example.com/download.tar.gz"
,#+end_src
#+end_example
- =org= ::
Results enclosed in a =BEGIN_SRC org= block. For comma-escape,
either {{{kbd(TAB)}}} in the block, or export the file. Usage
example: =:results value org=.
- =pp= ::
Result converted to pretty-print source code. Enclosed in a code
block. Languages supported: Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. Usage
example: =:results value pp=.
- =raw= ::
Interpreted as raw Org mode. Inserted directly into the buffer.
Aligned if it is a table. Usage example: =:results value raw=.
#+cindex: @samp{wrap}, header argument
The =wrap= header argument unconditionnally marks the results block by
appending strings to =#+BEGIN_= and =#+END_=. If no string is
specified, Org wraps the results in a =#+BEGIN_results=
... =#+END_results= block. It takes precedent over the =results=
value listed above. E.g.,
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :results html :wrap EXPORT markdown
"<blink>Welcome back to the 90's</blink>"
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
,#+BEGIN_EXPORT markdown
<blink>Welcome back to the 90's</blink>
,#+END_EXPORT
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Handling
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Handling options after collecting the results.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =silent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not insert results in the Org mode buffer, but echo them in
the minibuffer. Usage example: =:results output silent=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =replace= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Default. Insert results in the Org buffer. Remove previous
results. Usage example: =:results output replace=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =append= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Append results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the
bottom. Does not remove previous results. Usage example:
=:results output append=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =prepend= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prepend results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the
top. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: =:results
output prepend=.
*** Post-processing
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{post}, header argument
#+cindex: @samp{*this*}, in @samp{post} header argument
The =post= header argument is for post-processing results from block
evaluation. When =post= has any value, Org binds the results to
~*this*~ variable for easy passing to =var= header argument
specifications (see [[*Environment of a Code Block]]). That makes results
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
available to other code blocks, or even for direct Emacs Lisp code
execution.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following two examples illustrate =post= header argument in
action. The first one shows how to attach an =ATTR_LATEX= keyword
using =post=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: attr_wrap
,#+BEGIN_SRC sh :var data="" :var width="\\textwidth" :results output
echo "#+ATTR_LATEX: :width $width"
echo "$data"
,#+END_SRC
,#+HEADER: :file /tmp/it.png
,#+BEGIN_SRC dot :post attr_wrap(width="5cm", data=*this*) :results drawer
digraph{
a -> b;
b -> c;
c -> a;
}
,#+end_src
,#+RESULTS:
:RESULTS:
,#+ATTR_LATEX :width 5cm
[[file:/tmp/it.png]]
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The second example shows use of =colnames= header argument in =post=
to pass data between code blocks.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: round-tbl
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var tbl="" fmt="%.3f"
(mapcar (lambda (row)
(mapcar (lambda (cell)
(if (numberp cell)
(format fmt cell)
cell))
row))
tbl)
,#+end_src
,#+BEGIN_SRC R :colnames yes :post round-tbl[:colnames yes](*this*)
set.seed(42)
data.frame(foo=rnorm(1))
,#+END_SRC
,#+RESULTS:
| foo |
|-------|
| 1.371 |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
** Exporting Code Blocks
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:DESCRIPTION: Export contents and/or results.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: code block, exporting
#+cindex: source code, exporting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
It is possible to export the /code/ of code blocks, the /results/ of
code block evaluation, /both/ the code and the results of code block
evaluation, or /none/. Org defaults to exporting /code/ for most
languages. For some languages, such as ditaa, Org defaults to
/results/. To export just the body of code blocks, see [[*Literal
Examples]]. To selectively export sub-trees of an Org document, see
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[[*Exporting]].
#+cindex: @samp{exports}, header argument
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The =exports= header argument is to specify if that part of the Org
file is exported to, say, HTML or LaTeX formats.
- =code= ::
The default. The body of code is included into the exported
file. Example: =:exports code=.
- =results= ::
The results of evaluation of the code is included in the exported
file. Example: =:exports results=.
- =both= ::
Both the code and results of evaluation are included in the
exported file. Example: =:exports both=.
- =none= ::
Neither the code nor the results of evaluation is included in the
exported file. Whether the code is evaluated at all depends on
other options. Example: =:exports none=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-export-use-babel
To stop Org from evaluating code blocks to speed exports, use the
header argument =:eval never-export= (see [[*Evaluating Code Blocks]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To stop Org from evaluating code blocks for greater security, set the
~org-export-use-babel~ variable to ~nil~, but understand that header
arguments will have no effect.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Turning off evaluation comes in handy when batch processing. For
example, markup languages for wikis, which have a high risk of
untrusted code. Stopping code block evaluation also stops evaluation
of all header arguments of the code block. This may not be desirable
in some circumstances. So during export, to allow evaluation of just
the header arguments but not any code evaluation in the source block,
set =:eval never-export= (see [[*Evaluating Code Blocks]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org never evaluates code blocks in commented sub-trees when exporting
(see [[*Comment Lines]]). On the other hand, Org does evaluate code
blocks in sub-trees excluded from export (see [[*Export Settings]]).
** Extracting Source Code
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:DESCRIPTION: Create pure source code files.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: tangling
#+cindex: source code, extracting
#+cindex: code block, extracting source code
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Extracting source code from code blocks is a basic task in literate
programming. Org has features to make this easy. In literate
programming parlance, documents on creation are /woven/ with code and
documentation, and on export, the code is tangled for execution by
a computer. Org facilitates weaving and tangling for producing,
maintaining, sharing, and exporting literate programming documents.
Org provides extensive customization options for extracting source
code.
When Org tangles code blocks, it expands, merges, and transforms them.
Then Org recomposes them into one or more separate files, as
configured through the options. During this tangling process, Org
expands variables in the source code, and resolves any Noweb style
references (see [[*Noweb Reference Syntax]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Header arguments
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{tangle}, header argument
The =tangle= header argument specifies if the code block is exported
to source file(s).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =yes= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export the code block to source file. The file name for the
source file is derived from the name of the Org file, and the
file extension is derived from the source code language
identifier. Example: =:tangle yes=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =no= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The default. Do not extract the code in a source code file.
Example: =:tangle no=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{var(FILENAME)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Export the code block to source file whose file name is derived
from any string passed to the =tangle= header argument. Org
derives the file name as being relative to the directory of the
Org file's location. Example: =:tangle FILENAME=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{mkdirp}, header argument
The =mkdirp= header argument creates parent directories for tangled
files if the directory does not exist. =yes= enables directory
creation and =no= inhibits directory creation.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{comments}, header argument
The =comments= header argument controls inserting comments into
tangled files. These are above and beyond whatever comments may
already exist in the code block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =no= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The default. Do not insert any extra comments during tangling.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =link= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Wrap the code block in comments. Include links pointing back to
the place in the Org file from where the code was tangled.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =yes= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Kept for backward compatibility; same as =link=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =org= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Nearest headline text from Org file is inserted as comment. The
exact text that is inserted is picked from the leading context of
the source block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =both= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Includes both =link= and =org= options.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =noweb= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Includes =link= option, expands Noweb references (see [[*Noweb
Reference Syntax]]), and wraps them in link comments inside the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
body of the code block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{padline}, header argument
The =padline= header argument controls insertion of newlines to pad
source code in the tangled file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =yes= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Default. Insert a newline before and after each code block in
the tangled file.
- =no= ::
Do not insert newlines to pad the tangled code blocks.
#+cindex: @samp{shebang}, header argument
The =shebang= header argument can turn results into executable script
files. By setting it to a string value---for example, =:shebang
"#!/bin/bash"=---Org inserts that string as the first line of the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
tangled file that the code block is extracted to. Org then turns on
the tangled file's executable permission.
#+cindex: @samp{tangle-mode}, header argument
The =tangle-mode= header argument specifies what permissions to set
for tangled files by ~set-file-modes~. For example, to make
a read-only tangled file, use =:tangle-mode (identity #o444)=. To
make it executable, use =:tangle-mode (identity #o755)=. It also
overrides executable permission granted by =shebang=. When multiple
source code blocks tangle to a single file with different and
conflicting =tangle-mode= header arguments, Org's behavior is
undefined.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{no-expand}, header argument
By default Org expands code blocks during tangling. The =no-expand=
header argument turns off such expansions. Note that one side-effect
of expansion by ~org-babel-expand-src-block~ also assigns values (see
[[*Environment of a Code Block]]) to variables. Expansions also replace
Noweb references with their targets (see [[*Noweb Reference Syntax]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Some of these expansions may cause premature assignment, hence this
option. This option makes a difference only for tangling. It has no
effect when exporting since code blocks for execution have to be
expanded anyway.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Functions
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-babel-tangle~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-tangle
#+kindex: C-c C-v t
Tangle the current file. Bound to {{{kbd(C-c C-v t)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
With prefix argument only tangle the current code block.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-babel-tangle-file~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-tangle-file
#+kindex: C-c C-v f
Choose a file to tangle. Bound to {{{kbd(C-c C-v f)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Hooks
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-babel-post-tangle-hook~ ::
#+vindex: org-babel-post-tangle-hook
This hook is run from within code files tangled by
~org-babel-tangle~, making it suitable for post-processing,
compilation, and evaluation of code in the tangled files.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Jumping between code and Org
:PROPERTIES:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org
Debuggers normally link errors and messages back to the source code.
But for tangled files, we want to link back to the Org file, not to
the tangled source file. To make this extra jump, Org uses
~org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org~ function with two additional source
code block header arguments:
1. Set =padline= to true---this is the default setting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2. Set =comments= to =link=, which makes Org insert links to the Org
file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Languages
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: List of supported code block languages.
:END:
#+cindex: babel, languages
#+cindex: source code, languages
#+cindex: code block, languages
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.20 0.35 0.20 0.20
| Language | Identifier | Language | Identifier |
|------------+---------------+---------------+--------------|
| Asymptote | =asymptote= | Lua | =lua= |
| Awk | =awk= | MATLAB | =matlab= |
| C | =C= | Mscgen | =mscgen= |
| C++ | =C++=[fn:140] | OCaml | =ocaml= |
| Clojure | =clojure= | Octave | =octave= |
| CSS | =css= | Org mode | =org= |
| D | =D=[fn:141] | Oz | =oz= |
| ditaa | =ditaa= | Perl | =perl= |
| Emacs Calc | =calc= | Plantuml | =plantuml= |
| Emacs Lisp | =emacs-lisp= | Processing.js | =processing= |
| Fortran | =fortran= | Python | =python= |
| Gnuplot | =gnuplot= | R | =R= |
| GNU Screen | =screen= | Ruby | =ruby= |
| Graphviz | =dot= | Sass | =sass= |
| Haskell | =haskell= | Scheme | =scheme= |
| Java | =java= | Sed | =sed= |
| Javascript | =js= | shell | =sh= |
| LaTeX | =latex= | SQL | =sql= |
| Ledger | =ledger= | SQLite | =sqlite= |
| Lilypond | =lilypond= | Vala | =vala= |
| Lisp | =lisp= | | |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Additional documentation for some languages is at
https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-babel-load-languages
By default, only Emacs Lisp is enabled for evaluation. To enable or
disable other languages, customize the ~org-babel-load-languages~
variable either through the Emacs customization interface, or by
adding code to the init file as shown next.
In this example, evaluation is disabled for Emacs Lisp, and enabled
for R.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(org-babel-do-load-languages
'org-babel-load-languages
'((emacs-lisp . nil)
(R . t)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that this is not the only way to enable a language. Org also
enables languages when loaded with ~require~ statement. For example,
the following enables execution of Clojure code blocks:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(require 'ob-clojure)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
** Editing Source Code
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Language major-mode editing.
:END:
#+cindex: code block, editing
#+cindex: source code, editing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c '
Use {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} to edit the current code block. It opens a new
major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the source code block,
ready for any edits. Use {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} again to close the buffer
and return to the Org buffer.
#+kindex: C-x C-s
#+vindex: org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay
#+cindex: auto-save, in code block editing
{{{kbd(C-x C-s)}}} saves the buffer and updates the contents of the
Org buffer. Set ~org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay~ to save the base
buffer after a certain idle delay time. Set
~org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save~ to auto-save this buffer into
a separate file using Auto-save mode.
While editing the source code in the major mode, the Org Src minor
mode remains active. It provides these customization variables as
described below. For even more variables, look in the customization
group ~org-edit-structure~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-src-lang-modes~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-src-lang-modes
If an Emacs major-mode named ~<LANG>-mode~ exists, where
{{{var(<LANG>)}}} is the language identifier from code block's
header line, then the edit buffer uses that major mode. Use this
variable to arbitrarily map language identifiers to major modes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-src-window-setup~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-src-window-setup
For specifying Emacs window arrangement when the new edit buffer
is created.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-src-preserve-indentation~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: indentation, in code blocks
#+vindex: org-src-preserve-indentation
Default is ~nil~. Source code is indented. This indentation
applies during export or tangling, and depending on the context,
may alter leading spaces and tabs. When non-~nil~, source code
is aligned with the leftmost column. No lines are modified
during export or tangling, which is very useful for white-space
sensitive languages, such as Python.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
When ~nil~, Org returns to the edit buffer without further
prompts. The default prompts for a confirmation.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-src-fontify-natively
#+vindex: org-src-block-faces
Set ~org-src-fontify-natively~ to non-~nil~ to turn on native code
fontification in the /Org/ buffer. Fontification of code blocks can
give visual separation of text and code on the display page. To
further customize the appearance of ~org-block~ for specific
languages, customize ~org-src-block-faces~. The following example
shades the background of regular blocks, and colors source blocks only
for Python and Emacs Lisp languages.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(require 'color)
(set-face-attribute 'org-block nil :background
(color-darken-name
(face-attribute 'default :background) 3))
(setq org-src-block-faces '(("emacs-lisp" (:background "#EEE2FF"))
("python" (:background "#E5FFB8"))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
** Noweb Reference Syntax
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Literate programming in Org mode.
:END:
#+cindex: code block, Noweb reference
#+cindex: syntax, Noweb
#+cindex: source code, Noweb reference
Org supports named blocks in Noweb[fn:142] style syntax:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: <<CODE-BLOCK-ID>>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org can replace the construct with the source code, or the results of
evaluation, of the code block identified as {{{var(CODE-BLOCK-ID)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{noweb}, header argument
The =noweb= header argument controls expansion of Noweb syntax
references. Expansions occur when source code blocks are evaluated,
tangled, or exported.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =no= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Default. No expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of
the code when evaluating, tangling, or exporting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =yes= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code
block when evaluating, tangling, or exporting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =tangle= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code
block when tangling. No expansion when evaluating or exporting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =no-export= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code
block when evaluating or tangling. No expansion when exporting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =strip-export= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code
block when expanding prior to evaluating or tangling. Removes
Noweb syntax references when exporting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =eval= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code
block only before evaluating.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
In the following example,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: initialization
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
(setq sentence "Never a foot too far, even.")
,#+END_SRC
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :noweb yes
<<initialization>>
(reverse sentence)
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
the second code block is expanded as
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :noweb yes
(setq sentence "Never a foot too far, even.")
(reverse sentence)
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Noweb insertions honor prefix characters that appear before the Noweb
syntax reference. This behavior is illustrated in the following
example. Because the =<<example>>= Noweb reference appears behind the
SQL comment syntax, each line of the expanded Noweb reference is
commented. With:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: example
,#+BEGIN_SRC text
this is the
multi-line body of example
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
this code block:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes
---<<example>>
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
expands to:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes
---this is the
---multi-line body of example
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Since this change does not affect Noweb replacement text without
newlines in them, inline Noweb references are acceptable.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This feature can also be used for management of indentation in
exported code snippets. With:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: if-true
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none
print('do things when true')
,#+end_src
,#+name: if-false
,#+begin_src python :exports none
print('do things when false')
,#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
this code block:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+begin_src python :noweb yes :results output
if true:
<<if-true>>
else:
<<if-false>>
,#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
expands to:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
if true:
print('do things when true')
else:
print('do things when false')
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{noweb-ref}, header argument
When expanding Noweb style references, Org concatenates code blocks by
matching the reference name to either the code block name or, if none
is found, to the =noweb-ref= header argument.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For simple concatenation, set this =noweb-ref= header argument at the
sub-tree or file level. In the example Org file shown next, the body
of the source code in each block is extracted for concatenation to
a pure code file when tangled.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
<<fullest-disk>>
,#+END_SRC
,* the mount point of the fullest disk
:PROPERTIES:
:header-args: :noweb-ref fullest-disk
:END:
,** query all mounted disks
,#+BEGIN_SRC sh
df \
,#+END_SRC
,** strip the header row
,#+BEGIN_SRC sh
|sed '1d' \
,#+END_SRC
,** output mount point of fullest disk
,#+BEGIN_SRC sh
|awk '{if (u < +$5) {u = +$5; m = $6}} END {print m}'
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @samp{noweb-sep}, header argument
By default a newline separates each noweb reference concatenation. To
change this newline separator, edit the =noweb-sep= header argument.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Eventually, Org can include the results of a code block rather than
its body. To that effect, append parentheses, possibly including
arguments, to the code block name, as shown below.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that when using the above approach to a code block's results, the
code block name set by =NAME= keyword is required; the reference set
by =noweb-ref= does not work in that case.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Here is an example that demonstrates how the exported content changes
when Noweb style references are used with parentheses versus without.
With:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+NAME: some-code
,#+BEGIN_SRC python :var num=0 :results output :exports none
print(num*10)
,#+END_SRC
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
this code block:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes
<<some-code>>
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
expands to:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: print(num*10)
Below, a similar Noweb style reference is used, but with parentheses,
while setting a variable =num= to 10:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes
<<some-code(num=10)>>
,#+END_SRC
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
Note that now the expansion contains the results of the code block
=some-code=, not the code block itself:
: 100
** Library of Babel
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks.
:END:
#+cindex: babel, library of
#+cindex: source code, library
#+cindex: code block, library
The "Library of Babel" is a collection of code blocks. Like
a function library, these code blocks can be called from other Org
files. A collection of useful code blocks is available on [[https://orgmode.org/worg/library-of-babel.html][Worg]]. For
remote code block evaluation syntax, see [[*Evaluating Code Blocks]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-v i
#+findex: org-babel-lob-ingest
For any user to add code to the library, first save the code in
regular code blocks of an Org file, and then load the Org file with
~org-babel-lob-ingest~, which is bound to {{{kbd(C-c C-v i)}}}.
** Key bindings and Useful Functions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Work quickly with code blocks.
:END:
#+cindex: code block, key bindings
Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
the context.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Active key bindings in code blocks:
#+kindex: C-c C-c
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-execute-src-block
#+kindex: C-c C-o
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-open-src-block-result
#+kindex: M-UP
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-load-in-session
#+kindex: M-DOWN
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-pop-to-session
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.2 0.55
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| Key binding | Function |
|--------------------+-----------------------------------|
| {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} | ~org-babel-execute-src-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-o)}}} | ~org-babel-open-src-block-result~ |
| {{{kbd(M-UP)}}} | ~org-babel-load-in-session~ |
| {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} | ~org-babel-pop-to-session~ |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Active key bindings in Org mode buffer:
#+kindex: C-c C-v p
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-p
#+kindex: C-c C-v n
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-n
#+kindex: C-c C-v e
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-e
#+kindex: C-c C-v o
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-o
#+kindex: C-c C-v v
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-v
#+kindex: C-c C-v u
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-u
#+kindex: C-c C-v g
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-g
#+kindex: C-c C-v r
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-r
#+kindex: C-c C-v b
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-b
#+kindex: C-c C-v s
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-s
#+kindex: C-c C-v d
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-d
#+kindex: C-c C-v t
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-t
#+kindex: C-c C-v f
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-f
#+kindex: C-c C-v c
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-c
#+kindex: C-c C-v j
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-j
#+kindex: C-c C-v l
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-l
#+kindex: C-c C-v i
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-i
#+kindex: C-c C-v I
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-I
#+kindex: C-c C-v z
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-z
#+kindex: C-c C-v a
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-a
#+kindex: C-c C-v h
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-h
#+kindex: C-c C-v x
#+kindex: C-c C-v C-x
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-babel-previous-src-block
#+findex: org-babel-next-src-block
#+findex: org-babel-execute-maybe
#+findex: org-babel-open-src-block-result
#+findex: org-babel-expand-src-block
#+findex: org-babel-goto-src-block-head
#+findex: org-babel-goto-named-src-block
#+findex: org-babel-goto-named-result
#+findex: org-babel-execute-buffer
#+findex: org-babel-execute-subtree
#+findex: org-babel-demarcate-block
#+findex: org-babel-tangle
#+findex: org-babel-tangle-file
#+findex: org-babel-check-src-block
#+findex: org-babel-insert-header-arg
#+findex: org-babel-load-in-session
#+findex: org-babel-lob-ingest
#+findex: org-babel-view-src-block-info
#+findex: org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code
#+findex: org-babel-sha1-hash
#+findex: org-babel-describe-bindings
#+findex: org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.45 0.55
| Key binding | Function |
|------------------------------------------------+--------------------------------------------|
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v p)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-p)}}} | ~org-babel-previous-src-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v n)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-n)}}} | ~org-babel-next-src-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v e)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-e)}}} | ~org-babel-execute-maybe~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v o)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-o)}}} | ~org-babel-open-src-block-result~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v v)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-v)}}} | ~org-babel-expand-src-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v u)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-u)}}} | ~org-babel-goto-src-block-head~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v g)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-g)}}} | ~org-babel-goto-named-src-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v r)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-r)}}} | ~org-babel-goto-named-result~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v b)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-b)}}} | ~org-babel-execute-buffer~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v s)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-s)}}} | ~org-babel-execute-subtree~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v d)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-d)}}} | ~org-babel-demarcate-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v t)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-t)}}} | ~org-babel-tangle~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v f)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-f)}}} | ~org-babel-tangle-file~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v c)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-c)}}} | ~org-babel-check-src-block~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v j)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-j)}}} | ~org-babel-insert-header-arg~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v l)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-l)}}} | ~org-babel-load-in-session~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v i)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-i)}}} | ~org-babel-lob-ingest~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v I)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-I)}}} | ~org-babel-view-src-block-info~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v z)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-z)}}} | ~org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v a)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-a)}}} | ~org-babel-sha1-hash~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v h)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-h)}}} | ~org-babel-describe-bindings~ |
| {{{kbd(C-c C-v x)}}} or {{{kbd(C-c C-v C-x)}}} | ~org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer~ |
** Batch Execution
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Call functions from the command line.
:END:
#+cindex: code block, batch execution
#+cindex: source code, batch execution
Org mode features, including working with source code facilities can
be invoked from the command line. This enables building shell scripts
for batch processing, running automated system tasks, and expanding
Org mode's usefulness.
The sample script shows batch processing of multiple files using
~org-babel-tangle~.
#+begin_example
#!/bin/sh
# Tangle files with Org mode
#
emacs -Q --batch --eval "
(progn
(require 'ob-tangle)
(dolist (file command-line-args-left)
(with-current-buffer (find-file-noselect file)
(org-babel-tangle))))
" "$@"
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
* Miscellaneous
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere.
:END:
** Completion
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: M-@key{TAB} guesses completions.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: completion, of @TeX{} symbols
#+cindex: completion, of TODO keywords
#+cindex: completion, of dictionary words
#+cindex: completion, of option keywords
#+cindex: completion, of tags
#+cindex: completion, of property keys
#+cindex: completion, of link abbreviations
#+cindex: @TeX{} symbol completion
#+cindex: TODO keywords completion
#+cindex: dictionary word completion
#+cindex: option keyword completion
#+cindex: tag completion
#+cindex: link abbreviations, completion of
Org has in-buffer completions. Unlike minibuffer completions, which
are useful for quick command interactions, Org's in-buffer completions
are more suitable for content creation in Org documents. Type one or
more letters and invoke the hot key to complete the text in-place.
Depending on the context and the keys, Org offers different types of
completions. No minibuffer is involved. Such mode-specific hot keys
have become an integral part of Emacs and Org provides several
shortcuts.
- {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} ::
#+kindex: M-TAB
Complete word at point.
- At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
- After =\=, complete TeX symbols supported by the exporter.
- After =*=, complete headlines in the current buffer so that
they can be used in search links like:
: [[*find this headline]]
- After =:= in a headline, complete tags. Org deduces the list
of tags from the =TAGS= in-buffer option (see [[*Setting Tags]]),
the variable ~org-tag-alist~, or from all tags used in the
current buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- After =:= and not in a headline, complete property keys. The
list of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in
the current buffer.
- After =[=, complete link abbreviations (see [[*Link
Abbreviations]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- After =#+=, complete the special keywords like =TYP_TODO= or
file-specific =OPTIONS=. After option keyword is complete,
pressing {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} again inserts example settings for
this keyword.
- After =STARTUP= keyword, complete startup items.
- When point is anywhere else, complete dictionary words using
Ispell.
** Structure Templates
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Quick insertion of structural elements.
:END:
#+cindex: template insertion
#+cindex: insertion, of templates
With just a few keystrokes, it is possible to insert empty structural
blocks, such as =#+BEGIN_SRC= ... =#+END_SRC=, or to wrap existing
text in such a block.
- {{{kbd(C-c C-\,)}}} (~org-insert-structure-template~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-insert-structure-template
#+kindex: C-c C-,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Prompt for a type of block structure, and insert the block at
point. If the region is active, it is wrapped in the block.
First prompts the user for keys, which are used to look up
a structure type from the variable below. If the key is
{{{kbd(TAB)}}}, {{{kbd(RET)}}}, or {{{kbd(SPC)}}}, the user is
prompted to enter a block type.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-structure-template-alist
Available structure types are defined in
~org-structure-template-alist~, see the docstring for adding or
changing values.
#+cindex: Tempo
#+cindex: template expansion
#+cindex: insertion, of templates
#+vindex: org-tempo-keywords-alist
Org Tempo expands snippets to structures defined in
~org-structure-template-alist~ and ~org-tempo-keywords-alist~. For
example, {{{kbd(< s TAB)}}} creates a code block. Enable it by
customizing ~org-modules~ or add =(require 'org-tempo)= to your Emacs
init file[fn:143].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.1 0.9
| {{{kbd(a)}}} | =#+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii= ... =#+END_EXPORT= |
| {{{kbd(c)}}} | =#+BEGIN_CENTER= ... =#+END_CENTER= |
| {{{kbd(C)}}} | =#+BEGIN_COMMENT= ... =#+END_COMMENT= |
| {{{kbd(e)}}} | =#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE= ... =#+END_EXAMPLE= |
| {{{kbd(E)}}} | =#+BEGIN_EXPORT= ... =#+END_EXPORT= |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| {{{kbd(h)}}} | =#+BEGIN_EXPORT html= ... =#+END_EXPORT= |
| {{{kbd(l)}}} | =#+BEGIN_EXPORT latex= ... =#+END_EXPORT= |
| {{{kbd(q)}}} | =#+BEGIN_QUOTE= ... =#+END_QUOTE= |
| {{{kbd(s)}}} | =#+BEGIN_SRC= ... =#+END_SRC= |
| {{{kbd(v)}}} | =#+BEGIN_VERSE= ... =#+END_VERSE= |
** Escape Character
#+cindex: escape character
#+cindex: zero width space
You may sometimes want to write text that looks like Org syntax, but
should really read as plain text. Org may use a specific escape
character in some situations, e.g., a backslash in macros (see [[*Macro
Replacement]]). In the general case, however, we suggest to use the
zero width space. You can get it with one of the following:
: C-x 8 <RET> zero width space <RET>
: C-x 8 <RET> 200B <RET>
For example, in order to write =[[1,2]]= as-is in your document, you can
write this, where =X= denotes the zero width space character:
: [[X1,2]]
** Speed Keys
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline.
:END:
#+cindex: speed keys
Single keystrokes can execute custom commands in an Org file when
point is on a headline. Without the extra burden of a meta or
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
modifier key, Speed Keys can speed navigation or execute custom
commands. Besides faster navigation, Speed Keys may come in handy on
small mobile devices that do not have full keyboards. Speed Keys may
also work on TTY devices known for their problems when entering Emacs
key chords.
#+vindex: org-use-speed-commands
By default, Org has Speed Keys disabled. To activate Speed Keys, set
the variable ~org-use-speed-commands~ to a non-~nil~ value. To
trigger a Speed Key, point must be at the beginning of an Org
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
headline, before any of the stars.
#+vindex: org-speed-commands-user
#+findex: org-speed-command-help
Org comes with a pre-defined list of Speed Keys. To add or modify
Speed Keys, customize the variable, ~org-speed-commands-user~. For
more details, see the variable's docstring. With Speed Keys
activated, {{{kbd(M-x org-speed-command-help)}}}, or {{{kbd(?)}}} when
point is at the beginning of an Org headline, shows currently active
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Speed Keys, including the user-defined ones.
** Code Evaluation and Security Issues
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Org files evaluate in-line code.
:ALT_TITLE: Code Evaluation Security
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
Unlike plain text, running code comes with risk. Each source code
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
block, in terms of risk, is equivalent to an executable file. Org
therefore puts a few confirmation prompts by default. This is to
alert the casual user from accidentally running untrusted code.
For users who do not run code blocks or write code regularly, Org's
default settings should suffice. However, some users may want to
tweak the prompts for fewer interruptions. To weigh the risks of
automatic execution of code blocks, here are some details about code
evaluation.
Org evaluates code in the following circumstances:
- /Source code blocks/ ::
Org evaluates source code blocks in an Org file during export.
Org also evaluates a source code block with the {{{kbd(C-c
C-c)}}} key chord. Users exporting or running code blocks must
load files only from trusted sources. Be wary of customizing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
variables that remove or alter default security measures.
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-confirm-babel-evaluate
#+begin_defopt
When ~t~, Org prompts the user for confirmation before executing
each code block. When ~nil~, Org executes code blocks without
prompting the user for confirmation. When this option is set to
a custom function, Org invokes the function with these two
arguments: the source code language and the body of the code
block. The custom function must return either a ~t~ or ~nil~,
which determines if the user is prompted. Each source code
language can be handled separately through this function
argument.
#+end_defopt
For example, here is how to execute ditaa code blocks without
prompting:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
(not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ;don't ask for ditaa
(setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate #'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
- /Following =shell= and =elisp= links/ ::
Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (see
[[*External Links]]). Because such code is not visible, these links
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
have a potential risk. Org therefore prompts the user when it
encounters such links. The customization variables are:
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-confirm-shell-link-function
#+begin_defopt
Function that prompts the user before executing a shell link.
#+end_defopt
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-confirm-elisp-link-function
#+begin_defopt
Function that prompts the user before executing an Emacs Lisp link.
#+end_defopt
- /Formulas in tables/ ::
Formulas in tables (see [[*The Spreadsheet]]) are code that is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
evaluated either by the Calc interpreter, or by the Emacs Lisp
interpreter.
** Customization
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Adapting Org to your taste.
:END:
#+cindex: customization
#+cindex: options, for customization
#+cindex: variables, for customization
Org has more than 500 variables for customization. They can be
accessed through the usual {{{kbd(M-x org-customize)}}} command. Or
through the Org menu: Org \rarr Customization \rarr Browse Org Group.
Org also has per-file settings for some variables (see [[*Summary of
In-Buffer Settings]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Summary of In-Buffer Settings
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Overview of keywords.
:ALT_TITLE: In-buffer Settings
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: in-buffer settings
#+cindex: special keywords
In-buffer settings start with =#+=, followed by a keyword, a colon,
and then a word for each setting. Org accepts multiple settings on
the same line. Org also accepts multiple lines for a keyword. This
manual describes these settings throughout. A summary follows here.
#+cindex: refresh set-up
{{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} activates any changes to the in-buffer settings.
Closing and reopening the Org file in Emacs also activates the
changes.
#+attr_texinfo: :sep ,
- =#+ARCHIVE: %s_done= ::
#+cindex: @samp{ARCHIVE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-archive-location
Sets the archive location of the agenda file. The corresponding
variable is ~org-archive-location~.
- =#+CATEGORY= ::
#+cindex: @samp{CATEGORY}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Sets the category of the agenda file, which applies to the entire
document.
- =#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM ...= ::
#+cindex: @samp{COLUMNS}, property
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set the default format for columns view. This format applies
when columns view is invoked in locations where no =COLUMNS=
property applies.
- =#+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...= ::
#+cindex: @samp{CONSTANTS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-table-formula-constants
#+vindex: org-table-formula
Set file-local values for constants that table formulas can use.
This line sets the local variable
~org-table-formula-constants-local~. The global version of this
variable is ~org-table-formula-constants~.
- =#+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:= ::
#+cindex: @samp{FILETAGS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set tags that all entries in the file inherit from, including the
top-level entries.
- =#+LINK: linkword replace= ::
#+cindex: @samp{LINK}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-link-abbrev-alist
Each line specifies one abbreviation for one link. Use multiple
=LINK= keywords for more, see [[*Link Abbreviations]]. The
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
corresponding variable is ~org-link-abbrev-alist~.
- =#+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default= ::
#+cindex: @samp{PRIORITIES}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-highest-priority
#+vindex: org-lowest-priority
#+vindex: org-default-priority
This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities.
All three must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The
highest priority must have a lower ASCII number than the lowest
priority.
- =#+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value= ::
#+cindex: @samp{PROPERTY}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the
current buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of
a property.
- =#+SETUPFILE: file= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SETUPFILE}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The setup file or a URL pointing to such file is for additional
in-buffer settings. Org loads this file and parses it for any
settings in it only when Org opens the main file. If URL is
specified, the contents are downloaded and stored in a temporary
file cache. {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} on the settings line parses and
loads the file, and also resets the temporary file cache. Org
also parses and loads the document during normal exporting
process. Org parses the contents of this document as if it was
included in the buffer. It can be another Org file. To visit
the file---not a URL---use {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} while point is on the
line with the file name.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =#+STARTUP:= ::
#+cindex: @samp{STARTUP}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Startup options Org uses when first visiting a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-folded
The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the
outline tree. The corresponding variable for global default
settings is ~org-startup-folded~ with a default value of ~t~,
which is the same as ~overview~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =overview= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Top-level headlines only.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =content= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
All headlines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =showall= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
No folding on any entry.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =showeverything= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Show even drawer contents.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-indented
Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
~org-startup-indented~[fn:144].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =indent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Start with ~org-indent-mode~ turned on.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =noindent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Start with ~org-indent-mode~ turned off.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-align-all-tables
Aligns tables consistently upon visiting a file. The corresponding
variable is ~org-startup-align-all-tables~ with ~nil~ as default
value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =align= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Align all tables.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =noalign= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not align tables on startup.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-shrink-all-tables
Shrink table columns with a width cookie. The corresponding
variable is ~org-startup-shrink-all-tables~ with ~nil~ as default
value.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-with-inline-images
When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed.
The corresponding variable is ~org-startup-with-inline-images~,
with a default value ~nil~ to avoid delays when visiting a file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =inlineimages= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Show inline images.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =noinlineimages= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not show inline images on startup.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-log-done
#+vindex: org-log-note-clock-out
#+vindex: org-log-repeat
Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock
intervals can be configured using these options (see variables
~org-log-done~, ~org-log-note-clock-out~, and ~org-log-repeat~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =logdone= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =lognotedone= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record timestamp and a note when DONE.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nologdone= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not record when items are marked DONE.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =logrepeat= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a time when reinstating a repeating item.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =lognoterepeat= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a note when reinstating a repeating item.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nologrepeat= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not record when reinstating repeating item.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =lognoteclock-out= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a note when clocking out.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nolognoteclock-out= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not record a note when clocking out.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =logreschedule= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a timestamp when scheduling time changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =lognotereschedule= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a note when scheduling time changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nologreschedule= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not record when a scheduling date changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =logredeadline= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a timestamp when deadline changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =lognoteredeadline= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a note when deadline changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nologredeadline= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not record when a deadline date changes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =logrefile= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a timestamp when refiling.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =lognoterefile= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Record a note when refiling.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =nologrefile= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Do not record when refiling.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-hide-leading-stars
#+vindex: org-odd-levels-only
Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings,
and for indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
~org-hide-leading-stars~ and ~org-odd-levels-only~, both with
a default setting ~nil~ (meaning =showstars= and =oddeven=).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =hidestars= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =showstars= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Show all stars starting a headline.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =indent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Virtual indentation according to outline level.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =noindent= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
No virtual indentation according to outline level.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =odd= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Allow only odd outline levels (1, 3, ...).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =oddeven= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Allow all outline levels.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-put-time-stamp-overlays
#+vindex: org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
~org-put-time-stamp-overlays~ and ~org-time-stamp-overlay-formats~),
use:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =customtime= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Overlay custom time format.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: constants-unit-system
The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
~constants-unit-system~).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =constcgs= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=constants.el= should use the c-g-s unit system.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =constSI= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=constants.el= should use the SI unit system.
#+vindex: org-footnote-define-inline
#+vindex: org-footnote-auto-label
#+vindex: org-footnote-auto-adjust
To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
corresponding variables are ~org-footnote-define-inline~,
~org-footnote-auto-label~, and ~org-footnote-auto-adjust~.
- =fninline= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Define footnotes inline.
- =fnnoinline= ::
Define footnotes in separate section.
- =fnlocal= ::
Define footnotes near first reference, but not inline.
- =fnprompt= ::
Prompt for footnote labels.
- =fnauto= ::
Create =[fn:1]=-like labels automatically (default).
- =fnconfirm= ::
Offer automatic label for editing or confirmation.
- =fnadjust= ::
Automatically renumber and sort footnotes.
- =nofnadjust= ::
Do not renumber and sort automatically.
#+vindex: org-hide-block-startup
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding
variable is ~org-hide-block-startup~.
- =hideblocks= ::
Hide all begin/end blocks on startup.
- =nohideblocks= ::
Do not hide blocks on startup.
#+vindex: org-pretty-entities
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the
variable ~org-pretty-entities~ and the keywords
- =entitiespretty= ::
Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible.
- =entitiesplain= ::
Leave entities plain.
- =#+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)= ::
#+cindex: @samp{TAGS}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-tag-alist
These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid
tags in this file, and (potentially) the corresponding /fast tag
selection/ keys. The corresponding variable is ~org-tag-alist~.
- =#+TODO:=, =#+SEQ_TODO:=, =#+TYP_TODO:= ::
#+cindex: @samp{SEQ_TODO}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{TODO}, keyword
#+cindex: @samp{TYP_TODO}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-todo-keywords
These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
current file. The corresponding variable is ~org-todo-keywords~.
** The Very Busy {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} Key
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: When in doubt, press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
:END:
#+kindex: C-c C-c
#+cindex: @kbd{C-c C-c}, overview
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} key in Org serves many purposes depending on
the context. It is probably the most over-worked, multi-purpose key
combination in Org. Its uses are well documented throughout this
manual, but here is a consolidated list for easy reference.
- If any highlights shown in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
tree, or from clock display, remove such highlights.
- If point is in one of the special =KEYWORD= lines, scan the buffer
for these lines and update the information. Also reset the Org file
cache used to temporary store the contents of URLs used as values
for keywords like =SETUPFILE=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is inside a table, realign the table. The table realigns
even if automatic table editor is turned off.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is on a =TBLFM= keyword, re-apply the formulas to the
entire table.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
it. With a prefix argument, also jump to the target location after
saving the note.
- If point is on a =<<<target>>>=, update radio targets and
corresponding links in this buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is on a property line or at the start or end of a property
drawer, offer property commands.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
definition, and /vice versa/.
- If point is on a statistics cookie, update it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
of the checkbox.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the ordered
list.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is on the =#+BEGIN= line of a dynamic block, the block is
updated.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- If point is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
** A Cleaner Outline View
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline.
:ALT_TITLE: Clean View
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: hiding leading stars
#+cindex: dynamic indentation
#+cindex: odd-levels-only outlines
#+cindex: clean outline view
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org's default outline with stars and no indents can become too
cluttered for short documents. For /book-like/ long documents, the
effect is not as noticeable. Org provides an alternate stars and
indentation scheme, as shown on the right in the following table. It
uses only one star and indents text to line with the heading:
#+begin_example
,* Top level headline | * Top level headline
,** Second level | * Second level
,*** Third level | * Third level
some text | some text
,*** Third level | * Third level
more text | more text
,* Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: Indent mode
#+findex: org-indent-mode
To turn this mode on, use the minor mode, ~org-indent-mode~. Text
lines that are not headlines are prefixed with spaces to vertically
align with the headline text[fn:145].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-indent-indentation-per-level
To make more horizontal space, the headlines are shifted by two stars.
This can be configured by the ~org-indent-indentation-per-level~
variable. Only one star on each headline is visible, the rest are
masked with the same font color as the background.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that turning on ~org-indent-mode~ sets ~org-hide-leading-stars~
to ~t~ and ~org-adapt-indentation~ to ~nil~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-startup-indented
To globally turn on ~org-indent-mode~ for all files, customize the
variable ~org-startup-indented~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To turn on indenting for individual files, use =STARTUP= keyword as
follows:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+STARTUP: indent
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Indent on startup makes Org use hard spaces to align text with
headings as shown in examples below.
- /Indentation of text below headlines/ ::
Indent text to align with the headline.
#+begin_example
,*** Third level
more text, now indented
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+vindex: org-adapt-indentation
Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and
structure editing, preserving or adapting the indentation as
appropriate[fn:146].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Hiding leading stars/ ::
#+vindex: org-hide-leading-stars
Org can make leading stars invisible. For global preference,
configure the variable ~org-hide-leading-stars~. For per-file
preference, use these file =STARTUP= options:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+STARTUP: hidestars
,#+STARTUP: showstars
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
With stars hidden, the tree is shown as:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,* Top level headline
,* Second level
,* Third level
...
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-hide, face
Because Org makes the font color the same as the background color
to hide to stars, sometimes ~org-hide~ face may need tweaking to
get the effect right. For some black and white combinations,
~grey90~ on a white background might mask the stars better.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- /Odd levels/ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-odd-levels-only
Using stars for only odd levels, 1, 3, 5, ..., can also clean up
the clutter. This removes two stars from each level[fn:147].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For Org to properly handle this cleaner structure during edits
and exports, configure the variable ~org-odd-levels-only~. To
set this per-file, use either one of the following lines:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
,#+STARTUP: odd
,#+STARTUP: oddeven
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To switch between single and double stars layouts, use {{{kbd(M-x
org-convert-to-odd-levels)}}} and {{{kbd(M-x
org-convert-to-oddeven-levels)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Using Org on a TTY
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Using Org on a tty.
:ALT_TITLE: TTY Keys
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: tty key bindings
Org provides alternative key bindings for TTY and modern mobile
devices that cannot perform movement commands on point and key
bindings with modifier keys. Some of these workarounds may be more
cumbersome than necessary. Users should look into customizing these
further based on their usage needs. For example, the normal
{{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}} for editing timestamp might be better with
{{{kbd(C-c .)}}} chord.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2018-03-28 08:27:32 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.2 0.28 0.15 0.21
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| Default | Alternative 1 | Speed key | Alternative 2 |
|----------------------+--------------------------+--------------+----------------------|
| {{{kbd(S-TAB)}}} | {{{kbd(C-u TAB)}}} | {{{kbd(C)}}} | |
| {{{kbd(M-LEFT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x l)}}} | {{{kbd(l)}}} | {{{kbd(Esc LEFT)}}} |
| {{{kbd(M-S-LEFT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x L)}}} | {{{kbd(L)}}} | |
| {{{kbd(M-RIGHT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x r)}}} | {{{kbd(r)}}} | {{{kbd(Esc RIGHT)}}} |
| {{{kbd(M-S-RIGHT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x R)}}} | {{{kbd(R)}}} | |
| {{{kbd(M-UP)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x u)}}} | | {{{kbd(Esc UP)}}} |
| {{{kbd(M-S-UP)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x U)}}} | {{{kbd(U)}}} | |
| {{{kbd(M-DOWN)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x d)}}} | | {{{kbd(Esc DOWN)}}} |
| {{{kbd(M-S-DOWN)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x D)}}} | {{{kbd(D)}}} | |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
| {{{kbd(S-RET)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x c)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(M-RET)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x m)}}} | | {{{kbd(Esc RET)}}} |
| {{{kbd(M-S-RET)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x M)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c LEFT)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c RIGHT)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c UP)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c DOWN)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(C-S-LEFT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x LEFT)}}} | | |
| {{{kbd(C-S-RIGHT)}}} | {{{kbd(C-c C-x RIGHT)}}} | | |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Context Dependent Documentation
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Jump to Documentation for Context.
:ALT_TITLE: Documentation Access
:END:
#+cindex: documentation
#+cindex: Info
#+findex: org-info-find-node
{{{kbd(C-c C-x C-i)}}} in an Org file tries to open a suitable section
of the Org info documentation depending on the Org element at point.
For example on a headline the info documentation about the Org
document structure appears.
{{{kbd(q)}}} closes the info window.
** Interaction with Other Packages
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: With other Emacs packages.
:ALT_TITLE: Interaction
:END:
#+cindex: packages, interaction with other
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org's compatibility and the level of interaction with other Emacs
packages are documented here.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** Packages that Org cooperates with
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Packages Org cooperates with.
:ALT_TITLE: Cooperation
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =calc.el= by Dave Gillespie ::
#+cindex: @file{calc.el}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
functionality in its tables (see [[*The Spreadsheet]]). Org also
uses Calc for embedded calculations. See [[info:calc::Embedded%20Mode][GNU Emacs Calc Manual]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =constants.el= by Carsten Dominik ::
#+cindex: @file{constants.el}
#+vindex: org-table-formula-constants
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org can use names for constants in formulas in tables. Org can
also use calculation suffixes for units, such as =M= for =Mega=.
For a standard collection of such constants, install the
=constants= package. Install version 2.0 of this package,
available at [[http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools]]. Org checks
if the function ~constants-get~ has been autoloaded.
Installation instructions are in the file =constants.el=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =cdlatex.el= by Carsten Dominik ::
#+cindex: @file{cdlatex.el}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org mode can make use of the CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter
LaTeX fragments into Org files. See [[*Using CDLaTeX to enter
math]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =imenu.el= by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg ::
#+cindex: @file{imenu.el}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Imenu creates dynamic menus based on an index of items in a file.
Org mode supports Imenu menus. Enable it with a mode hook as
follows:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
(lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-imenu-depth
By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
depth using the option ~org-imenu-depth~.
- =speedbar.el= by Eric\nbsp{}M.\nbsp{}Ludlam ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @file{speedbar.el}
Speedbar package creates a special Emacs frame for displaying
files and index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar;
users can drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. The
{{{kbd(<)}}} in the Speedbar frame tweaks the agenda commands to
that file or to a subtree.
- =table.el= by Takaaki Ota ::
#+cindex: table editor, @file{table.el}
#+cindex: @file{table.el}
Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
package by Takaaki Ota. Org mode recognizes such tables and
exports them properly. {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} to edit these tables in
a special buffer, much like Org's code blocks. Because of
interference with other Org mode functionality, Takaaki Ota
tables cannot be edited directly in the Org buffer.
- {{{kbd(C-c ')}}} (~org-edit-special~) ::
#+kindex: C-c '
#+findex: org-edit-special
Edit a =table.el= table. Works when point is in
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a =table.el= table.
2018-02-16 08:17:33 -05:00
- {{{kbd(C-c ~)}}} (~org-table-create-with-table.el~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c ~
#+findex: org-table-create-with-table.el
Insert a =table.el= table. If there is already a table at
point, this command converts it between the =table.el=
format and the Org mode format. See the documentation
string of the command ~org-convert-table~ for the
restrictions under which this is possible.
*** Packages that conflict with Org mode
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Packages that lead to conflicts.
:ALT_TITLE: Conflicts
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: shift-selection-mode
#+vindex: org-support-shift-select
In Emacs, ~shift-selection-mode~ combines motions of point with shift
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
key to enlarge regions. Emacs sets this mode by default. This
conflicts with Org's use of {{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}} commands to change
timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types, etc.
Since {{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}} commands outside of specific contexts do
not do anything, Org offers the variable ~org-support-shift-select~
for customization. Org mode accommodates shift selection by (i)
making it available outside of the special contexts where special
commands apply, and (ii) extending an existing active region even if
point moves across a special context.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =cua.el= by Kim\nbsp{}F.\nbsp{}Storm ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @file{cua.el}
#+vindex: org-replace-disputed-keys
Org key bindings conflict with {{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}} keys used by
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
CUA mode. For Org to relinquish these bindings to CUA mode,
configure the variable ~org-replace-disputed-keys~. When set,
Org moves the following key bindings in Org files, and in the
agenda buffer---but not during date selection.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.4 0.4
| {{{kbd(S-UP)}}} \rArr{} {{{kbd(M-p)}}} | {{{kbd(S-DOWN)}}} \rArr{} {{{kbd(M-n)}}} |
| {{{kbd(S-LEFT)}}} \rArr{} {{{kbd(M--)}}} | {{{kbd(S-RIGHT)}}} \rArr{} {{{kbd(M-+)}}} |
| {{{kbd(C-S-LEFT)}}} \rArr{} {{{kbd(M-S--)}}} | {{{kbd(C-S-RIGHT)}}} \rArr{} {{{kbd(M-S-+)}}} |
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-disputed-keys
Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you
want to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
~org-disputed-keys~.
- =ecomplete.el= by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen ::
#+cindex: @file{ecomplete.el}
Ecomplete provides "electric" address completion in address
header lines in message buffers. Sadly Orgtbl mode cuts
Ecomplete's power supply: no completion happens when Orgtbl mode
is enabled in message buffers while entering text in address
header lines. If one wants to use ecomplete one should /not/
follow the advice to automagically turn on Orgtbl mode in message
buffers (see [[*The Orgtbl Minor Mode]]), but instead---after
filling in the message headers---turn on Orgtbl mode manually
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
when needed in the messages body.
- =filladapt.el= by Kyle Jones ::
#+cindex: @file{filladapt.el}
Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs,
list items and other elements. Many users reported problems
using both =filladapt.el= and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is
to disable filladapt like this:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =viper.el= by Michael Kifer ::
#+cindex: @file{viper.el}
#+kindex: C-c /
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Viper uses {{{kbd(C-c /)}}} and therefore makes this key not
access the corresponding Org mode command ~org-sparse-tree~. You
need to find another key for this command, or override the key in
~viper-vi-global-user-map~ with
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =windmove.el= by Hovav Shacham ::
#+cindex: @file{windmove.el}
This package also uses the {{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}} keys, so
everything written in the paragraph above about CUA mode also
applies here. If you want to make the windmove function active
in locations where Org mode does not have special functionality
on {{{kbd(S-<cursor>)}}}, add this to your configuration:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
;; Make windmove work in Org mode:
(add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
(add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
(add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
(add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =yasnippet.el= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: @file{yasnippet.el}
The way Org mode binds the {{{kbd(TAB)}}} key (binding to ~[tab]~
instead of ~"\t"~) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The
following code fixed this problem:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
(lambda ()
(setq-local yas/trigger-key [tab])
(define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The latest version of YASnippet does not play well with Org mode.
If the above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining
the following function:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
(let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Then, tell Org mode to use that function:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
(lambda ()
(make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
(setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
(add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
(define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Org Crypt
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Encrypting Org files.
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org Crypt encrypts the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
properties. Behind the scene, it uses the Emacs EasyPG library to
encrypt and decrypt files.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-crypt-tag-matcher
Any text below a headline that has a =crypt= tag is automatically
encrypted when the file is saved. To use a different tag, customize
the ~org-crypt-tag-matcher~ setting.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Here is a suggestion for Org Crypt settings in Emacs init file:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(require 'org-crypt)
(org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
(setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance '("crypt"))
(setq org-crypt-key nil)
;; GPG key to use for encryption
;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
(setq auto-save-default nil)
;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need to
;; turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often. Otherwise,
;; you'll get an (annoying) message each time you start Org.
;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
;;
;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
#+end_src
It's possible to use different keys for different headings by
specifying the respective key as property =CRYPTKEY=, e.g.:
#+begin_example
,* Totally secret :crypt:
:PROPERTIES:
:CRYPTKEY: 0x0123456789012345678901234567890123456789
:END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Excluding the =crypt= tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted
text from being encrypted again.
** Org Mobile
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Viewing and capture on a mobile device.
:END:
#+cindex: smartphone
Org Mobile is a protocol for synchronizing Org files between Emacs and
other applications, e.g., on mobile devices. It enables offline-views
and capture support for an Org mode system that is rooted on a "real"
computer. The external application can also record changes to
existing entries.
This appendix describes Org's support for agenda view formats
compatible with Org Mobile. It also describes synchronizing changes,
such as to notes, between the mobile application and the computer.
To change tags and TODO states in the mobile application, first
customize the variables ~org-todo-keywords~ and ~org-tag-alist~.
These should cover all the important tags and TODO keywords, even if
Org files use only some of them. Though the mobile application is
expected to support in-buffer settings, it is required to understand
TODO states /sets/ (see [[*Setting up keywords for individual files]]) and
/mutually exclusive/ tags (see [[*Setting Tags]]) only for those set in
these variables.
*** Setting up the staging area
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: For the mobile device.
:END:
#+vindex: org-mobile-directory
The mobile application needs access to a file directory on
a server[fn:148] to interact with Emacs. Pass its location through
the ~org-mobile-directory~ variable. If you can mount that directory
locally just set the variable to point to that directory:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-mobile-directory "~/orgmobile/")
#+end_src
Alternatively, by using TRAMP (see [[info:tramp][TRAMP User Manual]]),
~org-mobile-directory~ may point to a remote directory accessible
through, for example, SSH, SCP, or DAVS:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-mobile-directory "/davs:user@remote.host:/org/webdav/")
#+end_src
#+vindex: org-mobile-encryption
With a public server, consider encrypting the files. Org also
requires OpenSSL installed on the local computer. To turn on
encryption, set the same password in the mobile application and in
Emacs. Set the password in the variable
~org-mobile-use-encryption~[fn:149]. Note that even after the mobile
application encrypts the file contents, the file name remains visible
on the file systems of the local computer, the server, and the mobile
device.
*** Pushing to the mobile application
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Uploading Org files and agendas.
:END:
#+findex: org-mobile-push
#+vindex: org-mobile-files
The command ~org-mobile-push~ copies files listed in
~org-mobile-files~ into the staging area. Files include agenda files
(as listed in ~org-agenda-files~). Customize ~org-mobile-files~ to
add other files. File names are staged with paths relative to
~org-directory~, so all files should be inside this directory[fn:150].
Push creates a special Org file =agendas.org= with custom agenda views
defined by the user[fn:151].
Finally, Org writes the file =index.org=, containing links to other
files. The mobile application reads this file first from the server
to determine what other files to download for agendas. For faster
downloads, it is expected to only read files whose checksums[fn:152]
have changed.
*** Pulling from the mobile application
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Integrating captured and flagged items.
:END:
#+findex: org-mobile-pull
The command ~org-mobile-pull~ synchronizes changes with the server.
More specifically, it first pulls the Org files for viewing. It then
appends captured entries and pointers to flagged or changed entries to
the file =mobileorg.org= on the server. Org ultimately integrates its
data in an inbox file format, through the following steps:
1.
#+vindex: org-mobile-inbox-for-pull
Org moves all entries found in =mobileorg.org=[fn:153] and appends
them to the file pointed to by the variable
~org-mobile-inbox-for-pull~. It should reside neither in the
staging area nor on the server. Each captured entry and each
editing event is a top-level entry in the inbox file.
2.
#+cindex: @samp{FLAGGED}, tag
After moving the entries, Org processes changes to the shared
files. Some of them are applied directly and without user
interaction. Examples include changes to tags, TODO state,
headline and body text. Entries requiring further action are
tagged as =FLAGGED=. Org marks entries with problems with an error
message in the inbox. They have to be resolved manually.
3. Org generates an agenda view for flagged entries for user
intervention to clean up. For notes stored in flagged entries, Org
displays them in the echo area when point is on the corresponding
agenda item.
- {{{kbd(?)}}} ::
Pressing {{{kbd(?)}}} displays the entire flagged note in
another window. Org also pushes it to the kill ring. To
store flagged note as a normal note, use {{{kbd(? z C-y C-c
C-c)}}}. Pressing {{{kbd(?)}}} twice does these things: first
it removes the =FLAGGED= tag; second, it removes the flagged
note from the property drawer; third, it signals that manual
editing of the flagged entry is now finished.
#+kindex: ? @r{(Agenda dispatcher)}
From the agenda dispatcher, {{{kbd(?)}}} returns to the view to finish
processing flagged entries. Note that these entries may not be the
most recent since the mobile application searches files that were last
pulled. To get an updated agenda view with changes since the last
pull, pull again.
** Org Syntax
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Formal description of Org's syntax.
:END:
A reference document providing a formal description of Org's syntax is
available as [[https://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-syntax.html][a draft on Worg]], written and maintained by Nicolas
Goaziou. It defines Org's core internal concepts such as "headlines",
"sections", "affiliated keywords", "(greater) elements" and "objects".
Each part of an Org document belongs to one of the previous
categories.
To explore the abstract structure of an Org buffer, run this in
a buffer:
: M-: (org-element-parse-buffer) <RET>
#+texinfo: @noindent
It outputs a list containing the buffer's content represented as an
abstract structure. The export engine relies on the information
stored in this list. Most interactive commands---e.g., for structure
editing---also rely on the syntactic meaning of the surrounding
context.
#+cindex: syntax checker
#+cindex: linter
#+findex: org-lint
You can probe the syntax of your documents with the command
: M-x org-lint <RET>
#+texinfo: @noindent
It runs a number of checks to find common mistakes. It then displays
their location in a dedicated buffer, along with a description and
a "trust level", since false-positive are possible. From there, you
can operate on the reports with the following keys:
#+attr_texinfo: :columns 0.22 0.78
| {{{kbd(C-j)}}}, {{{kbd(TAB)}}} | Display the offending line |
| {{{kbd(RET)}}} | Move point to the offending line |
| {{{kbd(g)}}} | Check the document again |
| {{{kbd(h)}}} | Hide all reports from the same checker |
| {{{kbd(i)}}} | Also remove them from all subsequent checks |
| {{{kbd(S)}}} | Sort reports by the column at point |
* Hacking
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to hack your way around.
:APPENDIX: t
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:END:
#+cindex: hacking
This appendix describes some ways a user can extend the functionality
of Org.
** Hooks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to reach into Org's internals.
:END:
#+cindex: hooks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org has a large number of hook variables for adding functionality.
This appendix illustrates using a few. A complete list of hooks with
documentation is maintained by the Worg project at
https://orgmode.org/worg/doc.html#hooks.
** Add-on Packages
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Available extensions.
:END:
#+cindex: add-on packages
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Various authors wrote a large number of add-on packages for Org.
These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as
contributed packages with the separate release available at
https://orgmode.org. See the =contrib/README= file in the source code
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
directory for a list of contributed files. Worg page with more
information is at: https://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/.
** Adding Hyperlink Types
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: New custom link types.
:END:
#+cindex: hyperlinks, adding new types
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org has many built-in hyperlink types (see [[*Hyperlinks]]), and an
interface for adding new link types. The following example shows the
process of adding Org links to Unix man pages, which look like this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: [[man:printf][The printf manual]]
#+texinfo: @noindent
The following =org-man.el= file implements it
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
;;; org-man.el - Support for links to man pages in Org mode
(require 'org)
(org-link-set-parameters "man"
:follow org-man-command
:export #'org-man-export
:store #'org-man-store-link)
(defcustom org-man-command 'man
"The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
:group 'org-link
:type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
(defun org-man-store-link ()
"Store a link to a man page."
(when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
;; This is a man page, we do make this link.
(let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
(link (concat "man:" page))
(description (format "Man page for %s" page)))
(org-store-link-props
:type "man"
:link link
:description description))))
(defun org-man-get-page-name ()
"Extract the page name from the buffer name."
;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
(if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
(match-string 1 (buffer-name))
(error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
(defun org-man-export (link description format)
"Export a man page link from Org files."
(let ((path (format "http://man.he.net/?topic=%s&section=all" link))
(desc (or description link)))
(pcase format
(`html (format "<a target=\"_blank\" href=\"%s\">%s</a>" path desc))
(`latex (format "\\href{%s}{%s}" path desc))
(`texinfo (format "@uref{%s,%s}" path desc))
(`ascii (format "%s (%s)" desc path))
(t path))))
(provide 'org-man)
;;; org-man.el ends here
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
To activate links to man pages in Org, enter this in the Emacs init
file:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(require 'org-man)
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
A review of =org-man.el=:
1. First, =(require 'org)= ensures =org.el= is loaded.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
2.
#+findex: org-link-set-parameters
#+vindex: org-link-parameters
Then ~org-link-set-parameters~ defines a new link type with =man=
prefix and associates functions for following, exporting and
storing such links. See the variable ~org-link-parameters~ for
a complete list of possible associations.
3. The rest of the file implements necessary variables and functions.
For example, ~org-man-store-link~ is responsible for storing a link
when ~org-store-link~ (see [[*Handling Links]]) is called from a buffer
displaying a man page. It first checks if the ~major-mode~ is
appropriate. If check fails, the function returns ~nil~, which
means it isn't responsible for creating a link to the current
buffer. Otherwise the function makes a link string by combining
the =man:= prefix with the man topic. It also provides a default
description. The function ~org-insert-link~ can insert it back
into an Org buffer later on.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
** Adding Export Back-ends
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How to write new export back-ends.
:END:
#+cindex: Export, writing back-ends
Org's export engine makes it easy for writing new back-ends. The
framework on which the engine was built makes it easy to derive new
back-ends from existing ones.
#+findex: org-export-define-backend
#+findex: org-export-define-derived-backend
The two main entry points to the export engine are:
~org-export-define-backend~ and ~org-export-define-derived-backend~.
To grok these functions, see =ox-latex.el= for an example of defining
a new back-end from scratch, and =ox-beamer.el= for an example of
deriving from an existing engine.
For creating a new back-end from scratch, first set its name as
a symbol in an alist consisting of elements and export functions. To
make the back-end visible to the export dispatcher, set ~:menu-entry~
keyword. For export options specific to this back-end, set the
~:options-alist~.
For creating a new back-end from an existing one, set
~:translate-alist~ to an alist of export functions. This alist
replaces the parent back-end functions.
For complete documentation, see [[https://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-export-reference.html][the Org Export Reference on Worg]].
** Tables in Arbitrary Syntax
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs.
:END:
#+cindex: tables, in other modes
#+cindex: lists, in other modes
#+cindex: Orgtbl mode
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Due to Org's success in handling tables with Orgtbl, a frequently
requested feature is the use of Org's table functions in other modes,
e.g., LaTeX. This would be hard to do in a general way without
complicated customization nightmares. Moreover, that would take Org
away from its simplicity roots that Orgtbl has proven. There is,
however, an alternate approach to accomplishing the same.
This approach involves implementing a custom /translate/ function that
operates on a native Org /source table/ to produce a table in another
format. This strategy would keep the excellently working Orgtbl
simple and isolate complications, if any, confined to the translate
function. To add more alien table formats, we just add more translate
functions. Also the burden of developing custom translate functions
for new table formats is in the hands of those who know those formats
best.
*** Radio tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Sending and receiving radio tables.
:END:
#+cindex: radio tables
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Radio tables are target locations for translated tables that are not near
their source. Org finds the target location and inserts the translated
table.
The key to finding the target location is the magic words =BEGIN/END
RECEIVE ORGTBL=. They have to appear as comments in the current mode.
If the mode is C, then:
#+begin_example
/* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
/* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
At the location of source, Org needs a special line to direct Orgtbl
to translate and to find the target for inserting the translated
table. For example:
#+cindex: @samp{ORGTBL}, keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments ...
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
=table_name= is the table's reference name, which is also used in the
receiver lines, and the =translation_function= is the Lisp function
that translates. This line, in addition, may also contain alternating
key and value arguments at the end. The translation function gets
these values as a property list. A few standard parameters are
already recognized and acted upon before the translation function is
called:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:skip N= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count; include
them if they are to be skipped.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- =:skipcols (n1 n2 ...)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
List of columns to be skipped. First Org automatically discards
columns with calculation marks and then sends the table to the
translator function, which then skips columns as specified in
=skipcols=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To keep the source table intact in the buffer without being disturbed
when the source file is compiled or otherwise being worked on, use one
of these strategies:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Place the table in a block comment. For example, in C mode you
could wrap the table between =/*= and =*/= lines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Put the table after an "end" statement. For example ~\bye~ in TeX
and ~\end{document}~ in LaTeX.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Comment and un-comment each line of the table during edits. The
{{{kbd(M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment)}}} command makes toggling easy.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
*** A LaTeX example of radio tables
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Step by step, almost a tutorial.
:ALT_TITLE: A LaTeX example
:END:
#+cindex: @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To wrap a source table in LaTeX, use the =comment= environment
provided by =comment.sty=[fn:154]. To activate it, put
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~\usepackage{comment}~ in the document header. Orgtbl mode inserts
a radio table skeleton[fn:147] with the command {{{kbd(M-x
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
orgtbl-insert-radio-table)}}}, which prompts for a table name. For
example, if =salesfigures= is the name, the template inserts:
#+begin_example
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
\begin{comment}
,#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
| | |
\end{comment}
#+end_example
#+vindex: LaTeX-verbatim-environments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The line =#+ORGTBL: SEND= tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
~orgtbl-to-latex~ to convert the table to LaTeX format, then insert
the table at the target (receive) location named =salesfigures=. Now
the table is ready for data entry. It can even use spreadsheet
features[fn:155]:
#+begin_example
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
\begin{comment}
,#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
|-------+------+---------+---------|
| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
,#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
% $ (optional extra dollar to keep Font Lock happy, see footnote)
\end{comment}
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
After editing, {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} inserts the translated table at the
target location, between the two marker lines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For hand-made custom tables, note that the translator needs to skip
the first two lines of the source table. Also the command has to
/splice/ out the target table without the header and footer.
#+begin_example
\begin{tabular}{lrrr}
Month & \multicolumn{1}{c}{Days} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
\end{tabular}
%
\begin{comment}
,#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
|-------+------+---------+---------|
| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
,#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
\end{comment}
#+end_example
The LaTeX translator function ~orgtbl-to-latex~ is already part of
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Orgtbl mode and uses a =tabular= environment to typeset the table and
marks horizontal lines with ~\hline~. For additional parameters to
control output, see [[*Translator functions]]:
- =:splice BOOLEAN= ::
When {{{var(BOOLEAN}}} is non-~nil~, return only table body
lines; i.e., not wrapped in =tabular= environment. Default is
~nil~.
- =:fmt FMT= ::
Format string to warp each field. It should contain =%s= for the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in
dollar symbol, you could use =:fmt "$%s$"=. Format can also wrap
a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
=:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")=. In place of a string, a function
of one argument can be used; the function must return a formatted
string.
- =:efmt EFMT= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Format numbers as exponentials. The spec should have =%s= twice
for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example ="%s\\times10^{%s}"=.
This may also be a property list with column numbers and formats,
for example =:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^{%s}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^{%s}$")=. After
{{{var(EFMT)}}} has been applied to a value, {{{var(FMT)}}}---see
above---is also applied. Functions with two arguments can be
supplied instead of strings. By default, no special formatting
is applied.
*** Translator functions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Copy and modify.
:END:
#+cindex: HTML, and Orgtbl mode
#+cindex: translator function
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: orgtbl-to-csv
#+findex: orgtbl-to-tsv
#+findex: orgtbl-to-latex
#+findex: orgtbl-to-html
#+findex: orgtbl-to-texinfo
#+findex: orgtbl-to-unicode
#+findex: orgtbl-to-orgtbl
#+findex: orgtbl-to-generic
Orgtbl mode has built-in translator functions: ~orgtbl-to-csv~
(comma-separated values), ~orgtbl-to-tsv~ (TAB-separated values),
~orgtbl-to-latex~, ~orgtbl-to-html~, ~orgtbl-to-texinfo~,
~orgtbl-to-unicode~ and ~orgtbl-to-orgtbl~. They use the generic
translator, ~orgtbl-to-generic~, which delegates translations to
various export back-ends.
Properties passed to the function through the =ORGTBL SEND= line take
precedence over properties defined inside the function. For example,
this overrides the default LaTeX line endings, ~\\~, with ~\\[2mm]~:
: #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
For a new language translator, define a converter function. It can be
a generic function, such as shown in this example. It marks
a beginning and ending of a table with =!BTBL!= and =!ETBL!=;
a beginning and ending of lines with =!BL!= and =!EL!=; and uses a TAB
for a field separator:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun orgtbl-to-language (table params)
"Convert the orgtbl-mode TABLE to language."
(orgtbl-to-generic
table
(org-combine-plists
'(:tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!" :lstart "!BL!" :lend "!EL!" :sep "\t")
params)))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The documentation for the ~orgtbl-to-generic~ function shows
a complete list of parameters, each of which can be passed through to
~orgtbl-to-latex~, ~orgtbl-to-texinfo~, and any other function using
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
that generic function.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
For complicated translations the generic translator function could be
replaced by a custom translator function. Such a custom function must
take two arguments and return a single string containing the formatted
table. The first argument is the table whose lines are a list of
fields or the symbol ~hline~. The second argument is the property
list consisting of parameters specified in the =#+ORGTBL: SEND= line.
Please share your translator functions by posting them to the Org
users mailing list, at mailto:emacs-orgmode@gnu.org.
** Dynamic Blocks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Automatically filled blocks.
:END:
#+cindex: dynamic blocks
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org supports /dynamic blocks/ in Org documents. They are inserted
with begin and end markers like any other code block, but the contents
are updated automatically by a user function. For example, {{{kbd(C-c
C-x C-r)}}} inserts a dynamic table that updates the work time (see
[[*Clocking Work Time]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Dynamic blocks can have names and function parameters. The syntax is
similar to source code block specifications:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
...
,#+END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
These commands update dynamic blocks:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- {{{kbd(C-c C-x C-u)}}} (~org-dblock-update~) ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-c C-x C-u
#+findex: org-dblock-update
Update dynamic block at point.
- {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-x C-u)}}} ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+kindex: C-u C-c C-x C-u
Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Before updating a dynamic block, Org removes content between the
=BEGIN= and =END= markers. Org then reads the parameters on the
=BEGIN= line for passing to the writer function. If the function
expects to access the removed content, then Org expects an extra
parameter, =:content=, on the =BEGIN= line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The syntax for naming a writer function with a dynamic block labelled
=myblock= is: ~org-dblock-write:myblock~. Parameters come from the
=BEGIN= line.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following is an example of a dynamic block and a block writer function
that updates the time when the function was last run:
#+begin_example
,#+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
...
,#+END:
#+end_example
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The dynamic block's writer function:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
(let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
(insert "Last block update at: "
(format-time-string fmt))))
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To keep dynamic blocks up-to-date in an Org file, use the function,
~org-update-all-dblocks~ in hook, such as ~before-save-hook~. The
~org-update-all-dblocks~ function does not run if the file is not in
Org mode.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-narrow-to-block
Dynamic blocks, like any other block, can be narrowed with
~org-narrow-to-block~.
** Special Agenda Views
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Customized views.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda views, user-defined
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-function
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-function-global
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org provides a special hook to further limit items in agenda views:
~agenda~, ~agenda*~[fn:156], ~todo~, ~alltodo~, ~tags~, ~tags-todo~,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~tags-tree~. Specify a custom function that tests inclusion of every
matched item in the view. This function can also skip as much as is
needed.
For a global condition applicable to agenda views, use the
~org-agenda-skip-function-global~ variable. Org uses a global
condition with ~org-agenda-skip-function~ for custom searching.
This example defines a function for a custom view showing TODO items
with =waiting= status. Manually this is a multi-step search process,
but with a custom view, this can be automated as follows:
The custom function searches the subtree for the =waiting= tag and
returns ~nil~ on match. Otherwise it gives the location from where
the search continues.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
"Skip trees that are not waiting"
(let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
(if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
nil ; tag found, do not skip
subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
#+end_src
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To use this custom function in a custom agenda command:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(org-add-agenda-custom-command
'("b" todo "PROJECT"
((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
(org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
#+end_src
#+vindex: org-agenda-overriding-header
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Note that this also binds ~org-agenda-overriding-header~ to a more
meaningful string suitable for the agenda view.
#+vindex: org-odd-levels-only
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-function
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Search for entries with a limit set on levels for the custom search.
This is a general approach to creating custom searches in Org. To
include all levels, use =LEVEL>0=[fn:157]. Then to selectively pick
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the matched entries, use ~org-agenda-skip-function~, which also
accepts Lisp forms, such as ~org-agenda-skip-entry-if~ and
~org-agenda-skip-subtree-if~. For example:
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline
or scheduled.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the
entry.
- =(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
- =(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")= ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The following is an example of a search for =waiting= without the
special function:
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(org-add-agenda-custom-command
'("b" todo "PROJECT"
((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
'regexp ":waiting:"))
(org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
#+end_src
** Speeding Up Your Agendas
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Tips on how to speed up your agendas.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda views, optimization
Some agenda commands slow down when the Org files grow in size or
number. Here are tips to speed up:
- Reduce the number of Org agenda files to avoid slowdowns due to hard drive
accesses.
- Reduce the number of DONE and archived headlines so agenda
operations that skip over these can finish faster.
- Do not dim blocked tasks:
#+vindex: org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks nil)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
- Stop preparing agenda buffers on startup:
#+vindex: org-startup-folded
#+vindex: org-agenda-inhibit-startup
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-inhibit-startup t)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
- Disable tag inheritance for agendas:
#+vindex: org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
#+vindex: org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(setq org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance nil)
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_src
These options can be applied to selected agenda views. For more
details about generation of agenda views, see the docstrings for the
relevant variables, and this [[https://orgmode.org/worg/agenda-optimization.html][dedicated Worg page]] for agenda
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
optimization.
** Extracting Agenda Information
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Post-processing agenda information.
:END:
#+cindex: agenda, pipe
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+cindex: scripts, for agenda processing
Org provides commands to access agendas through Emacs batch mode.
Through this command-line interface, agendas are automated for further
processing or printing.
#+vindex: org-agenda-custom-commands
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+findex: org-batch-agenda
~org-batch-agenda~ creates an agenda view in ASCII and outputs to
standard output. This command takes one string parameter. When
string consists of a single character, Org uses it as a key to
~org-agenda-custom-commands~. These are the same ones available
through the agenda dispatcher (see [[*The Agenda Dispatcher]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This example command line directly prints the TODO list to the printer:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
: emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
When the string parameter length is two or more characters, Org
matches it with tags/TODO strings. For example, this example command
line prints items tagged with =shop=, but excludes items tagged with
=NewYork=:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_example
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
-eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
An example showing on-the-fly parameter modifications:
#+begin_example
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
-eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
org-agenda-span (quote month) \
org-agenda-include-diary nil \
org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
| lpr
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+end_example
#+texinfo: @noindent
which produces an agenda for the next 30 days from just the
=~/org/projects.org= file.
#+findex: org-batch-agenda-csv
For structured processing of agenda output, use ~org-batch-agenda-csv~
with the following fields:
- category :: The category of the item
- head :: The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY
- type :: The type of the agenda entry, can be
| ~todo~ | selected in TODO match |
| ~tagsmatch~ | selected in tags match |
| ~diary~ | imported from diary |
| ~deadline~ | a deadline |
| ~scheduled~ | scheduled |
| ~timestamp~ | appointment, selected by timestamp |
| ~closed~ | entry was closed on date |
| ~upcoming-deadline~ | warning about nearing deadline |
| ~past-scheduled~ | forwarded scheduled item |
| ~block~ | entry has date block including date |
- todo :: The TODO keyword, if any
- tags :: All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons
- date :: The relevant date, like =2007-2-14=
- time :: The time, like =15:00-16:50=
- extra :: String with extra planning info
- priority-l :: The priority letter if any was given
- priority-n :: The computed numerical priority
If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp,
including those items with =DEADLINE= and =SCHEDULED= keywords, then
Org includes date and time in the output.
If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp (or
deadline/scheduled), then Org includes date and time in the output.
Here is an example of a post-processing script in Perl. It takes the
CSV output from Emacs and prints with a checkbox:
#+begin_src perl
#!/usr/bin/perl
# define the Emacs command to run
$cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
# run it and capture the output
$agenda = qx{$cmd 2>/dev/null};
# loop over all lines
foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) {
# get the individual values
($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
$priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
# process and print
print "[ ] $head\n";
}
#+end_src
** Using the Property API
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Writing programs that use entry properties.
:END:
#+cindex: API, for properties
#+cindex: properties, API
Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
properties.
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-properties &optional pom which
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker {{{var(POM)}}}.
This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
if the property key was used several times. {{{var(POM)}}} may also
be ~nil~, in which case the current entry is used. If
{{{var(WHICH)}}} is ~nil~ or ~all~, get all properties. If
{{{var(WHICH)}}} is ~special~ or ~standard~, only get that subclass.
#+end_defun
#+vindex: org-use-property-inheritance
#+findex: org-insert-property-drawer
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Get value of {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} for entry at point-or-marker
{{{var(POM)}}}. By default, this only looks at properties defined
locally in the entry. If {{{var(INHERIT)}}} is non-~nil~ and the
entry does not have the property, then also check higher levels of the
hierarchy. If {{{var(INHERIT)}}} is the symbol ~selective~, use
inheritance if and only if the setting of
~org-use-property-inheritance~ selects {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} for
inheritance.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-delete pom property
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Delete the property {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} from entry at point-or-marker
{{{var(POM)}}}.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-put pom property value
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} to {{{var(VALUES)}}} for entry at
point-or-marker POM.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
#+begin_defun
Get all property keys in the current buffer.
#+end_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-insert-property-drawer
#+begin_defun
Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Set {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} at point-or-marker {{{var(POM)}}} to
{{{var(VALUES)}}}. {{{var(VALUES)}}} should be a list of strings.
They are concatenated, with spaces as separators.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Treat the value of the property {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} as
a whitespace-separated list of values and return the values as a list
of strings.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Treat the value of the property {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} as
a whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that
{{{var(VALUE)}}} is in this list.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Treat the value of the property {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} as
a whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that
{{{var(VALUE)}}} is /not/ in this list.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Treat the value of the property {{{var(PROPERTY)}}} as
a whitespace-separated list of values and check if {{{var(VALUE)}}} is
in this list.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-property-allowed-value-functions
#+begin_defopt
Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property,
and return a flat list of allowed values. If =:ETC= is one of the
values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
to be entered. The functions must return ~nil~ if they are not
responsible for this property.
#+end_defopt
** Using the Mapping API
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Mapping over all or selected entries.
:END:
#+cindex: API, for mapping
#+cindex: mapping entries, API
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries
satisfying certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used
to produce agenda views, but there is also an API that can be used to
execute arbitrary functions for each or selected entries. The main
entry point for this API is:
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
#+begin_defun
Call {{{var(FUNC)}}} at each headline selected by {{{var(MATCH)}}} in
{{{var(SCOPE)}}}.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{var(FUNC)}}} is a function or a Lisp form. With point positioned
at the beginning of the headline, call the function without arguments.
Org returns an alist of return values of calls to the function.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
To avoid preserving point, Org wraps the call to {{{var(FUNC)}}} in
~save-excursion~ form. After evaluation, Org moves point to the end
of the line that was just processed. Search continues from that point
forward. This may not always work as expected under some conditions,
such as if the current sub-tree was removed by a previous archiving
operation. In such rare circumstances, Org skips the next entry
entirely when it should not. To stop Org from such skips, make
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{var(FUNC)}}} set the variable ~org-map-continue-from~ to a specific
buffer position.
{{{var(MATCH)}}} is a tags/property/TODO match. Org iterates only
matched headlines. Org iterates over all headlines when
{{{var(MATCH)}}} is ~nil~ or ~t~.
{{{var(SCOPE)}}} determines the scope of this command. It can be any
of:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~nil~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The current buffer, respecting the restriction, if any.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~tree~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The subtree started with the entry at point.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~region~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The entries within the active region, if any.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~file~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The current buffer, without restriction.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~file-with-archives~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The current buffer, and any archives associated with it.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~agenda~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
All agenda files.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~agenda-with-archives~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
All agenda files with any archive files associated with them.
- list of filenames ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
If this is a list, all files in the list are scanned.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo: @noindent
The remaining arguments are treated as settings for the scanner's
skipping facilities. Valid arguments are:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~archive~ ::
Skip trees with the =ARCHIVE= tag.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- ~comment~ ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Skip trees with the COMMENT keyword.
- function or Lisp form ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+vindex: org-agenda-skip-function
Used as value for ~org-agenda-skip-function~, so whenever the
function returns ~t~, {{{var(FUNC)}}} is called for that entry
and search continues from the point where the function leaves it.
#+end_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The mapping routine can call any arbitrary function, even functions
that change meta data or query the property API (see [[*Using the
Property API]]). Here are some handy functions:
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-todo &optional arg
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the
functions for the many possible values for the argument
{{{var(ARG)}}}.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-priority &optional action
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function
for the possible values for {{{var(ACTION)}}}.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
#+begin_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Toggle the tag {{{var(TAG)}}} in the current entry. Setting
{{{var(ONOFF)}}} to either ~on~ or ~off~ does not toggle tag, but
ensure that it is either on or off.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-promote
#+begin_defun
Promote the current entry.
#+end_defun
#+attr_texinfo: :options org-demote
#+begin_defun
Demote the current entry.
#+end_defun
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
This example turns all entries tagged with =TOMORROW= into TODO
entries with keyword =UPCOMING=. Org ignores entries in comment trees
and archive trees.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(org-map-entries '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
"+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
#+end_src
The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=WAITING=, in all agenda files.
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
(length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
#+end_src
* History and Acknowledgments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: How Org came into being.
:APPENDIX: t
:END:
** From Carsten
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of
the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go.
However, having to remember eleven different commands with two or
three keys per command, only to hide and show parts of the outline
tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using
outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the tree,
organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. /Visibility cycling/
and /structure editing/ were originally implemented in the package
=outline-magic.el=, but quickly moved to the more general =org.el=.
As this environment became comfortable for project planning, the next
step was adding /TODO entries/, basic /timestamps/, and /table
support/. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org still
has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
functionality directly into a notes file.
Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to the
[[mailto:emacs-orgmode@gnu.org][mailing list]] have provided a constant stream of bug reports, feedback,
new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code. Many thanks to
everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am trying to keep
here a list of the people who had significant influence in shaping one
or more aspects of Org. The list may not be complete, if I have
forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and let me know.
Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
- Bastien Guerry ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of
them integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX
exporter and the plain list parser. His support during the early
days was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and
sponsored hosting costs for the orgmode.org website. Bastien
stepped in as maintainer of Org between 2011 and 2013, at a time
when I desperately needed a break.
- Eric Schulte and Dan Davison ::
2018-02-16 08:39:10 -05:00
Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org Babel system,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
which turns Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating
code and doing literate programming and reproducible research.
This has become one of Org's killer features that define what Org
is today.
- John Wiegley ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly
to Org, including the attachment system (=org-attach.el=),
integration with Apple Mail (=org-mac-message.el=), hierarchical
dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (=org-habits.el=), and
encryption (=org-crypt.el=). Also, the capture system is really
an extended copy of his great =remember.el=.
- Sebastian Rose ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the
pitiful work of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this
part of Org onto a much higher level. He also wrote
=org-info.js=, a Java script for displaying webpages derived from
Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with single-key
navigation.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
know what I am missing here!
** From Bastien
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org between 2011 and 2013. This
appendix would not be complete without adding a few more
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
acknowledgments and thanks.
I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
maintainership of Org. His unremitting support is what really helped
me getting more confident over time, with both the community and the
code.
When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
more knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is
a list of the persons I could rely on, they should really be
considered co-maintainers, either of the code or the community:
- Eric Schulte ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here
kept me away from worrying about possible bugs here and let me
focus on other parts.
- Nicolas Goaziou ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of
Org. His work on =org-element.el= and =ox.el= has been
outstanding, and it opened the doors for many new ideas and
features. He rewrote many of the old exporters to use the new
export engine, and helped with documenting this major change.
More importantly (if that's possible), he has been more than
reliable during all the work done for Org 8.0, and always very
reactive on the mailing list.
- Achim Gratz ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some /ad hoc/
tools into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He
patiently coped with the many hiccups that such a change can
create for users.
- Nick Dokos ::
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without
Nick, who patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible
to overestimate such a great help, and the list would not be so
active without him.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to
be fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not
be complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
** List of Contributions
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:UNNUMBERED: notoc
:END:
- Russel Adams came up with the idea for drawers.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Thomas Baumann wrote =org-bbdb.el= and =org-mhe.el=.
- Christophe Bataillon created the great unicorn logo that we use on
the Org mode website.
- Alex Bochannek provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Jan Böcker wrote =org-docview.el=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Brad Bozarth showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org files.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Tom Breton wrote =org-choose.el=.
- Charles Cave's suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
- Pavel Chalmoviansky influenced the agenda treatment of items with
specified time.
- Gregory Chernov patched support for Lisp forms into table
calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
porting =nouline.el= to XEmacs.
- Sacha Chua suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
- Baoqiu Cui contributed the DocBook exporter.
- Eddward DeVilla proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API
for them.
- Nick Dokos tracked down several nasty bugs.
- Kees Dullemond used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He
also asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
- Thomas\nbsp{}S.\nbsp{}Dye contributed documentation on Worg and helped
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
integrating the Org Babel documentation into the manual.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Christian Egli converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
inspired the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter,
and wrote =org-taskjuggler.el=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- David Emery provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported HTML
agendas.
- Nic Ferrier contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
- Miguel\nbsp{}A.\nbsp{}Figueroa-Villanueva implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- John Foerch figured out how to make incremental search show context
around a match in a hidden outline tree.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Raimar Finken wrote =org-git-line.el=.
- Mikael Fornius works as a mailing list moderator.
- Austin Frank works as a mailing list moderator.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Eric Fraga drove the development of Beamer export with ideas and
testing.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Barry Gidden did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
publication through Network Theory Ltd.
- Niels Giesen had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
- Nicolas Goaziou rewrote much of the plain list code.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Kai Grossjohann pointed out key-binding conflicts with other
packages.
- Brian Gough of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as
a book.
- Bernt Hansen has driven much of the support for auto-repeating
tasks, task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear
explanations have been critical when we started to adopt the Git
version control system.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Manuel Hermenegildo has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
patches.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Phil Jackson wrote =org-irc.el=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Scott Jaderholm proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
folded entries, and column view for properties.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Matt Jones wrote MobileOrg Android.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Tokuya Kameshima wrote =org-wl.el= and =org-mew.el=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Shidai Liu ("Leo") asked for embedded LaTeX and tested it. He also
provided frequent feedback and some patches.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Matt Lundin has proposed last-row references for table formulas and
named invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- David Maus wrote =org-atom.el=, maintains the issues file for Org,
and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent
replies, small fixes and patches.
- Jason\nbsp{}F.\nbsp{}McBrayer suggested agenda export to CSV format.
- Max Mikhanosha came up with the idea of refiling.
- Dmitri Minaev sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
basis.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Stefan Monnier provided a patch to keep the Emacs Lisp compiler
happy.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Richard Moreland wrote MobileOrg for the iPhone.
- Rick Moynihan proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
- Todd Neal provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
- Greg Newman refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Tim O'Callaghan suggested in-file links, search options for general
file links, and tags.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Osamu Okano wrote =orgcard2ref.pl=, a Perl program to create a text
version of the reference card.
- Takeshi Okano translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
into Japanese.
- Oliver Oppitz suggested multi-state TODO items.
- Scott Otterson sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
links, among other things.
- Pete Phillips helped during the development of the TAGS feature,
and provided frequent feedback.
- Martin Pohlack provided the code snippet to bundle character
insertion into bundles of 20 for undo.
- T.\nbsp{}V.\nbsp{}Raman reported bugs and suggested improvements.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Matthias Rempe (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
control.
- Paul Rivier provided the basic implementation of named footnotes.
He also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
- Kevin Rogers contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Frank Ruell solved the mystery of the =keymapp nil= bug, a conflict
with =allout.el=.
- Jason Riedy generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl
tables with extensive patches.
- Philip Rooke created the Org reference card, provided lots of
feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
- Christian Schlauer proposed angular brackets around links, among
other things.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Paul Sexton wrote =org-ctags.el=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Tom Shannon's =organizer-mode.el= inspired linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus.
- Ilya Shlyakhter proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in
literal examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Stathis Sideris wrote the =ditaa.jar= ASCII to PNG converter that is
now packaged into Org's =contrib/= directory.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Daniel Sinder came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
subtrees.
- Dale Smith proposed link abbreviations.
- James TD Smith has contributed a large number of patches for
useful tweaks and features.
- Adam Spiers asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
extension system, added support for Mairix, and proposed the mapping
API.
- Ulf Stegemann created the table to translate special symbols to
HTML, LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Andy Stewart contributed code to =org-w3m.el=, to copy
HTML content with links transformation to Org syntax.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- David O'Toole wrote =org-publish.el= and drafted the
manual chapter about publishing.
- Jambunathan\nbsp{}K.\nbsp{}contributed the ODT exporter.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Sebastien Vauban reported many issues with LaTeX and Beamer export
and enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
- Stefan Vollmar organized a video-recorded talk at the
Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation
of a concept index for HTML export.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Jürgen Vollmer contributed code generating the table of contents in
HTML output.
- Samuel Wales has provided important feedback and bug reports.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Chris Wallace provided a patch implementing the =QUOTE= block.
- David Wainberg suggested archiving, and improvements to the
linking system.
- Carsten Wimmer suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
linking to Gnus.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Roland Winkler requested additional key bindings to make Org work on
a TTY.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
- Piotr Zielinski wrote =org-mouse.el=, proposed agenda
blocks and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
2018-03-27 18:08:40 -04:00
- Marco Wahl wrote =org-eww.el=.
2016-05-19 16:20:18 -04:00
* GNU Free Documentation License
:PROPERTIES:
:APPENDIX: t
:DESCRIPTION: The license for this documentation.
:END:
2018-03-27 18:08:40 -04:00
#+texinfo: @include doclicense.texi
2016-05-19 16:20:18 -04:00
* Main Index
:PROPERTIES:
:INDEX: cp
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:DESCRIPTION: An index of Org's concepts and features.
:END:
* Key Index
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Key bindings and where they are described.
:INDEX: ky
:END:
* Command and Function Index
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Command names and some internal functions.
:INDEX: fn
:END:
* Variable Index
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:DESCRIPTION: Variables mentioned in the manual.
:INDEX: vr
:END:
This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones
that are mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
{{{kbd(M-x org-customize)}}} and then click yourself through the tree.
* Copying
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
:PROPERTIES:
:copying: t
:END:
This manual is for Org version {{{version}}}.
2018-01-07 00:28:44 -05:00
Copyright \copy 2004--2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+begin_quote
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
2018-03-28 10:24:15 -04:00
Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being "A GNU Manual,"
and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
2018-03-28 10:24:15 -04:00
is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License."
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and
modify this GNU manual."
#+end_quote
* Export Setup :noexport:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+subtitle: Release {{{version}}}
#+author: The Org Mode Developers
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+date: {{{modification-time}}}
#+language: en
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
# XXX: We cannot use TODO keyword as a node starts with "TODO".
#+todo: REVIEW FIXME | DONE
#+property: header-args :eval no
#+startup: overview nologdone
2018-01-20 09:21:25 -05:00
#+export_file_name: org.texi
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo_dir_category: Emacs editing modes
#+texinfo_dir_title: Org Mode: (org)
#+texinfo_dir_desc: Outline-based notes management and organizer
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
# Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
# Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
#+texinfo_header: @set txicodequoteundirected
#+texinfo_header: @set txicodequotebacktick
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
# Contact Info
#+texinfo_header: @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{https://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+texinfo_header: @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
#+texinfo_header: @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
#+texinfo_header: @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+options: H:4 num:t toc:t author:t \n:nil ::t |:t ^:nil -:t f:t *:t <:t e:t ':t
#+options: d:nil todo:nil pri:nil tags:not-in-toc stat:nil broken-links:mark
#+select_tags: export
#+exclude_tags: noexport
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
#+macro: cite @@texinfo:@cite{@@$1@@texinfo:}@@
#+macro: var @@texinfo:@var{@@$1@@texinfo:}@@
# The "version" macro extracts "Version" keyword from "org.el". It
# returns major.minor version number. This is sufficient since bugfix
# releases are not expected to add features and therefore imply manual
# modifications.
#+macro: version (eval (with-current-buffer (find-file-noselect "../lisp/org.el") (org-with-point-at 1 (if (re-search-forward "Version: +\\([0-9.]+\\)" nil t) (mapconcat #'identity (cl-subseq (split-string (match-string-no-properties 1) "\\.") 0 2) ".") (error "Missing \"Version\" keyword in \"org.el\"")))))
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
# The "kbd" macro turns KBD into @kbd{KBD}. Additionnally, it
# encloses case-sensitive special keys (SPC, RET...) within @key{...}.
2018-03-12 17:49:18 -04:00
#+macro: kbd (eval (let ((case-fold-search nil) (regexp (regexp-opt '("SPC" "RET" "LFD" "TAB" "BS" "ESC" "DELETE" "SHIFT" "Ctrl" "Meta" "Alt" "Cmd" "Super" "UP" "LEFT" "RIGHT" "DOWN") 'words))) (format "@@texinfo:@kbd{@@%s@@texinfo:}@@" (replace-regexp-in-string regexp "@@texinfo:@key{@@\\&@@texinfo:}@@" $1 t))))
* Footnotes
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:1] If you do not use Font Lock globally turn it on in Org buffer
with =(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:2] Please consider subscribing to the mailing list in order to
minimize the work the mailing list moderators have to do.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:3] See the variables ~org-special-ctrl-a/e~, ~org-special-ctrl-k~,
and ~org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree~ to configure special behavior of
{{{kbd(C-a)}}}, {{{kbd(C-e)}}}, and {{{kbd(C-k)}}} in headlines. Note
also that clocking only works with headings indented less than 30
stars.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:4] See, however, the option ~org-cycle-emulate-tab~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:5] The indirect buffer contains the entire buffer, but is narrowed
to the current tree. Editing the indirect buffer also changes the
original buffer, but without affecting visibility in that buffer. For
more information about indirect buffers, see [[info:emacs#Indirect%20Buffers][GNU Emacs Manual]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:6] When ~org-agenda-inhibit-startup~ is non-~nil~, Org does not
honor the default visibility state when first opening a file for the
agenda (see [[*Speeding Up Your Agendas]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:7] See also the variable ~org-show-context-detail~ to decide how
much context is shown around each match.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:8] This depends on the option ~org-remove-highlights-with-change~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:9] When using =*= as a bullet, lines must be indented so that they
are not interpreted as headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with
a star may be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even
though =*= is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list
items.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:10] You can filter out any of them by configuring
~org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:11] You can also get =a.=, =A.=, =a)= and =A)= by configuring
~org-list-allow-alphabetical~. To minimize confusion with normal
text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond that limit,
2018-01-06 20:35:20 -05:00
bullets automatically become numbers.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:12] If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie must be put
/before/ the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical lists, you
can also use counters like =[@b]=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:13] If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
variable ~org-M-RET-may-split-line~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:14] If you want to cycle around items that way, you may customize
~org-list-use-circular-motion~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:15] See ~org-list-use-circular-motion~ for a cyclic behavior.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:16] Many desktops intercept {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}} to switch windows.
Use {{{kbd(C-M-i)}}} or {{{kbd(ESC TAB)}}} instead.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:17] The corresponding in-buffer setting is: =#+STARTUP: fninline=
or =#+STARTUP: nofninline=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:18] The corresponding in-buffer options are =#+STARTUP: fnadjust=
and =#+STARTUP: nofnadjust=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:19] To insert a vertical bar into a table field, use =\vert= or,
inside a word =abc\vert{}def=.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:20] Org understands references typed by the user as =B4=, but it
does not use this syntax when offering a formula for editing. You can
customize this behavior using the variable
~org-table-use-standard-references~.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:21] The computation time scales as O(N^2) because table
{{{var(FOO)}}} is parsed for each field to be copied.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:22] The file =constants.el= can supply the values of constants in
two different unit systems, =SI= and =cgs=. Which one is used depends
on the value of the variable ~constants-unit-system~. You can use the
=STARTUP= options =constSI= and =constcgs= to set this value for the
current buffer.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:23] The printf reformatting is limited in precision because the
value passed to it is converted into an "integer" or "double". The
"integer" is limited in size by truncating the signed value to 32
bits. The "double" is limited in precision to 64 bits overall which
leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:24] Such names must start with an alphabetic character and use
only alphanumeric/underscore characters.
[fn:25] More accurately, the precise behavior depends on how point
arrived there---see [[info:elisp#Invisible%20Text][Invisible Text]].
[fn:26] To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion
can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the buffer and press {{{kbd(M-TAB)}}}. All headlines in the current
buffer are offered as completions.
[fn:27] When targeting a =NAME= keyword, the =CAPTION= keyword is
mandatory in order to get proper numbering (see [[*Captions]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:28] The actual behavior of the search depends on the value of the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
variable ~org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline~. If its value is
~nil~, then a fuzzy text search is done. If it is ~t~, then only the
exact headline is matched, ignoring spaces and statistic cookies. If
the value is ~query-to-create~, then an exact headline is searched; if
it is not found, then the user is queried to create it.
[fn:29] If the headline contains a timestamp, it is removed from the
link, which results in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a timestamp in the headline.
[fn:30] The Org Id library must first be loaded, either through
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-customize~, by enabling ~id~ in ~org-modules~, or by adding
=(require 'org-id)= in your Emacs init file.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:31] Note that you do not have to use this command to insert
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are
automatically enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for
the optional descriptive text.
[fn:32] After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed
from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list for later use,
use a triple {{{kbd(C-u)}}} prefix argument to {{{kbd(C-c C-l)}}}, or
configure the option ~org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion~.
[fn:33] This works if a function has been defined in the ~:complete~
2016-07-05 10:38:42 -04:00
property of a link in ~org-link-parameters~.
[fn:34] See the variable ~org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer~.
[fn:35] For backward compatibility, line numbers can also follow a
single colon.
[fn:36] Of course, you can make a document that contains only long
lists of TODO items, but this is not required.
[fn:37] Changing the variable ~org-todo-keywords~ only becomes
effective after restarting Org mode in a buffer.
[fn:38] This is also true for the {{{kbd(t)}}} command in the agenda
buffer.
[fn:39] All characters are allowed except =@=, =^= and =!=, which have
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a special meaning here.
[fn:40] Check also the variable ~org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo~,
it allows you to change the TODO state through the tags interface (see
[[*Setting Tags]]), in case you like to mingle the two concepts. Note
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
that this means you need to come up with unique keys across both sets
of keywords.
[fn:41] Org mode parses these lines only when Org mode is activated
after visiting a file. {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} with point in a line
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
starting with =#+= is simply restarting Org mode for the current
buffer.
[fn:42] The corresponding in-buffer setting is: =#+STARTUP: logdone=.
[fn:43] The corresponding in-buffer setting is: =#+STARTUP:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
lognotedone=.
[fn:44] See the variable ~org-log-states-order-reversed~.
[fn:45] Note that the =LOGBOOK= drawer is unfolded when pressing
{{{kbd(SPC)}}} in the agenda to show an entry---use {{{kbd(C-u
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
SPC)}}} to keep it folded here.
[fn:46] It is possible that Org mode records two timestamps when you
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
are using both ~org-log-done~ and state change logging. However, it
never prompts for two notes: if you have configured both, the state
change recording note takes precedence and cancel the closing note.
[fn:47] See also the option ~org-priority-start-cycle-with-default~.
[fn:48] To keep subtasks out of the global TODO list, see the option
~org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels~.
[fn:49] With the exception of description lists. But you can allow it
by modifying ~org-list-automatic-rules~ accordingly.
[fn:50] Set the variable ~org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics~ if you
want such cookies to count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just
those belonging to direct children.
[fn:51] {{{kbd(C-u C-c C-c)}}} on the /first/ item of a list with no
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
checkbox adds checkboxes to the rest of the list.
[fn:52] As with all these in-buffer settings, pressing {{{kbd(C-c
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
C-c)}}} activates any changes in the line.
[fn:53] This is only true if the search does not involve more complex
tests including properties (see [[*Property Searches]]).
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:54] To extend this default list to all tags used in all agenda
files (see [[*Agenda Views]]), customize the variable
~org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags~.
[fn:55] Keys are automatically assigned to tags that have no
configured keys.
[fn:56] If more than one summary type applies to the same property,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
the parent values are computed according to the first of them.
[fn:57] An age can be defined as a duration, using units defined in
~org-duration-units~, e.g., =3d 1h=. If any value in the column is as
such, the summary is also expressed as a duration.
[fn:58] Please note that the =COLUMNS= definition must be on a single
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
line; it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.
[fn:59] Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
distributed with the main distribution of Org---visit
[[https://orgmode.org]].
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:60] The Org date format is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
date/time format. To use an alternative format, see [[*Custom time
format]]. The day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
However, any date inserted or modified by Org adds that day name, for
reading convenience.
[fn:61] When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you need
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order
depends evilly on the variable ~calendar-date-style~. For example, to
specify a date December 12, 2005, the call might look like
=(diary-date 12 1 2005)= or =(diary-date 1 12 2005)= or =(diary-date
2005 12 1)=, depending on the settings. This has been the source of
much confusion. Org mode users can resort to special versions of
these functions like ~org-date~ or ~org-anniversary~. These work just
like the corresponding ~diary-~ functions, but with stable ISO order
of arguments (year, month, day) wherever applicable, independent of
the value of ~calendar-date-style~.
[fn:62] See the variable ~org-read-date-prefer-future~. You may set
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
that variable to the symbol ~time~ to even make a time before now
shift the date to tomorrow.
[fn:63] If you do not need/want the calendar, configure the variable
~org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt~.
[fn:64] If you find this distracting, turn off the display with
~org-read-date-display-live~.
[fn:65] It will still be listed on that date after it has been marked
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
DONE. If you do not like this, set the variable
~org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done~.
[fn:66] The =SCHEDULED= and =DEADLINE= dates are inserted on the line
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
right below the headline. Do not put any text between this line and
the headline.
[fn:67] Note the corresponding =STARTUP= options =logredeadline=,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=lognoteredeadline=, and =nologredeadline=.
[fn:68] Note the corresponding =STARTUP= options =logreschedule=,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=lognotereschedule=, and =nologreschedule=.
[fn:69] In fact, the target state is taken from, in this sequence, the
2017-12-29 14:37:14 -05:00
=REPEAT_TO_STATE= property, the variable ~org-todo-repeat-to-state~ if
it is a string, the previous TODO state if ~org-todo-repeat-to-state~
is ~t~, or the first state of the TODO state sequence.
[fn:70] You can change this using the option ~org-log-repeat~, or the
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=STARTUP= options =logrepeat=, =lognoterepeat=, and =nologrepeat=.
With =lognoterepeat=, you will also be prompted for a note.
[fn:71] Clocking only works if all headings are indented with less
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
than 30 stars. This is a hard-coded limitation of ~lmax~ in
~org-clock-sum~.
[fn:72] To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
on this task while outside Emacs, use =(setq org-clock-persist t)=.
[fn:73] To add an effort estimate "on the fly", hook a function doing
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
this to ~org-clock-in-prepare-hook~.
[fn:74] The last reset of the task is recorded by the =LAST_REPEAT=
property.
[fn:75] See also the variable ~org-clock-mode-line-total~.
[fn:76] The corresponding in-buffer setting is: =#+STARTUP:
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
lognoteclock-out=.
[fn:77] Language terms can be set through the variable
~org-clock-clocktable-language-setup~.
[fn:78] Note that all parameters must be specified in a single
line---the line is broken here only to fit it into the manual.
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[fn:79] On computers using macOS, idleness is based on actual user
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For X11, you can install
a utility program =x11idle.c=, available in the =contrib/scripts/=
directory of the Org Git distribution, or install the xprintidle
package and set it to the variable ~org-clock-x11idle-program-name~ if
you are running Debian, to get the same general treatment of idleness.
On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time only.
[fn:80] Please note the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in
a flat list (see [[*Using Column View in the Agenda]]).
[fn:81] Org used to offer four different targets for date/week tree
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
capture. Now, Org automatically translates these to use
~file+olp+datetree~, applying the ~:time-prompt~ and ~:tree-type~
properties. Please rewrite your date/week-tree targets using
~file+olp+datetree~ since the older targets are now deprecated.
[fn:82] A date tree is an outline structure with years on the highest
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
level, months or ISO weeks as sublevels and then dates on the lowest
level. Tags are allowed in the tree structure.
[fn:83] If you need one of these sequences literally, escape the =%=
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
with a backslash.
[fn:84] If you define your own link types (see [[*Adding Hyperlink
Types]]), any property you store with ~org-store-link-props~ can be
accessed in capture templates in a similar way.
[fn:85] This is always the other, not the user. See the variable
~org-from-is-user-regexp~.
[fn:86] If you move entries or Org files from one directory to
another, you may want to configure ~org-attach-directory~ to contain
an absolute path.
[fn:87] Note the corresponding =STARTUP= options =logrefile=,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=lognoterefile=, and =nologrefile=.
[fn:88] If the value of that variable is not a list, but a single file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
name, then the list of agenda files in maintained in that external
file.
[fn:89] When using the dispatcher, pressing {{{kbd(<)}}} before
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
selecting a command actually limits the command to the current file,
and ignores ~org-agenda-files~ until the next dispatcher command.
[fn:90] For backward compatibility, you can also press {{{kbd(1)}}} to
restrict to the current buffer.
[fn:91] For backward compatibility, you can also press {{{kbd(0)}}} to
restrict to the current region/subtree.
[fn:92] For backward compatibility, the universal prefix argument
{{{kbd(C-u)}}} causes all TODO entries to be listed before the agenda.
This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO list, or a block
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
agenda instead (see [[*Block agenda]]).
[fn:93] The variable ~org-anniversary~ used in the example is just
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
like ~diary-anniversary~, but the argument order is always according
to ISO and therefore independent of the value of
~calendar-date-style~.
[fn:94] You can, however, disable this by setting
2018-04-24 17:26:27 -04:00
~org-agenda-search-headline-for-time~ variable to a ~nil~ value.
[fn:95] Custom commands can preset a filter by binding the variable
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-agenda-tag-filter-preset~ as an option. This filter is then
applied to the view and persists as a basic filter through refreshes
and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of the
entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in
the global options section, not in the section of an individual block.
[fn:96] Only tags filtering is respected here, effort filtering is
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
ignored.
[fn:97] You can also create persistent custom functions through
~org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions~.
[fn:98] This file is parsed for the agenda when
~org-agenda-include-diary~ is set.
[fn:99] You can provide a description for a prefix key by inserting
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a cons cell with the prefix and the description.
[fn:100] /Planned/ means here that these entries have some planning
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
information attached to them, like a time-stamp, a scheduled or
a deadline string. See ~org-agenda-entry-types~ on how to set what
planning information is taken into account.
[fn:101] For HTML you need to install Hrvoje Niksic's =htmlize.el=
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
from [[https://github.com/hniksic/emacs-htmlize][Hrvoje Niksic's repository]].
[fn:102] To create PDF output, the Ghostscript ps2pdf utility must be
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
installed on the system. Selecting a PDF file also creates the
postscript file.
[fn:103] If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda or
the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
them in order to be able to specify file names.
[fn:104] Quoting depends on the system you use, please check the FAQ
for examples.
[fn:105] You can turn this on by default by setting the variable
~org-pretty-entities~, or on a per-file base with the =STARTUP= option
=entitiespretty=.
[fn:106] This behavior can be disabled with =-= export setting (see
[[*Export Settings]]).
[fn:107] LaTeX is a macro system based on Donald\nbsp{}E.\nbsp{}Knuth's TeX
system. Many of the features described here as "LaTeX" are really
from TeX, but for simplicity I am blurring this distinction.
[fn:108] When MathJax is used, only the environments recognized by
MathJax are processed. When dvipng, dvisvgm, or ImageMagick suite is
used to create images, any LaTeX environment is handled.
[fn:109] These are respectively available at
[[http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/]], [[http://dvisvgm.bplaced.net/]]
and from the ImageMagick suite. Choose the converter by setting the
variable ~org-preview-latex-default-process~ accordingly.
[fn:110] Org mode has a method to test if point is inside such
a fragment, see the documentation of the function
~org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p~.
[fn:111] This works automatically for the HTML backend (it requires
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
version 1.34 of the =htmlize.el= package, which you need to install).
Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be achieved using either the
[[https://www.ctan.org/pkg/listings][listings]] package or the [[https://www.ctan.org/pkg/minted][minted]] package. Refer to
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
~org-export-latex-listings~ for details.
[fn:112] Source code in code blocks may also be evaluated either
interactively or on export. See [[*Working with Source Code]] for more
information on evaluating code blocks.
[fn:113] Adding =-k= to =-n -r= /keeps/ the labels in the source code
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
while using line numbers for the links, which might be useful to
explain those in an Org mode example code.
[fn:114] Upon exit, lines starting with =*=, =,*=, =#+= and =,#+= get
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted by Org as
outline nodes or special syntax. These commas are stripped when
editing with {{{kbd(C-c ')}}}, and also before export.
[fn:115] You may select a different-mode with the variable
~org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode~.
[fn:116] What Emacs considers to be an image depends on
~image-file-name-extensions~ and ~image-file-name-regexps~.
[fn:117] The variable ~org-startup-with-inline-images~ can be set
within a buffer with the =STARTUP= options =inlineimages= and
=noinlineimages=.
[fn:118] The variable ~org-export-date-timestamp-format~ defines how
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
this timestamp are exported.
[fn:119] For export to LaTeX format---or LaTeX-related formats such as
Beamer---, the =org-latex-package-alist= variable needs further
configuration. See [[LaTeX specific export settings]].
[fn:120] At the moment, some export back-ends do not obey this
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
specification. For example, LaTeX export excludes every unnumbered
headline from the table of contents.
[fn:121] Note that ~org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline~ is
locally bound to non-~nil~. Therefore, ~org-link-search~ only matches
headlines and named elements.
[fn:122] Since commas separate the arguments, commas within arguments
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
have to be escaped with the backslash character. So only those
backslash characters before a comma need escaping with another
backslash character.
[fn:123] For a less drastic behavior, consider using a select tag (see
[[*Export Settings]]) instead.
[fn:124] If =BEAMER_ENV= is set, Org export adds =B_environment= tag
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
to make it visible. The tag serves as a visual aid and has no
semantic relevance.
[fn:125] By default Org loads MathJax from [[https://cdnjs.com][cdnjs.com]] as recommended by
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
[[http://www.mathjax.org][MathJax]].
[fn:126] Please note that exported formulas are part of an HTML
document, and that signs such as =<=, =>=, or =&= have special
meanings. See [[http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/tex.html#tex-and-latex-in-html-documents][MathJax TeX and LaTeX support]].
[fn:127] See [[http://docs.mathjax.org/en/latest/tex.html#tex-extensions][TeX and LaTeX extensions]] in the [[http://docs.mathjax.org][MathJax manual]] to learn
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
about extensions.
[fn:128] If the classes on TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
use the variables ~org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix~ and
~org-html-tag-class-prefix~ to make them unique.
[fn:129] This does not allow setting different bibliography compilers
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
for different files. However, "smart" LaTeX compilation systems, such
as latexmk, can select the correct bibliography compiler.
[fn:130] See [[http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html][Open Document Format for Office Applications
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
(OpenDocument) Version 1.2]].
[fn:131] See [[http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl][MathToWeb]].
[fn:132] See [[http://dlmf.nist.gov/LaTeXML/]].
[fn:133] [[http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html][OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification]]
[fn:134] See the =<table:table-template>= element of the
OpenDocument-v1.2 specification.
[fn:135] See the attributes =table:template-name=,
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=table:use-first-row-styles=, =table:use-last-row-styles=,
=table:use-first-column-styles=, =table:use-last-column-styles=,
=table:use-banding-rows-styles=, and =table:use-banding-column-styles=
of the =<table:table>= element in the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification.
[fn:136] If the publishing directory is the same as the source
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
directory, =file.org= is exported as =file.org.org=, so you probably
do not want to do this.
[fn:137] The option ~org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c~ can be used
to remove code evaluation from the {{{kbd(C-c C-c)}}} key binding.
[fn:138] Actually, the constructs =call_<name>()= and =src_<lang>{}=
are not evaluated when they appear in a keyword (see [[*Summary of
In-Buffer Settings]]).
[fn:139] Due to the way this header argument is implemented, it
implies ":results file". Therefore if it is set for multiple blocks
at once (by a subtree or buffer property for example), all blocks are
forced to produce file results. This is seldom desired behavior, so
it is recommended to set this header only on a per-block basis. It is
possible that this aspect of the implementation might change in the
future.
[fn:140] C++ language is handled in =ob-C.el=. Even though the
identifier for such source blocks is =C++=, you activate it by loading
the C language.
[fn:141] D language is handled in =ob-C.el=. Even though the
identifier for such source blocks is =D=, you activate it by loading
the C language.
[fn:142] For Noweb literate programming details, see
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/.
[fn:143] For more information, please refer to the commentary section
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
in =org-tempo.el=.
[fn:144] Note that ~org-indent-mode~ also sets the ~wrap-prefix~
property, such that ~visual-line-mode~ (or purely setting ~word-wrap~)
wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
[fn:145] The ~org-indent-mode~ also sets the ~wrap-prefix~ correctly
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
for indenting and wrapping long lines of headlines or text. This
minor mode handles ~visual-line-mode~ and directly applied settings
through ~word-wrap~.
[fn:146] Also see the variable ~org-adapt-indentation~.
[fn:147] Because =LEVEL=2= has 3 stars, =LEVEL=3= has 4 stars, and so
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
on.
[fn:148] For a server to host files, consider using a WebDAV server,
such as [[https://nextcloud.com][Nextcloud]]. Additional help is at this [[https://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav][FAQ entry]].
[fn:149] If Emacs is configured for safe storing of passwords, then
configure the variable ~org-mobile-encryption-password~; please read
the docstring of that variable.
[fn:150] Symbolic links in ~org-directory~ need to have the same name
as their targets.
[fn:151] While creating the agendas, Org mode forces =ID= properties
on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely
identified if Org Mobile flags them for further action. To avoid
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
setting properties configure the variable
~org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items~ to ~nil~. Org mode then relies
on outline paths, assuming they are unique.
[fn:152] Checksums are stored automatically in the file
2017-06-05 12:02:33 -04:00
=checksums.dat=.
[fn:153] The file will be empty after this operation.
[fn:154] https://www.ctan.org/pkg/comment
[fn:155] If the =TBLFM= keyword contains an odd number of dollar
characters, this may cause problems with Font Lock in LaTeX mode. As
shown in the example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside
the =comment= environment that is used to balance the dollar
expressions. If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library,
a much better solution is to add the =comment= environment to the
variable ~LaTeX-verbatim-environments~.
[fn:156] The ~agenda*~ view is the same as ~agenda~ except that it
only considers /appointments/, i.e., scheduled and deadline items that
have a time specification =[h]h:mm= in their time-stamps.
[fn:157] Note that, for ~org-odd-levels-only~, a level number
corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of stars.